blob: 687b92e21bb21057a4aaeb334c34963ab3d0ec69 [file] [log] [blame]
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00001//===--- SemaExpr.cpp - Semantic Analysis for Expressions -----------------===//
2//
3// The LLVM Compiler Infrastructure
4//
Chris Lattner0bc735f2007-12-29 19:59:25 +00005// This file is distributed under the University of Illinois Open Source
6// License. See LICENSE.TXT for details.
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00007//
8//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
9//
10// This file implements semantic analysis for expressions.
11//
12//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
13
John McCall2d887082010-08-25 22:03:47 +000014#include "clang/Sema/SemaInternal.h"
Douglas Gregore737f502010-08-12 20:07:10 +000015#include "clang/Sema/Initialization.h"
16#include "clang/Sema/Lookup.h"
17#include "clang/Sema/AnalysisBasedWarnings.h"
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +000018#include "clang/AST/ASTContext.h"
Douglas Gregorcc8a5d52010-04-29 00:18:15 +000019#include "clang/AST/CXXInheritance.h"
Daniel Dunbarc4a1dea2008-08-11 05:35:13 +000020#include "clang/AST/DeclObjC.h"
Anders Carlssond497ba72009-08-26 22:59:12 +000021#include "clang/AST/DeclTemplate.h"
Douglas Gregorbe0f7bd2010-09-11 20:24:53 +000022#include "clang/AST/EvaluatedExprVisitor.h"
Douglas Gregor8ecdb652010-04-28 22:16:22 +000023#include "clang/AST/Expr.h"
Chris Lattner04421082008-04-08 04:40:51 +000024#include "clang/AST/ExprCXX.h"
Steve Narofff494b572008-05-29 21:12:08 +000025#include "clang/AST/ExprObjC.h"
Douglas Gregorb4eeaff2010-05-07 23:12:07 +000026#include "clang/AST/RecursiveASTVisitor.h"
Douglas Gregor8ecdb652010-04-28 22:16:22 +000027#include "clang/AST/TypeLoc.h"
Anders Carlssond497ba72009-08-26 22:59:12 +000028#include "clang/Basic/PartialDiagnostic.h"
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +000029#include "clang/Basic/SourceManager.h"
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +000030#include "clang/Basic/TargetInfo.h"
Anders Carlssond497ba72009-08-26 22:59:12 +000031#include "clang/Lex/LiteralSupport.h"
32#include "clang/Lex/Preprocessor.h"
John McCall19510852010-08-20 18:27:03 +000033#include "clang/Sema/DeclSpec.h"
34#include "clang/Sema/Designator.h"
35#include "clang/Sema/Scope.h"
John McCall781472f2010-08-25 08:40:02 +000036#include "clang/Sema/ScopeInfo.h"
John McCall19510852010-08-20 18:27:03 +000037#include "clang/Sema/ParsedTemplate.h"
John McCall7cd088e2010-08-24 07:21:54 +000038#include "clang/Sema/Template.h"
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +000039using namespace clang;
John McCall781472f2010-08-25 08:40:02 +000040using namespace sema;
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +000041
David Chisnall0f436562009-08-17 16:35:33 +000042
Douglas Gregor48f3bb92009-02-18 21:56:37 +000043/// \brief Determine whether the use of this declaration is valid, and
44/// emit any corresponding diagnostics.
45///
46/// This routine diagnoses various problems with referencing
47/// declarations that can occur when using a declaration. For example,
48/// it might warn if a deprecated or unavailable declaration is being
49/// used, or produce an error (and return true) if a C++0x deleted
50/// function is being used.
51///
Chris Lattner52338262009-10-25 22:31:57 +000052/// If IgnoreDeprecated is set to true, this should not want about deprecated
53/// decls.
54///
Douglas Gregor48f3bb92009-02-18 21:56:37 +000055/// \returns true if there was an error (this declaration cannot be
56/// referenced), false otherwise.
Chris Lattner52338262009-10-25 22:31:57 +000057///
John McCall54abf7d2009-11-04 02:18:39 +000058bool Sema::DiagnoseUseOfDecl(NamedDecl *D, SourceLocation Loc) {
Douglas Gregor9b623632010-10-12 23:32:35 +000059 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus && isa<FunctionDecl>(D)) {
60 // If there were any diagnostics suppressed by template argument deduction,
61 // emit them now.
62 llvm::DenseMap<Decl *, llvm::SmallVector<PartialDiagnosticAt, 1> >::iterator
63 Pos = SuppressedDiagnostics.find(D->getCanonicalDecl());
64 if (Pos != SuppressedDiagnostics.end()) {
65 llvm::SmallVectorImpl<PartialDiagnosticAt> &Suppressed = Pos->second;
66 for (unsigned I = 0, N = Suppressed.size(); I != N; ++I)
67 Diag(Suppressed[I].first, Suppressed[I].second);
68
69 // Clear out the list of suppressed diagnostics, so that we don't emit
70 // them again for this specialization. However, we don't remove this
71 // entry from the table, because we want to avoid ever emitting these
72 // diagnostics again.
73 Suppressed.clear();
74 }
75 }
76
Chris Lattner76a642f2009-02-15 22:43:40 +000077 // See if the decl is deprecated.
Benjamin Kramerce2d1862010-10-09 15:49:00 +000078 if (const DeprecatedAttr *DA = D->getAttr<DeprecatedAttr>())
79 EmitDeprecationWarning(D, DA->getMessage(), Loc);
Chris Lattner76a642f2009-02-15 22:43:40 +000080
Chris Lattnerffb93682009-10-25 17:21:40 +000081 // See if the decl is unavailable
Fariborz Jahanianc784dc12010-10-06 23:12:32 +000082 if (const UnavailableAttr *UA = D->getAttr<UnavailableAttr>()) {
83 if (UA->getMessage().empty())
84 Diag(Loc, diag::err_unavailable) << D->getDeclName();
85 else
86 Diag(Loc, diag::err_unavailable_message)
Benjamin Kramerce2d1862010-10-09 15:49:00 +000087 << D->getDeclName() << UA->getMessage();
Chris Lattnerffb93682009-10-25 17:21:40 +000088 Diag(D->getLocation(), diag::note_unavailable_here) << 0;
89 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +000090
Douglas Gregor48f3bb92009-02-18 21:56:37 +000091 // See if this is a deleted function.
Douglas Gregor25d944a2009-02-24 04:26:15 +000092 if (FunctionDecl *FD = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(D)) {
Douglas Gregor48f3bb92009-02-18 21:56:37 +000093 if (FD->isDeleted()) {
94 Diag(Loc, diag::err_deleted_function_use);
95 Diag(D->getLocation(), diag::note_unavailable_here) << true;
96 return true;
97 }
Douglas Gregor25d944a2009-02-24 04:26:15 +000098 }
Douglas Gregor48f3bb92009-02-18 21:56:37 +000099
Anders Carlsson2127ecc2010-10-22 23:37:08 +0000100 // Warn if this is used but marked unused.
101 if (D->hasAttr<UnusedAttr>())
102 Diag(Loc, diag::warn_used_but_marked_unused) << D->getDeclName();
103
Douglas Gregor48f3bb92009-02-18 21:56:37 +0000104 return false;
Chris Lattner76a642f2009-02-15 22:43:40 +0000105}
106
Fariborz Jahanian5b530052009-05-13 18:09:35 +0000107/// DiagnoseSentinelCalls - This routine checks on method dispatch calls
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000108/// (and other functions in future), which have been declared with sentinel
Fariborz Jahanian5b530052009-05-13 18:09:35 +0000109/// attribute. It warns if call does not have the sentinel argument.
110///
111void Sema::DiagnoseSentinelCalls(NamedDecl *D, SourceLocation Loc,
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000112 Expr **Args, unsigned NumArgs) {
Argyrios Kyrtzidis40b598e2009-06-30 02:34:44 +0000113 const SentinelAttr *attr = D->getAttr<SentinelAttr>();
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000114 if (!attr)
Fariborz Jahanian88f1ba02009-05-13 23:20:50 +0000115 return;
Douglas Gregor92e986e2010-04-22 16:44:27 +0000116
117 // FIXME: In C++0x, if any of the arguments are parameter pack
118 // expansions, we can't check for the sentinel now.
Fariborz Jahanian88f1ba02009-05-13 23:20:50 +0000119 int sentinelPos = attr->getSentinel();
120 int nullPos = attr->getNullPos();
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000121
Mike Stump390b4cc2009-05-16 07:39:55 +0000122 // FIXME. ObjCMethodDecl and FunctionDecl need be derived from the same common
123 // base class. Then we won't be needing two versions of the same code.
Fariborz Jahanian88f1ba02009-05-13 23:20:50 +0000124 unsigned int i = 0;
Fariborz Jahanian236673e2009-05-14 18:00:00 +0000125 bool warnNotEnoughArgs = false;
126 int isMethod = 0;
127 if (ObjCMethodDecl *MD = dyn_cast<ObjCMethodDecl>(D)) {
128 // skip over named parameters.
129 ObjCMethodDecl::param_iterator P, E = MD->param_end();
130 for (P = MD->param_begin(); (P != E && i < NumArgs); ++P) {
131 if (nullPos)
132 --nullPos;
133 else
134 ++i;
135 }
136 warnNotEnoughArgs = (P != E || i >= NumArgs);
137 isMethod = 1;
Mike Stumpac5fc7c2009-08-04 21:02:39 +0000138 } else if (FunctionDecl *FD = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(D)) {
Fariborz Jahanian236673e2009-05-14 18:00:00 +0000139 // skip over named parameters.
140 ObjCMethodDecl::param_iterator P, E = FD->param_end();
141 for (P = FD->param_begin(); (P != E && i < NumArgs); ++P) {
142 if (nullPos)
143 --nullPos;
144 else
145 ++i;
146 }
147 warnNotEnoughArgs = (P != E || i >= NumArgs);
Mike Stumpac5fc7c2009-08-04 21:02:39 +0000148 } else if (VarDecl *V = dyn_cast<VarDecl>(D)) {
Fariborz Jahaniandaf04152009-05-15 20:33:25 +0000149 // block or function pointer call.
150 QualType Ty = V->getType();
151 if (Ty->isBlockPointerType() || Ty->isFunctionPointerType()) {
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000152 const FunctionType *FT = Ty->isFunctionPointerType()
John McCall183700f2009-09-21 23:43:11 +0000153 ? Ty->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType()->getAs<FunctionType>()
154 : Ty->getAs<BlockPointerType>()->getPointeeType()->getAs<FunctionType>();
Fariborz Jahaniandaf04152009-05-15 20:33:25 +0000155 if (const FunctionProtoType *Proto = dyn_cast<FunctionProtoType>(FT)) {
156 unsigned NumArgsInProto = Proto->getNumArgs();
157 unsigned k;
158 for (k = 0; (k != NumArgsInProto && i < NumArgs); k++) {
159 if (nullPos)
160 --nullPos;
161 else
162 ++i;
163 }
164 warnNotEnoughArgs = (k != NumArgsInProto || i >= NumArgs);
165 }
166 if (Ty->isBlockPointerType())
167 isMethod = 2;
Mike Stumpac5fc7c2009-08-04 21:02:39 +0000168 } else
Fariborz Jahaniandaf04152009-05-15 20:33:25 +0000169 return;
Mike Stumpac5fc7c2009-08-04 21:02:39 +0000170 } else
Fariborz Jahanian236673e2009-05-14 18:00:00 +0000171 return;
172
173 if (warnNotEnoughArgs) {
Fariborz Jahanian88f1ba02009-05-13 23:20:50 +0000174 Diag(Loc, diag::warn_not_enough_argument) << D->getDeclName();
Fariborz Jahanian236673e2009-05-14 18:00:00 +0000175 Diag(D->getLocation(), diag::note_sentinel_here) << isMethod;
Fariborz Jahanian88f1ba02009-05-13 23:20:50 +0000176 return;
177 }
178 int sentinel = i;
179 while (sentinelPos > 0 && i < NumArgs-1) {
180 --sentinelPos;
181 ++i;
182 }
183 if (sentinelPos > 0) {
184 Diag(Loc, diag::warn_not_enough_argument) << D->getDeclName();
Fariborz Jahanian236673e2009-05-14 18:00:00 +0000185 Diag(D->getLocation(), diag::note_sentinel_here) << isMethod;
Fariborz Jahanian88f1ba02009-05-13 23:20:50 +0000186 return;
187 }
188 while (i < NumArgs-1) {
189 ++i;
190 ++sentinel;
191 }
192 Expr *sentinelExpr = Args[sentinel];
John McCall8eb662e2010-05-06 23:53:00 +0000193 if (!sentinelExpr) return;
194 if (sentinelExpr->isTypeDependent()) return;
195 if (sentinelExpr->isValueDependent()) return;
Anders Carlsson343e6ff2010-11-05 15:21:33 +0000196
197 // nullptr_t is always treated as null.
198 if (sentinelExpr->getType()->isNullPtrType()) return;
199
Fariborz Jahanian9ccd7252010-07-14 16:37:51 +0000200 if (sentinelExpr->getType()->isAnyPointerType() &&
John McCall8eb662e2010-05-06 23:53:00 +0000201 sentinelExpr->IgnoreParenCasts()->isNullPointerConstant(Context,
202 Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNull))
203 return;
204
205 // Unfortunately, __null has type 'int'.
206 if (isa<GNUNullExpr>(sentinelExpr)) return;
207
208 Diag(Loc, diag::warn_missing_sentinel) << isMethod;
209 Diag(D->getLocation(), diag::note_sentinel_here) << isMethod;
Fariborz Jahanian5b530052009-05-13 18:09:35 +0000210}
211
Douglas Gregor4b2d3f72009-02-26 21:00:50 +0000212SourceRange Sema::getExprRange(ExprTy *E) const {
213 Expr *Ex = (Expr *)E;
214 return Ex? Ex->getSourceRange() : SourceRange();
215}
216
Chris Lattnere7a2e912008-07-25 21:10:04 +0000217//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
218// Standard Promotions and Conversions
219//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
220
Chris Lattnere7a2e912008-07-25 21:10:04 +0000221/// DefaultFunctionArrayConversion (C99 6.3.2.1p3, C99 6.3.2.1p4).
222void Sema::DefaultFunctionArrayConversion(Expr *&E) {
223 QualType Ty = E->getType();
224 assert(!Ty.isNull() && "DefaultFunctionArrayConversion - missing type");
225
Chris Lattnere7a2e912008-07-25 21:10:04 +0000226 if (Ty->isFunctionType())
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000227 ImpCastExprToType(E, Context.getPointerType(Ty),
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +0000228 CK_FunctionToPointerDecay);
Chris Lattner67d33d82008-07-25 21:33:13 +0000229 else if (Ty->isArrayType()) {
230 // In C90 mode, arrays only promote to pointers if the array expression is
231 // an lvalue. The relevant legalese is C90 6.2.2.1p3: "an lvalue that has
232 // type 'array of type' is converted to an expression that has type 'pointer
233 // to type'...". In C99 this was changed to: C99 6.3.2.1p3: "an expression
234 // that has type 'array of type' ...". The relevant change is "an lvalue"
235 // (C90) to "an expression" (C99).
Argyrios Kyrtzidisc39a3d72008-09-11 04:25:59 +0000236 //
237 // C++ 4.2p1:
238 // An lvalue or rvalue of type "array of N T" or "array of unknown bound of
239 // T" can be converted to an rvalue of type "pointer to T".
240 //
241 if (getLangOptions().C99 || getLangOptions().CPlusPlus ||
242 E->isLvalue(Context) == Expr::LV_Valid)
Anders Carlsson112a0a82009-08-07 23:48:20 +0000243 ImpCastExprToType(E, Context.getArrayDecayedType(Ty),
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +0000244 CK_ArrayToPointerDecay);
Chris Lattner67d33d82008-07-25 21:33:13 +0000245 }
Chris Lattnere7a2e912008-07-25 21:10:04 +0000246}
247
Douglas Gregora873dfc2010-02-03 00:27:59 +0000248void Sema::DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion(Expr *&E) {
249 DefaultFunctionArrayConversion(E);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +0000250
Douglas Gregora873dfc2010-02-03 00:27:59 +0000251 QualType Ty = E->getType();
252 assert(!Ty.isNull() && "DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion - missing type");
253 if (!Ty->isDependentType() && Ty.hasQualifiers() &&
254 (!getLangOptions().CPlusPlus || !Ty->isRecordType()) &&
255 E->isLvalue(Context) == Expr::LV_Valid) {
256 // C++ [conv.lval]p1:
257 // [...] If T is a non-class type, the type of the rvalue is the
258 // cv-unqualified version of T. Otherwise, the type of the
259 // rvalue is T
260 //
261 // C99 6.3.2.1p2:
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +0000262 // If the lvalue has qualified type, the value has the unqualified
263 // version of the type of the lvalue; otherwise, the value has the
Douglas Gregora873dfc2010-02-03 00:27:59 +0000264 // type of the lvalue.
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +0000265 ImpCastExprToType(E, Ty.getUnqualifiedType(), CK_NoOp);
Douglas Gregora873dfc2010-02-03 00:27:59 +0000266 }
267}
268
269
Chris Lattnere7a2e912008-07-25 21:10:04 +0000270/// UsualUnaryConversions - Performs various conversions that are common to most
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000271/// operators (C99 6.3). The conversions of array and function types are
Chris Lattnere7a2e912008-07-25 21:10:04 +0000272/// sometimes surpressed. For example, the array->pointer conversion doesn't
273/// apply if the array is an argument to the sizeof or address (&) operators.
274/// In these instances, this routine should *not* be called.
275Expr *Sema::UsualUnaryConversions(Expr *&Expr) {
276 QualType Ty = Expr->getType();
277 assert(!Ty.isNull() && "UsualUnaryConversions - missing type");
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000278
Douglas Gregorfc24e442009-05-01 20:41:21 +0000279 // C99 6.3.1.1p2:
280 //
281 // The following may be used in an expression wherever an int or
282 // unsigned int may be used:
283 // - an object or expression with an integer type whose integer
284 // conversion rank is less than or equal to the rank of int
285 // and unsigned int.
286 // - A bit-field of type _Bool, int, signed int, or unsigned int.
287 //
288 // If an int can represent all values of the original type, the
289 // value is converted to an int; otherwise, it is converted to an
290 // unsigned int. These are called the integer promotions. All
291 // other types are unchanged by the integer promotions.
Eli Friedman04e83572009-08-20 04:21:42 +0000292 QualType PTy = Context.isPromotableBitField(Expr);
293 if (!PTy.isNull()) {
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +0000294 ImpCastExprToType(Expr, PTy, CK_IntegralCast);
Eli Friedman04e83572009-08-20 04:21:42 +0000295 return Expr;
296 }
Douglas Gregorfc24e442009-05-01 20:41:21 +0000297 if (Ty->isPromotableIntegerType()) {
Eli Friedmana95d7572009-08-19 07:44:53 +0000298 QualType PT = Context.getPromotedIntegerType(Ty);
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +0000299 ImpCastExprToType(Expr, PT, CK_IntegralCast);
Douglas Gregorfc24e442009-05-01 20:41:21 +0000300 return Expr;
Eli Friedman04e83572009-08-20 04:21:42 +0000301 }
302
Douglas Gregora873dfc2010-02-03 00:27:59 +0000303 DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion(Expr);
Chris Lattnere7a2e912008-07-25 21:10:04 +0000304 return Expr;
305}
306
Chris Lattner05faf172008-07-25 22:25:12 +0000307/// DefaultArgumentPromotion (C99 6.5.2.2p6). Used for function calls that
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000308/// do not have a prototype. Arguments that have type float are promoted to
Chris Lattner05faf172008-07-25 22:25:12 +0000309/// double. All other argument types are converted by UsualUnaryConversions().
310void Sema::DefaultArgumentPromotion(Expr *&Expr) {
311 QualType Ty = Expr->getType();
312 assert(!Ty.isNull() && "DefaultArgumentPromotion - missing type");
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000313
Chris Lattner05faf172008-07-25 22:25:12 +0000314 // If this is a 'float' (CVR qualified or typedef) promote to double.
Chris Lattner40378332010-05-16 04:01:30 +0000315 if (Ty->isSpecificBuiltinType(BuiltinType::Float))
316 return ImpCastExprToType(Expr, Context.DoubleTy,
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +0000317 CK_FloatingCast);
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000318
Chris Lattner05faf172008-07-25 22:25:12 +0000319 UsualUnaryConversions(Expr);
320}
321
Chris Lattner312531a2009-04-12 08:11:20 +0000322/// DefaultVariadicArgumentPromotion - Like DefaultArgumentPromotion, but
323/// will warn if the resulting type is not a POD type, and rejects ObjC
324/// interfaces passed by value. This returns true if the argument type is
325/// completely illegal.
Chris Lattner40378332010-05-16 04:01:30 +0000326bool Sema::DefaultVariadicArgumentPromotion(Expr *&Expr, VariadicCallType CT,
327 FunctionDecl *FDecl) {
Anders Carlssondce5e2c2009-01-16 16:48:51 +0000328 DefaultArgumentPromotion(Expr);
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000329
Chris Lattner40378332010-05-16 04:01:30 +0000330 // __builtin_va_start takes the second argument as a "varargs" argument, but
331 // it doesn't actually do anything with it. It doesn't need to be non-pod
332 // etc.
333 if (FDecl && FDecl->getBuiltinID() == Builtin::BI__builtin_va_start)
334 return false;
335
John McCallc12c5bb2010-05-15 11:32:37 +0000336 if (Expr->getType()->isObjCObjectType() &&
Douglas Gregor1c7c3fb2009-12-22 01:01:55 +0000337 DiagRuntimeBehavior(Expr->getLocStart(),
338 PDiag(diag::err_cannot_pass_objc_interface_to_vararg)
339 << Expr->getType() << CT))
340 return true;
Douglas Gregor75b699a2009-12-12 07:25:49 +0000341
Douglas Gregor1c7c3fb2009-12-22 01:01:55 +0000342 if (!Expr->getType()->isPODType() &&
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +0000343 DiagRuntimeBehavior(Expr->getLocStart(),
Douglas Gregor1c7c3fb2009-12-22 01:01:55 +0000344 PDiag(diag::warn_cannot_pass_non_pod_arg_to_vararg)
345 << Expr->getType() << CT))
346 return true;
Chris Lattner312531a2009-04-12 08:11:20 +0000347
348 return false;
Anders Carlssondce5e2c2009-01-16 16:48:51 +0000349}
350
Chris Lattnere7a2e912008-07-25 21:10:04 +0000351/// UsualArithmeticConversions - Performs various conversions that are common to
352/// binary operators (C99 6.3.1.8). If both operands aren't arithmetic, this
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000353/// routine returns the first non-arithmetic type found. The client is
Chris Lattnere7a2e912008-07-25 21:10:04 +0000354/// responsible for emitting appropriate error diagnostics.
355/// FIXME: verify the conversion rules for "complex int" are consistent with
356/// GCC.
357QualType Sema::UsualArithmeticConversions(Expr *&lhsExpr, Expr *&rhsExpr,
358 bool isCompAssign) {
Eli Friedmanab3a8522009-03-28 01:22:36 +0000359 if (!isCompAssign)
Chris Lattnere7a2e912008-07-25 21:10:04 +0000360 UsualUnaryConversions(lhsExpr);
Eli Friedmanab3a8522009-03-28 01:22:36 +0000361
362 UsualUnaryConversions(rhsExpr);
Douglas Gregoreb8f3062008-11-12 17:17:38 +0000363
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000364 // For conversion purposes, we ignore any qualifiers.
Chris Lattnere7a2e912008-07-25 21:10:04 +0000365 // For example, "const float" and "float" are equivalent.
Chris Lattnerb77792e2008-07-26 22:17:49 +0000366 QualType lhs =
367 Context.getCanonicalType(lhsExpr->getType()).getUnqualifiedType();
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000368 QualType rhs =
Chris Lattnerb77792e2008-07-26 22:17:49 +0000369 Context.getCanonicalType(rhsExpr->getType()).getUnqualifiedType();
Douglas Gregoreb8f3062008-11-12 17:17:38 +0000370
371 // If both types are identical, no conversion is needed.
372 if (lhs == rhs)
373 return lhs;
374
375 // If either side is a non-arithmetic type (e.g. a pointer), we are done.
376 // The caller can deal with this (e.g. pointer + int).
377 if (!lhs->isArithmeticType() || !rhs->isArithmeticType())
378 return lhs;
379
John McCallcf33b242010-11-13 08:17:45 +0000380 // Apply unary and bitfield promotions to the LHS's type.
381 QualType lhs_unpromoted = lhs;
382 if (lhs->isPromotableIntegerType())
383 lhs = Context.getPromotedIntegerType(lhs);
Eli Friedman04e83572009-08-20 04:21:42 +0000384 QualType LHSBitfieldPromoteTy = Context.isPromotableBitField(lhsExpr);
Douglas Gregor2d833e32009-05-02 00:36:19 +0000385 if (!LHSBitfieldPromoteTy.isNull())
386 lhs = LHSBitfieldPromoteTy;
John McCallcf33b242010-11-13 08:17:45 +0000387 if (lhs != lhs_unpromoted && !isCompAssign)
388 ImpCastExprToType(lhsExpr, lhs, CK_IntegralCast);
Douglas Gregor2d833e32009-05-02 00:36:19 +0000389
John McCallcf33b242010-11-13 08:17:45 +0000390 // If both types are identical, no conversion is needed.
391 if (lhs == rhs)
392 return lhs;
393
394 // At this point, we have two different arithmetic types.
395
396 // Handle complex types first (C99 6.3.1.8p1).
397 bool LHSComplexFloat = lhs->isComplexType();
398 bool RHSComplexFloat = rhs->isComplexType();
399 if (LHSComplexFloat || RHSComplexFloat) {
400 // if we have an integer operand, the result is the complex type.
401
John McCall2bb5d002010-11-13 09:02:35 +0000402 if (!RHSComplexFloat && !rhs->isRealFloatingType()) {
403 if (rhs->isIntegerType()) {
404 QualType fp = cast<ComplexType>(lhs)->getElementType();
405 ImpCastExprToType(rhsExpr, fp, CK_IntegralToFloating);
406 ImpCastExprToType(rhsExpr, lhs, CK_FloatingRealToComplex);
407 } else {
408 assert(rhs->isComplexIntegerType());
John McCallf3ea8cf2010-11-14 08:17:51 +0000409 ImpCastExprToType(rhsExpr, lhs, CK_IntegralComplexToFloatingComplex);
John McCall2bb5d002010-11-13 09:02:35 +0000410 }
John McCallcf33b242010-11-13 08:17:45 +0000411 return lhs;
412 }
413
John McCall2bb5d002010-11-13 09:02:35 +0000414 if (!LHSComplexFloat && !lhs->isRealFloatingType()) {
415 if (!isCompAssign) {
416 // int -> float -> _Complex float
417 if (lhs->isIntegerType()) {
418 QualType fp = cast<ComplexType>(rhs)->getElementType();
419 ImpCastExprToType(lhsExpr, fp, CK_IntegralToFloating);
420 ImpCastExprToType(lhsExpr, rhs, CK_FloatingRealToComplex);
421 } else {
422 assert(lhs->isComplexIntegerType());
John McCallf3ea8cf2010-11-14 08:17:51 +0000423 ImpCastExprToType(lhsExpr, rhs, CK_IntegralComplexToFloatingComplex);
John McCall2bb5d002010-11-13 09:02:35 +0000424 }
425 }
John McCallcf33b242010-11-13 08:17:45 +0000426 return rhs;
427 }
428
429 // This handles complex/complex, complex/float, or float/complex.
430 // When both operands are complex, the shorter operand is converted to the
431 // type of the longer, and that is the type of the result. This corresponds
432 // to what is done when combining two real floating-point operands.
433 // The fun begins when size promotion occur across type domains.
434 // From H&S 6.3.4: When one operand is complex and the other is a real
435 // floating-point type, the less precise type is converted, within it's
436 // real or complex domain, to the precision of the other type. For example,
437 // when combining a "long double" with a "double _Complex", the
438 // "double _Complex" is promoted to "long double _Complex".
439 int order = Context.getFloatingTypeOrder(lhs, rhs);
440
441 // If both are complex, just cast to the more precise type.
442 if (LHSComplexFloat && RHSComplexFloat) {
443 if (order > 0) {
444 // _Complex float -> _Complex double
John McCall2bb5d002010-11-13 09:02:35 +0000445 ImpCastExprToType(rhsExpr, lhs, CK_FloatingComplexCast);
John McCallcf33b242010-11-13 08:17:45 +0000446 return lhs;
447
448 } else if (order < 0) {
449 // _Complex float -> _Complex double
450 if (!isCompAssign)
John McCall2bb5d002010-11-13 09:02:35 +0000451 ImpCastExprToType(lhsExpr, rhs, CK_FloatingComplexCast);
John McCallcf33b242010-11-13 08:17:45 +0000452 return rhs;
453 }
454 return lhs;
455 }
456
457 // If just the LHS is complex, the RHS needs to be converted,
458 // and the LHS might need to be promoted.
459 if (LHSComplexFloat) {
460 if (order > 0) { // LHS is wider
461 // float -> _Complex double
John McCall2bb5d002010-11-13 09:02:35 +0000462 QualType fp = cast<ComplexType>(lhs)->getElementType();
463 ImpCastExprToType(rhsExpr, fp, CK_FloatingCast);
464 ImpCastExprToType(rhsExpr, lhs, CK_FloatingRealToComplex);
John McCallcf33b242010-11-13 08:17:45 +0000465 return lhs;
466 }
467
468 // RHS is at least as wide. Find its corresponding complex type.
469 QualType result = (order == 0 ? lhs : Context.getComplexType(rhs));
470
471 // double -> _Complex double
John McCall2bb5d002010-11-13 09:02:35 +0000472 ImpCastExprToType(rhsExpr, result, CK_FloatingRealToComplex);
John McCallcf33b242010-11-13 08:17:45 +0000473
474 // _Complex float -> _Complex double
475 if (!isCompAssign && order < 0)
John McCall2bb5d002010-11-13 09:02:35 +0000476 ImpCastExprToType(lhsExpr, result, CK_FloatingComplexCast);
John McCallcf33b242010-11-13 08:17:45 +0000477
478 return result;
479 }
480
481 // Just the RHS is complex, so the LHS needs to be converted
482 // and the RHS might need to be promoted.
483 assert(RHSComplexFloat);
484
485 if (order < 0) { // RHS is wider
486 // float -> _Complex double
John McCall2bb5d002010-11-13 09:02:35 +0000487 if (!isCompAssign) {
488 ImpCastExprToType(lhsExpr, rhs, CK_FloatingCast);
489 ImpCastExprToType(lhsExpr, rhs, CK_FloatingRealToComplex);
490 }
John McCallcf33b242010-11-13 08:17:45 +0000491 return rhs;
492 }
493
494 // LHS is at least as wide. Find its corresponding complex type.
495 QualType result = (order == 0 ? rhs : Context.getComplexType(lhs));
496
497 // double -> _Complex double
498 if (!isCompAssign)
John McCall2bb5d002010-11-13 09:02:35 +0000499 ImpCastExprToType(lhsExpr, result, CK_FloatingRealToComplex);
John McCallcf33b242010-11-13 08:17:45 +0000500
501 // _Complex float -> _Complex double
502 if (order > 0)
John McCall2bb5d002010-11-13 09:02:35 +0000503 ImpCastExprToType(rhsExpr, result, CK_FloatingComplexCast);
John McCallcf33b242010-11-13 08:17:45 +0000504
505 return result;
506 }
507
508 // Now handle "real" floating types (i.e. float, double, long double).
509 bool LHSFloat = lhs->isRealFloatingType();
510 bool RHSFloat = rhs->isRealFloatingType();
511 if (LHSFloat || RHSFloat) {
512 // If we have two real floating types, convert the smaller operand
513 // to the bigger result.
514 if (LHSFloat && RHSFloat) {
515 int order = Context.getFloatingTypeOrder(lhs, rhs);
516 if (order > 0) {
517 ImpCastExprToType(rhsExpr, lhs, CK_FloatingCast);
518 return lhs;
519 }
520
521 assert(order < 0 && "illegal float comparison");
522 if (!isCompAssign)
523 ImpCastExprToType(lhsExpr, rhs, CK_FloatingCast);
524 return rhs;
525 }
526
527 // If we have an integer operand, the result is the real floating type.
528 if (LHSFloat) {
529 if (rhs->isIntegerType()) {
530 // Convert rhs to the lhs floating point type.
531 ImpCastExprToType(rhsExpr, lhs, CK_IntegralToFloating);
532 return lhs;
533 }
534
535 // Convert both sides to the appropriate complex float.
536 assert(rhs->isComplexIntegerType());
537 QualType result = Context.getComplexType(lhs);
538
539 // _Complex int -> _Complex float
John McCallf3ea8cf2010-11-14 08:17:51 +0000540 ImpCastExprToType(rhsExpr, result, CK_IntegralComplexToFloatingComplex);
John McCallcf33b242010-11-13 08:17:45 +0000541
542 // float -> _Complex float
543 if (!isCompAssign)
John McCall2bb5d002010-11-13 09:02:35 +0000544 ImpCastExprToType(lhsExpr, result, CK_FloatingRealToComplex);
John McCallcf33b242010-11-13 08:17:45 +0000545
546 return result;
547 }
548
549 assert(RHSFloat);
550 if (lhs->isIntegerType()) {
551 // Convert lhs to the rhs floating point type.
552 if (!isCompAssign)
553 ImpCastExprToType(lhsExpr, rhs, CK_IntegralToFloating);
554 return rhs;
555 }
556
557 // Convert both sides to the appropriate complex float.
558 assert(lhs->isComplexIntegerType());
559 QualType result = Context.getComplexType(rhs);
560
561 // _Complex int -> _Complex float
562 if (!isCompAssign)
John McCallf3ea8cf2010-11-14 08:17:51 +0000563 ImpCastExprToType(lhsExpr, result, CK_IntegralComplexToFloatingComplex);
John McCallcf33b242010-11-13 08:17:45 +0000564
565 // float -> _Complex float
John McCall2bb5d002010-11-13 09:02:35 +0000566 ImpCastExprToType(rhsExpr, result, CK_FloatingRealToComplex);
John McCallcf33b242010-11-13 08:17:45 +0000567
568 return result;
569 }
570
571 // Handle GCC complex int extension.
572 // FIXME: if the operands are (int, _Complex long), we currently
573 // don't promote the complex. Also, signedness?
574 const ComplexType *lhsComplexInt = lhs->getAsComplexIntegerType();
575 const ComplexType *rhsComplexInt = rhs->getAsComplexIntegerType();
576 if (lhsComplexInt && rhsComplexInt) {
577 int order = Context.getIntegerTypeOrder(lhsComplexInt->getElementType(),
578 rhsComplexInt->getElementType());
579 assert(order && "inequal types with equal element ordering");
580 if (order > 0) {
581 // _Complex int -> _Complex long
John McCall2bb5d002010-11-13 09:02:35 +0000582 ImpCastExprToType(rhsExpr, lhs, CK_IntegralComplexCast);
John McCallcf33b242010-11-13 08:17:45 +0000583 return lhs;
584 }
585
586 if (!isCompAssign)
John McCall2bb5d002010-11-13 09:02:35 +0000587 ImpCastExprToType(lhsExpr, rhs, CK_IntegralComplexCast);
John McCallcf33b242010-11-13 08:17:45 +0000588 return rhs;
589 } else if (lhsComplexInt) {
590 // int -> _Complex int
John McCall2bb5d002010-11-13 09:02:35 +0000591 ImpCastExprToType(rhsExpr, lhs, CK_IntegralRealToComplex);
John McCallcf33b242010-11-13 08:17:45 +0000592 return lhs;
593 } else if (rhsComplexInt) {
594 // int -> _Complex int
595 if (!isCompAssign)
John McCall2bb5d002010-11-13 09:02:35 +0000596 ImpCastExprToType(lhsExpr, rhs, CK_IntegralRealToComplex);
John McCallcf33b242010-11-13 08:17:45 +0000597 return rhs;
598 }
599
600 // Finally, we have two differing integer types.
601 // The rules for this case are in C99 6.3.1.8
602 int compare = Context.getIntegerTypeOrder(lhs, rhs);
603 bool lhsSigned = lhs->hasSignedIntegerRepresentation(),
604 rhsSigned = rhs->hasSignedIntegerRepresentation();
605 if (lhsSigned == rhsSigned) {
606 // Same signedness; use the higher-ranked type
607 if (compare >= 0) {
608 ImpCastExprToType(rhsExpr, lhs, CK_IntegralCast);
609 return lhs;
610 } else if (!isCompAssign)
611 ImpCastExprToType(lhsExpr, rhs, CK_IntegralCast);
612 return rhs;
613 } else if (compare != (lhsSigned ? 1 : -1)) {
614 // The unsigned type has greater than or equal rank to the
615 // signed type, so use the unsigned type
616 if (rhsSigned) {
617 ImpCastExprToType(rhsExpr, lhs, CK_IntegralCast);
618 return lhs;
619 } else if (!isCompAssign)
620 ImpCastExprToType(lhsExpr, rhs, CK_IntegralCast);
621 return rhs;
622 } else if (Context.getIntWidth(lhs) != Context.getIntWidth(rhs)) {
623 // The two types are different widths; if we are here, that
624 // means the signed type is larger than the unsigned type, so
625 // use the signed type.
626 if (lhsSigned) {
627 ImpCastExprToType(rhsExpr, lhs, CK_IntegralCast);
628 return lhs;
629 } else if (!isCompAssign)
630 ImpCastExprToType(lhsExpr, rhs, CK_IntegralCast);
631 return rhs;
632 } else {
633 // The signed type is higher-ranked than the unsigned type,
634 // but isn't actually any bigger (like unsigned int and long
635 // on most 32-bit systems). Use the unsigned type corresponding
636 // to the signed type.
637 QualType result =
638 Context.getCorrespondingUnsignedType(lhsSigned ? lhs : rhs);
639 ImpCastExprToType(rhsExpr, result, CK_IntegralCast);
640 if (!isCompAssign)
641 ImpCastExprToType(lhsExpr, result, CK_IntegralCast);
642 return result;
643 }
Douglas Gregoreb8f3062008-11-12 17:17:38 +0000644}
645
Chris Lattnere7a2e912008-07-25 21:10:04 +0000646//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
647// Semantic Analysis for various Expression Types
648//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
649
650
Steve Narofff69936d2007-09-16 03:34:24 +0000651/// ActOnStringLiteral - The specified tokens were lexed as pasted string
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +0000652/// fragments (e.g. "foo" "bar" L"baz"). The result string has to handle string
653/// concatenation ([C99 5.1.1.2, translation phase #6]), so it may come from
654/// multiple tokens. However, the common case is that StringToks points to one
655/// string.
Sebastian Redlcd965b92009-01-18 18:53:16 +0000656///
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +0000657ExprResult
Sean Hunt6cf75022010-08-30 17:47:05 +0000658Sema::ActOnStringLiteral(const Token *StringToks, unsigned NumStringToks) {
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +0000659 assert(NumStringToks && "Must have at least one string!");
660
Chris Lattnerbbee00b2009-01-16 18:51:42 +0000661 StringLiteralParser Literal(StringToks, NumStringToks, PP);
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +0000662 if (Literal.hadError)
Sebastian Redlcd965b92009-01-18 18:53:16 +0000663 return ExprError();
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +0000664
665 llvm::SmallVector<SourceLocation, 4> StringTokLocs;
666 for (unsigned i = 0; i != NumStringToks; ++i)
667 StringTokLocs.push_back(StringToks[i].getLocation());
Chris Lattnera7ad98f2008-02-11 00:02:17 +0000668
Chris Lattnera7ad98f2008-02-11 00:02:17 +0000669 QualType StrTy = Context.CharTy;
Argyrios Kyrtzidis55f4b022008-08-09 17:20:01 +0000670 if (Literal.AnyWide) StrTy = Context.getWCharType();
Chris Lattnera7ad98f2008-02-11 00:02:17 +0000671 if (Literal.Pascal) StrTy = Context.UnsignedCharTy;
Douglas Gregor77a52232008-09-12 00:47:35 +0000672
673 // A C++ string literal has a const-qualified element type (C++ 2.13.4p1).
Chris Lattner7dc480f2010-06-15 18:05:34 +0000674 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus || getLangOptions().ConstStrings)
Douglas Gregor77a52232008-09-12 00:47:35 +0000675 StrTy.addConst();
Sebastian Redlcd965b92009-01-18 18:53:16 +0000676
Chris Lattnera7ad98f2008-02-11 00:02:17 +0000677 // Get an array type for the string, according to C99 6.4.5. This includes
678 // the nul terminator character as well as the string length for pascal
679 // strings.
680 StrTy = Context.getConstantArrayType(StrTy,
Chris Lattnerdbb1ecc2009-02-26 23:01:51 +0000681 llvm::APInt(32, Literal.GetNumStringChars()+1),
Chris Lattnera7ad98f2008-02-11 00:02:17 +0000682 ArrayType::Normal, 0);
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000683
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +0000684 // Pass &StringTokLocs[0], StringTokLocs.size() to factory!
Sean Hunt6cf75022010-08-30 17:47:05 +0000685 return Owned(StringLiteral::Create(Context, Literal.GetString(),
686 Literal.GetStringLength(),
687 Literal.AnyWide, StrTy,
688 &StringTokLocs[0],
689 StringTokLocs.size()));
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +0000690}
691
Chris Lattner639e2d32008-10-20 05:16:36 +0000692/// ShouldSnapshotBlockValueReference - Return true if a reference inside of
693/// CurBlock to VD should cause it to be snapshotted (as we do for auto
694/// variables defined outside the block) or false if this is not needed (e.g.
695/// for values inside the block or for globals).
696///
Douglas Gregor076ceb02010-03-01 20:44:28 +0000697/// This also keeps the 'hasBlockDeclRefExprs' in the BlockScopeInfo records
Chris Lattner17f3a6d2009-04-21 22:26:47 +0000698/// up-to-date.
699///
Douglas Gregor9ea9bdb2010-03-01 23:15:13 +0000700static bool ShouldSnapshotBlockValueReference(Sema &S, BlockScopeInfo *CurBlock,
Chris Lattner639e2d32008-10-20 05:16:36 +0000701 ValueDecl *VD) {
702 // If the value is defined inside the block, we couldn't snapshot it even if
703 // we wanted to.
704 if (CurBlock->TheDecl == VD->getDeclContext())
705 return false;
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000706
Chris Lattner639e2d32008-10-20 05:16:36 +0000707 // If this is an enum constant or function, it is constant, don't snapshot.
708 if (isa<EnumConstantDecl>(VD) || isa<FunctionDecl>(VD))
709 return false;
710
711 // If this is a reference to an extern, static, or global variable, no need to
712 // snapshot it.
713 // FIXME: What about 'const' variables in C++?
714 if (const VarDecl *Var = dyn_cast<VarDecl>(VD))
Chris Lattner17f3a6d2009-04-21 22:26:47 +0000715 if (!Var->hasLocalStorage())
716 return false;
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000717
Chris Lattner17f3a6d2009-04-21 22:26:47 +0000718 // Blocks that have these can't be constant.
719 CurBlock->hasBlockDeclRefExprs = true;
720
721 // If we have nested blocks, the decl may be declared in an outer block (in
722 // which case that outer block doesn't get "hasBlockDeclRefExprs") or it may
723 // be defined outside all of the current blocks (in which case the blocks do
724 // all get the bit). Walk the nesting chain.
Douglas Gregor9ea9bdb2010-03-01 23:15:13 +0000725 for (unsigned I = S.FunctionScopes.size() - 1; I; --I) {
726 BlockScopeInfo *NextBlock = dyn_cast<BlockScopeInfo>(S.FunctionScopes[I]);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +0000727
Douglas Gregor9ea9bdb2010-03-01 23:15:13 +0000728 if (!NextBlock)
729 continue;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +0000730
Chris Lattner17f3a6d2009-04-21 22:26:47 +0000731 // If we found the defining block for the variable, don't mark the block as
732 // having a reference outside it.
733 if (NextBlock->TheDecl == VD->getDeclContext())
734 break;
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000735
Chris Lattner17f3a6d2009-04-21 22:26:47 +0000736 // Otherwise, the DeclRef from the inner block causes the outer one to need
737 // a snapshot as well.
738 NextBlock->hasBlockDeclRefExprs = true;
739 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000740
Chris Lattner639e2d32008-10-20 05:16:36 +0000741 return true;
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000742}
743
Chris Lattner639e2d32008-10-20 05:16:36 +0000744
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +0000745ExprResult
John McCalldbd872f2009-12-08 09:08:17 +0000746Sema::BuildDeclRefExpr(ValueDecl *D, QualType Ty, SourceLocation Loc,
Sebastian Redlebc07d52009-02-03 20:19:35 +0000747 const CXXScopeSpec *SS) {
Abramo Bagnara25777432010-08-11 22:01:17 +0000748 DeclarationNameInfo NameInfo(D->getDeclName(), Loc);
749 return BuildDeclRefExpr(D, Ty, NameInfo, SS);
750}
751
752/// BuildDeclRefExpr - Build a DeclRefExpr.
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +0000753ExprResult
Abramo Bagnara25777432010-08-11 22:01:17 +0000754Sema::BuildDeclRefExpr(ValueDecl *D, QualType Ty,
755 const DeclarationNameInfo &NameInfo,
756 const CXXScopeSpec *SS) {
Anders Carlssone2bb2242009-06-26 19:16:07 +0000757 if (Context.getCanonicalType(Ty) == Context.UndeducedAutoTy) {
Abramo Bagnara25777432010-08-11 22:01:17 +0000758 Diag(NameInfo.getLoc(),
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000759 diag::err_auto_variable_cannot_appear_in_own_initializer)
Anders Carlssone2bb2242009-06-26 19:16:07 +0000760 << D->getDeclName();
761 return ExprError();
762 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000763
Anders Carlssone41590d2009-06-24 00:10:43 +0000764 if (const VarDecl *VD = dyn_cast<VarDecl>(D)) {
Douglas Gregor15dedf02010-04-27 21:10:04 +0000765 if (isa<NonTypeTemplateParmDecl>(VD)) {
766 // Non-type template parameters can be referenced anywhere they are
767 // visible.
Douglas Gregor63982352010-07-13 18:40:04 +0000768 Ty = Ty.getNonLValueExprType(Context);
Douglas Gregor15dedf02010-04-27 21:10:04 +0000769 } else if (const CXXMethodDecl *MD = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(CurContext)) {
Anders Carlssone41590d2009-06-24 00:10:43 +0000770 if (const FunctionDecl *FD = MD->getParent()->isLocalClass()) {
771 if (VD->hasLocalStorage() && VD->getDeclContext() != CurContext) {
Abramo Bagnara25777432010-08-11 22:01:17 +0000772 Diag(NameInfo.getLoc(),
773 diag::err_reference_to_local_var_in_enclosing_function)
Anders Carlssone41590d2009-06-24 00:10:43 +0000774 << D->getIdentifier() << FD->getDeclName();
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000775 Diag(D->getLocation(), diag::note_local_variable_declared_here)
Anders Carlssone41590d2009-06-24 00:10:43 +0000776 << D->getIdentifier();
777 return ExprError();
778 }
779 }
780 }
781 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000782
Abramo Bagnara25777432010-08-11 22:01:17 +0000783 MarkDeclarationReferenced(NameInfo.getLoc(), D);
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000784
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +0000785 return Owned(DeclRefExpr::Create(Context,
786 SS? (NestedNameSpecifier *)SS->getScopeRep() : 0,
787 SS? SS->getRange() : SourceRange(),
Abramo Bagnara25777432010-08-11 22:01:17 +0000788 D, NameInfo, Ty));
Douglas Gregor1a49af92009-01-06 05:10:23 +0000789}
790
Douglas Gregorffb4b6e2009-04-15 06:41:24 +0000791/// \brief Given a field that represents a member of an anonymous
792/// struct/union, build the path from that field's context to the
793/// actual member.
794///
795/// Construct the sequence of field member references we'll have to
796/// perform to get to the field in the anonymous union/struct. The
797/// list of members is built from the field outward, so traverse it
798/// backwards to go from an object in the current context to the field
799/// we found.
800///
801/// \returns The variable from which the field access should begin,
802/// for an anonymous struct/union that is not a member of another
803/// class. Otherwise, returns NULL.
804VarDecl *Sema::BuildAnonymousStructUnionMemberPath(FieldDecl *Field,
805 llvm::SmallVectorImpl<FieldDecl *> &Path) {
Douglas Gregorbcbffc42009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000806 assert(Field->getDeclContext()->isRecord() &&
807 cast<RecordDecl>(Field->getDeclContext())->isAnonymousStructOrUnion()
808 && "Field must be stored inside an anonymous struct or union");
809
Douglas Gregorffb4b6e2009-04-15 06:41:24 +0000810 Path.push_back(Field);
Douglas Gregorbcbffc42009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000811 VarDecl *BaseObject = 0;
812 DeclContext *Ctx = Field->getDeclContext();
813 do {
814 RecordDecl *Record = cast<RecordDecl>(Ctx);
John McCallbc365c52010-05-21 01:17:40 +0000815 ValueDecl *AnonObject = Record->getAnonymousStructOrUnionObject();
Douglas Gregorbcbffc42009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000816 if (FieldDecl *AnonField = dyn_cast<FieldDecl>(AnonObject))
Douglas Gregorffb4b6e2009-04-15 06:41:24 +0000817 Path.push_back(AnonField);
Douglas Gregorbcbffc42009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000818 else {
819 BaseObject = cast<VarDecl>(AnonObject);
820 break;
821 }
822 Ctx = Ctx->getParent();
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000823 } while (Ctx->isRecord() &&
Douglas Gregorbcbffc42009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000824 cast<RecordDecl>(Ctx)->isAnonymousStructOrUnion());
Douglas Gregorffb4b6e2009-04-15 06:41:24 +0000825
826 return BaseObject;
827}
828
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +0000829ExprResult
Douglas Gregorffb4b6e2009-04-15 06:41:24 +0000830Sema::BuildAnonymousStructUnionMemberReference(SourceLocation Loc,
831 FieldDecl *Field,
832 Expr *BaseObjectExpr,
833 SourceLocation OpLoc) {
834 llvm::SmallVector<FieldDecl *, 4> AnonFields;
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000835 VarDecl *BaseObject = BuildAnonymousStructUnionMemberPath(Field,
Douglas Gregorffb4b6e2009-04-15 06:41:24 +0000836 AnonFields);
837
Douglas Gregorbcbffc42009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000838 // Build the expression that refers to the base object, from
839 // which we will build a sequence of member references to each
840 // of the anonymous union objects and, eventually, the field we
841 // found via name lookup.
842 bool BaseObjectIsPointer = false;
John McCall0953e762009-09-24 19:53:00 +0000843 Qualifiers BaseQuals;
Douglas Gregorbcbffc42009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000844 if (BaseObject) {
845 // BaseObject is an anonymous struct/union variable (and is,
846 // therefore, not part of another non-anonymous record).
Douglas Gregore0762c92009-06-19 23:52:42 +0000847 MarkDeclarationReferenced(Loc, BaseObject);
Steve Naroff6ece14c2009-01-21 00:14:39 +0000848 BaseObjectExpr = new (Context) DeclRefExpr(BaseObject,BaseObject->getType(),
Devang Patela2c21a22010-10-12 23:23:25 +0000849 Loc);
John McCall0953e762009-09-24 19:53:00 +0000850 BaseQuals
851 = Context.getCanonicalType(BaseObject->getType()).getQualifiers();
Douglas Gregorbcbffc42009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000852 } else if (BaseObjectExpr) {
853 // The caller provided the base object expression. Determine
854 // whether its a pointer and whether it adds any qualifiers to the
855 // anonymous struct/union fields we're looking into.
856 QualType ObjectType = BaseObjectExpr->getType();
Ted Kremenek6217b802009-07-29 21:53:49 +0000857 if (const PointerType *ObjectPtr = ObjectType->getAs<PointerType>()) {
Douglas Gregorbcbffc42009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000858 BaseObjectIsPointer = true;
859 ObjectType = ObjectPtr->getPointeeType();
860 }
John McCall0953e762009-09-24 19:53:00 +0000861 BaseQuals
862 = Context.getCanonicalType(ObjectType).getQualifiers();
Douglas Gregorbcbffc42009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000863 } else {
864 // We've found a member of an anonymous struct/union that is
865 // inside a non-anonymous struct/union, so in a well-formed
866 // program our base object expression is "this".
John McCallea1471e2010-05-20 01:18:31 +0000867 DeclContext *DC = getFunctionLevelDeclContext();
868 if (CXXMethodDecl *MD = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(DC)) {
Douglas Gregorbcbffc42009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000869 if (!MD->isStatic()) {
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000870 QualType AnonFieldType
Douglas Gregorbcbffc42009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000871 = Context.getTagDeclType(
872 cast<RecordDecl>(AnonFields.back()->getDeclContext()));
873 QualType ThisType = Context.getTagDeclType(MD->getParent());
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000874 if ((Context.getCanonicalType(AnonFieldType)
Douglas Gregorbcbffc42009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000875 == Context.getCanonicalType(ThisType)) ||
876 IsDerivedFrom(ThisType, AnonFieldType)) {
877 // Our base object expression is "this".
Douglas Gregor8aa5f402009-12-24 20:23:34 +0000878 BaseObjectExpr = new (Context) CXXThisExpr(Loc,
Douglas Gregor828a1972010-01-07 23:12:05 +0000879 MD->getThisType(Context),
880 /*isImplicit=*/true);
Douglas Gregorbcbffc42009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000881 BaseObjectIsPointer = true;
882 }
883 } else {
Sebastian Redlcd965b92009-01-18 18:53:16 +0000884 return ExprError(Diag(Loc,diag::err_invalid_member_use_in_static_method)
885 << Field->getDeclName());
Douglas Gregorbcbffc42009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000886 }
John McCall0953e762009-09-24 19:53:00 +0000887 BaseQuals = Qualifiers::fromCVRMask(MD->getTypeQualifiers());
Douglas Gregorbcbffc42009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000888 }
889
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +0000890 if (!BaseObjectExpr)
Sebastian Redlcd965b92009-01-18 18:53:16 +0000891 return ExprError(Diag(Loc, diag::err_invalid_non_static_member_use)
892 << Field->getDeclName());
Douglas Gregorbcbffc42009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000893 }
894
895 // Build the implicit member references to the field of the
896 // anonymous struct/union.
897 Expr *Result = BaseObjectExpr;
John McCall0953e762009-09-24 19:53:00 +0000898 Qualifiers ResultQuals = BaseQuals;
Douglas Gregorbcbffc42009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000899 for (llvm::SmallVector<FieldDecl *, 4>::reverse_iterator
900 FI = AnonFields.rbegin(), FIEnd = AnonFields.rend();
901 FI != FIEnd; ++FI) {
902 QualType MemberType = (*FI)->getType();
John McCall0953e762009-09-24 19:53:00 +0000903 Qualifiers MemberTypeQuals =
904 Context.getCanonicalType(MemberType).getQualifiers();
905
906 // CVR attributes from the base are picked up by members,
907 // except that 'mutable' members don't pick up 'const'.
908 if ((*FI)->isMutable())
909 ResultQuals.removeConst();
910
911 // GC attributes are never picked up by members.
912 ResultQuals.removeObjCGCAttr();
913
914 // TR 18037 does not allow fields to be declared with address spaces.
915 assert(!MemberTypeQuals.hasAddressSpace());
916
917 Qualifiers NewQuals = ResultQuals + MemberTypeQuals;
918 if (NewQuals != MemberTypeQuals)
919 MemberType = Context.getQualifiedType(MemberType, NewQuals);
920
Douglas Gregore0762c92009-06-19 23:52:42 +0000921 MarkDeclarationReferenced(Loc, *FI);
John McCall6bb80172010-03-30 21:47:33 +0000922 PerformObjectMemberConversion(Result, /*FIXME:Qualifier=*/0, *FI, *FI);
Douglas Gregorbd4c4ae2009-08-26 22:36:53 +0000923 // FIXME: Might this end up being a qualified name?
Steve Naroff6ece14c2009-01-21 00:14:39 +0000924 Result = new (Context) MemberExpr(Result, BaseObjectIsPointer, *FI,
925 OpLoc, MemberType);
Douglas Gregorbcbffc42009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000926 BaseObjectIsPointer = false;
John McCall0953e762009-09-24 19:53:00 +0000927 ResultQuals = NewQuals;
Douglas Gregorbcbffc42009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000928 }
929
Sebastian Redlcd965b92009-01-18 18:53:16 +0000930 return Owned(Result);
Douglas Gregorbcbffc42009-01-07 00:43:41 +0000931}
932
Abramo Bagnara25777432010-08-11 22:01:17 +0000933/// Decomposes the given name into a DeclarationNameInfo, its location, and
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +0000934/// possibly a list of template arguments.
935///
936/// If this produces template arguments, it is permitted to call
937/// DecomposeTemplateName.
938///
939/// This actually loses a lot of source location information for
940/// non-standard name kinds; we should consider preserving that in
941/// some way.
942static void DecomposeUnqualifiedId(Sema &SemaRef,
943 const UnqualifiedId &Id,
944 TemplateArgumentListInfo &Buffer,
Abramo Bagnara25777432010-08-11 22:01:17 +0000945 DeclarationNameInfo &NameInfo,
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +0000946 const TemplateArgumentListInfo *&TemplateArgs) {
947 if (Id.getKind() == UnqualifiedId::IK_TemplateId) {
948 Buffer.setLAngleLoc(Id.TemplateId->LAngleLoc);
949 Buffer.setRAngleLoc(Id.TemplateId->RAngleLoc);
950
951 ASTTemplateArgsPtr TemplateArgsPtr(SemaRef,
952 Id.TemplateId->getTemplateArgs(),
953 Id.TemplateId->NumArgs);
954 SemaRef.translateTemplateArguments(TemplateArgsPtr, Buffer);
955 TemplateArgsPtr.release();
956
John McCall2b5289b2010-08-23 07:28:44 +0000957 TemplateName TName = Id.TemplateId->Template.get();
Abramo Bagnara25777432010-08-11 22:01:17 +0000958 SourceLocation TNameLoc = Id.TemplateId->TemplateNameLoc;
959 NameInfo = SemaRef.Context.getNameForTemplate(TName, TNameLoc);
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +0000960 TemplateArgs = &Buffer;
961 } else {
Abramo Bagnara25777432010-08-11 22:01:17 +0000962 NameInfo = SemaRef.GetNameFromUnqualifiedId(Id);
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +0000963 TemplateArgs = 0;
964 }
965}
966
John McCall4c72d3e2010-02-08 19:26:07 +0000967/// Determines whether the given record is "fully-formed" at the given
968/// location, i.e. whether a qualified lookup into it is assured of
969/// getting consistent results already.
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +0000970static bool IsFullyFormedScope(Sema &SemaRef, CXXRecordDecl *Record) {
John McCall4c72d3e2010-02-08 19:26:07 +0000971 if (!Record->hasDefinition())
972 return false;
973
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +0000974 for (CXXRecordDecl::base_class_iterator I = Record->bases_begin(),
975 E = Record->bases_end(); I != E; ++I) {
976 CanQualType BaseT = SemaRef.Context.getCanonicalType((*I).getType());
977 CanQual<RecordType> BaseRT = BaseT->getAs<RecordType>();
978 if (!BaseRT) return false;
979
980 CXXRecordDecl *BaseRecord = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(BaseRT->getDecl());
John McCall4c72d3e2010-02-08 19:26:07 +0000981 if (!BaseRecord->hasDefinition() ||
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +0000982 !IsFullyFormedScope(SemaRef, BaseRecord))
983 return false;
984 }
985
986 return true;
987}
988
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +0000989/// Determines if the given class is provably not derived from all of
990/// the prospective base classes.
991static bool IsProvablyNotDerivedFrom(Sema &SemaRef,
992 CXXRecordDecl *Record,
993 const llvm::SmallPtrSet<CXXRecordDecl*, 4> &Bases) {
John McCallb1b42562009-12-01 22:28:41 +0000994 if (Bases.count(Record->getCanonicalDecl()))
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +0000995 return false;
996
Douglas Gregor952b0172010-02-11 01:04:33 +0000997 RecordDecl *RD = Record->getDefinition();
John McCallb1b42562009-12-01 22:28:41 +0000998 if (!RD) return false;
999 Record = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(RD);
1000
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00001001 for (CXXRecordDecl::base_class_iterator I = Record->bases_begin(),
1002 E = Record->bases_end(); I != E; ++I) {
1003 CanQualType BaseT = SemaRef.Context.getCanonicalType((*I).getType());
1004 CanQual<RecordType> BaseRT = BaseT->getAs<RecordType>();
1005 if (!BaseRT) return false;
1006
1007 CXXRecordDecl *BaseRecord = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(BaseRT->getDecl());
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00001008 if (!IsProvablyNotDerivedFrom(SemaRef, BaseRecord, Bases))
1009 return false;
1010 }
1011
1012 return true;
1013}
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001014
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00001015enum IMAKind {
1016 /// The reference is definitely not an instance member access.
1017 IMA_Static,
1018
1019 /// The reference may be an implicit instance member access.
1020 IMA_Mixed,
1021
1022 /// The reference may be to an instance member, but it is invalid if
1023 /// so, because the context is not an instance method.
1024 IMA_Mixed_StaticContext,
1025
1026 /// The reference may be to an instance member, but it is invalid if
1027 /// so, because the context is from an unrelated class.
1028 IMA_Mixed_Unrelated,
1029
1030 /// The reference is definitely an implicit instance member access.
1031 IMA_Instance,
1032
1033 /// The reference may be to an unresolved using declaration.
1034 IMA_Unresolved,
1035
1036 /// The reference may be to an unresolved using declaration and the
1037 /// context is not an instance method.
1038 IMA_Unresolved_StaticContext,
1039
1040 /// The reference is to a member of an anonymous structure in a
1041 /// non-class context.
1042 IMA_AnonymousMember,
1043
1044 /// All possible referrents are instance members and the current
1045 /// context is not an instance method.
1046 IMA_Error_StaticContext,
1047
1048 /// All possible referrents are instance members of an unrelated
1049 /// class.
1050 IMA_Error_Unrelated
1051};
1052
1053/// The given lookup names class member(s) and is not being used for
1054/// an address-of-member expression. Classify the type of access
1055/// according to whether it's possible that this reference names an
1056/// instance member. This is best-effort; it is okay to
1057/// conservatively answer "yes", in which case some errors will simply
1058/// not be caught until template-instantiation.
1059static IMAKind ClassifyImplicitMemberAccess(Sema &SemaRef,
1060 const LookupResult &R) {
John McCall3b4294e2009-12-16 12:17:52 +00001061 assert(!R.empty() && (*R.begin())->isCXXClassMember());
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00001062
John McCallea1471e2010-05-20 01:18:31 +00001063 DeclContext *DC = SemaRef.getFunctionLevelDeclContext();
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00001064 bool isStaticContext =
John McCallea1471e2010-05-20 01:18:31 +00001065 (!isa<CXXMethodDecl>(DC) ||
1066 cast<CXXMethodDecl>(DC)->isStatic());
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00001067
1068 if (R.isUnresolvableResult())
1069 return isStaticContext ? IMA_Unresolved_StaticContext : IMA_Unresolved;
1070
1071 // Collect all the declaring classes of instance members we find.
1072 bool hasNonInstance = false;
1073 llvm::SmallPtrSet<CXXRecordDecl*, 4> Classes;
1074 for (LookupResult::iterator I = R.begin(), E = R.end(); I != E; ++I) {
John McCall161755a2010-04-06 21:38:20 +00001075 NamedDecl *D = *I;
1076 if (D->isCXXInstanceMember()) {
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00001077 CXXRecordDecl *R = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(D->getDeclContext());
1078
1079 // If this is a member of an anonymous record, move out to the
1080 // innermost non-anonymous struct or union. If there isn't one,
1081 // that's a special case.
1082 while (R->isAnonymousStructOrUnion()) {
1083 R = dyn_cast<CXXRecordDecl>(R->getParent());
1084 if (!R) return IMA_AnonymousMember;
1085 }
1086 Classes.insert(R->getCanonicalDecl());
1087 }
1088 else
1089 hasNonInstance = true;
1090 }
1091
1092 // If we didn't find any instance members, it can't be an implicit
1093 // member reference.
1094 if (Classes.empty())
1095 return IMA_Static;
1096
1097 // If the current context is not an instance method, it can't be
1098 // an implicit member reference.
1099 if (isStaticContext)
1100 return (hasNonInstance ? IMA_Mixed_StaticContext : IMA_Error_StaticContext);
1101
1102 // If we can prove that the current context is unrelated to all the
1103 // declaring classes, it can't be an implicit member reference (in
1104 // which case it's an error if any of those members are selected).
1105 if (IsProvablyNotDerivedFrom(SemaRef,
John McCallea1471e2010-05-20 01:18:31 +00001106 cast<CXXMethodDecl>(DC)->getParent(),
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00001107 Classes))
1108 return (hasNonInstance ? IMA_Mixed_Unrelated : IMA_Error_Unrelated);
1109
1110 return (hasNonInstance ? IMA_Mixed : IMA_Instance);
1111}
1112
1113/// Diagnose a reference to a field with no object available.
1114static void DiagnoseInstanceReference(Sema &SemaRef,
1115 const CXXScopeSpec &SS,
1116 const LookupResult &R) {
1117 SourceLocation Loc = R.getNameLoc();
1118 SourceRange Range(Loc);
1119 if (SS.isSet()) Range.setBegin(SS.getRange().getBegin());
1120
1121 if (R.getAsSingle<FieldDecl>()) {
1122 if (CXXMethodDecl *MD = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(SemaRef.CurContext)) {
1123 if (MD->isStatic()) {
1124 // "invalid use of member 'x' in static member function"
1125 SemaRef.Diag(Loc, diag::err_invalid_member_use_in_static_method)
1126 << Range << R.getLookupName();
1127 return;
1128 }
1129 }
1130
1131 SemaRef.Diag(Loc, diag::err_invalid_non_static_member_use)
1132 << R.getLookupName() << Range;
1133 return;
1134 }
1135
1136 SemaRef.Diag(Loc, diag::err_member_call_without_object) << Range;
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00001137}
1138
John McCall578b69b2009-12-16 08:11:27 +00001139/// Diagnose an empty lookup.
1140///
1141/// \return false if new lookup candidates were found
Nick Lewycky03d98c52010-07-06 19:51:49 +00001142bool Sema::DiagnoseEmptyLookup(Scope *S, CXXScopeSpec &SS, LookupResult &R,
1143 CorrectTypoContext CTC) {
John McCall578b69b2009-12-16 08:11:27 +00001144 DeclarationName Name = R.getLookupName();
1145
John McCall578b69b2009-12-16 08:11:27 +00001146 unsigned diagnostic = diag::err_undeclared_var_use;
Douglas Gregorbb092ba2009-12-31 05:20:13 +00001147 unsigned diagnostic_suggest = diag::err_undeclared_var_use_suggest;
John McCall578b69b2009-12-16 08:11:27 +00001148 if (Name.getNameKind() == DeclarationName::CXXOperatorName ||
1149 Name.getNameKind() == DeclarationName::CXXLiteralOperatorName ||
Douglas Gregorbb092ba2009-12-31 05:20:13 +00001150 Name.getNameKind() == DeclarationName::CXXConversionFunctionName) {
John McCall578b69b2009-12-16 08:11:27 +00001151 diagnostic = diag::err_undeclared_use;
Douglas Gregorbb092ba2009-12-31 05:20:13 +00001152 diagnostic_suggest = diag::err_undeclared_use_suggest;
1153 }
John McCall578b69b2009-12-16 08:11:27 +00001154
Douglas Gregorbb092ba2009-12-31 05:20:13 +00001155 // If the original lookup was an unqualified lookup, fake an
1156 // unqualified lookup. This is useful when (for example) the
1157 // original lookup would not have found something because it was a
1158 // dependent name.
Nick Lewycky03d98c52010-07-06 19:51:49 +00001159 for (DeclContext *DC = SS.isEmpty() ? CurContext : 0;
Douglas Gregorbb092ba2009-12-31 05:20:13 +00001160 DC; DC = DC->getParent()) {
John McCall578b69b2009-12-16 08:11:27 +00001161 if (isa<CXXRecordDecl>(DC)) {
1162 LookupQualifiedName(R, DC);
1163
1164 if (!R.empty()) {
1165 // Don't give errors about ambiguities in this lookup.
1166 R.suppressDiagnostics();
1167
1168 CXXMethodDecl *CurMethod = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(CurContext);
1169 bool isInstance = CurMethod &&
1170 CurMethod->isInstance() &&
1171 DC == CurMethod->getParent();
1172
1173 // Give a code modification hint to insert 'this->'.
1174 // TODO: fixit for inserting 'Base<T>::' in the other cases.
1175 // Actually quite difficult!
Nick Lewycky03d98c52010-07-06 19:51:49 +00001176 if (isInstance) {
Nick Lewycky03d98c52010-07-06 19:51:49 +00001177 UnresolvedLookupExpr *ULE = cast<UnresolvedLookupExpr>(
1178 CallsUndergoingInstantiation.back()->getCallee());
Nick Lewyckyd9ca4ab2010-08-20 20:54:15 +00001179 CXXMethodDecl *DepMethod = cast_or_null<CXXMethodDecl>(
Nick Lewycky03d98c52010-07-06 19:51:49 +00001180 CurMethod->getInstantiatedFromMemberFunction());
Eli Friedmana7e68452010-08-22 01:00:03 +00001181 if (DepMethod) {
Nick Lewyckyd9ca4ab2010-08-20 20:54:15 +00001182 Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diagnostic) << Name
1183 << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(R.getNameLoc(), "this->");
1184 QualType DepThisType = DepMethod->getThisType(Context);
1185 CXXThisExpr *DepThis = new (Context) CXXThisExpr(
1186 R.getNameLoc(), DepThisType, false);
1187 TemplateArgumentListInfo TList;
1188 if (ULE->hasExplicitTemplateArgs())
1189 ULE->copyTemplateArgumentsInto(TList);
1190 CXXDependentScopeMemberExpr *DepExpr =
1191 CXXDependentScopeMemberExpr::Create(
1192 Context, DepThis, DepThisType, true, SourceLocation(),
1193 ULE->getQualifier(), ULE->getQualifierRange(), NULL,
1194 R.getLookupNameInfo(), &TList);
1195 CallsUndergoingInstantiation.back()->setCallee(DepExpr);
Eli Friedmana7e68452010-08-22 01:00:03 +00001196 } else {
Nick Lewyckyd9ca4ab2010-08-20 20:54:15 +00001197 // FIXME: we should be able to handle this case too. It is correct
1198 // to add this-> here. This is a workaround for PR7947.
1199 Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diagnostic) << Name;
Eli Friedmana7e68452010-08-22 01:00:03 +00001200 }
Nick Lewycky03d98c52010-07-06 19:51:49 +00001201 } else {
John McCall578b69b2009-12-16 08:11:27 +00001202 Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diagnostic) << Name;
Nick Lewycky03d98c52010-07-06 19:51:49 +00001203 }
John McCall578b69b2009-12-16 08:11:27 +00001204
1205 // Do we really want to note all of these?
1206 for (LookupResult::iterator I = R.begin(), E = R.end(); I != E; ++I)
1207 Diag((*I)->getLocation(), diag::note_dependent_var_use);
1208
1209 // Tell the callee to try to recover.
1210 return false;
1211 }
Douglas Gregore26f0432010-08-09 22:38:14 +00001212
1213 R.clear();
John McCall578b69b2009-12-16 08:11:27 +00001214 }
1215 }
1216
Douglas Gregorbb092ba2009-12-31 05:20:13 +00001217 // We didn't find anything, so try to correct for a typo.
Douglas Gregoraaf87162010-04-14 20:04:41 +00001218 DeclarationName Corrected;
Daniel Dunbardc32cdf2010-06-02 15:46:52 +00001219 if (S && (Corrected = CorrectTypo(R, S, &SS, 0, false, CTC))) {
Douglas Gregoraaf87162010-04-14 20:04:41 +00001220 if (!R.empty()) {
1221 if (isa<ValueDecl>(*R.begin()) || isa<FunctionTemplateDecl>(*R.begin())) {
1222 if (SS.isEmpty())
1223 Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diagnostic_suggest) << Name << R.getLookupName()
1224 << FixItHint::CreateReplacement(R.getNameLoc(),
1225 R.getLookupName().getAsString());
1226 else
1227 Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diag::err_no_member_suggest)
1228 << Name << computeDeclContext(SS, false) << R.getLookupName()
1229 << SS.getRange()
1230 << FixItHint::CreateReplacement(R.getNameLoc(),
1231 R.getLookupName().getAsString());
1232 if (NamedDecl *ND = R.getAsSingle<NamedDecl>())
1233 Diag(ND->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_decl)
1234 << ND->getDeclName();
1235
1236 // Tell the callee to try to recover.
1237 return false;
1238 }
Sean Hunt1e3f5ba2010-04-28 23:02:27 +00001239
Douglas Gregoraaf87162010-04-14 20:04:41 +00001240 if (isa<TypeDecl>(*R.begin()) || isa<ObjCInterfaceDecl>(*R.begin())) {
1241 // FIXME: If we ended up with a typo for a type name or
1242 // Objective-C class name, we're in trouble because the parser
1243 // is in the wrong place to recover. Suggest the typo
1244 // correction, but don't make it a fix-it since we're not going
1245 // to recover well anyway.
1246 if (SS.isEmpty())
1247 Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diagnostic_suggest) << Name << R.getLookupName();
1248 else
1249 Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diag::err_no_member_suggest)
1250 << Name << computeDeclContext(SS, false) << R.getLookupName()
1251 << SS.getRange();
1252
1253 // Don't try to recover; it won't work.
1254 return true;
1255 }
1256 } else {
Sean Hunt1e3f5ba2010-04-28 23:02:27 +00001257 // FIXME: We found a keyword. Suggest it, but don't provide a fix-it
Douglas Gregoraaf87162010-04-14 20:04:41 +00001258 // because we aren't able to recover.
Douglas Gregord203a162010-01-01 00:15:04 +00001259 if (SS.isEmpty())
Douglas Gregoraaf87162010-04-14 20:04:41 +00001260 Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diagnostic_suggest) << Name << Corrected;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001261 else
Douglas Gregord203a162010-01-01 00:15:04 +00001262 Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diag::err_no_member_suggest)
Douglas Gregoraaf87162010-04-14 20:04:41 +00001263 << Name << computeDeclContext(SS, false) << Corrected
1264 << SS.getRange();
Douglas Gregord203a162010-01-01 00:15:04 +00001265 return true;
1266 }
Douglas Gregord203a162010-01-01 00:15:04 +00001267 R.clear();
Douglas Gregorbb092ba2009-12-31 05:20:13 +00001268 }
1269
1270 // Emit a special diagnostic for failed member lookups.
1271 // FIXME: computing the declaration context might fail here (?)
1272 if (!SS.isEmpty()) {
1273 Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diag::err_no_member)
1274 << Name << computeDeclContext(SS, false)
1275 << SS.getRange();
1276 return true;
1277 }
1278
John McCall578b69b2009-12-16 08:11:27 +00001279 // Give up, we can't recover.
1280 Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diagnostic) << Name;
1281 return true;
1282}
1283
Douglas Gregorca45da02010-11-02 20:36:02 +00001284ObjCPropertyDecl *Sema::canSynthesizeProvisionalIvar(IdentifierInfo *II) {
1285 ObjCMethodDecl *CurMeth = getCurMethodDecl();
Fariborz Jahanian69d56242010-07-22 23:33:21 +00001286 ObjCInterfaceDecl *IDecl = CurMeth->getClassInterface();
1287 if (!IDecl)
1288 return 0;
1289 ObjCImplementationDecl *ClassImpDecl = IDecl->getImplementation();
1290 if (!ClassImpDecl)
1291 return 0;
Douglas Gregorca45da02010-11-02 20:36:02 +00001292 ObjCPropertyDecl *property = LookupPropertyDecl(IDecl, II);
Fariborz Jahanian69d56242010-07-22 23:33:21 +00001293 if (!property)
1294 return 0;
1295 if (ObjCPropertyImplDecl *PIDecl = ClassImpDecl->FindPropertyImplDecl(II))
Douglas Gregorca45da02010-11-02 20:36:02 +00001296 if (PIDecl->getPropertyImplementation() == ObjCPropertyImplDecl::Dynamic ||
1297 PIDecl->getPropertyIvarDecl())
Fariborz Jahanian69d56242010-07-22 23:33:21 +00001298 return 0;
1299 return property;
1300}
1301
Douglas Gregorca45da02010-11-02 20:36:02 +00001302bool Sema::canSynthesizeProvisionalIvar(ObjCPropertyDecl *Property) {
1303 ObjCMethodDecl *CurMeth = getCurMethodDecl();
1304 ObjCInterfaceDecl *IDecl = CurMeth->getClassInterface();
1305 if (!IDecl)
1306 return false;
1307 ObjCImplementationDecl *ClassImpDecl = IDecl->getImplementation();
1308 if (!ClassImpDecl)
1309 return false;
1310 if (ObjCPropertyImplDecl *PIDecl
1311 = ClassImpDecl->FindPropertyImplDecl(Property->getIdentifier()))
1312 if (PIDecl->getPropertyImplementation() == ObjCPropertyImplDecl::Dynamic ||
1313 PIDecl->getPropertyIvarDecl())
1314 return false;
1315
1316 return true;
1317}
1318
Fariborz Jahanianad51e742010-07-17 00:59:30 +00001319static ObjCIvarDecl *SynthesizeProvisionalIvar(Sema &SemaRef,
Fariborz Jahanian73f666f2010-07-30 16:59:05 +00001320 LookupResult &Lookup,
Fariborz Jahanianad51e742010-07-17 00:59:30 +00001321 IdentifierInfo *II,
1322 SourceLocation NameLoc) {
1323 ObjCMethodDecl *CurMeth = SemaRef.getCurMethodDecl();
Fariborz Jahanian73f666f2010-07-30 16:59:05 +00001324 bool LookForIvars;
1325 if (Lookup.empty())
1326 LookForIvars = true;
1327 else if (CurMeth->isClassMethod())
1328 LookForIvars = false;
1329 else
1330 LookForIvars = (Lookup.isSingleResult() &&
1331 Lookup.getFoundDecl()->isDefinedOutsideFunctionOrMethod());
1332 if (!LookForIvars)
1333 return 0;
1334
Fariborz Jahanianad51e742010-07-17 00:59:30 +00001335 ObjCInterfaceDecl *IDecl = CurMeth->getClassInterface();
1336 if (!IDecl)
1337 return 0;
1338 ObjCImplementationDecl *ClassImpDecl = IDecl->getImplementation();
Fariborz Jahanian84ef4b22010-07-19 16:14:33 +00001339 if (!ClassImpDecl)
1340 return 0;
Fariborz Jahanianad51e742010-07-17 00:59:30 +00001341 bool DynamicImplSeen = false;
1342 ObjCPropertyDecl *property = SemaRef.LookupPropertyDecl(IDecl, II);
1343 if (!property)
1344 return 0;
Fariborz Jahanian43e1b462010-10-19 19:08:23 +00001345 if (ObjCPropertyImplDecl *PIDecl = ClassImpDecl->FindPropertyImplDecl(II)) {
Fariborz Jahanianad51e742010-07-17 00:59:30 +00001346 DynamicImplSeen =
1347 (PIDecl->getPropertyImplementation() == ObjCPropertyImplDecl::Dynamic);
Fariborz Jahanian43e1b462010-10-19 19:08:23 +00001348 // property implementation has a designated ivar. No need to assume a new
1349 // one.
1350 if (!DynamicImplSeen && PIDecl->getPropertyIvarDecl())
1351 return 0;
1352 }
Fariborz Jahanianad51e742010-07-17 00:59:30 +00001353 if (!DynamicImplSeen) {
Fariborz Jahanian84ef4b22010-07-19 16:14:33 +00001354 QualType PropType = SemaRef.Context.getCanonicalType(property->getType());
1355 ObjCIvarDecl *Ivar = ObjCIvarDecl::Create(SemaRef.Context, ClassImpDecl,
Fariborz Jahanianad51e742010-07-17 00:59:30 +00001356 NameLoc,
1357 II, PropType, /*Dinfo=*/0,
1358 ObjCIvarDecl::Protected,
1359 (Expr *)0, true);
1360 ClassImpDecl->addDecl(Ivar);
1361 IDecl->makeDeclVisibleInContext(Ivar, false);
1362 property->setPropertyIvarDecl(Ivar);
1363 return Ivar;
1364 }
1365 return 0;
1366}
1367
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00001368ExprResult Sema::ActOnIdExpression(Scope *S,
John McCallfb97e752010-08-24 22:52:39 +00001369 CXXScopeSpec &SS,
1370 UnqualifiedId &Id,
1371 bool HasTrailingLParen,
1372 bool isAddressOfOperand) {
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001373 assert(!(isAddressOfOperand && HasTrailingLParen) &&
1374 "cannot be direct & operand and have a trailing lparen");
1375
1376 if (SS.isInvalid())
Douglas Gregor4c921ae2009-01-30 01:04:22 +00001377 return ExprError();
Douglas Gregor5953d8b2009-03-19 17:26:29 +00001378
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00001379 TemplateArgumentListInfo TemplateArgsBuffer;
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001380
1381 // Decompose the UnqualifiedId into the following data.
Abramo Bagnara25777432010-08-11 22:01:17 +00001382 DeclarationNameInfo NameInfo;
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001383 const TemplateArgumentListInfo *TemplateArgs;
Abramo Bagnara25777432010-08-11 22:01:17 +00001384 DecomposeUnqualifiedId(*this, Id, TemplateArgsBuffer, NameInfo, TemplateArgs);
Douglas Gregor5953d8b2009-03-19 17:26:29 +00001385
Abramo Bagnara25777432010-08-11 22:01:17 +00001386 DeclarationName Name = NameInfo.getName();
Douglas Gregor10c42622008-11-18 15:03:34 +00001387 IdentifierInfo *II = Name.getAsIdentifierInfo();
Abramo Bagnara25777432010-08-11 22:01:17 +00001388 SourceLocation NameLoc = NameInfo.getLoc();
John McCallba135432009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001389
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001390 // C++ [temp.dep.expr]p3:
1391 // An id-expression is type-dependent if it contains:
Douglas Gregor48026d22010-01-11 18:40:55 +00001392 // -- an identifier that was declared with a dependent type,
1393 // (note: handled after lookup)
1394 // -- a template-id that is dependent,
1395 // (note: handled in BuildTemplateIdExpr)
1396 // -- a conversion-function-id that specifies a dependent type,
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001397 // -- a nested-name-specifier that contains a class-name that
1398 // names a dependent type.
1399 // Determine whether this is a member of an unknown specialization;
1400 // we need to handle these differently.
Eli Friedman647c8b32010-08-06 23:41:47 +00001401 bool DependentID = false;
1402 if (Name.getNameKind() == DeclarationName::CXXConversionFunctionName &&
1403 Name.getCXXNameType()->isDependentType()) {
1404 DependentID = true;
1405 } else if (SS.isSet()) {
1406 DeclContext *DC = computeDeclContext(SS, false);
1407 if (DC) {
1408 if (RequireCompleteDeclContext(SS, DC))
1409 return ExprError();
1410 // FIXME: We should be checking whether DC is the current instantiation.
1411 if (CXXRecordDecl *RD = dyn_cast<CXXRecordDecl>(DC))
1412 DependentID = !IsFullyFormedScope(*this, RD);
1413 } else {
1414 DependentID = true;
1415 }
1416 }
1417
1418 if (DependentID) {
Abramo Bagnara25777432010-08-11 22:01:17 +00001419 return ActOnDependentIdExpression(SS, NameInfo, isAddressOfOperand,
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001420 TemplateArgs);
1421 }
Fariborz Jahanian69d56242010-07-22 23:33:21 +00001422 bool IvarLookupFollowUp = false;
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001423 // Perform the required lookup.
Abramo Bagnara25777432010-08-11 22:01:17 +00001424 LookupResult R(*this, NameInfo, LookupOrdinaryName);
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001425 if (TemplateArgs) {
Douglas Gregord2235f62010-05-20 20:58:56 +00001426 // Lookup the template name again to correctly establish the context in
1427 // which it was found. This is really unfortunate as we already did the
1428 // lookup to determine that it was a template name in the first place. If
1429 // this becomes a performance hit, we can work harder to preserve those
1430 // results until we get here but it's likely not worth it.
Douglas Gregor1fd6d442010-05-21 23:18:07 +00001431 bool MemberOfUnknownSpecialization;
1432 LookupTemplateName(R, S, SS, QualType(), /*EnteringContext=*/false,
1433 MemberOfUnknownSpecialization);
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001434 } else {
Fariborz Jahanian69d56242010-07-22 23:33:21 +00001435 IvarLookupFollowUp = (!SS.isSet() && II && getCurMethodDecl());
Fariborz Jahanian48c2d562010-01-12 23:58:59 +00001436 LookupParsedName(R, S, &SS, !IvarLookupFollowUp);
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001437
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001438 // If this reference is in an Objective-C method, then we need to do
1439 // some special Objective-C lookup, too.
Fariborz Jahanian48c2d562010-01-12 23:58:59 +00001440 if (IvarLookupFollowUp) {
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00001441 ExprResult E(LookupInObjCMethod(R, S, II, true));
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001442 if (E.isInvalid())
1443 return ExprError();
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001444
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001445 Expr *Ex = E.takeAs<Expr>();
1446 if (Ex) return Owned(Ex);
Fariborz Jahanianad51e742010-07-17 00:59:30 +00001447 // Synthesize ivars lazily
1448 if (getLangOptions().ObjCNonFragileABI2) {
Fariborz Jahanian73f666f2010-07-30 16:59:05 +00001449 if (SynthesizeProvisionalIvar(*this, R, II, NameLoc))
Fariborz Jahanianad51e742010-07-17 00:59:30 +00001450 return ActOnIdExpression(S, SS, Id, HasTrailingLParen,
1451 isAddressOfOperand);
1452 }
Fariborz Jahanianf759b4d2010-08-13 18:09:39 +00001453 // for further use, this must be set to false if in class method.
1454 IvarLookupFollowUp = getCurMethodDecl()->isInstanceMethod();
Steve Naroffe3e9add2008-06-02 23:03:37 +00001455 }
Chris Lattner8a934232008-03-31 00:36:02 +00001456 }
Douglas Gregorc71e28c2009-02-16 19:28:42 +00001457
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001458 if (R.isAmbiguous())
1459 return ExprError();
1460
Douglas Gregor48f3bb92009-02-18 21:56:37 +00001461 // Determine whether this name might be a candidate for
1462 // argument-dependent lookup.
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001463 bool ADL = UseArgumentDependentLookup(SS, R, HasTrailingLParen);
Douglas Gregor48f3bb92009-02-18 21:56:37 +00001464
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001465 if (R.empty() && !ADL) {
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00001466 // Otherwise, this could be an implicitly declared function reference (legal
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001467 // in C90, extension in C99, forbidden in C++).
1468 if (HasTrailingLParen && II && !getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
1469 NamedDecl *D = ImplicitlyDefineFunction(NameLoc, *II, S);
1470 if (D) R.addDecl(D);
1471 }
1472
1473 // If this name wasn't predeclared and if this is not a function
1474 // call, diagnose the problem.
1475 if (R.empty()) {
Douglas Gregor91f7ac72010-05-18 16:14:23 +00001476 if (DiagnoseEmptyLookup(S, SS, R, CTC_Unknown))
John McCall578b69b2009-12-16 08:11:27 +00001477 return ExprError();
1478
1479 assert(!R.empty() &&
1480 "DiagnoseEmptyLookup returned false but added no results");
Douglas Gregorf06cdae2010-01-03 18:01:57 +00001481
1482 // If we found an Objective-C instance variable, let
1483 // LookupInObjCMethod build the appropriate expression to
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001484 // reference the ivar.
Douglas Gregorf06cdae2010-01-03 18:01:57 +00001485 if (ObjCIvarDecl *Ivar = R.getAsSingle<ObjCIvarDecl>()) {
1486 R.clear();
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00001487 ExprResult E(LookupInObjCMethod(R, S, Ivar->getIdentifier()));
Douglas Gregorf06cdae2010-01-03 18:01:57 +00001488 assert(E.isInvalid() || E.get());
1489 return move(E);
1490 }
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00001491 }
1492 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001493
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001494 // This is guaranteed from this point on.
1495 assert(!R.empty() || ADL);
1496
1497 if (VarDecl *Var = R.getAsSingle<VarDecl>()) {
Fariborz Jahanian69d56242010-07-22 23:33:21 +00001498 if (getLangOptions().ObjCNonFragileABI && IvarLookupFollowUp &&
Fariborz Jahanianb1d58e32010-07-29 16:53:53 +00001499 !getLangOptions().ObjCNonFragileABI2 &&
1500 Var->isFileVarDecl()) {
Douglas Gregorca45da02010-11-02 20:36:02 +00001501 ObjCPropertyDecl *Property = canSynthesizeProvisionalIvar(II);
Fariborz Jahanian69d56242010-07-22 23:33:21 +00001502 if (Property) {
1503 Diag(NameLoc, diag::warn_ivar_variable_conflict) << Var->getDeclName();
1504 Diag(Property->getLocation(), diag::note_property_declare);
Fariborz Jahanianf759b4d2010-08-13 18:09:39 +00001505 Diag(Var->getLocation(), diag::note_global_declared_at);
Fariborz Jahanian69d56242010-07-22 23:33:21 +00001506 }
1507 }
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001508 } else if (FunctionDecl *Func = R.getAsSingle<FunctionDecl>()) {
Douglas Gregor751f9a42009-06-30 15:47:41 +00001509 if (!getLangOptions().CPlusPlus && !Func->hasPrototype()) {
1510 // C99 DR 316 says that, if a function type comes from a
1511 // function definition (without a prototype), that type is only
1512 // used for checking compatibility. Therefore, when referencing
1513 // the function, we pretend that we don't have the full function
1514 // type.
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001515 if (DiagnoseUseOfDecl(Func, NameLoc))
Douglas Gregor751f9a42009-06-30 15:47:41 +00001516 return ExprError();
Douglas Gregorbcbffc42009-01-07 00:43:41 +00001517
Douglas Gregor751f9a42009-06-30 15:47:41 +00001518 QualType T = Func->getType();
1519 QualType NoProtoType = T;
John McCall183700f2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00001520 if (const FunctionProtoType *Proto = T->getAs<FunctionProtoType>())
Eli Friedman9a0fcfe2010-05-17 02:50:18 +00001521 NoProtoType = Context.getFunctionNoProtoType(Proto->getResultType(),
1522 Proto->getExtInfo());
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001523 return BuildDeclRefExpr(Func, NoProtoType, NameLoc, &SS);
Douglas Gregor751f9a42009-06-30 15:47:41 +00001524 }
1525 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001526
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00001527 // Check whether this might be a C++ implicit instance member access.
John McCallfb97e752010-08-24 22:52:39 +00001528 // C++ [class.mfct.non-static]p3:
1529 // When an id-expression that is not part of a class member access
1530 // syntax and not used to form a pointer to member is used in the
1531 // body of a non-static member function of class X, if name lookup
1532 // resolves the name in the id-expression to a non-static non-type
1533 // member of some class C, the id-expression is transformed into a
1534 // class member access expression using (*this) as the
1535 // postfix-expression to the left of the . operator.
John McCall9c72c602010-08-27 09:08:28 +00001536 //
1537 // But we don't actually need to do this for '&' operands if R
1538 // resolved to a function or overloaded function set, because the
1539 // expression is ill-formed if it actually works out to be a
1540 // non-static member function:
1541 //
1542 // C++ [expr.ref]p4:
1543 // Otherwise, if E1.E2 refers to a non-static member function. . .
1544 // [t]he expression can be used only as the left-hand operand of a
1545 // member function call.
1546 //
1547 // There are other safeguards against such uses, but it's important
1548 // to get this right here so that we don't end up making a
1549 // spuriously dependent expression if we're inside a dependent
1550 // instance method.
John McCall3b4294e2009-12-16 12:17:52 +00001551 if (!R.empty() && (*R.begin())->isCXXClassMember()) {
John McCall9c72c602010-08-27 09:08:28 +00001552 bool MightBeImplicitMember;
1553 if (!isAddressOfOperand)
1554 MightBeImplicitMember = true;
1555 else if (!SS.isEmpty())
1556 MightBeImplicitMember = false;
1557 else if (R.isOverloadedResult())
1558 MightBeImplicitMember = false;
Douglas Gregore2248be2010-08-30 16:00:47 +00001559 else if (R.isUnresolvableResult())
1560 MightBeImplicitMember = true;
John McCall9c72c602010-08-27 09:08:28 +00001561 else
1562 MightBeImplicitMember = isa<FieldDecl>(R.getFoundDecl());
1563
1564 if (MightBeImplicitMember)
John McCall3b4294e2009-12-16 12:17:52 +00001565 return BuildPossibleImplicitMemberExpr(SS, R, TemplateArgs);
John McCall5b3f9132009-11-22 01:44:31 +00001566 }
1567
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001568 if (TemplateArgs)
1569 return BuildTemplateIdExpr(SS, R, ADL, *TemplateArgs);
John McCall5b3f9132009-11-22 01:44:31 +00001570
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001571 return BuildDeclarationNameExpr(SS, R, ADL);
1572}
1573
John McCall3b4294e2009-12-16 12:17:52 +00001574/// Builds an expression which might be an implicit member expression.
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00001575ExprResult
John McCall3b4294e2009-12-16 12:17:52 +00001576Sema::BuildPossibleImplicitMemberExpr(const CXXScopeSpec &SS,
1577 LookupResult &R,
1578 const TemplateArgumentListInfo *TemplateArgs) {
1579 switch (ClassifyImplicitMemberAccess(*this, R)) {
1580 case IMA_Instance:
1581 return BuildImplicitMemberExpr(SS, R, TemplateArgs, true);
1582
1583 case IMA_AnonymousMember:
1584 assert(R.isSingleResult());
1585 return BuildAnonymousStructUnionMemberReference(R.getNameLoc(),
1586 R.getAsSingle<FieldDecl>());
1587
1588 case IMA_Mixed:
1589 case IMA_Mixed_Unrelated:
1590 case IMA_Unresolved:
1591 return BuildImplicitMemberExpr(SS, R, TemplateArgs, false);
1592
1593 case IMA_Static:
1594 case IMA_Mixed_StaticContext:
1595 case IMA_Unresolved_StaticContext:
1596 if (TemplateArgs)
1597 return BuildTemplateIdExpr(SS, R, false, *TemplateArgs);
1598 return BuildDeclarationNameExpr(SS, R, false);
1599
1600 case IMA_Error_StaticContext:
1601 case IMA_Error_Unrelated:
1602 DiagnoseInstanceReference(*this, SS, R);
1603 return ExprError();
1604 }
1605
1606 llvm_unreachable("unexpected instance member access kind");
1607 return ExprError();
1608}
1609
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00001610/// BuildQualifiedDeclarationNameExpr - Build a C++ qualified
1611/// declaration name, generally during template instantiation.
1612/// There's a large number of things which don't need to be done along
1613/// this path.
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00001614ExprResult
Jeffrey Yasskin9ab14542010-04-08 16:38:48 +00001615Sema::BuildQualifiedDeclarationNameExpr(CXXScopeSpec &SS,
Abramo Bagnara25777432010-08-11 22:01:17 +00001616 const DeclarationNameInfo &NameInfo) {
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001617 DeclContext *DC;
Douglas Gregore6ec5c42010-04-28 07:04:26 +00001618 if (!(DC = computeDeclContext(SS, false)) || DC->isDependentContext())
Abramo Bagnara25777432010-08-11 22:01:17 +00001619 return BuildDependentDeclRefExpr(SS, NameInfo, 0);
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001620
John McCall77bb1aa2010-05-01 00:40:08 +00001621 if (RequireCompleteDeclContext(SS, DC))
Douglas Gregore6ec5c42010-04-28 07:04:26 +00001622 return ExprError();
1623
Abramo Bagnara25777432010-08-11 22:01:17 +00001624 LookupResult R(*this, NameInfo, LookupOrdinaryName);
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001625 LookupQualifiedName(R, DC);
1626
1627 if (R.isAmbiguous())
1628 return ExprError();
1629
1630 if (R.empty()) {
Abramo Bagnara25777432010-08-11 22:01:17 +00001631 Diag(NameInfo.getLoc(), diag::err_no_member)
1632 << NameInfo.getName() << DC << SS.getRange();
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001633 return ExprError();
1634 }
1635
1636 return BuildDeclarationNameExpr(SS, R, /*ADL*/ false);
1637}
1638
1639/// LookupInObjCMethod - The parser has read a name in, and Sema has
1640/// detected that we're currently inside an ObjC method. Perform some
1641/// additional lookup.
1642///
1643/// Ideally, most of this would be done by lookup, but there's
1644/// actually quite a lot of extra work involved.
1645///
1646/// Returns a null sentinel to indicate trivial success.
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00001647ExprResult
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001648Sema::LookupInObjCMethod(LookupResult &Lookup, Scope *S,
Chris Lattnereb483eb2010-04-11 08:28:14 +00001649 IdentifierInfo *II, bool AllowBuiltinCreation) {
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001650 SourceLocation Loc = Lookup.getNameLoc();
Chris Lattneraec43db2010-04-12 05:10:17 +00001651 ObjCMethodDecl *CurMethod = getCurMethodDecl();
Sean Hunt1e3f5ba2010-04-28 23:02:27 +00001652
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001653 // There are two cases to handle here. 1) scoped lookup could have failed,
1654 // in which case we should look for an ivar. 2) scoped lookup could have
1655 // found a decl, but that decl is outside the current instance method (i.e.
1656 // a global variable). In these two cases, we do a lookup for an ivar with
1657 // this name, if the lookup sucedes, we replace it our current decl.
1658
1659 // If we're in a class method, we don't normally want to look for
1660 // ivars. But if we don't find anything else, and there's an
1661 // ivar, that's an error.
Chris Lattneraec43db2010-04-12 05:10:17 +00001662 bool IsClassMethod = CurMethod->isClassMethod();
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001663
1664 bool LookForIvars;
1665 if (Lookup.empty())
1666 LookForIvars = true;
1667 else if (IsClassMethod)
1668 LookForIvars = false;
1669 else
1670 LookForIvars = (Lookup.isSingleResult() &&
1671 Lookup.getFoundDecl()->isDefinedOutsideFunctionOrMethod());
Fariborz Jahanian412e7982010-02-09 19:31:38 +00001672 ObjCInterfaceDecl *IFace = 0;
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001673 if (LookForIvars) {
Chris Lattneraec43db2010-04-12 05:10:17 +00001674 IFace = CurMethod->getClassInterface();
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001675 ObjCInterfaceDecl *ClassDeclared;
1676 if (ObjCIvarDecl *IV = IFace->lookupInstanceVariable(II, ClassDeclared)) {
1677 // Diagnose using an ivar in a class method.
1678 if (IsClassMethod)
1679 return ExprError(Diag(Loc, diag::error_ivar_use_in_class_method)
1680 << IV->getDeclName());
1681
1682 // If we're referencing an invalid decl, just return this as a silent
1683 // error node. The error diagnostic was already emitted on the decl.
1684 if (IV->isInvalidDecl())
1685 return ExprError();
1686
1687 // Check if referencing a field with __attribute__((deprecated)).
1688 if (DiagnoseUseOfDecl(IV, Loc))
1689 return ExprError();
1690
1691 // Diagnose the use of an ivar outside of the declaring class.
1692 if (IV->getAccessControl() == ObjCIvarDecl::Private &&
1693 ClassDeclared != IFace)
1694 Diag(Loc, diag::error_private_ivar_access) << IV->getDeclName();
1695
1696 // FIXME: This should use a new expr for a direct reference, don't
1697 // turn this into Self->ivar, just return a BareIVarExpr or something.
1698 IdentifierInfo &II = Context.Idents.get("self");
1699 UnqualifiedId SelfName;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001700 SelfName.setIdentifier(&II, SourceLocation());
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001701 CXXScopeSpec SelfScopeSpec;
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00001702 ExprResult SelfExpr = ActOnIdExpression(S, SelfScopeSpec,
Douglas Gregore45bb6a2010-09-22 16:33:13 +00001703 SelfName, false, false);
1704 if (SelfExpr.isInvalid())
1705 return ExprError();
1706
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001707 MarkDeclarationReferenced(Loc, IV);
1708 return Owned(new (Context)
1709 ObjCIvarRefExpr(IV, IV->getType(), Loc,
1710 SelfExpr.takeAs<Expr>(), true, true));
1711 }
Chris Lattneraec43db2010-04-12 05:10:17 +00001712 } else if (CurMethod->isInstanceMethod()) {
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001713 // We should warn if a local variable hides an ivar.
Chris Lattneraec43db2010-04-12 05:10:17 +00001714 ObjCInterfaceDecl *IFace = CurMethod->getClassInterface();
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001715 ObjCInterfaceDecl *ClassDeclared;
1716 if (ObjCIvarDecl *IV = IFace->lookupInstanceVariable(II, ClassDeclared)) {
1717 if (IV->getAccessControl() != ObjCIvarDecl::Private ||
1718 IFace == ClassDeclared)
1719 Diag(Loc, diag::warn_ivar_use_hidden) << IV->getDeclName();
1720 }
1721 }
1722
Fariborz Jahanian48c2d562010-01-12 23:58:59 +00001723 if (Lookup.empty() && II && AllowBuiltinCreation) {
1724 // FIXME. Consolidate this with similar code in LookupName.
1725 if (unsigned BuiltinID = II->getBuiltinID()) {
1726 if (!(getLangOptions().CPlusPlus &&
1727 Context.BuiltinInfo.isPredefinedLibFunction(BuiltinID))) {
1728 NamedDecl *D = LazilyCreateBuiltin((IdentifierInfo *)II, BuiltinID,
1729 S, Lookup.isForRedeclaration(),
1730 Lookup.getNameLoc());
1731 if (D) Lookup.addDecl(D);
1732 }
1733 }
1734 }
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001735 // Sentinel value saying that we didn't do anything special.
1736 return Owned((Expr*) 0);
Douglas Gregor751f9a42009-06-30 15:47:41 +00001737}
John McCallba135432009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001738
John McCall6bb80172010-03-30 21:47:33 +00001739/// \brief Cast a base object to a member's actual type.
1740///
1741/// Logically this happens in three phases:
1742///
1743/// * First we cast from the base type to the naming class.
1744/// The naming class is the class into which we were looking
1745/// when we found the member; it's the qualifier type if a
1746/// qualifier was provided, and otherwise it's the base type.
1747///
1748/// * Next we cast from the naming class to the declaring class.
1749/// If the member we found was brought into a class's scope by
1750/// a using declaration, this is that class; otherwise it's
1751/// the class declaring the member.
1752///
1753/// * Finally we cast from the declaring class to the "true"
1754/// declaring class of the member. This conversion does not
1755/// obey access control.
Fariborz Jahanianf3e53d32009-07-29 19:40:11 +00001756bool
Douglas Gregor5fccd362010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001757Sema::PerformObjectMemberConversion(Expr *&From,
1758 NestedNameSpecifier *Qualifier,
John McCall6bb80172010-03-30 21:47:33 +00001759 NamedDecl *FoundDecl,
Douglas Gregor5fccd362010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001760 NamedDecl *Member) {
1761 CXXRecordDecl *RD = dyn_cast<CXXRecordDecl>(Member->getDeclContext());
1762 if (!RD)
1763 return false;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001764
Douglas Gregor5fccd362010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001765 QualType DestRecordType;
1766 QualType DestType;
1767 QualType FromRecordType;
1768 QualType FromType = From->getType();
1769 bool PointerConversions = false;
1770 if (isa<FieldDecl>(Member)) {
1771 DestRecordType = Context.getCanonicalType(Context.getTypeDeclType(RD));
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001772
Douglas Gregor5fccd362010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001773 if (FromType->getAs<PointerType>()) {
1774 DestType = Context.getPointerType(DestRecordType);
1775 FromRecordType = FromType->getPointeeType();
1776 PointerConversions = true;
1777 } else {
1778 DestType = DestRecordType;
1779 FromRecordType = FromType;
Fariborz Jahanian98a541e2009-07-29 18:40:24 +00001780 }
Douglas Gregor5fccd362010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001781 } else if (CXXMethodDecl *Method = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(Member)) {
1782 if (Method->isStatic())
1783 return false;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001784
Douglas Gregor5fccd362010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001785 DestType = Method->getThisType(Context);
1786 DestRecordType = DestType->getPointeeType();
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001787
Douglas Gregor5fccd362010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001788 if (FromType->getAs<PointerType>()) {
1789 FromRecordType = FromType->getPointeeType();
1790 PointerConversions = true;
1791 } else {
1792 FromRecordType = FromType;
1793 DestType = DestRecordType;
1794 }
1795 } else {
1796 // No conversion necessary.
1797 return false;
1798 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001799
Douglas Gregor5fccd362010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001800 if (DestType->isDependentType() || FromType->isDependentType())
1801 return false;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001802
Douglas Gregor5fccd362010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001803 // If the unqualified types are the same, no conversion is necessary.
1804 if (Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(FromRecordType, DestRecordType))
1805 return false;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001806
John McCall6bb80172010-03-30 21:47:33 +00001807 SourceRange FromRange = From->getSourceRange();
1808 SourceLocation FromLoc = FromRange.getBegin();
1809
John McCall5baba9d2010-08-25 10:28:54 +00001810 ExprValueKind VK = CastCategory(From);
Sebastian Redl906082e2010-07-20 04:20:21 +00001811
Douglas Gregor5fccd362010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001812 // C++ [class.member.lookup]p8:
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001813 // [...] Ambiguities can often be resolved by qualifying a name with its
Douglas Gregor5fccd362010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001814 // class name.
1815 //
1816 // If the member was a qualified name and the qualified referred to a
1817 // specific base subobject type, we'll cast to that intermediate type
1818 // first and then to the object in which the member is declared. That allows
1819 // one to resolve ambiguities in, e.g., a diamond-shaped hierarchy such as:
1820 //
1821 // class Base { public: int x; };
1822 // class Derived1 : public Base { };
1823 // class Derived2 : public Base { };
1824 // class VeryDerived : public Derived1, public Derived2 { void f(); };
1825 //
1826 // void VeryDerived::f() {
1827 // x = 17; // error: ambiguous base subobjects
1828 // Derived1::x = 17; // okay, pick the Base subobject of Derived1
1829 // }
Douglas Gregor5fccd362010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001830 if (Qualifier) {
John McCall6bb80172010-03-30 21:47:33 +00001831 QualType QType = QualType(Qualifier->getAsType(), 0);
1832 assert(!QType.isNull() && "lookup done with dependent qualifier?");
1833 assert(QType->isRecordType() && "lookup done with non-record type");
1834
1835 QualType QRecordType = QualType(QType->getAs<RecordType>(), 0);
1836
1837 // In C++98, the qualifier type doesn't actually have to be a base
1838 // type of the object type, in which case we just ignore it.
1839 // Otherwise build the appropriate casts.
1840 if (IsDerivedFrom(FromRecordType, QRecordType)) {
John McCallf871d0c2010-08-07 06:22:56 +00001841 CXXCastPath BasePath;
John McCall6bb80172010-03-30 21:47:33 +00001842 if (CheckDerivedToBaseConversion(FromRecordType, QRecordType,
Anders Carlssoncee22422010-04-24 19:22:20 +00001843 FromLoc, FromRange, &BasePath))
John McCall6bb80172010-03-30 21:47:33 +00001844 return true;
1845
Douglas Gregor5fccd362010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001846 if (PointerConversions)
John McCall6bb80172010-03-30 21:47:33 +00001847 QType = Context.getPointerType(QType);
John McCall5baba9d2010-08-25 10:28:54 +00001848 ImpCastExprToType(From, QType, CK_UncheckedDerivedToBase,
1849 VK, &BasePath);
John McCall6bb80172010-03-30 21:47:33 +00001850
1851 FromType = QType;
1852 FromRecordType = QRecordType;
1853
1854 // If the qualifier type was the same as the destination type,
1855 // we're done.
1856 if (Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(FromRecordType, DestRecordType))
1857 return false;
Douglas Gregor5fccd362010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001858 }
1859 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001860
John McCall6bb80172010-03-30 21:47:33 +00001861 bool IgnoreAccess = false;
Douglas Gregor5fccd362010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001862
John McCall6bb80172010-03-30 21:47:33 +00001863 // If we actually found the member through a using declaration, cast
1864 // down to the using declaration's type.
1865 //
1866 // Pointer equality is fine here because only one declaration of a
1867 // class ever has member declarations.
1868 if (FoundDecl->getDeclContext() != Member->getDeclContext()) {
1869 assert(isa<UsingShadowDecl>(FoundDecl));
1870 QualType URecordType = Context.getTypeDeclType(
1871 cast<CXXRecordDecl>(FoundDecl->getDeclContext()));
1872
1873 // We only need to do this if the naming-class to declaring-class
1874 // conversion is non-trivial.
1875 if (!Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(FromRecordType, URecordType)) {
1876 assert(IsDerivedFrom(FromRecordType, URecordType));
John McCallf871d0c2010-08-07 06:22:56 +00001877 CXXCastPath BasePath;
John McCall6bb80172010-03-30 21:47:33 +00001878 if (CheckDerivedToBaseConversion(FromRecordType, URecordType,
Anders Carlssoncee22422010-04-24 19:22:20 +00001879 FromLoc, FromRange, &BasePath))
John McCall6bb80172010-03-30 21:47:33 +00001880 return true;
Sean Hunt1e3f5ba2010-04-28 23:02:27 +00001881
John McCall6bb80172010-03-30 21:47:33 +00001882 QualType UType = URecordType;
1883 if (PointerConversions)
1884 UType = Context.getPointerType(UType);
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00001885 ImpCastExprToType(From, UType, CK_UncheckedDerivedToBase,
John McCall5baba9d2010-08-25 10:28:54 +00001886 VK, &BasePath);
John McCall6bb80172010-03-30 21:47:33 +00001887 FromType = UType;
1888 FromRecordType = URecordType;
1889 }
1890
1891 // We don't do access control for the conversion from the
1892 // declaring class to the true declaring class.
1893 IgnoreAccess = true;
Douglas Gregor5fccd362010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001894 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001895
John McCallf871d0c2010-08-07 06:22:56 +00001896 CXXCastPath BasePath;
Anders Carlssoncee22422010-04-24 19:22:20 +00001897 if (CheckDerivedToBaseConversion(FromRecordType, DestRecordType,
1898 FromLoc, FromRange, &BasePath,
John McCall6bb80172010-03-30 21:47:33 +00001899 IgnoreAccess))
Douglas Gregor5fccd362010-03-03 23:55:11 +00001900 return true;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00001901
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00001902 ImpCastExprToType(From, DestType, CK_UncheckedDerivedToBase,
John McCall5baba9d2010-08-25 10:28:54 +00001903 VK, &BasePath);
Fariborz Jahanianf3e53d32009-07-29 19:40:11 +00001904 return false;
Fariborz Jahanian98a541e2009-07-29 18:40:24 +00001905}
Douglas Gregor751f9a42009-06-30 15:47:41 +00001906
Douglas Gregor83f6faf2009-08-31 23:41:50 +00001907/// \brief Build a MemberExpr AST node.
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001908static MemberExpr *BuildMemberExpr(ASTContext &C, Expr *Base, bool isArrow,
Eli Friedmanf595cc42009-12-04 06:40:45 +00001909 const CXXScopeSpec &SS, ValueDecl *Member,
John McCall161755a2010-04-06 21:38:20 +00001910 DeclAccessPair FoundDecl,
Abramo Bagnara25777432010-08-11 22:01:17 +00001911 const DeclarationNameInfo &MemberNameInfo,
1912 QualType Ty,
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001913 const TemplateArgumentListInfo *TemplateArgs = 0) {
1914 NestedNameSpecifier *Qualifier = 0;
1915 SourceRange QualifierRange;
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00001916 if (SS.isSet()) {
1917 Qualifier = (NestedNameSpecifier *) SS.getScopeRep();
1918 QualifierRange = SS.getRange();
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001919 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00001920
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001921 return MemberExpr::Create(C, Base, isArrow, Qualifier, QualifierRange,
Abramo Bagnara25777432010-08-11 22:01:17 +00001922 Member, FoundDecl, MemberNameInfo,
1923 TemplateArgs, Ty);
Douglas Gregorbd4c4ae2009-08-26 22:36:53 +00001924}
1925
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00001926/// Builds an implicit member access expression. The current context
1927/// is known to be an instance method, and the given unqualified lookup
1928/// set is known to contain only instance members, at least one of which
1929/// is from an appropriate type.
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00001930ExprResult
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00001931Sema::BuildImplicitMemberExpr(const CXXScopeSpec &SS,
1932 LookupResult &R,
1933 const TemplateArgumentListInfo *TemplateArgs,
1934 bool IsKnownInstance) {
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001935 assert(!R.empty() && !R.isAmbiguous());
1936
John McCallba135432009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001937 SourceLocation Loc = R.getNameLoc();
Sebastian Redlebc07d52009-02-03 20:19:35 +00001938
Douglas Gregorbcbffc42009-01-07 00:43:41 +00001939 // We may have found a field within an anonymous union or struct
1940 // (C++ [class.union]).
Douglas Gregore961afb2009-10-22 07:08:30 +00001941 // FIXME: This needs to happen post-isImplicitMemberReference?
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001942 // FIXME: template-ids inside anonymous structs?
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00001943 if (FieldDecl *FD = R.getAsSingle<FieldDecl>())
Douglas Gregorbcbffc42009-01-07 00:43:41 +00001944 if (cast<RecordDecl>(FD->getDeclContext())->isAnonymousStructOrUnion())
John McCall5b3f9132009-11-22 01:44:31 +00001945 return BuildAnonymousStructUnionMemberReference(Loc, FD);
Sebastian Redlcd965b92009-01-18 18:53:16 +00001946
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00001947 // If this is known to be an instance access, go ahead and build a
1948 // 'this' expression now.
John McCallea1471e2010-05-20 01:18:31 +00001949 DeclContext *DC = getFunctionLevelDeclContext();
1950 QualType ThisType = cast<CXXMethodDecl>(DC)->getThisType(Context);
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00001951 Expr *This = 0; // null signifies implicit access
1952 if (IsKnownInstance) {
Douglas Gregor828a1972010-01-07 23:12:05 +00001953 SourceLocation Loc = R.getNameLoc();
1954 if (SS.getRange().isValid())
1955 Loc = SS.getRange().getBegin();
1956 This = new (Context) CXXThisExpr(Loc, ThisType, /*isImplicit=*/true);
Douglas Gregor88a35142008-12-22 05:46:06 +00001957 }
1958
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00001959 return BuildMemberReferenceExpr(This, ThisType,
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00001960 /*OpLoc*/ SourceLocation(),
1961 /*IsArrow*/ true,
John McCallc2233c52010-01-15 08:34:02 +00001962 SS,
1963 /*FirstQualifierInScope*/ 0,
1964 R, TemplateArgs);
John McCallba135432009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001965}
1966
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001967bool Sema::UseArgumentDependentLookup(const CXXScopeSpec &SS,
John McCall5b3f9132009-11-22 01:44:31 +00001968 const LookupResult &R,
1969 bool HasTrailingLParen) {
John McCallba135432009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001970 // Only when used directly as the postfix-expression of a call.
1971 if (!HasTrailingLParen)
1972 return false;
1973
1974 // Never if a scope specifier was provided.
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00001975 if (SS.isSet())
John McCallba135432009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001976 return false;
1977
1978 // Only in C++ or ObjC++.
John McCall5b3f9132009-11-22 01:44:31 +00001979 if (!getLangOptions().CPlusPlus)
John McCallba135432009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001980 return false;
1981
1982 // Turn off ADL when we find certain kinds of declarations during
1983 // normal lookup:
1984 for (LookupResult::iterator I = R.begin(), E = R.end(); I != E; ++I) {
1985 NamedDecl *D = *I;
1986
1987 // C++0x [basic.lookup.argdep]p3:
1988 // -- a declaration of a class member
1989 // Since using decls preserve this property, we check this on the
1990 // original decl.
John McCall3b4294e2009-12-16 12:17:52 +00001991 if (D->isCXXClassMember())
John McCallba135432009-11-21 08:51:07 +00001992 return false;
1993
1994 // C++0x [basic.lookup.argdep]p3:
1995 // -- a block-scope function declaration that is not a
1996 // using-declaration
1997 // NOTE: we also trigger this for function templates (in fact, we
1998 // don't check the decl type at all, since all other decl types
1999 // turn off ADL anyway).
2000 if (isa<UsingShadowDecl>(D))
2001 D = cast<UsingShadowDecl>(D)->getTargetDecl();
2002 else if (D->getDeclContext()->isFunctionOrMethod())
2003 return false;
2004
2005 // C++0x [basic.lookup.argdep]p3:
2006 // -- a declaration that is neither a function or a function
2007 // template
2008 // And also for builtin functions.
2009 if (isa<FunctionDecl>(D)) {
2010 FunctionDecl *FDecl = cast<FunctionDecl>(D);
2011
2012 // But also builtin functions.
2013 if (FDecl->getBuiltinID() && FDecl->isImplicit())
2014 return false;
2015 } else if (!isa<FunctionTemplateDecl>(D))
2016 return false;
2017 }
2018
2019 return true;
2020}
2021
2022
John McCallba135432009-11-21 08:51:07 +00002023/// Diagnoses obvious problems with the use of the given declaration
2024/// as an expression. This is only actually called for lookups that
2025/// were not overloaded, and it doesn't promise that the declaration
2026/// will in fact be used.
2027static bool CheckDeclInExpr(Sema &S, SourceLocation Loc, NamedDecl *D) {
2028 if (isa<TypedefDecl>(D)) {
2029 S.Diag(Loc, diag::err_unexpected_typedef) << D->getDeclName();
2030 return true;
2031 }
2032
2033 if (isa<ObjCInterfaceDecl>(D)) {
2034 S.Diag(Loc, diag::err_unexpected_interface) << D->getDeclName();
2035 return true;
2036 }
2037
2038 if (isa<NamespaceDecl>(D)) {
2039 S.Diag(Loc, diag::err_unexpected_namespace) << D->getDeclName();
2040 return true;
2041 }
2042
2043 return false;
2044}
2045
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00002046ExprResult
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00002047Sema::BuildDeclarationNameExpr(const CXXScopeSpec &SS,
John McCall5b3f9132009-11-22 01:44:31 +00002048 LookupResult &R,
2049 bool NeedsADL) {
John McCallfead20c2009-12-08 22:45:53 +00002050 // If this is a single, fully-resolved result and we don't need ADL,
2051 // just build an ordinary singleton decl ref.
Douglas Gregor86b8e092010-01-29 17:15:43 +00002052 if (!NeedsADL && R.isSingleResult() && !R.getAsSingle<FunctionTemplateDecl>())
Abramo Bagnara25777432010-08-11 22:01:17 +00002053 return BuildDeclarationNameExpr(SS, R.getLookupNameInfo(),
2054 R.getFoundDecl());
John McCallba135432009-11-21 08:51:07 +00002055
2056 // We only need to check the declaration if there's exactly one
2057 // result, because in the overloaded case the results can only be
2058 // functions and function templates.
John McCall5b3f9132009-11-22 01:44:31 +00002059 if (R.isSingleResult() &&
2060 CheckDeclInExpr(*this, R.getNameLoc(), R.getFoundDecl()))
John McCallba135432009-11-21 08:51:07 +00002061 return ExprError();
2062
John McCallc373d482010-01-27 01:50:18 +00002063 // Otherwise, just build an unresolved lookup expression. Suppress
2064 // any lookup-related diagnostics; we'll hash these out later, when
2065 // we've picked a target.
2066 R.suppressDiagnostics();
2067
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00002068 bool Dependent
2069 = UnresolvedLookupExpr::ComputeDependence(R.begin(), R.end(), 0);
John McCallba135432009-11-21 08:51:07 +00002070 UnresolvedLookupExpr *ULE
John McCallc373d482010-01-27 01:50:18 +00002071 = UnresolvedLookupExpr::Create(Context, Dependent, R.getNamingClass(),
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00002072 (NestedNameSpecifier*) SS.getScopeRep(),
Abramo Bagnara25777432010-08-11 22:01:17 +00002073 SS.getRange(), R.getLookupNameInfo(),
Douglas Gregor5a84dec2010-05-23 18:57:34 +00002074 NeedsADL, R.isOverloadedResult(),
2075 R.begin(), R.end());
John McCallba135432009-11-21 08:51:07 +00002076
2077 return Owned(ULE);
2078}
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00002079
John McCallba135432009-11-21 08:51:07 +00002080
2081/// \brief Complete semantic analysis for a reference to the given declaration.
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00002082ExprResult
John McCallf7a1a742009-11-24 19:00:30 +00002083Sema::BuildDeclarationNameExpr(const CXXScopeSpec &SS,
Abramo Bagnara25777432010-08-11 22:01:17 +00002084 const DeclarationNameInfo &NameInfo,
2085 NamedDecl *D) {
John McCallba135432009-11-21 08:51:07 +00002086 assert(D && "Cannot refer to a NULL declaration");
John McCall7453ed42009-11-22 00:44:51 +00002087 assert(!isa<FunctionTemplateDecl>(D) &&
2088 "Cannot refer unambiguously to a function template");
John McCallba135432009-11-21 08:51:07 +00002089
Abramo Bagnara25777432010-08-11 22:01:17 +00002090 SourceLocation Loc = NameInfo.getLoc();
John McCallba135432009-11-21 08:51:07 +00002091 if (CheckDeclInExpr(*this, Loc, D))
2092 return ExprError();
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002093
Douglas Gregor9af2f522009-12-01 16:58:18 +00002094 if (TemplateDecl *Template = dyn_cast<TemplateDecl>(D)) {
2095 // Specifically diagnose references to class templates that are missing
2096 // a template argument list.
2097 Diag(Loc, diag::err_template_decl_ref)
2098 << Template << SS.getRange();
2099 Diag(Template->getLocation(), diag::note_template_decl_here);
2100 return ExprError();
2101 }
2102
2103 // Make sure that we're referring to a value.
2104 ValueDecl *VD = dyn_cast<ValueDecl>(D);
2105 if (!VD) {
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00002106 Diag(Loc, diag::err_ref_non_value)
Douglas Gregor9af2f522009-12-01 16:58:18 +00002107 << D << SS.getRange();
John McCall87cf6702009-12-18 18:35:10 +00002108 Diag(D->getLocation(), diag::note_declared_at);
Douglas Gregor9af2f522009-12-01 16:58:18 +00002109 return ExprError();
2110 }
Sebastian Redlcd965b92009-01-18 18:53:16 +00002111
Douglas Gregor48f3bb92009-02-18 21:56:37 +00002112 // Check whether this declaration can be used. Note that we suppress
2113 // this check when we're going to perform argument-dependent lookup
2114 // on this function name, because this might not be the function
2115 // that overload resolution actually selects.
John McCallba135432009-11-21 08:51:07 +00002116 if (DiagnoseUseOfDecl(VD, Loc))
Douglas Gregor48f3bb92009-02-18 21:56:37 +00002117 return ExprError();
2118
Steve Naroffdd972f22008-09-05 22:11:13 +00002119 // Only create DeclRefExpr's for valid Decl's.
2120 if (VD->isInvalidDecl())
Sebastian Redlcd965b92009-01-18 18:53:16 +00002121 return ExprError();
2122
Chris Lattner639e2d32008-10-20 05:16:36 +00002123 // If the identifier reference is inside a block, and it refers to a value
2124 // that is outside the block, create a BlockDeclRefExpr instead of a
2125 // DeclRefExpr. This ensures the value is treated as a copy-in snapshot when
2126 // the block is formed.
Steve Naroffdd972f22008-09-05 22:11:13 +00002127 //
Chris Lattner639e2d32008-10-20 05:16:36 +00002128 // We do not do this for things like enum constants, global variables, etc,
2129 // as they do not get snapshotted.
2130 //
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00002131 if (getCurBlock() &&
Douglas Gregor9ea9bdb2010-03-01 23:15:13 +00002132 ShouldSnapshotBlockValueReference(*this, getCurBlock(), VD)) {
Mike Stump0d6fd572010-01-05 02:56:35 +00002133 if (VD->getType().getTypePtr()->isVariablyModifiedType()) {
2134 Diag(Loc, diag::err_ref_vm_type);
2135 Diag(D->getLocation(), diag::note_declared_at);
2136 return ExprError();
2137 }
2138
Fariborz Jahanian8596bbe2010-03-16 23:39:51 +00002139 if (VD->getType()->isArrayType()) {
Mike Stump28497342010-01-05 03:10:36 +00002140 Diag(Loc, diag::err_ref_array_type);
2141 Diag(D->getLocation(), diag::note_declared_at);
2142 return ExprError();
2143 }
2144
Douglas Gregore0762c92009-06-19 23:52:42 +00002145 MarkDeclarationReferenced(Loc, VD);
Eli Friedman5fdeae12009-03-22 23:00:19 +00002146 QualType ExprTy = VD->getType().getNonReferenceType();
Steve Naroff090276f2008-10-10 01:28:17 +00002147 // The BlocksAttr indicates the variable is bound by-reference.
Argyrios Kyrtzidis40b598e2009-06-30 02:34:44 +00002148 if (VD->getAttr<BlocksAttr>())
Eli Friedman5fdeae12009-03-22 23:00:19 +00002149 return Owned(new (Context) BlockDeclRefExpr(VD, ExprTy, Loc, true));
Fariborz Jahanian7d5c74e2009-06-19 23:37:08 +00002150 // This is to record that a 'const' was actually synthesize and added.
2151 bool constAdded = !ExprTy.isConstQualified();
Steve Naroff090276f2008-10-10 01:28:17 +00002152 // Variable will be bound by-copy, make it const within the closure.
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002153
Eli Friedman5fdeae12009-03-22 23:00:19 +00002154 ExprTy.addConst();
Fariborz Jahanian52bc56a2010-07-12 17:26:57 +00002155 QualType T = VD->getType();
Fariborz Jahanian59da45a2010-06-04 21:35:44 +00002156 BlockDeclRefExpr *BDRE = new (Context) BlockDeclRefExpr(VD,
2157 ExprTy, Loc, false,
Fariborz Jahanian84ca0082010-07-12 18:12:03 +00002158 constAdded);
Fariborz Jahanian833f42e2010-07-09 22:21:32 +00002159 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
2160 if (!T->isDependentType() && !T->isReferenceType()) {
2161 Expr *E = new (Context)
2162 DeclRefExpr(const_cast<ValueDecl*>(BDRE->getDecl()), T,
2163 SourceLocation());
Fariborz Jahaniane27e9d62010-11-11 00:11:38 +00002164 if (T->getAs<RecordType>())
2165 if (!T->isUnionType()) {
2166 ExprResult Res = PerformCopyInitialization(
Fariborz Jahanian833f42e2010-07-09 22:21:32 +00002167 InitializedEntity::InitializeBlock(VD->getLocation(),
Fariborz Jahanian310b1c42010-06-07 16:14:00 +00002168 T, false),
Fariborz Jahanian833f42e2010-07-09 22:21:32 +00002169 SourceLocation(),
2170 Owned(E));
Fariborz Jahaniane27e9d62010-11-11 00:11:38 +00002171 if (!Res.isInvalid()) {
2172 Res = MaybeCreateCXXExprWithTemporaries(Res.get());
2173 Expr *Init = Res.takeAs<Expr>();
2174 BDRE->setCopyConstructorExpr(Init);
2175 }
Fariborz Jahanian833f42e2010-07-09 22:21:32 +00002176 }
Fariborz Jahanian59da45a2010-06-04 21:35:44 +00002177 }
2178 }
2179 return Owned(BDRE);
Steve Naroff090276f2008-10-10 01:28:17 +00002180 }
2181 // If this reference is not in a block or if the referenced variable is
2182 // within the block, create a normal DeclRefExpr.
Douglas Gregor898574e2008-12-05 23:32:09 +00002183
Abramo Bagnara25777432010-08-11 22:01:17 +00002184 return BuildDeclRefExpr(VD, VD->getType().getNonReferenceType(),
2185 NameInfo, &SS);
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002186}
2187
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00002188ExprResult Sema::ActOnPredefinedExpr(SourceLocation Loc,
Sebastian Redlcd965b92009-01-18 18:53:16 +00002189 tok::TokenKind Kind) {
Chris Lattnerd9f69102008-08-10 01:53:14 +00002190 PredefinedExpr::IdentType IT;
Sebastian Redlcd965b92009-01-18 18:53:16 +00002191
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002192 switch (Kind) {
Chris Lattner1423ea42008-01-12 18:39:25 +00002193 default: assert(0 && "Unknown simple primary expr!");
Chris Lattnerd9f69102008-08-10 01:53:14 +00002194 case tok::kw___func__: IT = PredefinedExpr::Func; break; // [C99 6.4.2.2]
2195 case tok::kw___FUNCTION__: IT = PredefinedExpr::Function; break;
2196 case tok::kw___PRETTY_FUNCTION__: IT = PredefinedExpr::PrettyFunction; break;
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002197 }
Chris Lattner1423ea42008-01-12 18:39:25 +00002198
Chris Lattnerfa28b302008-01-12 08:14:25 +00002199 // Pre-defined identifiers are of type char[x], where x is the length of the
2200 // string.
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002201
Anders Carlsson3a082d82009-09-08 18:24:21 +00002202 Decl *currentDecl = getCurFunctionOrMethodDecl();
Fariborz Jahanianeb024ac2010-07-23 21:53:24 +00002203 if (!currentDecl && getCurBlock())
2204 currentDecl = getCurBlock()->TheDecl;
Anders Carlsson3a082d82009-09-08 18:24:21 +00002205 if (!currentDecl) {
Chris Lattnerb0da9232008-12-12 05:05:20 +00002206 Diag(Loc, diag::ext_predef_outside_function);
Anders Carlsson3a082d82009-09-08 18:24:21 +00002207 currentDecl = Context.getTranslationUnitDecl();
Chris Lattnerb0da9232008-12-12 05:05:20 +00002208 }
Sebastian Redlcd965b92009-01-18 18:53:16 +00002209
Anders Carlsson773f3972009-09-11 01:22:35 +00002210 QualType ResTy;
2211 if (cast<DeclContext>(currentDecl)->isDependentContext()) {
2212 ResTy = Context.DependentTy;
2213 } else {
Anders Carlsson848fa642010-02-11 18:20:28 +00002214 unsigned Length = PredefinedExpr::ComputeName(IT, currentDecl).length();
Sebastian Redlcd965b92009-01-18 18:53:16 +00002215
Anders Carlsson773f3972009-09-11 01:22:35 +00002216 llvm::APInt LengthI(32, Length + 1);
John McCall0953e762009-09-24 19:53:00 +00002217 ResTy = Context.CharTy.withConst();
Anders Carlsson773f3972009-09-11 01:22:35 +00002218 ResTy = Context.getConstantArrayType(ResTy, LengthI, ArrayType::Normal, 0);
2219 }
Steve Naroff6ece14c2009-01-21 00:14:39 +00002220 return Owned(new (Context) PredefinedExpr(Loc, ResTy, IT));
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002221}
2222
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00002223ExprResult Sema::ActOnCharacterConstant(const Token &Tok) {
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002224 llvm::SmallString<16> CharBuffer;
Douglas Gregor453091c2010-03-16 22:30:13 +00002225 bool Invalid = false;
2226 llvm::StringRef ThisTok = PP.getSpelling(Tok, CharBuffer, &Invalid);
2227 if (Invalid)
2228 return ExprError();
Sebastian Redlcd965b92009-01-18 18:53:16 +00002229
Benjamin Kramerddeea562010-02-27 13:44:12 +00002230 CharLiteralParser Literal(ThisTok.begin(), ThisTok.end(), Tok.getLocation(),
2231 PP);
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002232 if (Literal.hadError())
Sebastian Redlcd965b92009-01-18 18:53:16 +00002233 return ExprError();
Chris Lattnerfc62bfd2008-03-01 08:32:21 +00002234
Chris Lattnere8337df2009-12-30 21:19:39 +00002235 QualType Ty;
2236 if (!getLangOptions().CPlusPlus)
2237 Ty = Context.IntTy; // 'x' and L'x' -> int in C.
2238 else if (Literal.isWide())
2239 Ty = Context.WCharTy; // L'x' -> wchar_t in C++.
Eli Friedman136b0cd2010-02-03 18:21:45 +00002240 else if (Literal.isMultiChar())
2241 Ty = Context.IntTy; // 'wxyz' -> int in C++.
Chris Lattnere8337df2009-12-30 21:19:39 +00002242 else
2243 Ty = Context.CharTy; // 'x' -> char in C++
Chris Lattnerfc62bfd2008-03-01 08:32:21 +00002244
Sebastian Redle91b3bc2009-01-20 22:23:13 +00002245 return Owned(new (Context) CharacterLiteral(Literal.getValue(),
2246 Literal.isWide(),
Chris Lattnere8337df2009-12-30 21:19:39 +00002247 Ty, Tok.getLocation()));
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002248}
2249
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00002250ExprResult Sema::ActOnNumericConstant(const Token &Tok) {
Sebastian Redlcd965b92009-01-18 18:53:16 +00002251 // Fast path for a single digit (which is quite common). A single digit
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002252 // cannot have a trigraph, escaped newline, radix prefix, or type suffix.
2253 if (Tok.getLength() == 1) {
Chris Lattner7216dc92009-01-26 22:36:52 +00002254 const char Val = PP.getSpellingOfSingleCharacterNumericConstant(Tok);
Chris Lattner0c21e842009-01-16 07:10:29 +00002255 unsigned IntSize = Context.Target.getIntWidth();
Argyrios Kyrtzidis9996a7f2010-08-28 09:06:06 +00002256 return Owned(IntegerLiteral::Create(Context, llvm::APInt(IntSize, Val-'0'),
Steve Naroff0a473932009-01-20 19:53:53 +00002257 Context.IntTy, Tok.getLocation()));
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002258 }
Ted Kremenek28396602009-01-13 23:19:12 +00002259
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002260 llvm::SmallString<512> IntegerBuffer;
Chris Lattner2a299042008-09-30 20:53:45 +00002261 // Add padding so that NumericLiteralParser can overread by one character.
2262 IntegerBuffer.resize(Tok.getLength()+1);
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002263 const char *ThisTokBegin = &IntegerBuffer[0];
Sebastian Redlcd965b92009-01-18 18:53:16 +00002264
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002265 // Get the spelling of the token, which eliminates trigraphs, etc.
Douglas Gregor453091c2010-03-16 22:30:13 +00002266 bool Invalid = false;
2267 unsigned ActualLength = PP.getSpelling(Tok, ThisTokBegin, &Invalid);
2268 if (Invalid)
2269 return ExprError();
Sebastian Redlcd965b92009-01-18 18:53:16 +00002270
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002271 NumericLiteralParser Literal(ThisTokBegin, ThisTokBegin+ActualLength,
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002272 Tok.getLocation(), PP);
2273 if (Literal.hadError)
Sebastian Redlcd965b92009-01-18 18:53:16 +00002274 return ExprError();
2275
Chris Lattner5d661452007-08-26 03:42:43 +00002276 Expr *Res;
Sebastian Redlcd965b92009-01-18 18:53:16 +00002277
Chris Lattner5d661452007-08-26 03:42:43 +00002278 if (Literal.isFloatingLiteral()) {
Chris Lattner525a0502007-09-22 18:29:59 +00002279 QualType Ty;
Chris Lattnerb7cfe882008-06-30 18:32:54 +00002280 if (Literal.isFloat)
Chris Lattner525a0502007-09-22 18:29:59 +00002281 Ty = Context.FloatTy;
Chris Lattnerb7cfe882008-06-30 18:32:54 +00002282 else if (!Literal.isLong)
Chris Lattner525a0502007-09-22 18:29:59 +00002283 Ty = Context.DoubleTy;
Chris Lattnerb7cfe882008-06-30 18:32:54 +00002284 else
Chris Lattner9e9b6dc2008-03-08 08:52:55 +00002285 Ty = Context.LongDoubleTy;
Chris Lattnerb7cfe882008-06-30 18:32:54 +00002286
2287 const llvm::fltSemantics &Format = Context.getFloatTypeSemantics(Ty);
2288
John McCall94c939d2009-12-24 09:08:04 +00002289 using llvm::APFloat;
2290 APFloat Val(Format);
2291
2292 APFloat::opStatus result = Literal.GetFloatValue(Val);
John McCall9f2df882009-12-24 11:09:08 +00002293
2294 // Overflow is always an error, but underflow is only an error if
2295 // we underflowed to zero (APFloat reports denormals as underflow).
2296 if ((result & APFloat::opOverflow) ||
2297 ((result & APFloat::opUnderflow) && Val.isZero())) {
John McCall94c939d2009-12-24 09:08:04 +00002298 unsigned diagnostic;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00002299 llvm::SmallString<20> buffer;
John McCall94c939d2009-12-24 09:08:04 +00002300 if (result & APFloat::opOverflow) {
John McCall2a0d7572010-02-26 23:35:57 +00002301 diagnostic = diag::warn_float_overflow;
John McCall94c939d2009-12-24 09:08:04 +00002302 APFloat::getLargest(Format).toString(buffer);
2303 } else {
John McCall2a0d7572010-02-26 23:35:57 +00002304 diagnostic = diag::warn_float_underflow;
John McCall94c939d2009-12-24 09:08:04 +00002305 APFloat::getSmallest(Format).toString(buffer);
2306 }
2307
2308 Diag(Tok.getLocation(), diagnostic)
2309 << Ty
2310 << llvm::StringRef(buffer.data(), buffer.size());
2311 }
2312
2313 bool isExact = (result == APFloat::opOK);
Argyrios Kyrtzidis9996a7f2010-08-28 09:06:06 +00002314 Res = FloatingLiteral::Create(Context, Val, isExact, Ty, Tok.getLocation());
Sebastian Redlcd965b92009-01-18 18:53:16 +00002315
Chris Lattner5d661452007-08-26 03:42:43 +00002316 } else if (!Literal.isIntegerLiteral()) {
Sebastian Redlcd965b92009-01-18 18:53:16 +00002317 return ExprError();
Chris Lattner5d661452007-08-26 03:42:43 +00002318 } else {
Chris Lattnerf0467b32008-04-02 04:24:33 +00002319 QualType Ty;
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002320
Neil Boothb9449512007-08-29 22:00:19 +00002321 // long long is a C99 feature.
2322 if (!getLangOptions().C99 && !getLangOptions().CPlusPlus0x &&
Neil Booth79859c32007-08-29 22:13:52 +00002323 Literal.isLongLong)
Neil Boothb9449512007-08-29 22:00:19 +00002324 Diag(Tok.getLocation(), diag::ext_longlong);
2325
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002326 // Get the value in the widest-possible width.
Chris Lattner98be4942008-03-05 18:54:05 +00002327 llvm::APInt ResultVal(Context.Target.getIntMaxTWidth(), 0);
Sebastian Redlcd965b92009-01-18 18:53:16 +00002328
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002329 if (Literal.GetIntegerValue(ResultVal)) {
2330 // If this value didn't fit into uintmax_t, warn and force to ull.
2331 Diag(Tok.getLocation(), diag::warn_integer_too_large);
Chris Lattnerf0467b32008-04-02 04:24:33 +00002332 Ty = Context.UnsignedLongLongTy;
2333 assert(Context.getTypeSize(Ty) == ResultVal.getBitWidth() &&
Chris Lattner98be4942008-03-05 18:54:05 +00002334 "long long is not intmax_t?");
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002335 } else {
2336 // If this value fits into a ULL, try to figure out what else it fits into
2337 // according to the rules of C99 6.4.4.1p5.
Sebastian Redlcd965b92009-01-18 18:53:16 +00002338
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002339 // Octal, Hexadecimal, and integers with a U suffix are allowed to
2340 // be an unsigned int.
2341 bool AllowUnsigned = Literal.isUnsigned || Literal.getRadix() != 10;
2342
2343 // Check from smallest to largest, picking the smallest type we can.
Chris Lattner8cbcb0e2008-05-09 05:59:00 +00002344 unsigned Width = 0;
Chris Lattner97c51562007-08-23 21:58:08 +00002345 if (!Literal.isLong && !Literal.isLongLong) {
2346 // Are int/unsigned possibilities?
Chris Lattner8cbcb0e2008-05-09 05:59:00 +00002347 unsigned IntSize = Context.Target.getIntWidth();
Sebastian Redlcd965b92009-01-18 18:53:16 +00002348
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002349 // Does it fit in a unsigned int?
2350 if (ResultVal.isIntN(IntSize)) {
2351 // Does it fit in a signed int?
2352 if (!Literal.isUnsigned && ResultVal[IntSize-1] == 0)
Chris Lattnerf0467b32008-04-02 04:24:33 +00002353 Ty = Context.IntTy;
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002354 else if (AllowUnsigned)
Chris Lattnerf0467b32008-04-02 04:24:33 +00002355 Ty = Context.UnsignedIntTy;
Chris Lattner8cbcb0e2008-05-09 05:59:00 +00002356 Width = IntSize;
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002357 }
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002358 }
Sebastian Redlcd965b92009-01-18 18:53:16 +00002359
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002360 // Are long/unsigned long possibilities?
Chris Lattnerf0467b32008-04-02 04:24:33 +00002361 if (Ty.isNull() && !Literal.isLongLong) {
Chris Lattner8cbcb0e2008-05-09 05:59:00 +00002362 unsigned LongSize = Context.Target.getLongWidth();
Sebastian Redlcd965b92009-01-18 18:53:16 +00002363
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002364 // Does it fit in a unsigned long?
2365 if (ResultVal.isIntN(LongSize)) {
2366 // Does it fit in a signed long?
2367 if (!Literal.isUnsigned && ResultVal[LongSize-1] == 0)
Chris Lattnerf0467b32008-04-02 04:24:33 +00002368 Ty = Context.LongTy;
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002369 else if (AllowUnsigned)
Chris Lattnerf0467b32008-04-02 04:24:33 +00002370 Ty = Context.UnsignedLongTy;
Chris Lattner8cbcb0e2008-05-09 05:59:00 +00002371 Width = LongSize;
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002372 }
Sebastian Redlcd965b92009-01-18 18:53:16 +00002373 }
2374
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002375 // Finally, check long long if needed.
Chris Lattnerf0467b32008-04-02 04:24:33 +00002376 if (Ty.isNull()) {
Chris Lattner8cbcb0e2008-05-09 05:59:00 +00002377 unsigned LongLongSize = Context.Target.getLongLongWidth();
Sebastian Redlcd965b92009-01-18 18:53:16 +00002378
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002379 // Does it fit in a unsigned long long?
2380 if (ResultVal.isIntN(LongLongSize)) {
2381 // Does it fit in a signed long long?
2382 if (!Literal.isUnsigned && ResultVal[LongLongSize-1] == 0)
Chris Lattnerf0467b32008-04-02 04:24:33 +00002383 Ty = Context.LongLongTy;
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002384 else if (AllowUnsigned)
Chris Lattnerf0467b32008-04-02 04:24:33 +00002385 Ty = Context.UnsignedLongLongTy;
Chris Lattner8cbcb0e2008-05-09 05:59:00 +00002386 Width = LongLongSize;
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002387 }
2388 }
Sebastian Redlcd965b92009-01-18 18:53:16 +00002389
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002390 // If we still couldn't decide a type, we probably have something that
2391 // does not fit in a signed long long, but has no U suffix.
Chris Lattnerf0467b32008-04-02 04:24:33 +00002392 if (Ty.isNull()) {
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002393 Diag(Tok.getLocation(), diag::warn_integer_too_large_for_signed);
Chris Lattnerf0467b32008-04-02 04:24:33 +00002394 Ty = Context.UnsignedLongLongTy;
Chris Lattner8cbcb0e2008-05-09 05:59:00 +00002395 Width = Context.Target.getLongLongWidth();
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002396 }
Sebastian Redlcd965b92009-01-18 18:53:16 +00002397
Chris Lattner8cbcb0e2008-05-09 05:59:00 +00002398 if (ResultVal.getBitWidth() != Width)
2399 ResultVal.trunc(Width);
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002400 }
Argyrios Kyrtzidis9996a7f2010-08-28 09:06:06 +00002401 Res = IntegerLiteral::Create(Context, ResultVal, Ty, Tok.getLocation());
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002402 }
Sebastian Redlcd965b92009-01-18 18:53:16 +00002403
Chris Lattner5d661452007-08-26 03:42:43 +00002404 // If this is an imaginary literal, create the ImaginaryLiteral wrapper.
2405 if (Literal.isImaginary)
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002406 Res = new (Context) ImaginaryLiteral(Res,
Steve Naroff6ece14c2009-01-21 00:14:39 +00002407 Context.getComplexType(Res->getType()));
Sebastian Redlcd965b92009-01-18 18:53:16 +00002408
2409 return Owned(Res);
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002410}
2411
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00002412ExprResult Sema::ActOnParenExpr(SourceLocation L,
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00002413 SourceLocation R, Expr *E) {
Chris Lattnerf0467b32008-04-02 04:24:33 +00002414 assert((E != 0) && "ActOnParenExpr() missing expr");
Steve Naroff6ece14c2009-01-21 00:14:39 +00002415 return Owned(new (Context) ParenExpr(L, R, E));
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002416}
2417
2418/// The UsualUnaryConversions() function is *not* called by this routine.
2419/// See C99 6.3.2.1p[2-4] for more details.
Sebastian Redl28507842009-02-26 14:39:58 +00002420bool Sema::CheckSizeOfAlignOfOperand(QualType exprType,
Sebastian Redl05189992008-11-11 17:56:53 +00002421 SourceLocation OpLoc,
John McCall2a984ca2010-10-12 00:20:44 +00002422 SourceRange ExprRange,
Sebastian Redl05189992008-11-11 17:56:53 +00002423 bool isSizeof) {
Sebastian Redl28507842009-02-26 14:39:58 +00002424 if (exprType->isDependentType())
2425 return false;
2426
Sebastian Redl5d484e82009-11-23 17:18:46 +00002427 // C++ [expr.sizeof]p2: "When applied to a reference or a reference type,
2428 // the result is the size of the referenced type."
2429 // C++ [expr.alignof]p3: "When alignof is applied to a reference type, the
2430 // result shall be the alignment of the referenced type."
2431 if (const ReferenceType *Ref = exprType->getAs<ReferenceType>())
2432 exprType = Ref->getPointeeType();
2433
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002434 // C99 6.5.3.4p1:
John McCall5ab75172009-11-04 07:28:41 +00002435 if (exprType->isFunctionType()) {
Chris Lattner1efaa952009-04-24 00:30:45 +00002436 // alignof(function) is allowed as an extension.
Chris Lattner01072922009-01-24 19:46:37 +00002437 if (isSizeof)
2438 Diag(OpLoc, diag::ext_sizeof_function_type) << ExprRange;
2439 return false;
2440 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002441
Chris Lattner1efaa952009-04-24 00:30:45 +00002442 // Allow sizeof(void)/alignof(void) as an extension.
Chris Lattner01072922009-01-24 19:46:37 +00002443 if (exprType->isVoidType()) {
Chris Lattnerfa25bbb2008-11-19 05:08:23 +00002444 Diag(OpLoc, diag::ext_sizeof_void_type)
2445 << (isSizeof ? "sizeof" : "__alignof") << ExprRange;
Chris Lattner01072922009-01-24 19:46:37 +00002446 return false;
2447 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002448
Chris Lattner1efaa952009-04-24 00:30:45 +00002449 if (RequireCompleteType(OpLoc, exprType,
Douglas Gregor5cc07df2009-12-15 16:44:32 +00002450 PDiag(diag::err_sizeof_alignof_incomplete_type)
2451 << int(!isSizeof) << ExprRange))
Chris Lattner1efaa952009-04-24 00:30:45 +00002452 return true;
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002453
Chris Lattner1efaa952009-04-24 00:30:45 +00002454 // Reject sizeof(interface) and sizeof(interface<proto>) in 64-bit mode.
John McCallc12c5bb2010-05-15 11:32:37 +00002455 if (LangOpts.ObjCNonFragileABI && exprType->isObjCObjectType()) {
Chris Lattner1efaa952009-04-24 00:30:45 +00002456 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_sizeof_nonfragile_interface)
Chris Lattner5cb10d32009-04-24 22:30:50 +00002457 << exprType << isSizeof << ExprRange;
2458 return true;
Chris Lattnerca790922009-04-21 19:55:16 +00002459 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002460
Chris Lattner1efaa952009-04-24 00:30:45 +00002461 return false;
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002462}
2463
John McCall2a984ca2010-10-12 00:20:44 +00002464static bool CheckAlignOfExpr(Sema &S, Expr *E, SourceLocation OpLoc,
2465 SourceRange ExprRange) {
Chris Lattner31e21e02009-01-24 20:17:12 +00002466 E = E->IgnoreParens();
Sebastian Redl28507842009-02-26 14:39:58 +00002467
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002468 // alignof decl is always ok.
Chris Lattner31e21e02009-01-24 20:17:12 +00002469 if (isa<DeclRefExpr>(E))
2470 return false;
Sebastian Redl28507842009-02-26 14:39:58 +00002471
2472 // Cannot know anything else if the expression is dependent.
2473 if (E->isTypeDependent())
2474 return false;
2475
Douglas Gregor33bbbc52009-05-02 02:18:30 +00002476 if (E->getBitField()) {
John McCall2a984ca2010-10-12 00:20:44 +00002477 S. Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_sizeof_alignof_bitfield) << 1 << ExprRange;
Douglas Gregor33bbbc52009-05-02 02:18:30 +00002478 return true;
Chris Lattner31e21e02009-01-24 20:17:12 +00002479 }
Douglas Gregor33bbbc52009-05-02 02:18:30 +00002480
2481 // Alignment of a field access is always okay, so long as it isn't a
2482 // bit-field.
2483 if (MemberExpr *ME = dyn_cast<MemberExpr>(E))
Mike Stump8e1fab22009-07-22 18:58:19 +00002484 if (isa<FieldDecl>(ME->getMemberDecl()))
Douglas Gregor33bbbc52009-05-02 02:18:30 +00002485 return false;
2486
John McCall2a984ca2010-10-12 00:20:44 +00002487 return S.CheckSizeOfAlignOfOperand(E->getType(), OpLoc, ExprRange, false);
Chris Lattner31e21e02009-01-24 20:17:12 +00002488}
2489
Douglas Gregorba498172009-03-13 21:01:28 +00002490/// \brief Build a sizeof or alignof expression given a type operand.
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00002491ExprResult
John McCalla93c9342009-12-07 02:54:59 +00002492Sema::CreateSizeOfAlignOfExpr(TypeSourceInfo *TInfo,
John McCall5ab75172009-11-04 07:28:41 +00002493 SourceLocation OpLoc,
Douglas Gregorba498172009-03-13 21:01:28 +00002494 bool isSizeOf, SourceRange R) {
John McCalla93c9342009-12-07 02:54:59 +00002495 if (!TInfo)
Douglas Gregorba498172009-03-13 21:01:28 +00002496 return ExprError();
2497
John McCalla93c9342009-12-07 02:54:59 +00002498 QualType T = TInfo->getType();
John McCall5ab75172009-11-04 07:28:41 +00002499
Douglas Gregorba498172009-03-13 21:01:28 +00002500 if (!T->isDependentType() &&
2501 CheckSizeOfAlignOfOperand(T, OpLoc, R, isSizeOf))
2502 return ExprError();
2503
2504 // C99 6.5.3.4p4: the type (an unsigned integer type) is size_t.
John McCalla93c9342009-12-07 02:54:59 +00002505 return Owned(new (Context) SizeOfAlignOfExpr(isSizeOf, TInfo,
Douglas Gregorba498172009-03-13 21:01:28 +00002506 Context.getSizeType(), OpLoc,
2507 R.getEnd()));
2508}
2509
2510/// \brief Build a sizeof or alignof expression given an expression
2511/// operand.
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00002512ExprResult
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002513Sema::CreateSizeOfAlignOfExpr(Expr *E, SourceLocation OpLoc,
Douglas Gregorba498172009-03-13 21:01:28 +00002514 bool isSizeOf, SourceRange R) {
2515 // Verify that the operand is valid.
2516 bool isInvalid = false;
2517 if (E->isTypeDependent()) {
2518 // Delay type-checking for type-dependent expressions.
2519 } else if (!isSizeOf) {
John McCall2a984ca2010-10-12 00:20:44 +00002520 isInvalid = CheckAlignOfExpr(*this, E, OpLoc, R);
Douglas Gregor33bbbc52009-05-02 02:18:30 +00002521 } else if (E->getBitField()) { // C99 6.5.3.4p1.
Douglas Gregorba498172009-03-13 21:01:28 +00002522 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_sizeof_alignof_bitfield) << 0;
2523 isInvalid = true;
John McCall2cd11fe2010-10-12 02:09:17 +00002524 } else if (E->getType()->isPlaceholderType()) {
2525 ExprResult PE = CheckPlaceholderExpr(E, OpLoc);
2526 if (PE.isInvalid()) return ExprError();
2527 return CreateSizeOfAlignOfExpr(PE.take(), OpLoc, isSizeOf, R);
Douglas Gregorba498172009-03-13 21:01:28 +00002528 } else {
2529 isInvalid = CheckSizeOfAlignOfOperand(E->getType(), OpLoc, R, true);
2530 }
2531
2532 if (isInvalid)
2533 return ExprError();
2534
2535 // C99 6.5.3.4p4: the type (an unsigned integer type) is size_t.
2536 return Owned(new (Context) SizeOfAlignOfExpr(isSizeOf, E,
2537 Context.getSizeType(), OpLoc,
2538 R.getEnd()));
2539}
2540
Sebastian Redl05189992008-11-11 17:56:53 +00002541/// ActOnSizeOfAlignOfExpr - Handle @c sizeof(type) and @c sizeof @c expr and
2542/// the same for @c alignof and @c __alignof
2543/// Note that the ArgRange is invalid if isType is false.
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00002544ExprResult
Sebastian Redl05189992008-11-11 17:56:53 +00002545Sema::ActOnSizeOfAlignOfExpr(SourceLocation OpLoc, bool isSizeof, bool isType,
2546 void *TyOrEx, const SourceRange &ArgRange) {
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002547 // If error parsing type, ignore.
Sebastian Redl0eb23302009-01-19 00:08:26 +00002548 if (TyOrEx == 0) return ExprError();
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002549
Sebastian Redl05189992008-11-11 17:56:53 +00002550 if (isType) {
John McCalla93c9342009-12-07 02:54:59 +00002551 TypeSourceInfo *TInfo;
John McCallb3d87482010-08-24 05:47:05 +00002552 (void) GetTypeFromParser(ParsedType::getFromOpaquePtr(TyOrEx), &TInfo);
John McCalla93c9342009-12-07 02:54:59 +00002553 return CreateSizeOfAlignOfExpr(TInfo, OpLoc, isSizeof, ArgRange);
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002554 }
Sebastian Redl05189992008-11-11 17:56:53 +00002555
Douglas Gregorba498172009-03-13 21:01:28 +00002556 Expr *ArgEx = (Expr *)TyOrEx;
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00002557 ExprResult Result
Douglas Gregorba498172009-03-13 21:01:28 +00002558 = CreateSizeOfAlignOfExpr(ArgEx, OpLoc, isSizeof, ArgEx->getSourceRange());
2559
Douglas Gregorba498172009-03-13 21:01:28 +00002560 return move(Result);
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002561}
2562
Chris Lattnerba27e2a2009-02-17 08:12:06 +00002563QualType Sema::CheckRealImagOperand(Expr *&V, SourceLocation Loc, bool isReal) {
Sebastian Redl28507842009-02-26 14:39:58 +00002564 if (V->isTypeDependent())
2565 return Context.DependentTy;
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002566
Chris Lattnercc26ed72007-08-26 05:39:26 +00002567 // These operators return the element type of a complex type.
John McCall183700f2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00002568 if (const ComplexType *CT = V->getType()->getAs<ComplexType>())
Chris Lattnerdbb36972007-08-24 21:16:53 +00002569 return CT->getElementType();
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002570
Chris Lattnercc26ed72007-08-26 05:39:26 +00002571 // Otherwise they pass through real integer and floating point types here.
2572 if (V->getType()->isArithmeticType())
2573 return V->getType();
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002574
John McCall2cd11fe2010-10-12 02:09:17 +00002575 // Test for placeholders.
2576 ExprResult PR = CheckPlaceholderExpr(V, Loc);
2577 if (PR.isInvalid()) return QualType();
2578 if (PR.take() != V) {
2579 V = PR.take();
2580 return CheckRealImagOperand(V, Loc, isReal);
2581 }
2582
Chris Lattnercc26ed72007-08-26 05:39:26 +00002583 // Reject anything else.
Chris Lattnerba27e2a2009-02-17 08:12:06 +00002584 Diag(Loc, diag::err_realimag_invalid_type) << V->getType()
2585 << (isReal ? "__real" : "__imag");
Chris Lattnercc26ed72007-08-26 05:39:26 +00002586 return QualType();
Chris Lattnerdbb36972007-08-24 21:16:53 +00002587}
2588
2589
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002590
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00002591ExprResult
Sebastian Redl0eb23302009-01-19 00:08:26 +00002592Sema::ActOnPostfixUnaryOp(Scope *S, SourceLocation OpLoc,
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00002593 tok::TokenKind Kind, Expr *Input) {
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00002594 UnaryOperatorKind Opc;
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002595 switch (Kind) {
2596 default: assert(0 && "Unknown unary op!");
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00002597 case tok::plusplus: Opc = UO_PostInc; break;
2598 case tok::minusminus: Opc = UO_PostDec; break;
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002599 }
Sebastian Redl0eb23302009-01-19 00:08:26 +00002600
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00002601 return BuildUnaryOp(S, OpLoc, Opc, Input);
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002602}
2603
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00002604ExprResult
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00002605Sema::ActOnArraySubscriptExpr(Scope *S, Expr *Base, SourceLocation LLoc,
2606 Expr *Idx, SourceLocation RLoc) {
Nate Begeman2ef13e52009-08-10 23:49:36 +00002607 // Since this might be a postfix expression, get rid of ParenListExprs.
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00002608 ExprResult Result = MaybeConvertParenListExprToParenExpr(S, Base);
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00002609 if (Result.isInvalid()) return ExprError();
2610 Base = Result.take();
Nate Begeman2ef13e52009-08-10 23:49:36 +00002611
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00002612 Expr *LHSExp = Base, *RHSExp = Idx;
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002613
Douglas Gregor337c6b92008-11-19 17:17:41 +00002614 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus &&
Douglas Gregor3384c9c2009-05-19 00:01:19 +00002615 (LHSExp->isTypeDependent() || RHSExp->isTypeDependent())) {
Douglas Gregor3384c9c2009-05-19 00:01:19 +00002616 return Owned(new (Context) ArraySubscriptExpr(LHSExp, RHSExp,
2617 Context.DependentTy, RLoc));
2618 }
2619
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002620 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus &&
Sebastian Redl0eb23302009-01-19 00:08:26 +00002621 (LHSExp->getType()->isRecordType() ||
Eli Friedman03f332a2008-12-15 22:34:21 +00002622 LHSExp->getType()->isEnumeralType() ||
2623 RHSExp->getType()->isRecordType() ||
2624 RHSExp->getType()->isEnumeralType())) {
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00002625 return CreateOverloadedArraySubscriptExpr(LLoc, RLoc, Base, Idx);
Douglas Gregor337c6b92008-11-19 17:17:41 +00002626 }
2627
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00002628 return CreateBuiltinArraySubscriptExpr(Base, LLoc, Idx, RLoc);
Sebastian Redlf322ed62009-10-29 20:17:01 +00002629}
2630
2631
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00002632ExprResult
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00002633Sema::CreateBuiltinArraySubscriptExpr(Expr *Base, SourceLocation LLoc,
2634 Expr *Idx, SourceLocation RLoc) {
2635 Expr *LHSExp = Base;
2636 Expr *RHSExp = Idx;
Sebastian Redlf322ed62009-10-29 20:17:01 +00002637
Chris Lattner12d9ff62007-07-16 00:14:47 +00002638 // Perform default conversions.
Douglas Gregora873dfc2010-02-03 00:27:59 +00002639 if (!LHSExp->getType()->getAs<VectorType>())
2640 DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion(LHSExp);
2641 DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion(RHSExp);
Sebastian Redl0eb23302009-01-19 00:08:26 +00002642
Chris Lattner12d9ff62007-07-16 00:14:47 +00002643 QualType LHSTy = LHSExp->getType(), RHSTy = RHSExp->getType();
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002644
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002645 // C99 6.5.2.1p2: the expression e1[e2] is by definition precisely equivalent
Chris Lattner73d0d4f2007-08-30 17:45:32 +00002646 // to the expression *((e1)+(e2)). This means the array "Base" may actually be
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00002647 // in the subscript position. As a result, we need to derive the array base
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002648 // and index from the expression types.
Chris Lattner12d9ff62007-07-16 00:14:47 +00002649 Expr *BaseExpr, *IndexExpr;
2650 QualType ResultType;
Sebastian Redl28507842009-02-26 14:39:58 +00002651 if (LHSTy->isDependentType() || RHSTy->isDependentType()) {
2652 BaseExpr = LHSExp;
2653 IndexExpr = RHSExp;
2654 ResultType = Context.DependentTy;
Ted Kremenek6217b802009-07-29 21:53:49 +00002655 } else if (const PointerType *PTy = LHSTy->getAs<PointerType>()) {
Chris Lattner12d9ff62007-07-16 00:14:47 +00002656 BaseExpr = LHSExp;
2657 IndexExpr = RHSExp;
Chris Lattner12d9ff62007-07-16 00:14:47 +00002658 ResultType = PTy->getPointeeType();
Ted Kremenek6217b802009-07-29 21:53:49 +00002659 } else if (const PointerType *PTy = RHSTy->getAs<PointerType>()) {
Chris Lattner7a2e0472007-07-16 00:23:25 +00002660 // Handle the uncommon case of "123[Ptr]".
Chris Lattner12d9ff62007-07-16 00:14:47 +00002661 BaseExpr = RHSExp;
2662 IndexExpr = LHSExp;
Chris Lattner12d9ff62007-07-16 00:14:47 +00002663 ResultType = PTy->getPointeeType();
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002664 } else if (const ObjCObjectPointerType *PTy =
John McCall183700f2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00002665 LHSTy->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>()) {
Steve Naroff14108da2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00002666 BaseExpr = LHSExp;
2667 IndexExpr = RHSExp;
2668 ResultType = PTy->getPointeeType();
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002669 } else if (const ObjCObjectPointerType *PTy =
John McCall183700f2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00002670 RHSTy->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>()) {
Steve Naroff14108da2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00002671 // Handle the uncommon case of "123[Ptr]".
2672 BaseExpr = RHSExp;
2673 IndexExpr = LHSExp;
2674 ResultType = PTy->getPointeeType();
John McCall183700f2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00002675 } else if (const VectorType *VTy = LHSTy->getAs<VectorType>()) {
Chris Lattnerc8629632007-07-31 19:29:30 +00002676 BaseExpr = LHSExp; // vectors: V[123]
Chris Lattner12d9ff62007-07-16 00:14:47 +00002677 IndexExpr = RHSExp;
Nate Begeman334a8022009-01-18 00:45:31 +00002678
Chris Lattner12d9ff62007-07-16 00:14:47 +00002679 // FIXME: need to deal with const...
2680 ResultType = VTy->getElementType();
Eli Friedman7c32f8e2009-04-25 23:46:54 +00002681 } else if (LHSTy->isArrayType()) {
2682 // If we see an array that wasn't promoted by
Douglas Gregora873dfc2010-02-03 00:27:59 +00002683 // DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion, it must be an array that
Eli Friedman7c32f8e2009-04-25 23:46:54 +00002684 // wasn't promoted because of the C90 rule that doesn't
2685 // allow promoting non-lvalue arrays. Warn, then
2686 // force the promotion here.
2687 Diag(LHSExp->getLocStart(), diag::ext_subscript_non_lvalue) <<
2688 LHSExp->getSourceRange();
Eli Friedman73c39ab2009-10-20 08:27:19 +00002689 ImpCastExprToType(LHSExp, Context.getArrayDecayedType(LHSTy),
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00002690 CK_ArrayToPointerDecay);
Eli Friedman7c32f8e2009-04-25 23:46:54 +00002691 LHSTy = LHSExp->getType();
2692
2693 BaseExpr = LHSExp;
2694 IndexExpr = RHSExp;
Ted Kremenek6217b802009-07-29 21:53:49 +00002695 ResultType = LHSTy->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
Eli Friedman7c32f8e2009-04-25 23:46:54 +00002696 } else if (RHSTy->isArrayType()) {
2697 // Same as previous, except for 123[f().a] case
2698 Diag(RHSExp->getLocStart(), diag::ext_subscript_non_lvalue) <<
2699 RHSExp->getSourceRange();
Eli Friedman73c39ab2009-10-20 08:27:19 +00002700 ImpCastExprToType(RHSExp, Context.getArrayDecayedType(RHSTy),
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00002701 CK_ArrayToPointerDecay);
Eli Friedman7c32f8e2009-04-25 23:46:54 +00002702 RHSTy = RHSExp->getType();
2703
2704 BaseExpr = RHSExp;
2705 IndexExpr = LHSExp;
Ted Kremenek6217b802009-07-29 21:53:49 +00002706 ResultType = RHSTy->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002707 } else {
Chris Lattner338395d2009-04-25 22:50:55 +00002708 return ExprError(Diag(LLoc, diag::err_typecheck_subscript_value)
2709 << LHSExp->getSourceRange() << RHSExp->getSourceRange());
Sebastian Redl0eb23302009-01-19 00:08:26 +00002710 }
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002711 // C99 6.5.2.1p1
Douglas Gregorf6094622010-07-23 15:58:24 +00002712 if (!IndexExpr->getType()->isIntegerType() && !IndexExpr->isTypeDependent())
Chris Lattner338395d2009-04-25 22:50:55 +00002713 return ExprError(Diag(LLoc, diag::err_typecheck_subscript_not_integer)
2714 << IndexExpr->getSourceRange());
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002715
Daniel Dunbar7e88a602009-09-17 06:31:17 +00002716 if ((IndexExpr->getType()->isSpecificBuiltinType(BuiltinType::Char_S) ||
Sam Weinig0f9a5b52009-09-14 20:14:57 +00002717 IndexExpr->getType()->isSpecificBuiltinType(BuiltinType::Char_U))
2718 && !IndexExpr->isTypeDependent())
Sam Weinig76e2b712009-09-14 01:58:58 +00002719 Diag(LLoc, diag::warn_subscript_is_char) << IndexExpr->getSourceRange();
2720
Douglas Gregore7450f52009-03-24 19:52:54 +00002721 // C99 6.5.2.1p1: "shall have type "pointer to *object* type". Similarly,
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002722 // C++ [expr.sub]p1: The type "T" shall be a completely-defined object
2723 // type. Note that Functions are not objects, and that (in C99 parlance)
Douglas Gregore7450f52009-03-24 19:52:54 +00002724 // incomplete types are not object types.
2725 if (ResultType->isFunctionType()) {
2726 Diag(BaseExpr->getLocStart(), diag::err_subscript_function_type)
2727 << ResultType << BaseExpr->getSourceRange();
2728 return ExprError();
2729 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002730
Abramo Bagnara46358452010-09-13 06:50:07 +00002731 if (ResultType->isVoidType() && !getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
2732 // GNU extension: subscripting on pointer to void
2733 Diag(LLoc, diag::ext_gnu_void_ptr)
2734 << BaseExpr->getSourceRange();
2735 } else if (!ResultType->isDependentType() &&
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002736 RequireCompleteType(LLoc, ResultType,
Anders Carlssonb7906612009-08-26 23:45:07 +00002737 PDiag(diag::err_subscript_incomplete_type)
2738 << BaseExpr->getSourceRange()))
Douglas Gregore7450f52009-03-24 19:52:54 +00002739 return ExprError();
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002740
Chris Lattner1efaa952009-04-24 00:30:45 +00002741 // Diagnose bad cases where we step over interface counts.
John McCallc12c5bb2010-05-15 11:32:37 +00002742 if (ResultType->isObjCObjectType() && LangOpts.ObjCNonFragileABI) {
Chris Lattner1efaa952009-04-24 00:30:45 +00002743 Diag(LLoc, diag::err_subscript_nonfragile_interface)
2744 << ResultType << BaseExpr->getSourceRange();
2745 return ExprError();
2746 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002747
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00002748 return Owned(new (Context) ArraySubscriptExpr(LHSExp, RHSExp,
Steve Naroff6ece14c2009-01-21 00:14:39 +00002749 ResultType, RLoc));
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00002750}
2751
Steve Naroffe1b31fe2007-07-27 22:15:19 +00002752QualType Sema::
Nate Begeman213541a2008-04-18 23:10:10 +00002753CheckExtVectorComponent(QualType baseType, SourceLocation OpLoc,
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002754 const IdentifierInfo *CompName,
Anders Carlsson8f28f992009-08-26 18:25:21 +00002755 SourceLocation CompLoc) {
Daniel Dunbar2ad32892009-10-18 02:09:38 +00002756 // FIXME: Share logic with ExtVectorElementExpr::containsDuplicateElements,
2757 // see FIXME there.
2758 //
2759 // FIXME: This logic can be greatly simplified by splitting it along
2760 // halving/not halving and reworking the component checking.
John McCall183700f2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00002761 const ExtVectorType *vecType = baseType->getAs<ExtVectorType>();
Nate Begeman8a997642008-05-09 06:41:27 +00002762
Steve Naroffe1b31fe2007-07-27 22:15:19 +00002763 // The vector accessor can't exceed the number of elements.
Daniel Dunbare013d682009-10-18 20:26:12 +00002764 const char *compStr = CompName->getNameStart();
Nate Begeman353417a2009-01-18 01:47:54 +00002765
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00002766 // This flag determines whether or not the component is one of the four
Nate Begeman353417a2009-01-18 01:47:54 +00002767 // special names that indicate a subset of exactly half the elements are
2768 // to be selected.
2769 bool HalvingSwizzle = false;
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00002770
Nate Begeman353417a2009-01-18 01:47:54 +00002771 // This flag determines whether or not CompName has an 's' char prefix,
2772 // indicating that it is a string of hex values to be used as vector indices.
Nate Begeman131f4652009-06-25 21:06:09 +00002773 bool HexSwizzle = *compStr == 's' || *compStr == 'S';
Nate Begeman8a997642008-05-09 06:41:27 +00002774
2775 // Check that we've found one of the special components, or that the component
2776 // names must come from the same set.
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00002777 if (!strcmp(compStr, "hi") || !strcmp(compStr, "lo") ||
Nate Begeman353417a2009-01-18 01:47:54 +00002778 !strcmp(compStr, "even") || !strcmp(compStr, "odd")) {
2779 HalvingSwizzle = true;
Nate Begeman8a997642008-05-09 06:41:27 +00002780 } else if (vecType->getPointAccessorIdx(*compStr) != -1) {
Chris Lattner88dca042007-08-02 22:33:49 +00002781 do
2782 compStr++;
2783 while (*compStr && vecType->getPointAccessorIdx(*compStr) != -1);
Nate Begeman353417a2009-01-18 01:47:54 +00002784 } else if (HexSwizzle || vecType->getNumericAccessorIdx(*compStr) != -1) {
Chris Lattner88dca042007-08-02 22:33:49 +00002785 do
2786 compStr++;
Nate Begeman353417a2009-01-18 01:47:54 +00002787 while (*compStr && vecType->getNumericAccessorIdx(*compStr) != -1);
Chris Lattner88dca042007-08-02 22:33:49 +00002788 }
Nate Begeman353417a2009-01-18 01:47:54 +00002789
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00002790 if (!HalvingSwizzle && *compStr) {
Steve Naroffe1b31fe2007-07-27 22:15:19 +00002791 // We didn't get to the end of the string. This means the component names
2792 // didn't come from the same set *or* we encountered an illegal name.
Chris Lattnerfa25bbb2008-11-19 05:08:23 +00002793 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_ext_vector_component_name_illegal)
Benjamin Kramer476d8b82010-08-11 14:47:12 +00002794 << llvm::StringRef(compStr, 1) << SourceRange(CompLoc);
Steve Naroffe1b31fe2007-07-27 22:15:19 +00002795 return QualType();
2796 }
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00002797
Nate Begeman353417a2009-01-18 01:47:54 +00002798 // Ensure no component accessor exceeds the width of the vector type it
2799 // operates on.
2800 if (!HalvingSwizzle) {
Daniel Dunbare013d682009-10-18 20:26:12 +00002801 compStr = CompName->getNameStart();
Nate Begeman353417a2009-01-18 01:47:54 +00002802
2803 if (HexSwizzle)
Steve Naroffe1b31fe2007-07-27 22:15:19 +00002804 compStr++;
Nate Begeman353417a2009-01-18 01:47:54 +00002805
2806 while (*compStr) {
2807 if (!vecType->isAccessorWithinNumElements(*compStr++)) {
2808 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_ext_vector_component_exceeds_length)
2809 << baseType << SourceRange(CompLoc);
2810 return QualType();
2811 }
2812 }
Steve Naroffe1b31fe2007-07-27 22:15:19 +00002813 }
Nate Begeman8a997642008-05-09 06:41:27 +00002814
Steve Naroffe1b31fe2007-07-27 22:15:19 +00002815 // The component accessor looks fine - now we need to compute the actual type.
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00002816 // The vector type is implied by the component accessor. For example,
Steve Naroffe1b31fe2007-07-27 22:15:19 +00002817 // vec4.b is a float, vec4.xy is a vec2, vec4.rgb is a vec3, etc.
Nate Begeman353417a2009-01-18 01:47:54 +00002818 // vec4.s0 is a float, vec4.s23 is a vec3, etc.
Nate Begeman8a997642008-05-09 06:41:27 +00002819 // vec4.hi, vec4.lo, vec4.e, and vec4.o all return vec2.
Nate Begeman0479a0b2009-12-15 18:13:04 +00002820 unsigned CompSize = HalvingSwizzle ? (vecType->getNumElements() + 1) / 2
Anders Carlsson8f28f992009-08-26 18:25:21 +00002821 : CompName->getLength();
Nate Begeman353417a2009-01-18 01:47:54 +00002822 if (HexSwizzle)
2823 CompSize--;
2824
Steve Naroffe1b31fe2007-07-27 22:15:19 +00002825 if (CompSize == 1)
2826 return vecType->getElementType();
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00002827
Nate Begeman213541a2008-04-18 23:10:10 +00002828 QualType VT = Context.getExtVectorType(vecType->getElementType(), CompSize);
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00002829 // Now look up the TypeDefDecl from the vector type. Without this,
Nate Begeman213541a2008-04-18 23:10:10 +00002830 // diagostics look bad. We want extended vector types to appear built-in.
2831 for (unsigned i = 0, E = ExtVectorDecls.size(); i != E; ++i) {
2832 if (ExtVectorDecls[i]->getUnderlyingType() == VT)
2833 return Context.getTypedefType(ExtVectorDecls[i]);
Steve Naroffbea0b342007-07-29 16:33:31 +00002834 }
2835 return VT; // should never get here (a typedef type should always be found).
Steve Naroffe1b31fe2007-07-27 22:15:19 +00002836}
2837
Fariborz Jahanianf2ad2c92010-10-11 21:29:12 +00002838static Decl *FindGetterSetterNameDeclFromProtocolList(const ObjCProtocolDecl*PDecl,
Anders Carlsson8f28f992009-08-26 18:25:21 +00002839 IdentifierInfo *Member,
Douglas Gregor6ab35242009-04-09 21:40:53 +00002840 const Selector &Sel,
2841 ASTContext &Context) {
Fariborz Jahanianf2ad2c92010-10-11 21:29:12 +00002842 if (Member)
2843 if (ObjCPropertyDecl *PD = PDecl->FindPropertyDeclaration(Member))
2844 return PD;
Argyrios Kyrtzidis17945a02009-06-30 02:36:12 +00002845 if (ObjCMethodDecl *OMD = PDecl->getInstanceMethod(Sel))
Fariborz Jahanian2ce1be02009-03-19 18:15:34 +00002846 return OMD;
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00002847
Fariborz Jahanian2ce1be02009-03-19 18:15:34 +00002848 for (ObjCProtocolDecl::protocol_iterator I = PDecl->protocol_begin(),
2849 E = PDecl->protocol_end(); I != E; ++I) {
Fariborz Jahanianf2ad2c92010-10-11 21:29:12 +00002850 if (Decl *D = FindGetterSetterNameDeclFromProtocolList(*I, Member, Sel,
2851 Context))
Fariborz Jahanian2ce1be02009-03-19 18:15:34 +00002852 return D;
2853 }
2854 return 0;
2855}
2856
Fariborz Jahanianf2ad2c92010-10-11 21:29:12 +00002857static Decl *FindGetterSetterNameDecl(const ObjCObjectPointerType *QIdTy,
2858 IdentifierInfo *Member,
2859 const Selector &Sel,
2860 ASTContext &Context) {
Fariborz Jahanian2ce1be02009-03-19 18:15:34 +00002861 // Check protocols on qualified interfaces.
2862 Decl *GDecl = 0;
Steve Naroffd1b3c2d2009-06-17 22:40:22 +00002863 for (ObjCObjectPointerType::qual_iterator I = QIdTy->qual_begin(),
Fariborz Jahanian2ce1be02009-03-19 18:15:34 +00002864 E = QIdTy->qual_end(); I != E; ++I) {
Fariborz Jahanianf2ad2c92010-10-11 21:29:12 +00002865 if (Member)
2866 if (ObjCPropertyDecl *PD = (*I)->FindPropertyDeclaration(Member)) {
2867 GDecl = PD;
2868 break;
2869 }
2870 // Also must look for a getter or setter name which uses property syntax.
Argyrios Kyrtzidis17945a02009-06-30 02:36:12 +00002871 if (ObjCMethodDecl *OMD = (*I)->getInstanceMethod(Sel)) {
Fariborz Jahanian2ce1be02009-03-19 18:15:34 +00002872 GDecl = OMD;
2873 break;
2874 }
2875 }
2876 if (!GDecl) {
Steve Naroffd1b3c2d2009-06-17 22:40:22 +00002877 for (ObjCObjectPointerType::qual_iterator I = QIdTy->qual_begin(),
Fariborz Jahanian2ce1be02009-03-19 18:15:34 +00002878 E = QIdTy->qual_end(); I != E; ++I) {
2879 // Search in the protocol-qualifier list of current protocol.
Fariborz Jahanianf2ad2c92010-10-11 21:29:12 +00002880 GDecl = FindGetterSetterNameDeclFromProtocolList(*I, Member, Sel,
2881 Context);
Fariborz Jahanian2ce1be02009-03-19 18:15:34 +00002882 if (GDecl)
2883 return GDecl;
2884 }
2885 }
2886 return GDecl;
2887}
Chris Lattner76a642f2009-02-15 22:43:40 +00002888
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00002889ExprResult
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00002890Sema::ActOnDependentMemberExpr(Expr *BaseExpr, QualType BaseType,
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002891 bool IsArrow, SourceLocation OpLoc,
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002892 const CXXScopeSpec &SS,
2893 NamedDecl *FirstQualifierInScope,
Abramo Bagnara25777432010-08-11 22:01:17 +00002894 const DeclarationNameInfo &NameInfo,
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002895 const TemplateArgumentListInfo *TemplateArgs) {
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002896 // Even in dependent contexts, try to diagnose base expressions with
2897 // obviously wrong types, e.g.:
2898 //
2899 // T* t;
2900 // t.f;
2901 //
2902 // In Obj-C++, however, the above expression is valid, since it could be
2903 // accessing the 'f' property if T is an Obj-C interface. The extra check
2904 // allows this, while still reporting an error if T is a struct pointer.
2905 if (!IsArrow) {
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002906 const PointerType *PT = BaseType->getAs<PointerType>();
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002907 if (PT && (!getLangOptions().ObjC1 ||
2908 PT->getPointeeType()->isRecordType())) {
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002909 assert(BaseExpr && "cannot happen with implicit member accesses");
Abramo Bagnara25777432010-08-11 22:01:17 +00002910 Diag(NameInfo.getLoc(), diag::err_typecheck_member_reference_struct_union)
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002911 << BaseType << BaseExpr->getSourceRange();
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002912 return ExprError();
2913 }
2914 }
2915
Abramo Bagnara25777432010-08-11 22:01:17 +00002916 assert(BaseType->isDependentType() ||
2917 NameInfo.getName().isDependentName() ||
Douglas Gregor01e56ae2010-04-12 20:54:26 +00002918 isDependentScopeSpecifier(SS));
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002919
2920 // Get the type being accessed in BaseType. If this is an arrow, the BaseExpr
2921 // must have pointer type, and the accessed type is the pointee.
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002922 return Owned(CXXDependentScopeMemberExpr::Create(Context, BaseExpr, BaseType,
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002923 IsArrow, OpLoc,
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00002924 SS.getScopeRep(),
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002925 SS.getRange(),
2926 FirstQualifierInScope,
Abramo Bagnara25777432010-08-11 22:01:17 +00002927 NameInfo, TemplateArgs));
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002928}
2929
2930/// We know that the given qualified member reference points only to
2931/// declarations which do not belong to the static type of the base
2932/// expression. Diagnose the problem.
2933static void DiagnoseQualifiedMemberReference(Sema &SemaRef,
2934 Expr *BaseExpr,
2935 QualType BaseType,
John McCall2f841ba2009-12-02 03:53:29 +00002936 const CXXScopeSpec &SS,
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002937 const LookupResult &R) {
John McCall2f841ba2009-12-02 03:53:29 +00002938 // If this is an implicit member access, use a different set of
2939 // diagnostics.
2940 if (!BaseExpr)
2941 return DiagnoseInstanceReference(SemaRef, SS, R);
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002942
John McCall110acc12010-04-27 01:43:38 +00002943 SemaRef.Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diag::err_qualified_member_of_unrelated)
2944 << SS.getRange() << R.getRepresentativeDecl() << BaseType;
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002945}
2946
2947// Check whether the declarations we found through a nested-name
2948// specifier in a member expression are actually members of the base
2949// type. The restriction here is:
2950//
2951// C++ [expr.ref]p2:
2952// ... In these cases, the id-expression shall name a
2953// member of the class or of one of its base classes.
2954//
2955// So it's perfectly legitimate for the nested-name specifier to name
2956// an unrelated class, and for us to find an overload set including
2957// decls from classes which are not superclasses, as long as the decl
2958// we actually pick through overload resolution is from a superclass.
2959bool Sema::CheckQualifiedMemberReference(Expr *BaseExpr,
2960 QualType BaseType,
John McCall2f841ba2009-12-02 03:53:29 +00002961 const CXXScopeSpec &SS,
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002962 const LookupResult &R) {
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002963 const RecordType *BaseRT = BaseType->getAs<RecordType>();
2964 if (!BaseRT) {
2965 // We can't check this yet because the base type is still
2966 // dependent.
2967 assert(BaseType->isDependentType());
2968 return false;
2969 }
2970 CXXRecordDecl *BaseRecord = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(BaseRT->getDecl());
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002971
2972 for (LookupResult::iterator I = R.begin(), E = R.end(); I != E; ++I) {
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002973 // If this is an implicit member reference and we find a
2974 // non-instance member, it's not an error.
John McCall161755a2010-04-06 21:38:20 +00002975 if (!BaseExpr && !(*I)->isCXXInstanceMember())
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002976 return false;
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00002977
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002978 // Note that we use the DC of the decl, not the underlying decl.
Eli Friedman02463762010-07-27 20:51:02 +00002979 DeclContext *DC = (*I)->getDeclContext();
2980 while (DC->isTransparentContext())
2981 DC = DC->getParent();
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002982
Douglas Gregor9d4bb942010-07-28 22:27:52 +00002983 if (!DC->isRecord())
2984 continue;
2985
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002986 llvm::SmallPtrSet<CXXRecordDecl*,4> MemberRecord;
Eli Friedman02463762010-07-27 20:51:02 +00002987 MemberRecord.insert(cast<CXXRecordDecl>(DC)->getCanonicalDecl());
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002988
2989 if (!IsProvablyNotDerivedFrom(*this, BaseRecord, MemberRecord))
2990 return false;
2991 }
2992
John McCall2f841ba2009-12-02 03:53:29 +00002993 DiagnoseQualifiedMemberReference(*this, BaseExpr, BaseType, SS, R);
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00002994 return true;
2995}
2996
2997static bool
2998LookupMemberExprInRecord(Sema &SemaRef, LookupResult &R,
2999 SourceRange BaseRange, const RecordType *RTy,
John McCallad00b772010-06-16 08:42:20 +00003000 SourceLocation OpLoc, CXXScopeSpec &SS,
3001 bool HasTemplateArgs) {
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00003002 RecordDecl *RDecl = RTy->getDecl();
3003 if (SemaRef.RequireCompleteType(OpLoc, QualType(RTy, 0),
Douglas Gregorfe6b2d42010-03-29 23:34:08 +00003004 SemaRef.PDiag(diag::err_typecheck_incomplete_tag)
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00003005 << BaseRange))
3006 return true;
3007
John McCallad00b772010-06-16 08:42:20 +00003008 if (HasTemplateArgs) {
3009 // LookupTemplateName doesn't expect these both to exist simultaneously.
3010 QualType ObjectType = SS.isSet() ? QualType() : QualType(RTy, 0);
3011
3012 bool MOUS;
3013 SemaRef.LookupTemplateName(R, 0, SS, ObjectType, false, MOUS);
3014 return false;
3015 }
3016
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00003017 DeclContext *DC = RDecl;
3018 if (SS.isSet()) {
3019 // If the member name was a qualified-id, look into the
3020 // nested-name-specifier.
3021 DC = SemaRef.computeDeclContext(SS, false);
3022
John McCall77bb1aa2010-05-01 00:40:08 +00003023 if (SemaRef.RequireCompleteDeclContext(SS, DC)) {
John McCall2f841ba2009-12-02 03:53:29 +00003024 SemaRef.Diag(SS.getRange().getEnd(), diag::err_typecheck_incomplete_tag)
3025 << SS.getRange() << DC;
3026 return true;
3027 }
3028
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00003029 assert(DC && "Cannot handle non-computable dependent contexts in lookup");
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003030
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00003031 if (!isa<TypeDecl>(DC)) {
3032 SemaRef.Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diag::err_qualified_member_nonclass)
3033 << DC << SS.getRange();
3034 return true;
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003035 }
3036 }
3037
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00003038 // The record definition is complete, now look up the member.
3039 SemaRef.LookupQualifiedName(R, DC);
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003040
Douglas Gregor2dcc0112009-12-31 07:42:17 +00003041 if (!R.empty())
3042 return false;
3043
3044 // We didn't find anything with the given name, so try to correct
3045 // for typos.
3046 DeclarationName Name = R.getLookupName();
Sean Hunt1e3f5ba2010-04-28 23:02:27 +00003047 if (SemaRef.CorrectTypo(R, 0, &SS, DC, false, Sema::CTC_MemberLookup) &&
Douglas Gregoraaf87162010-04-14 20:04:41 +00003048 !R.empty() &&
Douglas Gregor2dcc0112009-12-31 07:42:17 +00003049 (isa<ValueDecl>(*R.begin()) || isa<FunctionTemplateDecl>(*R.begin()))) {
3050 SemaRef.Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diag::err_no_member_suggest)
3051 << Name << DC << R.getLookupName() << SS.getRange()
Douglas Gregor849b2432010-03-31 17:46:05 +00003052 << FixItHint::CreateReplacement(R.getNameLoc(),
3053 R.getLookupName().getAsString());
Douglas Gregor67dd1d42010-01-07 00:17:44 +00003054 if (NamedDecl *ND = R.getAsSingle<NamedDecl>())
3055 SemaRef.Diag(ND->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_decl)
3056 << ND->getDeclName();
Douglas Gregor2dcc0112009-12-31 07:42:17 +00003057 return false;
3058 } else {
3059 R.clear();
Douglas Gregor12eb5d62010-06-29 19:27:42 +00003060 R.setLookupName(Name);
Douglas Gregor2dcc0112009-12-31 07:42:17 +00003061 }
3062
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003063 return false;
3064}
3065
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00003066ExprResult
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00003067Sema::BuildMemberReferenceExpr(Expr *Base, QualType BaseType,
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003068 SourceLocation OpLoc, bool IsArrow,
Jeffrey Yasskin9ab14542010-04-08 16:38:48 +00003069 CXXScopeSpec &SS,
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003070 NamedDecl *FirstQualifierInScope,
Abramo Bagnara25777432010-08-11 22:01:17 +00003071 const DeclarationNameInfo &NameInfo,
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003072 const TemplateArgumentListInfo *TemplateArgs) {
John McCall2f841ba2009-12-02 03:53:29 +00003073 if (BaseType->isDependentType() ||
3074 (SS.isSet() && isDependentScopeSpecifier(SS)))
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00003075 return ActOnDependentMemberExpr(Base, BaseType,
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003076 IsArrow, OpLoc,
3077 SS, FirstQualifierInScope,
Abramo Bagnara25777432010-08-11 22:01:17 +00003078 NameInfo, TemplateArgs);
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003079
Abramo Bagnara25777432010-08-11 22:01:17 +00003080 LookupResult R(*this, NameInfo, LookupMemberName);
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003081
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00003082 // Implicit member accesses.
3083 if (!Base) {
3084 QualType RecordTy = BaseType;
3085 if (IsArrow) RecordTy = RecordTy->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
3086 if (LookupMemberExprInRecord(*this, R, SourceRange(),
3087 RecordTy->getAs<RecordType>(),
John McCallad00b772010-06-16 08:42:20 +00003088 OpLoc, SS, TemplateArgs != 0))
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00003089 return ExprError();
3090
3091 // Explicit member accesses.
3092 } else {
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00003093 ExprResult Result =
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00003094 LookupMemberExpr(R, Base, IsArrow, OpLoc,
John McCalld226f652010-08-21 09:40:31 +00003095 SS, /*ObjCImpDecl*/ 0, TemplateArgs != 0);
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00003096
3097 if (Result.isInvalid()) {
3098 Owned(Base);
3099 return ExprError();
3100 }
3101
3102 if (Result.get())
3103 return move(Result);
Sebastian Redlf3e63372010-05-07 09:25:11 +00003104
3105 // LookupMemberExpr can modify Base, and thus change BaseType
3106 BaseType = Base->getType();
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003107 }
3108
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00003109 return BuildMemberReferenceExpr(Base, BaseType,
John McCallc2233c52010-01-15 08:34:02 +00003110 OpLoc, IsArrow, SS, FirstQualifierInScope,
3111 R, TemplateArgs);
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003112}
3113
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00003114ExprResult
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00003115Sema::BuildMemberReferenceExpr(Expr *BaseExpr, QualType BaseExprType,
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00003116 SourceLocation OpLoc, bool IsArrow,
3117 const CXXScopeSpec &SS,
John McCallc2233c52010-01-15 08:34:02 +00003118 NamedDecl *FirstQualifierInScope,
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003119 LookupResult &R,
Douglas Gregor06a9f362010-05-01 20:49:11 +00003120 const TemplateArgumentListInfo *TemplateArgs,
3121 bool SuppressQualifierCheck) {
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00003122 QualType BaseType = BaseExprType;
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003123 if (IsArrow) {
3124 assert(BaseType->isPointerType());
3125 BaseType = BaseType->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
3126 }
John McCall161755a2010-04-06 21:38:20 +00003127 R.setBaseObjectType(BaseType);
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003128
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00003129 NestedNameSpecifier *Qualifier = SS.getScopeRep();
Abramo Bagnara25777432010-08-11 22:01:17 +00003130 const DeclarationNameInfo &MemberNameInfo = R.getLookupNameInfo();
3131 DeclarationName MemberName = MemberNameInfo.getName();
3132 SourceLocation MemberLoc = MemberNameInfo.getLoc();
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003133
3134 if (R.isAmbiguous())
Douglas Gregorfe85ced2009-08-06 03:17:00 +00003135 return ExprError();
3136
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003137 if (R.empty()) {
3138 // Rederive where we looked up.
3139 DeclContext *DC = (SS.isSet()
3140 ? computeDeclContext(SS, false)
3141 : BaseType->getAs<RecordType>()->getDecl());
Nate Begeman2ef13e52009-08-10 23:49:36 +00003142
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003143 Diag(R.getNameLoc(), diag::err_no_member)
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00003144 << MemberName << DC
3145 << (BaseExpr ? BaseExpr->getSourceRange() : SourceRange());
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003146 return ExprError();
3147 }
3148
John McCallc2233c52010-01-15 08:34:02 +00003149 // Diagnose lookups that find only declarations from a non-base
3150 // type. This is possible for either qualified lookups (which may
3151 // have been qualified with an unrelated type) or implicit member
3152 // expressions (which were found with unqualified lookup and thus
3153 // may have come from an enclosing scope). Note that it's okay for
3154 // lookup to find declarations from a non-base type as long as those
3155 // aren't the ones picked by overload resolution.
3156 if ((SS.isSet() || !BaseExpr ||
3157 (isa<CXXThisExpr>(BaseExpr) &&
3158 cast<CXXThisExpr>(BaseExpr)->isImplicit())) &&
Douglas Gregor06a9f362010-05-01 20:49:11 +00003159 !SuppressQualifierCheck &&
John McCallc2233c52010-01-15 08:34:02 +00003160 CheckQualifiedMemberReference(BaseExpr, BaseType, SS, R))
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003161 return ExprError();
3162
3163 // Construct an unresolved result if we in fact got an unresolved
3164 // result.
3165 if (R.isOverloadedResult() || R.isUnresolvableResult()) {
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00003166 bool Dependent =
John McCall410a3f32009-12-19 02:05:44 +00003167 BaseExprType->isDependentType() ||
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00003168 R.isUnresolvableResult() ||
John McCall7bb12da2010-02-02 06:20:04 +00003169 OverloadExpr::ComputeDependence(R.begin(), R.end(), TemplateArgs);
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003170
John McCallc373d482010-01-27 01:50:18 +00003171 // Suppress any lookup-related diagnostics; we'll do these when we
3172 // pick a member.
3173 R.suppressDiagnostics();
3174
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003175 UnresolvedMemberExpr *MemExpr
3176 = UnresolvedMemberExpr::Create(Context, Dependent,
3177 R.isUnresolvableResult(),
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00003178 BaseExpr, BaseExprType,
3179 IsArrow, OpLoc,
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003180 Qualifier, SS.getRange(),
Abramo Bagnara25777432010-08-11 22:01:17 +00003181 MemberNameInfo,
Douglas Gregor5a84dec2010-05-23 18:57:34 +00003182 TemplateArgs, R.begin(), R.end());
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003183
3184 return Owned(MemExpr);
3185 }
3186
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003187 assert(R.isSingleResult());
John McCall161755a2010-04-06 21:38:20 +00003188 DeclAccessPair FoundDecl = R.begin().getPair();
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003189 NamedDecl *MemberDecl = R.getFoundDecl();
3190
3191 // FIXME: diagnose the presence of template arguments now.
3192
3193 // If the decl being referenced had an error, return an error for this
3194 // sub-expr without emitting another error, in order to avoid cascading
3195 // error cases.
3196 if (MemberDecl->isInvalidDecl())
3197 return ExprError();
3198
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00003199 // Handle the implicit-member-access case.
3200 if (!BaseExpr) {
3201 // If this is not an instance member, convert to a non-member access.
John McCall161755a2010-04-06 21:38:20 +00003202 if (!MemberDecl->isCXXInstanceMember())
Abramo Bagnara25777432010-08-11 22:01:17 +00003203 return BuildDeclarationNameExpr(SS, R.getLookupNameInfo(), MemberDecl);
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00003204
Douglas Gregor828a1972010-01-07 23:12:05 +00003205 SourceLocation Loc = R.getNameLoc();
3206 if (SS.getRange().isValid())
3207 Loc = SS.getRange().getBegin();
3208 BaseExpr = new (Context) CXXThisExpr(Loc, BaseExprType,/*isImplicit=*/true);
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00003209 }
3210
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003211 bool ShouldCheckUse = true;
3212 if (CXXMethodDecl *MD = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(MemberDecl)) {
3213 // Don't diagnose the use of a virtual member function unless it's
3214 // explicitly qualified.
3215 if (MD->isVirtual() && !SS.isSet())
3216 ShouldCheckUse = false;
3217 }
3218
3219 // Check the use of this member.
3220 if (ShouldCheckUse && DiagnoseUseOfDecl(MemberDecl, MemberLoc)) {
3221 Owned(BaseExpr);
3222 return ExprError();
3223 }
3224
3225 if (FieldDecl *FD = dyn_cast<FieldDecl>(MemberDecl)) {
3226 // We may have found a field within an anonymous union or struct
3227 // (C++ [class.union]).
Eli Friedman16c53782009-12-04 07:18:51 +00003228 if (cast<RecordDecl>(FD->getDeclContext())->isAnonymousStructOrUnion() &&
3229 !BaseType->getAs<RecordType>()->getDecl()->isAnonymousStructOrUnion())
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003230 return BuildAnonymousStructUnionMemberReference(MemberLoc, FD,
3231 BaseExpr, OpLoc);
3232
3233 // Figure out the type of the member; see C99 6.5.2.3p3, C++ [expr.ref]
3234 QualType MemberType = FD->getType();
3235 if (const ReferenceType *Ref = MemberType->getAs<ReferenceType>())
3236 MemberType = Ref->getPointeeType();
3237 else {
3238 Qualifiers BaseQuals = BaseType.getQualifiers();
3239 BaseQuals.removeObjCGCAttr();
3240 if (FD->isMutable()) BaseQuals.removeConst();
3241
3242 Qualifiers MemberQuals
3243 = Context.getCanonicalType(MemberType).getQualifiers();
3244
3245 Qualifiers Combined = BaseQuals + MemberQuals;
3246 if (Combined != MemberQuals)
3247 MemberType = Context.getQualifiedType(MemberType, Combined);
3248 }
3249
3250 MarkDeclarationReferenced(MemberLoc, FD);
John McCall6bb80172010-03-30 21:47:33 +00003251 if (PerformObjectMemberConversion(BaseExpr, Qualifier, FoundDecl, FD))
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003252 return ExprError();
3253 return Owned(BuildMemberExpr(Context, BaseExpr, IsArrow, SS,
Abramo Bagnara25777432010-08-11 22:01:17 +00003254 FD, FoundDecl, MemberNameInfo,
3255 MemberType));
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003256 }
3257
3258 if (VarDecl *Var = dyn_cast<VarDecl>(MemberDecl)) {
3259 MarkDeclarationReferenced(MemberLoc, Var);
3260 return Owned(BuildMemberExpr(Context, BaseExpr, IsArrow, SS,
Abramo Bagnara25777432010-08-11 22:01:17 +00003261 Var, FoundDecl, MemberNameInfo,
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003262 Var->getType().getNonReferenceType()));
3263 }
3264
3265 if (FunctionDecl *MemberFn = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(MemberDecl)) {
3266 MarkDeclarationReferenced(MemberLoc, MemberDecl);
3267 return Owned(BuildMemberExpr(Context, BaseExpr, IsArrow, SS,
Abramo Bagnara25777432010-08-11 22:01:17 +00003268 MemberFn, FoundDecl, MemberNameInfo,
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003269 MemberFn->getType()));
3270 }
3271
3272 if (EnumConstantDecl *Enum = dyn_cast<EnumConstantDecl>(MemberDecl)) {
3273 MarkDeclarationReferenced(MemberLoc, MemberDecl);
3274 return Owned(BuildMemberExpr(Context, BaseExpr, IsArrow, SS,
Abramo Bagnara25777432010-08-11 22:01:17 +00003275 Enum, FoundDecl, MemberNameInfo,
3276 Enum->getType()));
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003277 }
3278
3279 Owned(BaseExpr);
3280
Douglas Gregorb0fd4832010-04-25 20:55:08 +00003281 // We found something that we didn't expect. Complain.
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003282 if (isa<TypeDecl>(MemberDecl))
Abramo Bagnara25777432010-08-11 22:01:17 +00003283 Diag(MemberLoc, diag::err_typecheck_member_reference_type)
Douglas Gregorb0fd4832010-04-25 20:55:08 +00003284 << MemberName << BaseType << int(IsArrow);
3285 else
3286 Diag(MemberLoc, diag::err_typecheck_member_reference_unknown)
3287 << MemberName << BaseType << int(IsArrow);
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003288
Douglas Gregorb0fd4832010-04-25 20:55:08 +00003289 Diag(MemberDecl->getLocation(), diag::note_member_declared_here)
3290 << MemberName;
Douglas Gregor2b147f02010-04-25 21:15:30 +00003291 R.suppressDiagnostics();
Douglas Gregorb0fd4832010-04-25 20:55:08 +00003292 return ExprError();
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003293}
3294
3295/// Look up the given member of the given non-type-dependent
3296/// expression. This can return in one of two ways:
3297/// * If it returns a sentinel null-but-valid result, the caller will
3298/// assume that lookup was performed and the results written into
3299/// the provided structure. It will take over from there.
3300/// * Otherwise, the returned expression will be produced in place of
3301/// an ordinary member expression.
3302///
3303/// The ObjCImpDecl bit is a gross hack that will need to be properly
3304/// fixed for ObjC++.
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00003305ExprResult
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003306Sema::LookupMemberExpr(LookupResult &R, Expr *&BaseExpr,
John McCall812c1542009-12-07 22:46:59 +00003307 bool &IsArrow, SourceLocation OpLoc,
Jeffrey Yasskin9ab14542010-04-08 16:38:48 +00003308 CXXScopeSpec &SS,
John McCalld226f652010-08-21 09:40:31 +00003309 Decl *ObjCImpDecl, bool HasTemplateArgs) {
Douglas Gregora71d8192009-09-04 17:36:40 +00003310 assert(BaseExpr && "no base expression");
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003311
Steve Naroff3cc4af82007-12-16 21:42:28 +00003312 // Perform default conversions.
3313 DefaultFunctionArrayConversion(BaseExpr);
Sebastian Redl0eb23302009-01-19 00:08:26 +00003314
Steve Naroffdfa6aae2007-07-26 03:11:44 +00003315 QualType BaseType = BaseExpr->getType();
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003316 assert(!BaseType->isDependentType());
3317
3318 DeclarationName MemberName = R.getLookupName();
3319 SourceLocation MemberLoc = R.getNameLoc();
Douglas Gregor3f0b5fd2009-11-06 06:30:47 +00003320
3321 // If the user is trying to apply -> or . to a function pointer
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003322 // type, it's probably because they forgot parentheses to call that
Douglas Gregor3f0b5fd2009-11-06 06:30:47 +00003323 // function. Suggest the addition of those parentheses, build the
3324 // call, and continue on.
3325 if (const PointerType *Ptr = BaseType->getAs<PointerType>()) {
3326 if (const FunctionProtoType *Fun
3327 = Ptr->getPointeeType()->getAs<FunctionProtoType>()) {
3328 QualType ResultTy = Fun->getResultType();
3329 if (Fun->getNumArgs() == 0 &&
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003330 ((!IsArrow && ResultTy->isRecordType()) ||
3331 (IsArrow && ResultTy->isPointerType() &&
Douglas Gregor3f0b5fd2009-11-06 06:30:47 +00003332 ResultTy->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType()
3333 ->isRecordType()))) {
3334 SourceLocation Loc = PP.getLocForEndOfToken(BaseExpr->getLocEnd());
Nick Lewycky3d6c45d2010-10-15 21:43:24 +00003335 Diag(BaseExpr->getExprLoc(), diag::err_member_reference_needs_call)
Douglas Gregor3f0b5fd2009-11-06 06:30:47 +00003336 << QualType(Fun, 0)
Douglas Gregor849b2432010-03-31 17:46:05 +00003337 << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(Loc, "()");
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003338
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00003339 ExprResult NewBase
Douglas Gregora1a04782010-09-09 16:33:13 +00003340 = ActOnCallExpr(0, BaseExpr, Loc, MultiExprArg(*this, 0, 0), Loc);
Douglas Gregorf918b832010-06-21 22:46:46 +00003341 BaseExpr = 0;
Douglas Gregor3f0b5fd2009-11-06 06:30:47 +00003342 if (NewBase.isInvalid())
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003343 return ExprError();
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003344
Douglas Gregor3f0b5fd2009-11-06 06:30:47 +00003345 BaseExpr = NewBase.takeAs<Expr>();
3346 DefaultFunctionArrayConversion(BaseExpr);
3347 BaseType = BaseExpr->getType();
3348 }
3349 }
3350 }
3351
David Chisnall0f436562009-08-17 16:35:33 +00003352 // If this is an Objective-C pseudo-builtin and a definition is provided then
3353 // use that.
3354 if (BaseType->isObjCIdType()) {
Fariborz Jahanian6d910f02009-12-07 20:09:25 +00003355 if (IsArrow) {
3356 // Handle the following exceptional case PObj->isa.
3357 if (const ObjCObjectPointerType *OPT =
3358 BaseType->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>()) {
John McCallc12c5bb2010-05-15 11:32:37 +00003359 if (OPT->getObjectType()->isObjCId() &&
Fariborz Jahanian6d910f02009-12-07 20:09:25 +00003360 MemberName.getAsIdentifierInfo()->isStr("isa"))
Fariborz Jahanian83dc3252009-12-09 19:05:56 +00003361 return Owned(new (Context) ObjCIsaExpr(BaseExpr, true, MemberLoc,
3362 Context.getObjCClassType()));
Fariborz Jahanian6d910f02009-12-07 20:09:25 +00003363 }
3364 }
David Chisnall0f436562009-08-17 16:35:33 +00003365 // We have an 'id' type. Rather than fall through, we check if this
3366 // is a reference to 'isa'.
3367 if (BaseType != Context.ObjCIdRedefinitionType) {
3368 BaseType = Context.ObjCIdRedefinitionType;
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00003369 ImpCastExprToType(BaseExpr, BaseType, CK_BitCast);
David Chisnall0f436562009-08-17 16:35:33 +00003370 }
David Chisnall0f436562009-08-17 16:35:33 +00003371 }
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003372
Fariborz Jahanian369a3bd2009-11-25 23:07:42 +00003373 // If this is an Objective-C pseudo-builtin and a definition is provided then
3374 // use that.
3375 if (Context.isObjCSelType(BaseType)) {
3376 // We have an 'SEL' type. Rather than fall through, we check if this
3377 // is a reference to 'sel_id'.
3378 if (BaseType != Context.ObjCSelRedefinitionType) {
3379 BaseType = Context.ObjCSelRedefinitionType;
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00003380 ImpCastExprToType(BaseExpr, BaseType, CK_BitCast);
Fariborz Jahanian369a3bd2009-11-25 23:07:42 +00003381 }
3382 }
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003383
Steve Naroffdfa6aae2007-07-26 03:11:44 +00003384 assert(!BaseType.isNull() && "no type for member expression");
Sebastian Redl0eb23302009-01-19 00:08:26 +00003385
Fariborz Jahanianb2ef1be2009-09-22 16:48:37 +00003386 // Handle properties on ObjC 'Class' types.
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003387 if (!IsArrow && BaseType->isObjCClassType()) {
Fariborz Jahanianb2ef1be2009-09-22 16:48:37 +00003388 // Also must look for a getter name which uses property syntax.
3389 IdentifierInfo *Member = MemberName.getAsIdentifierInfo();
3390 Selector Sel = PP.getSelectorTable().getNullarySelector(Member);
3391 if (ObjCMethodDecl *MD = getCurMethodDecl()) {
3392 ObjCInterfaceDecl *IFace = MD->getClassInterface();
3393 ObjCMethodDecl *Getter;
3394 // FIXME: need to also look locally in the implementation.
3395 if ((Getter = IFace->lookupClassMethod(Sel))) {
3396 // Check the use of this method.
3397 if (DiagnoseUseOfDecl(Getter, MemberLoc))
3398 return ExprError();
3399 }
3400 // If we found a getter then this may be a valid dot-reference, we
3401 // will look for the matching setter, in case it is needed.
3402 Selector SetterSel =
3403 SelectorTable::constructSetterName(PP.getIdentifierTable(),
3404 PP.getSelectorTable(), Member);
3405 ObjCMethodDecl *Setter = IFace->lookupClassMethod(SetterSel);
3406 if (!Setter) {
3407 // If this reference is in an @implementation, also check for 'private'
3408 // methods.
Steve Naroffd789d3d2009-10-01 23:46:04 +00003409 Setter = IFace->lookupPrivateInstanceMethod(SetterSel);
Fariborz Jahanianb2ef1be2009-09-22 16:48:37 +00003410 }
3411 // Look through local category implementations associated with the class.
3412 if (!Setter)
3413 Setter = IFace->getCategoryClassMethod(SetterSel);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003414
Fariborz Jahanianb2ef1be2009-09-22 16:48:37 +00003415 if (Setter && DiagnoseUseOfDecl(Setter, MemberLoc))
3416 return ExprError();
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003417
Fariborz Jahanianb2ef1be2009-09-22 16:48:37 +00003418 if (Getter || Setter) {
3419 QualType PType;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003420
Fariborz Jahanianb2ef1be2009-09-22 16:48:37 +00003421 if (Getter)
Douglas Gregor5291c3c2010-07-13 08:18:22 +00003422 PType = Getter->getSendResultType();
Fariborz Jahanianb2ef1be2009-09-22 16:48:37 +00003423 else
3424 // Get the expression type from Setter's incoming parameter.
3425 PType = (*(Setter->param_end() -1))->getType();
3426 // FIXME: we must check that the setter has property type.
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003427 return Owned(new (Context) ObjCImplicitSetterGetterRefExpr(Getter,
Fariborz Jahanianb2ef1be2009-09-22 16:48:37 +00003428 PType,
3429 Setter, MemberLoc, BaseExpr));
3430 }
3431 return ExprError(Diag(MemberLoc, diag::err_property_not_found)
3432 << MemberName << BaseType);
3433 }
3434 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003435
Fariborz Jahanianb2ef1be2009-09-22 16:48:37 +00003436 if (BaseType->isObjCClassType() &&
3437 BaseType != Context.ObjCClassRedefinitionType) {
3438 BaseType = Context.ObjCClassRedefinitionType;
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00003439 ImpCastExprToType(BaseExpr, BaseType, CK_BitCast);
Fariborz Jahanianb2ef1be2009-09-22 16:48:37 +00003440 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003441
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003442 if (IsArrow) {
3443 if (const PointerType *PT = BaseType->getAs<PointerType>())
Steve Naroffdfa6aae2007-07-26 03:11:44 +00003444 BaseType = PT->getPointeeType();
Steve Naroff14108da2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00003445 else if (BaseType->isObjCObjectPointerType())
3446 ;
John McCall812c1542009-12-07 22:46:59 +00003447 else if (BaseType->isRecordType()) {
3448 // Recover from arrow accesses to records, e.g.:
3449 // struct MyRecord foo;
3450 // foo->bar
3451 // This is actually well-formed in C++ if MyRecord has an
3452 // overloaded operator->, but that should have been dealt with
3453 // by now.
3454 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_member_reference_suggestion)
3455 << BaseType << int(IsArrow) << BaseExpr->getSourceRange()
Douglas Gregor849b2432010-03-31 17:46:05 +00003456 << FixItHint::CreateReplacement(OpLoc, ".");
John McCall812c1542009-12-07 22:46:59 +00003457 IsArrow = false;
3458 } else {
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003459 Diag(MemberLoc, diag::err_typecheck_member_reference_arrow)
3460 << BaseType << BaseExpr->getSourceRange();
3461 return ExprError();
Anders Carlsson4ef27702009-05-16 20:31:20 +00003462 }
John McCall812c1542009-12-07 22:46:59 +00003463 } else {
3464 // Recover from dot accesses to pointers, e.g.:
3465 // type *foo;
3466 // foo.bar
3467 // This is actually well-formed in two cases:
3468 // - 'type' is an Objective C type
3469 // - 'bar' is a pseudo-destructor name which happens to refer to
3470 // the appropriate pointer type
3471 if (MemberName.getNameKind() != DeclarationName::CXXDestructorName) {
3472 const PointerType *PT = BaseType->getAs<PointerType>();
3473 if (PT && PT->getPointeeType()->isRecordType()) {
3474 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_member_reference_suggestion)
3475 << BaseType << int(IsArrow) << BaseExpr->getSourceRange()
Douglas Gregor849b2432010-03-31 17:46:05 +00003476 << FixItHint::CreateReplacement(OpLoc, "->");
John McCall812c1542009-12-07 22:46:59 +00003477 BaseType = PT->getPointeeType();
3478 IsArrow = true;
3479 }
3480 }
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003481 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003482
John McCallc12c5bb2010-05-15 11:32:37 +00003483 // Handle field access to simple records.
Ted Kremenek6217b802009-07-29 21:53:49 +00003484 if (const RecordType *RTy = BaseType->getAs<RecordType>()) {
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00003485 if (LookupMemberExprInRecord(*this, R, BaseExpr->getSourceRange(),
John McCallad00b772010-06-16 08:42:20 +00003486 RTy, OpLoc, SS, HasTemplateArgs))
Douglas Gregor4ec339f2009-01-19 19:26:10 +00003487 return ExprError();
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003488 return Owned((Expr*) 0);
Chris Lattnerfb173ec2008-07-21 04:28:12 +00003489 }
Sebastian Redl0eb23302009-01-19 00:08:26 +00003490
Chris Lattnera38e6b12008-07-21 04:59:05 +00003491 // Handle access to Objective-C instance variables, such as "Obj->ivar" and
3492 // (*Obj).ivar.
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003493 if ((IsArrow && BaseType->isObjCObjectPointerType()) ||
John McCallc12c5bb2010-05-15 11:32:37 +00003494 (!IsArrow && BaseType->isObjCObjectType())) {
John McCall183700f2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00003495 const ObjCObjectPointerType *OPT = BaseType->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>();
John McCallc12c5bb2010-05-15 11:32:37 +00003496 ObjCInterfaceDecl *IDecl =
3497 OPT ? OPT->getInterfaceDecl()
3498 : BaseType->getAs<ObjCObjectType>()->getInterface();
3499 if (IDecl) {
Anders Carlsson8f28f992009-08-26 18:25:21 +00003500 IdentifierInfo *Member = MemberName.getAsIdentifierInfo();
3501
Steve Naroffc70e8d92009-07-16 00:25:06 +00003502 ObjCInterfaceDecl *ClassDeclared;
Anders Carlsson8f28f992009-08-26 18:25:21 +00003503 ObjCIvarDecl *IV = IDecl->lookupInstanceVariable(Member, ClassDeclared);
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003504
Douglas Gregorf06cdae2010-01-03 18:01:57 +00003505 if (!IV) {
3506 // Attempt to correct for typos in ivar names.
3507 LookupResult Res(*this, R.getLookupName(), R.getNameLoc(),
3508 LookupMemberName);
Douglas Gregor9a632ea2010-10-20 03:06:34 +00003509 if (CorrectTypo(Res, 0, 0, IDecl, false,
3510 IsArrow? CTC_ObjCIvarLookup
3511 : CTC_ObjCPropertyLookup) &&
Douglas Gregorf06cdae2010-01-03 18:01:57 +00003512 (IV = Res.getAsSingle<ObjCIvarDecl>())) {
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003513 Diag(R.getNameLoc(),
Douglas Gregorf06cdae2010-01-03 18:01:57 +00003514 diag::err_typecheck_member_reference_ivar_suggest)
3515 << IDecl->getDeclName() << MemberName << IV->getDeclName()
Douglas Gregor849b2432010-03-31 17:46:05 +00003516 << FixItHint::CreateReplacement(R.getNameLoc(),
3517 IV->getNameAsString());
Douglas Gregor67dd1d42010-01-07 00:17:44 +00003518 Diag(IV->getLocation(), diag::note_previous_decl)
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003519 << IV->getDeclName();
Douglas Gregor12eb5d62010-06-29 19:27:42 +00003520 } else {
3521 Res.clear();
3522 Res.setLookupName(Member);
Douglas Gregorf06cdae2010-01-03 18:01:57 +00003523 }
3524 }
3525
Steve Naroffc70e8d92009-07-16 00:25:06 +00003526 if (IV) {
3527 // If the decl being referenced had an error, return an error for this
3528 // sub-expr without emitting another error, in order to avoid cascading
3529 // error cases.
3530 if (IV->isInvalidDecl())
3531 return ExprError();
Douglas Gregor48f3bb92009-02-18 21:56:37 +00003532
Steve Naroffc70e8d92009-07-16 00:25:06 +00003533 // Check whether we can reference this field.
3534 if (DiagnoseUseOfDecl(IV, MemberLoc))
3535 return ExprError();
3536 if (IV->getAccessControl() != ObjCIvarDecl::Public &&
3537 IV->getAccessControl() != ObjCIvarDecl::Package) {
3538 ObjCInterfaceDecl *ClassOfMethodDecl = 0;
3539 if (ObjCMethodDecl *MD = getCurMethodDecl())
3540 ClassOfMethodDecl = MD->getClassInterface();
3541 else if (ObjCImpDecl && getCurFunctionDecl()) {
3542 // Case of a c-function declared inside an objc implementation.
3543 // FIXME: For a c-style function nested inside an objc implementation
3544 // class, there is no implementation context available, so we pass
3545 // down the context as argument to this routine. Ideally, this context
3546 // need be passed down in the AST node and somehow calculated from the
3547 // AST for a function decl.
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003548 if (ObjCImplementationDecl *IMPD =
John McCalld226f652010-08-21 09:40:31 +00003549 dyn_cast<ObjCImplementationDecl>(ObjCImpDecl))
Steve Naroffc70e8d92009-07-16 00:25:06 +00003550 ClassOfMethodDecl = IMPD->getClassInterface();
3551 else if (ObjCCategoryImplDecl* CatImplClass =
John McCalld226f652010-08-21 09:40:31 +00003552 dyn_cast<ObjCCategoryImplDecl>(ObjCImpDecl))
Steve Naroffc70e8d92009-07-16 00:25:06 +00003553 ClassOfMethodDecl = CatImplClass->getClassInterface();
3554 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003555
3556 if (IV->getAccessControl() == ObjCIvarDecl::Private) {
3557 if (ClassDeclared != IDecl ||
Steve Naroffc70e8d92009-07-16 00:25:06 +00003558 ClassOfMethodDecl != ClassDeclared)
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003559 Diag(MemberLoc, diag::error_private_ivar_access)
Steve Naroffc70e8d92009-07-16 00:25:06 +00003560 << IV->getDeclName();
Mike Stumpac5fc7c2009-08-04 21:02:39 +00003561 } else if (!IDecl->isSuperClassOf(ClassOfMethodDecl))
3562 // @protected
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003563 Diag(MemberLoc, diag::error_protected_ivar_access)
Steve Naroffc70e8d92009-07-16 00:25:06 +00003564 << IV->getDeclName();
Steve Naroffb06d8752009-03-04 18:34:24 +00003565 }
Steve Naroffc70e8d92009-07-16 00:25:06 +00003566
3567 return Owned(new (Context) ObjCIvarRefExpr(IV, IV->getType(),
3568 MemberLoc, BaseExpr,
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003569 IsArrow));
Fariborz Jahanian935fd762009-03-03 01:21:12 +00003570 }
Steve Naroffc70e8d92009-07-16 00:25:06 +00003571 return ExprError(Diag(MemberLoc, diag::err_typecheck_member_reference_ivar)
Anders Carlsson8f28f992009-08-26 18:25:21 +00003572 << IDecl->getDeclName() << MemberName
Steve Naroffc70e8d92009-07-16 00:25:06 +00003573 << BaseExpr->getSourceRange());
Fariborz Jahanianaaa63a72008-12-13 22:20:28 +00003574 }
Chris Lattnerfb173ec2008-07-21 04:28:12 +00003575 }
Steve Naroffde2e22d2009-07-15 18:40:39 +00003576 // Handle properties on 'id' and qualified "id".
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003577 if (!IsArrow && (BaseType->isObjCIdType() ||
3578 BaseType->isObjCQualifiedIdType())) {
John McCall183700f2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00003579 const ObjCObjectPointerType *QIdTy = BaseType->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>();
Anders Carlsson8f28f992009-08-26 18:25:21 +00003580 IdentifierInfo *Member = MemberName.getAsIdentifierInfo();
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003581
Steve Naroff14108da2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00003582 // Check protocols on qualified interfaces.
Anders Carlsson8f28f992009-08-26 18:25:21 +00003583 Selector Sel = PP.getSelectorTable().getNullarySelector(Member);
Fariborz Jahanianf2ad2c92010-10-11 21:29:12 +00003584 if (Decl *PMDecl = FindGetterSetterNameDecl(QIdTy, Member, Sel,
3585 Context)) {
Steve Naroff14108da2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00003586 if (ObjCPropertyDecl *PD = dyn_cast<ObjCPropertyDecl>(PMDecl)) {
3587 // Check the use of this declaration
3588 if (DiagnoseUseOfDecl(PD, MemberLoc))
3589 return ExprError();
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003590
Steve Naroff14108da2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00003591 return Owned(new (Context) ObjCPropertyRefExpr(PD, PD->getType(),
Fariborz Jahanian8ac2d442010-10-14 16:04:05 +00003592 MemberLoc,
3593 BaseExpr));
Steve Naroff14108da2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00003594 }
3595 if (ObjCMethodDecl *OMD = dyn_cast<ObjCMethodDecl>(PMDecl)) {
3596 // Check the use of this method.
3597 if (DiagnoseUseOfDecl(OMD, MemberLoc))
3598 return ExprError();
Fariborz Jahanianf2ad2c92010-10-11 21:29:12 +00003599 Selector SetterSel =
3600 SelectorTable::constructSetterName(PP.getIdentifierTable(),
3601 PP.getSelectorTable(), Member);
3602 ObjCMethodDecl *SMD = 0;
3603 if (Decl *SDecl = FindGetterSetterNameDecl(QIdTy, /*Property id*/0,
3604 SetterSel, Context))
3605 SMD = dyn_cast<ObjCMethodDecl>(SDecl);
3606 QualType PType = OMD->getSendResultType();
3607 return Owned(new (Context) ObjCImplicitSetterGetterRefExpr(OMD, PType,
3608 SMD,
3609 MemberLoc,
3610 BaseExpr));
Steve Naroff14108da2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00003611 }
3612 }
Sebastian Redl0eb23302009-01-19 00:08:26 +00003613
Steve Naroff14108da2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00003614 return ExprError(Diag(MemberLoc, diag::err_property_not_found)
Anders Carlsson8f28f992009-08-26 18:25:21 +00003615 << MemberName << BaseType);
Steve Naroff14108da2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00003616 }
Sean Hunt1e3f5ba2010-04-28 23:02:27 +00003617
Chris Lattnera38e6b12008-07-21 04:59:05 +00003618 // Handle Objective-C property access, which is "Obj.property" where Obj is a
3619 // pointer to a (potentially qualified) interface type.
Chris Lattner7f816522010-04-11 07:45:24 +00003620 if (!IsArrow)
3621 if (const ObjCObjectPointerType *OPT =
3622 BaseType->getAsObjCInterfacePointerType())
Fariborz Jahanian8ac2d442010-10-14 16:04:05 +00003623 return HandleExprPropertyRefExpr(OPT, BaseExpr, MemberName, MemberLoc,
3624 SourceLocation(), QualType(), false);
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003625
Steve Narofff242b1b2009-07-24 17:54:45 +00003626 // Handle the following exceptional case (*Obj).isa.
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003627 if (!IsArrow &&
John McCallc12c5bb2010-05-15 11:32:37 +00003628 BaseType->isObjCObjectType() &&
3629 BaseType->getAs<ObjCObjectType>()->isObjCId() &&
Anders Carlsson8f28f992009-08-26 18:25:21 +00003630 MemberName.getAsIdentifierInfo()->isStr("isa"))
Steve Narofff242b1b2009-07-24 17:54:45 +00003631 return Owned(new (Context) ObjCIsaExpr(BaseExpr, false, MemberLoc,
Fariborz Jahanian83dc3252009-12-09 19:05:56 +00003632 Context.getObjCClassType()));
Steve Narofff242b1b2009-07-24 17:54:45 +00003633
Chris Lattnerfb173ec2008-07-21 04:28:12 +00003634 // Handle 'field access' to vectors, such as 'V.xx'.
Chris Lattner73525de2009-02-16 21:11:58 +00003635 if (BaseType->isExtVectorType()) {
Anders Carlsson8f28f992009-08-26 18:25:21 +00003636 IdentifierInfo *Member = MemberName.getAsIdentifierInfo();
Chris Lattnerfb173ec2008-07-21 04:28:12 +00003637 QualType ret = CheckExtVectorComponent(BaseType, OpLoc, Member, MemberLoc);
3638 if (ret.isNull())
Sebastian Redl0eb23302009-01-19 00:08:26 +00003639 return ExprError();
Anders Carlsson8f28f992009-08-26 18:25:21 +00003640 return Owned(new (Context) ExtVectorElementExpr(ret, BaseExpr, *Member,
Steve Naroff6ece14c2009-01-21 00:14:39 +00003641 MemberLoc));
Chris Lattnerfb173ec2008-07-21 04:28:12 +00003642 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003643
Douglas Gregor214f31a2009-03-27 06:00:30 +00003644 Diag(MemberLoc, diag::err_typecheck_member_reference_struct_union)
3645 << BaseType << BaseExpr->getSourceRange();
3646
Douglas Gregor214f31a2009-03-27 06:00:30 +00003647 return ExprError();
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00003648}
3649
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003650/// The main callback when the parser finds something like
3651/// expression . [nested-name-specifier] identifier
3652/// expression -> [nested-name-specifier] identifier
3653/// where 'identifier' encompasses a fairly broad spectrum of
3654/// possibilities, including destructor and operator references.
3655///
3656/// \param OpKind either tok::arrow or tok::period
3657/// \param HasTrailingLParen whether the next token is '(', which
3658/// is used to diagnose mis-uses of special members that can
3659/// only be called
3660/// \param ObjCImpDecl the current ObjC @implementation decl;
3661/// this is an ugly hack around the fact that ObjC @implementations
3662/// aren't properly put in the context chain
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00003663ExprResult Sema::ActOnMemberAccessExpr(Scope *S, Expr *Base,
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003664 SourceLocation OpLoc,
3665 tok::TokenKind OpKind,
Jeffrey Yasskin9ab14542010-04-08 16:38:48 +00003666 CXXScopeSpec &SS,
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003667 UnqualifiedId &Id,
John McCalld226f652010-08-21 09:40:31 +00003668 Decl *ObjCImpDecl,
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003669 bool HasTrailingLParen) {
3670 if (SS.isSet() && SS.isInvalid())
3671 return ExprError();
3672
3673 TemplateArgumentListInfo TemplateArgsBuffer;
3674
3675 // Decompose the name into its component parts.
Abramo Bagnara25777432010-08-11 22:01:17 +00003676 DeclarationNameInfo NameInfo;
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003677 const TemplateArgumentListInfo *TemplateArgs;
3678 DecomposeUnqualifiedId(*this, Id, TemplateArgsBuffer,
Abramo Bagnara25777432010-08-11 22:01:17 +00003679 NameInfo, TemplateArgs);
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003680
Abramo Bagnara25777432010-08-11 22:01:17 +00003681 DeclarationName Name = NameInfo.getName();
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003682 bool IsArrow = (OpKind == tok::arrow);
3683
3684 NamedDecl *FirstQualifierInScope
3685 = (!SS.isSet() ? 0 : FindFirstQualifierInScope(S,
3686 static_cast<NestedNameSpecifier*>(SS.getScopeRep())));
3687
3688 // This is a postfix expression, so get rid of ParenListExprs.
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00003689 ExprResult Result = MaybeConvertParenListExprToParenExpr(S, Base);
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00003690 if (Result.isInvalid()) return ExprError();
3691 Base = Result.take();
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003692
Douglas Gregor01e56ae2010-04-12 20:54:26 +00003693 if (Base->getType()->isDependentType() || Name.isDependentName() ||
3694 isDependentScopeSpecifier(SS)) {
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00003695 Result = ActOnDependentMemberExpr(Base, Base->getType(),
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003696 IsArrow, OpLoc,
3697 SS, FirstQualifierInScope,
Abramo Bagnara25777432010-08-11 22:01:17 +00003698 NameInfo, TemplateArgs);
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003699 } else {
Abramo Bagnara25777432010-08-11 22:01:17 +00003700 LookupResult R(*this, NameInfo, LookupMemberName);
John McCallad00b772010-06-16 08:42:20 +00003701 Result = LookupMemberExpr(R, Base, IsArrow, OpLoc,
3702 SS, ObjCImpDecl, TemplateArgs != 0);
Sean Hunt1e3f5ba2010-04-28 23:02:27 +00003703
John McCallad00b772010-06-16 08:42:20 +00003704 if (Result.isInvalid()) {
3705 Owned(Base);
3706 return ExprError();
3707 }
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003708
John McCallad00b772010-06-16 08:42:20 +00003709 if (Result.get()) {
3710 // The only way a reference to a destructor can be used is to
3711 // immediately call it, which falls into this case. If the
3712 // next token is not a '(', produce a diagnostic and build the
3713 // call now.
3714 if (!HasTrailingLParen &&
3715 Id.getKind() == UnqualifiedId::IK_DestructorName)
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00003716 return DiagnoseDtorReference(NameInfo.getLoc(), Result.get());
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003717
John McCallad00b772010-06-16 08:42:20 +00003718 return move(Result);
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003719 }
3720
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00003721 Result = BuildMemberReferenceExpr(Base, Base->getType(),
John McCallc2233c52010-01-15 08:34:02 +00003722 OpLoc, IsArrow, SS, FirstQualifierInScope,
3723 R, TemplateArgs);
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003724 }
3725
3726 return move(Result);
Anders Carlsson8f28f992009-08-26 18:25:21 +00003727}
3728
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00003729ExprResult Sema::BuildCXXDefaultArgExpr(SourceLocation CallLoc,
Anders Carlsson56c5e332009-08-25 03:49:14 +00003730 FunctionDecl *FD,
3731 ParmVarDecl *Param) {
3732 if (Param->hasUnparsedDefaultArg()) {
Douglas Gregorbe0f7bd2010-09-11 20:24:53 +00003733 Diag(CallLoc,
Anders Carlsson56c5e332009-08-25 03:49:14 +00003734 diag::err_use_of_default_argument_to_function_declared_later) <<
3735 FD << cast<CXXRecordDecl>(FD->getDeclContext())->getDeclName();
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003736 Diag(UnparsedDefaultArgLocs[Param],
Anders Carlsson56c5e332009-08-25 03:49:14 +00003737 diag::note_default_argument_declared_here);
Douglas Gregorbe0f7bd2010-09-11 20:24:53 +00003738 return ExprError();
3739 }
3740
3741 if (Param->hasUninstantiatedDefaultArg()) {
3742 Expr *UninstExpr = Param->getUninstantiatedDefaultArg();
Anders Carlsson56c5e332009-08-25 03:49:14 +00003743
Douglas Gregorbe0f7bd2010-09-11 20:24:53 +00003744 // Instantiate the expression.
3745 MultiLevelTemplateArgumentList ArgList
3746 = getTemplateInstantiationArgs(FD, 0, /*RelativeToPrimary=*/true);
Anders Carlsson25cae7f2009-09-05 05:14:19 +00003747
Douglas Gregorbe0f7bd2010-09-11 20:24:53 +00003748 std::pair<const TemplateArgument *, unsigned> Innermost
3749 = ArgList.getInnermost();
3750 InstantiatingTemplate Inst(*this, CallLoc, Param, Innermost.first,
3751 Innermost.second);
Anders Carlsson56c5e332009-08-25 03:49:14 +00003752
Douglas Gregorbe0f7bd2010-09-11 20:24:53 +00003753 ExprResult Result = SubstExpr(UninstExpr, ArgList);
3754 if (Result.isInvalid())
3755 return ExprError();
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003756
Douglas Gregorbe0f7bd2010-09-11 20:24:53 +00003757 // Check the expression as an initializer for the parameter.
3758 InitializedEntity Entity
Fariborz Jahanian745da3a2010-09-24 17:30:16 +00003759 = InitializedEntity::InitializeParameter(Context, Param);
Douglas Gregorbe0f7bd2010-09-11 20:24:53 +00003760 InitializationKind Kind
3761 = InitializationKind::CreateCopy(Param->getLocation(),
3762 /*FIXME:EqualLoc*/UninstExpr->getSourceRange().getBegin());
3763 Expr *ResultE = Result.takeAs<Expr>();
Douglas Gregor65222e82009-12-23 18:19:08 +00003764
Douglas Gregorbe0f7bd2010-09-11 20:24:53 +00003765 InitializationSequence InitSeq(*this, Entity, Kind, &ResultE, 1);
3766 Result = InitSeq.Perform(*this, Entity, Kind,
3767 MultiExprArg(*this, &ResultE, 1));
3768 if (Result.isInvalid())
3769 return ExprError();
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003770
Douglas Gregorbe0f7bd2010-09-11 20:24:53 +00003771 // Build the default argument expression.
3772 return Owned(CXXDefaultArgExpr::Create(Context, CallLoc, Param,
3773 Result.takeAs<Expr>()));
Anders Carlsson56c5e332009-08-25 03:49:14 +00003774 }
3775
Douglas Gregorbe0f7bd2010-09-11 20:24:53 +00003776 // If the default expression creates temporaries, we need to
3777 // push them to the current stack of expression temporaries so they'll
3778 // be properly destroyed.
3779 // FIXME: We should really be rebuilding the default argument with new
3780 // bound temporaries; see the comment in PR5810.
Douglas Gregor5833b0b2010-09-14 22:55:20 +00003781 for (unsigned i = 0, e = Param->getNumDefaultArgTemporaries(); i != e; ++i) {
3782 CXXTemporary *Temporary = Param->getDefaultArgTemporary(i);
3783 MarkDeclarationReferenced(Param->getDefaultArg()->getLocStart(),
3784 const_cast<CXXDestructorDecl*>(Temporary->getDestructor()));
3785 ExprTemporaries.push_back(Temporary);
3786 }
Douglas Gregorbe0f7bd2010-09-11 20:24:53 +00003787
3788 // We already type-checked the argument, so we know it works.
Douglas Gregor4fcf5b22010-09-11 23:32:50 +00003789 // Just mark all of the declarations in this potentially-evaluated expression
3790 // as being "referenced".
Douglas Gregorbe0f7bd2010-09-11 20:24:53 +00003791 MarkDeclarationsReferencedInExpr(Param->getDefaultArg());
Douglas Gregor036aed12009-12-23 23:03:06 +00003792 return Owned(CXXDefaultArgExpr::Create(Context, CallLoc, Param));
Anders Carlsson56c5e332009-08-25 03:49:14 +00003793}
3794
Douglas Gregor88a35142008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003795/// ConvertArgumentsForCall - Converts the arguments specified in
3796/// Args/NumArgs to the parameter types of the function FDecl with
3797/// function prototype Proto. Call is the call expression itself, and
3798/// Fn is the function expression. For a C++ member function, this
3799/// routine does not attempt to convert the object argument. Returns
3800/// true if the call is ill-formed.
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00003801bool
3802Sema::ConvertArgumentsForCall(CallExpr *Call, Expr *Fn,
Douglas Gregor88a35142008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003803 FunctionDecl *FDecl,
Douglas Gregor72564e72009-02-26 23:50:07 +00003804 const FunctionProtoType *Proto,
Douglas Gregor88a35142008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003805 Expr **Args, unsigned NumArgs,
3806 SourceLocation RParenLoc) {
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00003807 // C99 6.5.2.2p7 - the arguments are implicitly converted, as if by
Douglas Gregor88a35142008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003808 // assignment, to the types of the corresponding parameter, ...
3809 unsigned NumArgsInProto = Proto->getNumArgs();
Douglas Gregor3fd56d72009-01-23 21:30:56 +00003810 bool Invalid = false;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003811
Douglas Gregor88a35142008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003812 // If too few arguments are available (and we don't have default
3813 // arguments for the remaining parameters), don't make the call.
3814 if (NumArgs < NumArgsInProto) {
3815 if (!FDecl || NumArgs < FDecl->getMinRequiredArguments())
3816 return Diag(RParenLoc, diag::err_typecheck_call_too_few_args)
Sean Hunt1e3f5ba2010-04-28 23:02:27 +00003817 << Fn->getType()->isBlockPointerType()
Eric Christopherd77b9a22010-04-16 04:48:22 +00003818 << NumArgsInProto << NumArgs << Fn->getSourceRange();
Ted Kremenek8189cde2009-02-07 01:47:29 +00003819 Call->setNumArgs(Context, NumArgsInProto);
Douglas Gregor88a35142008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003820 }
3821
3822 // If too many are passed and not variadic, error on the extras and drop
3823 // them.
3824 if (NumArgs > NumArgsInProto) {
3825 if (!Proto->isVariadic()) {
3826 Diag(Args[NumArgsInProto]->getLocStart(),
3827 diag::err_typecheck_call_too_many_args)
Sean Hunt1e3f5ba2010-04-28 23:02:27 +00003828 << Fn->getType()->isBlockPointerType()
Eric Christopherccfa9632010-04-16 04:56:46 +00003829 << NumArgsInProto << NumArgs << Fn->getSourceRange()
Douglas Gregor88a35142008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003830 << SourceRange(Args[NumArgsInProto]->getLocStart(),
3831 Args[NumArgs-1]->getLocEnd());
3832 // This deletes the extra arguments.
Ted Kremenek8189cde2009-02-07 01:47:29 +00003833 Call->setNumArgs(Context, NumArgsInProto);
Fariborz Jahanian048f52a2009-11-24 18:29:37 +00003834 return true;
Douglas Gregor88a35142008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003835 }
Douglas Gregor88a35142008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003836 }
Fariborz Jahanian048f52a2009-11-24 18:29:37 +00003837 llvm::SmallVector<Expr *, 8> AllArgs;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003838 VariadicCallType CallType =
Fariborz Jahanian4cd1c702009-11-24 19:27:49 +00003839 Proto->isVariadic() ? VariadicFunction : VariadicDoesNotApply;
3840 if (Fn->getType()->isBlockPointerType())
3841 CallType = VariadicBlock; // Block
3842 else if (isa<MemberExpr>(Fn))
3843 CallType = VariadicMethod;
Fariborz Jahanian048f52a2009-11-24 18:29:37 +00003844 Invalid = GatherArgumentsForCall(Call->getSourceRange().getBegin(), FDecl,
Fariborz Jahanian2fe168f2009-11-24 21:37:28 +00003845 Proto, 0, Args, NumArgs, AllArgs, CallType);
Fariborz Jahanian048f52a2009-11-24 18:29:37 +00003846 if (Invalid)
3847 return true;
3848 unsigned TotalNumArgs = AllArgs.size();
3849 for (unsigned i = 0; i < TotalNumArgs; ++i)
3850 Call->setArg(i, AllArgs[i]);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003851
Fariborz Jahanian048f52a2009-11-24 18:29:37 +00003852 return false;
3853}
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00003854
Fariborz Jahanian048f52a2009-11-24 18:29:37 +00003855bool Sema::GatherArgumentsForCall(SourceLocation CallLoc,
3856 FunctionDecl *FDecl,
3857 const FunctionProtoType *Proto,
3858 unsigned FirstProtoArg,
3859 Expr **Args, unsigned NumArgs,
3860 llvm::SmallVector<Expr *, 8> &AllArgs,
Fariborz Jahanian4cd1c702009-11-24 19:27:49 +00003861 VariadicCallType CallType) {
Fariborz Jahanian048f52a2009-11-24 18:29:37 +00003862 unsigned NumArgsInProto = Proto->getNumArgs();
3863 unsigned NumArgsToCheck = NumArgs;
3864 bool Invalid = false;
3865 if (NumArgs != NumArgsInProto)
3866 // Use default arguments for missing arguments
3867 NumArgsToCheck = NumArgsInProto;
3868 unsigned ArgIx = 0;
Douglas Gregor88a35142008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003869 // Continue to check argument types (even if we have too few/many args).
Fariborz Jahanian048f52a2009-11-24 18:29:37 +00003870 for (unsigned i = FirstProtoArg; i != NumArgsToCheck; i++) {
Douglas Gregor88a35142008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003871 QualType ProtoArgType = Proto->getArgType(i);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003872
Douglas Gregor88a35142008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003873 Expr *Arg;
Fariborz Jahanian048f52a2009-11-24 18:29:37 +00003874 if (ArgIx < NumArgs) {
3875 Arg = Args[ArgIx++];
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003876
Eli Friedmane7c6f7a2009-03-22 22:00:50 +00003877 if (RequireCompleteType(Arg->getSourceRange().getBegin(),
3878 ProtoArgType,
Anders Carlssonb7906612009-08-26 23:45:07 +00003879 PDiag(diag::err_call_incomplete_argument)
Fariborz Jahanian048f52a2009-11-24 18:29:37 +00003880 << Arg->getSourceRange()))
Eli Friedmane7c6f7a2009-03-22 22:00:50 +00003881 return true;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003882
Douglas Gregora188ff22009-12-22 16:09:06 +00003883 // Pass the argument
3884 ParmVarDecl *Param = 0;
3885 if (FDecl && i < FDecl->getNumParams())
3886 Param = FDecl->getParamDecl(i);
Douglas Gregoraa037312009-12-22 07:24:36 +00003887
Douglas Gregora188ff22009-12-22 16:09:06 +00003888 InitializedEntity Entity =
Fariborz Jahanian745da3a2010-09-24 17:30:16 +00003889 Param? InitializedEntity::InitializeParameter(Context, Param)
3890 : InitializedEntity::InitializeParameter(Context, ProtoArgType);
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00003891 ExprResult ArgE = PerformCopyInitialization(Entity,
Douglas Gregora188ff22009-12-22 16:09:06 +00003892 SourceLocation(),
3893 Owned(Arg));
3894 if (ArgE.isInvalid())
3895 return true;
3896
3897 Arg = ArgE.takeAs<Expr>();
Anders Carlsson5e300d12009-06-12 16:51:40 +00003898 } else {
Anders Carlssoned961f92009-08-25 02:29:20 +00003899 ParmVarDecl *Param = FDecl->getParamDecl(i);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003900
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00003901 ExprResult ArgExpr =
Fariborz Jahanian048f52a2009-11-24 18:29:37 +00003902 BuildCXXDefaultArgExpr(CallLoc, FDecl, Param);
Anders Carlsson56c5e332009-08-25 03:49:14 +00003903 if (ArgExpr.isInvalid())
3904 return true;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003905
Anders Carlsson56c5e332009-08-25 03:49:14 +00003906 Arg = ArgExpr.takeAs<Expr>();
Anders Carlsson5e300d12009-06-12 16:51:40 +00003907 }
Fariborz Jahanian048f52a2009-11-24 18:29:37 +00003908 AllArgs.push_back(Arg);
Douglas Gregor88a35142008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003909 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003910
Douglas Gregor88a35142008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003911 // If this is a variadic call, handle args passed through "...".
Fariborz Jahanian4cd1c702009-11-24 19:27:49 +00003912 if (CallType != VariadicDoesNotApply) {
Douglas Gregor88a35142008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003913 // Promote the arguments (C99 6.5.2.2p7).
Chris Lattner40378332010-05-16 04:01:30 +00003914 for (unsigned i = ArgIx; i != NumArgs; ++i) {
Douglas Gregor88a35142008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003915 Expr *Arg = Args[i];
Chris Lattner40378332010-05-16 04:01:30 +00003916 Invalid |= DefaultVariadicArgumentPromotion(Arg, CallType, FDecl);
Fariborz Jahanian048f52a2009-11-24 18:29:37 +00003917 AllArgs.push_back(Arg);
Douglas Gregor88a35142008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003918 }
3919 }
Douglas Gregor3fd56d72009-01-23 21:30:56 +00003920 return Invalid;
Douglas Gregor88a35142008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003921}
3922
Steve Narofff69936d2007-09-16 03:34:24 +00003923/// ActOnCallExpr - Handle a call to Fn with the specified array of arguments.
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00003924/// This provides the location of the left/right parens and a list of comma
3925/// locations.
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00003926ExprResult
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00003927Sema::ActOnCallExpr(Scope *S, Expr *Fn, SourceLocation LParenLoc,
Douglas Gregora1a04782010-09-09 16:33:13 +00003928 MultiExprArg args, SourceLocation RParenLoc) {
Sebastian Redl0eb23302009-01-19 00:08:26 +00003929 unsigned NumArgs = args.size();
Nate Begeman2ef13e52009-08-10 23:49:36 +00003930
3931 // Since this might be a postfix expression, get rid of ParenListExprs.
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00003932 ExprResult Result = MaybeConvertParenListExprToParenExpr(S, Fn);
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00003933 if (Result.isInvalid()) return ExprError();
3934 Fn = Result.take();
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003935
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00003936 Expr **Args = args.release();
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003937
Douglas Gregor88a35142008-12-22 05:46:06 +00003938 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
Douglas Gregora71d8192009-09-04 17:36:40 +00003939 // If this is a pseudo-destructor expression, build the call immediately.
3940 if (isa<CXXPseudoDestructorExpr>(Fn)) {
3941 if (NumArgs > 0) {
3942 // Pseudo-destructor calls should not have any arguments.
3943 Diag(Fn->getLocStart(), diag::err_pseudo_dtor_call_with_args)
Douglas Gregor849b2432010-03-31 17:46:05 +00003944 << FixItHint::CreateRemoval(
Douglas Gregora71d8192009-09-04 17:36:40 +00003945 SourceRange(Args[0]->getLocStart(),
3946 Args[NumArgs-1]->getLocEnd()));
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003947
Douglas Gregora71d8192009-09-04 17:36:40 +00003948 NumArgs = 0;
3949 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003950
Douglas Gregora71d8192009-09-04 17:36:40 +00003951 return Owned(new (Context) CallExpr(Context, Fn, 0, 0, Context.VoidTy,
3952 RParenLoc));
3953 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00003954
Douglas Gregor17330012009-02-04 15:01:18 +00003955 // Determine whether this is a dependent call inside a C++ template,
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00003956 // in which case we won't do any semantic analysis now.
Mike Stump390b4cc2009-05-16 07:39:55 +00003957 // FIXME: Will need to cache the results of name lookup (including ADL) in
3958 // Fn.
Douglas Gregor17330012009-02-04 15:01:18 +00003959 bool Dependent = false;
3960 if (Fn->isTypeDependent())
3961 Dependent = true;
3962 else if (Expr::hasAnyTypeDependentArguments(Args, NumArgs))
3963 Dependent = true;
3964
3965 if (Dependent)
Ted Kremenek668bf912009-02-09 20:51:47 +00003966 return Owned(new (Context) CallExpr(Context, Fn, Args, NumArgs,
Douglas Gregor17330012009-02-04 15:01:18 +00003967 Context.DependentTy, RParenLoc));
3968
3969 // Determine whether this is a call to an object (C++ [over.call.object]).
3970 if (Fn->getType()->isRecordType())
3971 return Owned(BuildCallToObjectOfClassType(S, Fn, LParenLoc, Args, NumArgs,
Douglas Gregora1a04782010-09-09 16:33:13 +00003972 RParenLoc));
Douglas Gregor17330012009-02-04 15:01:18 +00003973
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003974 Expr *NakedFn = Fn->IgnoreParens();
3975
3976 // Determine whether this is a call to an unresolved member function.
3977 if (UnresolvedMemberExpr *MemE = dyn_cast<UnresolvedMemberExpr>(NakedFn)) {
3978 // If lookup was unresolved but not dependent (i.e. didn't find
3979 // an unresolved using declaration), it has to be an overloaded
3980 // function set, which means it must contain either multiple
3981 // declarations (all methods or method templates) or a single
3982 // method template.
3983 assert((MemE->getNumDecls() > 1) ||
Douglas Gregor2b147f02010-04-25 21:15:30 +00003984 isa<FunctionTemplateDecl>(
3985 (*MemE->decls_begin())->getUnderlyingDecl()));
Douglas Gregor958aeb02009-12-01 03:34:29 +00003986 (void)MemE;
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003987
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00003988 return BuildCallToMemberFunction(S, Fn, LParenLoc, Args, NumArgs,
Douglas Gregora1a04782010-09-09 16:33:13 +00003989 RParenLoc);
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003990 }
3991
Douglas Gregorfa047642009-02-04 00:32:51 +00003992 // Determine whether this is a call to a member function.
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003993 if (MemberExpr *MemExpr = dyn_cast<MemberExpr>(NakedFn)) {
Douglas Gregore53060f2009-06-25 22:08:12 +00003994 NamedDecl *MemDecl = MemExpr->getMemberDecl();
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00003995 if (isa<CXXMethodDecl>(MemDecl))
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00003996 return BuildCallToMemberFunction(S, Fn, LParenLoc, Args, NumArgs,
Douglas Gregora1a04782010-09-09 16:33:13 +00003997 RParenLoc);
Douglas Gregore53060f2009-06-25 22:08:12 +00003998 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00003999
Anders Carlsson83ccfc32009-10-03 17:40:22 +00004000 // Determine whether this is a call to a pointer-to-member function.
John McCall129e2df2009-11-30 22:42:35 +00004001 if (BinaryOperator *BO = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(NakedFn)) {
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004002 if (BO->getOpcode() == BO_PtrMemD ||
4003 BO->getOpcode() == BO_PtrMemI) {
Douglas Gregor5f970ee2010-05-04 18:18:31 +00004004 if (const FunctionProtoType *FPT
4005 = BO->getType()->getAs<FunctionProtoType>()) {
Douglas Gregor5291c3c2010-07-13 08:18:22 +00004006 QualType ResultTy = FPT->getCallResultType(Context);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004007
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00004008 CXXMemberCallExpr *TheCall
4009 = new (Context) CXXMemberCallExpr(Context, BO, Args,
4010 NumArgs, ResultTy,
4011 RParenLoc);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004012
4013 if (CheckCallReturnType(FPT->getResultType(),
4014 BO->getRHS()->getSourceRange().getBegin(),
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00004015 TheCall, 0))
Fariborz Jahanian5de24502009-10-28 16:49:46 +00004016 return ExprError();
Anders Carlsson8d6d90d2009-10-15 00:41:48 +00004017
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00004018 if (ConvertArgumentsForCall(TheCall, BO, 0, FPT, Args, NumArgs,
Fariborz Jahanian5de24502009-10-28 16:49:46 +00004019 RParenLoc))
4020 return ExprError();
Anders Carlsson83ccfc32009-10-03 17:40:22 +00004021
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00004022 return MaybeBindToTemporary(TheCall);
Fariborz Jahanian5de24502009-10-28 16:49:46 +00004023 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004024 return ExprError(Diag(Fn->getLocStart(),
Fariborz Jahanian5de24502009-10-28 16:49:46 +00004025 diag::err_typecheck_call_not_function)
4026 << Fn->getType() << Fn->getSourceRange());
Anders Carlsson83ccfc32009-10-03 17:40:22 +00004027 }
4028 }
Douglas Gregor88a35142008-12-22 05:46:06 +00004029 }
4030
Douglas Gregorfa047642009-02-04 00:32:51 +00004031 // If we're directly calling a function, get the appropriate declaration.
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004032 // Also, in C++, keep track of whether we should perform argument-dependent
Douglas Gregor6db8ed42009-06-30 23:57:56 +00004033 // lookup and whether there were any explicitly-specified template arguments.
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004034
Eli Friedmanefa42f72009-12-26 03:35:45 +00004035 Expr *NakedFn = Fn->IgnoreParens();
Douglas Gregoref9b1492010-11-09 20:03:54 +00004036 if (isa<UnresolvedLookupExpr>(NakedFn)) {
4037 UnresolvedLookupExpr *ULE = cast<UnresolvedLookupExpr>(NakedFn);
4038 return BuildOverloadedCallExpr(S, Fn, ULE, LParenLoc, Args, NumArgs,
4039 RParenLoc);
4040 }
4041
John McCall3b4294e2009-12-16 12:17:52 +00004042 NamedDecl *NDecl = 0;
Douglas Gregord8f0ade2010-10-25 20:48:33 +00004043 if (UnaryOperator *UnOp = dyn_cast<UnaryOperator>(NakedFn))
4044 if (UnOp->getOpcode() == UO_AddrOf)
4045 NakedFn = UnOp->getSubExpr()->IgnoreParens();
4046
John McCall3b4294e2009-12-16 12:17:52 +00004047 if (isa<DeclRefExpr>(NakedFn))
4048 NDecl = cast<DeclRefExpr>(NakedFn)->getDecl();
4049
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00004050 return BuildResolvedCallExpr(Fn, NDecl, LParenLoc, Args, NumArgs, RParenLoc);
4051}
4052
John McCall3b4294e2009-12-16 12:17:52 +00004053/// BuildResolvedCallExpr - Build a call to a resolved expression,
4054/// i.e. an expression not of \p OverloadTy. The expression should
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00004055/// unary-convert to an expression of function-pointer or
4056/// block-pointer type.
4057///
4058/// \param NDecl the declaration being called, if available
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00004059ExprResult
John McCallaa81e162009-12-01 22:10:20 +00004060Sema::BuildResolvedCallExpr(Expr *Fn, NamedDecl *NDecl,
4061 SourceLocation LParenLoc,
4062 Expr **Args, unsigned NumArgs,
4063 SourceLocation RParenLoc) {
4064 FunctionDecl *FDecl = dyn_cast_or_null<FunctionDecl>(NDecl);
4065
Chris Lattner04421082008-04-08 04:40:51 +00004066 // Promote the function operand.
4067 UsualUnaryConversions(Fn);
4068
Chris Lattner925e60d2007-12-28 05:29:59 +00004069 // Make the call expr early, before semantic checks. This guarantees cleanup
4070 // of arguments and function on error.
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00004071 CallExpr *TheCall = new (Context) CallExpr(Context, Fn,
4072 Args, NumArgs,
4073 Context.BoolTy,
4074 RParenLoc);
Sebastian Redl0eb23302009-01-19 00:08:26 +00004075
Steve Naroffdd972f22008-09-05 22:11:13 +00004076 const FunctionType *FuncT;
4077 if (!Fn->getType()->isBlockPointerType()) {
4078 // C99 6.5.2.2p1 - "The expression that denotes the called function shall
4079 // have type pointer to function".
Ted Kremenek6217b802009-07-29 21:53:49 +00004080 const PointerType *PT = Fn->getType()->getAs<PointerType>();
Steve Naroffdd972f22008-09-05 22:11:13 +00004081 if (PT == 0)
Sebastian Redl0eb23302009-01-19 00:08:26 +00004082 return ExprError(Diag(LParenLoc, diag::err_typecheck_call_not_function)
4083 << Fn->getType() << Fn->getSourceRange());
John McCall183700f2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00004084 FuncT = PT->getPointeeType()->getAs<FunctionType>();
Steve Naroffdd972f22008-09-05 22:11:13 +00004085 } else { // This is a block call.
Ted Kremenek6217b802009-07-29 21:53:49 +00004086 FuncT = Fn->getType()->getAs<BlockPointerType>()->getPointeeType()->
John McCall183700f2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00004087 getAs<FunctionType>();
Steve Naroffdd972f22008-09-05 22:11:13 +00004088 }
Chris Lattner925e60d2007-12-28 05:29:59 +00004089 if (FuncT == 0)
Sebastian Redl0eb23302009-01-19 00:08:26 +00004090 return ExprError(Diag(LParenLoc, diag::err_typecheck_call_not_function)
4091 << Fn->getType() << Fn->getSourceRange());
4092
Eli Friedmane7c6f7a2009-03-22 22:00:50 +00004093 // Check for a valid return type
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004094 if (CheckCallReturnType(FuncT->getResultType(),
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00004095 Fn->getSourceRange().getBegin(), TheCall,
Anders Carlsson8c8d9192009-10-09 23:51:55 +00004096 FDecl))
Eli Friedmane7c6f7a2009-03-22 22:00:50 +00004097 return ExprError();
4098
Chris Lattner925e60d2007-12-28 05:29:59 +00004099 // We know the result type of the call, set it.
Douglas Gregor5291c3c2010-07-13 08:18:22 +00004100 TheCall->setType(FuncT->getCallResultType(Context));
Sebastian Redl0eb23302009-01-19 00:08:26 +00004101
Douglas Gregor72564e72009-02-26 23:50:07 +00004102 if (const FunctionProtoType *Proto = dyn_cast<FunctionProtoType>(FuncT)) {
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00004103 if (ConvertArgumentsForCall(TheCall, Fn, FDecl, Proto, Args, NumArgs,
Douglas Gregor88a35142008-12-22 05:46:06 +00004104 RParenLoc))
Sebastian Redl0eb23302009-01-19 00:08:26 +00004105 return ExprError();
Chris Lattner925e60d2007-12-28 05:29:59 +00004106 } else {
Douglas Gregor72564e72009-02-26 23:50:07 +00004107 assert(isa<FunctionNoProtoType>(FuncT) && "Unknown FunctionType!");
Sebastian Redl0eb23302009-01-19 00:08:26 +00004108
Douglas Gregor74734d52009-04-02 15:37:10 +00004109 if (FDecl) {
4110 // Check if we have too few/too many template arguments, based
4111 // on our knowledge of the function definition.
4112 const FunctionDecl *Def = 0;
Argyrios Kyrtzidis06a54a32010-07-07 11:31:19 +00004113 if (FDecl->hasBody(Def) && NumArgs != Def->param_size()) {
Douglas Gregor46542412010-10-25 20:39:23 +00004114 const FunctionProtoType *Proto
4115 = Def->getType()->getAs<FunctionProtoType>();
4116 if (!Proto || !(Proto->isVariadic() && NumArgs >= Def->param_size()))
Eli Friedmanbc4e29f2009-06-01 09:24:59 +00004117 Diag(RParenLoc, diag::warn_call_wrong_number_of_arguments)
4118 << (NumArgs > Def->param_size()) << FDecl << Fn->getSourceRange();
Eli Friedmanbc4e29f2009-06-01 09:24:59 +00004119 }
Douglas Gregor46542412010-10-25 20:39:23 +00004120
4121 // If the function we're calling isn't a function prototype, but we have
4122 // a function prototype from a prior declaratiom, use that prototype.
4123 if (!FDecl->hasPrototype())
4124 Proto = FDecl->getType()->getAs<FunctionProtoType>();
Douglas Gregor74734d52009-04-02 15:37:10 +00004125 }
4126
Steve Naroffb291ab62007-08-28 23:30:39 +00004127 // Promote the arguments (C99 6.5.2.2p6).
Chris Lattner925e60d2007-12-28 05:29:59 +00004128 for (unsigned i = 0; i != NumArgs; i++) {
4129 Expr *Arg = Args[i];
Douglas Gregor46542412010-10-25 20:39:23 +00004130
4131 if (Proto && i < Proto->getNumArgs()) {
Douglas Gregor46542412010-10-25 20:39:23 +00004132 InitializedEntity Entity
4133 = InitializedEntity::InitializeParameter(Context,
4134 Proto->getArgType(i));
4135 ExprResult ArgE = PerformCopyInitialization(Entity,
4136 SourceLocation(),
4137 Owned(Arg));
4138 if (ArgE.isInvalid())
4139 return true;
4140
4141 Arg = ArgE.takeAs<Expr>();
4142
4143 } else {
4144 DefaultArgumentPromotion(Arg);
Douglas Gregor46542412010-10-25 20:39:23 +00004145 }
4146
Douglas Gregor0700bbf2010-10-26 05:45:40 +00004147 if (RequireCompleteType(Arg->getSourceRange().getBegin(),
4148 Arg->getType(),
4149 PDiag(diag::err_call_incomplete_argument)
4150 << Arg->getSourceRange()))
4151 return ExprError();
4152
Chris Lattner925e60d2007-12-28 05:29:59 +00004153 TheCall->setArg(i, Arg);
Steve Naroffb291ab62007-08-28 23:30:39 +00004154 }
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00004155 }
Chris Lattner925e60d2007-12-28 05:29:59 +00004156
Douglas Gregor88a35142008-12-22 05:46:06 +00004157 if (CXXMethodDecl *Method = dyn_cast_or_null<CXXMethodDecl>(FDecl))
4158 if (!Method->isStatic())
Sebastian Redl0eb23302009-01-19 00:08:26 +00004159 return ExprError(Diag(LParenLoc, diag::err_member_call_without_object)
4160 << Fn->getSourceRange());
Douglas Gregor88a35142008-12-22 05:46:06 +00004161
Fariborz Jahaniandaf04152009-05-15 20:33:25 +00004162 // Check for sentinels
4163 if (NDecl)
4164 DiagnoseSentinelCalls(NDecl, LParenLoc, Args, NumArgs);
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004165
Chris Lattner59907c42007-08-10 20:18:51 +00004166 // Do special checking on direct calls to functions.
Anders Carlssond406bf02009-08-16 01:56:34 +00004167 if (FDecl) {
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00004168 if (CheckFunctionCall(FDecl, TheCall))
Anders Carlssond406bf02009-08-16 01:56:34 +00004169 return ExprError();
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004170
Douglas Gregor7814e6d2009-09-12 00:22:50 +00004171 if (unsigned BuiltinID = FDecl->getBuiltinID())
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00004172 return CheckBuiltinFunctionCall(BuiltinID, TheCall);
Anders Carlssond406bf02009-08-16 01:56:34 +00004173 } else if (NDecl) {
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00004174 if (CheckBlockCall(NDecl, TheCall))
Anders Carlssond406bf02009-08-16 01:56:34 +00004175 return ExprError();
4176 }
Chris Lattner59907c42007-08-10 20:18:51 +00004177
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00004178 return MaybeBindToTemporary(TheCall);
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00004179}
4180
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00004181ExprResult
John McCallb3d87482010-08-24 05:47:05 +00004182Sema::ActOnCompoundLiteral(SourceLocation LParenLoc, ParsedType Ty,
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00004183 SourceLocation RParenLoc, Expr *InitExpr) {
Steve Narofff69936d2007-09-16 03:34:24 +00004184 assert((Ty != 0) && "ActOnCompoundLiteral(): missing type");
Steve Naroffaff1edd2007-07-19 21:32:11 +00004185 // FIXME: put back this assert when initializers are worked out.
Steve Narofff69936d2007-09-16 03:34:24 +00004186 //assert((InitExpr != 0) && "ActOnCompoundLiteral(): missing expression");
John McCall42f56b52010-01-18 19:35:47 +00004187
4188 TypeSourceInfo *TInfo;
4189 QualType literalType = GetTypeFromParser(Ty, &TInfo);
4190 if (!TInfo)
4191 TInfo = Context.getTrivialTypeSourceInfo(literalType);
4192
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00004193 return BuildCompoundLiteralExpr(LParenLoc, TInfo, RParenLoc, InitExpr);
John McCall42f56b52010-01-18 19:35:47 +00004194}
4195
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00004196ExprResult
John McCall42f56b52010-01-18 19:35:47 +00004197Sema::BuildCompoundLiteralExpr(SourceLocation LParenLoc, TypeSourceInfo *TInfo,
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00004198 SourceLocation RParenLoc, Expr *literalExpr) {
John McCall42f56b52010-01-18 19:35:47 +00004199 QualType literalType = TInfo->getType();
Anders Carlssond35c8322007-12-05 07:24:19 +00004200
Eli Friedman6223c222008-05-20 05:22:08 +00004201 if (literalType->isArrayType()) {
Argyrios Kyrtzidise6fe9a22010-11-08 19:14:19 +00004202 if (RequireCompleteType(LParenLoc, Context.getBaseElementType(literalType),
4203 PDiag(diag::err_illegal_decl_array_incomplete_type)
4204 << SourceRange(LParenLoc,
4205 literalExpr->getSourceRange().getEnd())))
4206 return ExprError();
Chris Lattnerc63a1f22008-08-04 07:31:14 +00004207 if (literalType->isVariableArrayType())
Sebastian Redlb8a6aca2009-01-19 22:31:54 +00004208 return ExprError(Diag(LParenLoc, diag::err_variable_object_no_init)
4209 << SourceRange(LParenLoc, literalExpr->getSourceRange().getEnd()));
Douglas Gregor690dc7f2009-05-21 23:48:18 +00004210 } else if (!literalType->isDependentType() &&
4211 RequireCompleteType(LParenLoc, literalType,
Anders Carlssonb7906612009-08-26 23:45:07 +00004212 PDiag(diag::err_typecheck_decl_incomplete_type)
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004213 << SourceRange(LParenLoc,
Anders Carlssonb7906612009-08-26 23:45:07 +00004214 literalExpr->getSourceRange().getEnd())))
Sebastian Redlb8a6aca2009-01-19 22:31:54 +00004215 return ExprError();
Eli Friedman6223c222008-05-20 05:22:08 +00004216
Douglas Gregor99a2e602009-12-16 01:38:02 +00004217 InitializedEntity Entity
Douglas Gregord6542d82009-12-22 15:35:07 +00004218 = InitializedEntity::InitializeTemporary(literalType);
Douglas Gregor99a2e602009-12-16 01:38:02 +00004219 InitializationKind Kind
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004220 = InitializationKind::CreateCast(SourceRange(LParenLoc, RParenLoc),
Douglas Gregor99a2e602009-12-16 01:38:02 +00004221 /*IsCStyleCast=*/true);
Eli Friedman08544622009-12-22 02:35:53 +00004222 InitializationSequence InitSeq(*this, Entity, Kind, &literalExpr, 1);
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00004223 ExprResult Result = InitSeq.Perform(*this, Entity, Kind,
John McCallca0408f2010-08-23 06:44:23 +00004224 MultiExprArg(*this, &literalExpr, 1),
Eli Friedman08544622009-12-22 02:35:53 +00004225 &literalType);
4226 if (Result.isInvalid())
Sebastian Redlb8a6aca2009-01-19 22:31:54 +00004227 return ExprError();
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00004228 literalExpr = Result.get();
Steve Naroffe9b12192008-01-14 18:19:28 +00004229
Chris Lattner371f2582008-12-04 23:50:19 +00004230 bool isFileScope = getCurFunctionOrMethodDecl() == 0;
Steve Naroffe9b12192008-01-14 18:19:28 +00004231 if (isFileScope) { // 6.5.2.5p3
Steve Naroffd0091aa2008-01-10 22:15:12 +00004232 if (CheckForConstantInitializer(literalExpr, literalType))
Sebastian Redlb8a6aca2009-01-19 22:31:54 +00004233 return ExprError();
Steve Naroffd0091aa2008-01-10 22:15:12 +00004234 }
Eli Friedman08544622009-12-22 02:35:53 +00004235
John McCall1d7d8d62010-01-19 22:33:45 +00004236 return Owned(new (Context) CompoundLiteralExpr(LParenLoc, TInfo, literalType,
Steve Naroff6ece14c2009-01-21 00:14:39 +00004237 literalExpr, isFileScope));
Steve Naroff4aa88f82007-07-19 01:06:55 +00004238}
4239
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00004240ExprResult
Sebastian Redlb8a6aca2009-01-19 22:31:54 +00004241Sema::ActOnInitList(SourceLocation LBraceLoc, MultiExprArg initlist,
Sebastian Redlb8a6aca2009-01-19 22:31:54 +00004242 SourceLocation RBraceLoc) {
4243 unsigned NumInit = initlist.size();
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00004244 Expr **InitList = initlist.release();
Anders Carlsson66b5a8a2007-08-31 04:56:16 +00004245
Steve Naroff08d92e42007-09-15 18:49:24 +00004246 // Semantic analysis for initializers is done by ActOnDeclarator() and
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004247 // CheckInitializer() - it requires knowledge of the object being intialized.
Sebastian Redlb8a6aca2009-01-19 22:31:54 +00004248
Ted Kremenek709210f2010-04-13 23:39:13 +00004249 InitListExpr *E = new (Context) InitListExpr(Context, LBraceLoc, InitList,
4250 NumInit, RBraceLoc);
Chris Lattnerf0467b32008-04-02 04:24:33 +00004251 E->setType(Context.VoidTy); // FIXME: just a place holder for now.
Sebastian Redlb8a6aca2009-01-19 22:31:54 +00004252 return Owned(E);
Steve Naroff4aa88f82007-07-19 01:06:55 +00004253}
4254
John McCallf3ea8cf2010-11-14 08:17:51 +00004255enum ScalarKind {
4256 SK_Pointer,
4257 SK_Bool,
4258 SK_Integral,
4259 SK_Floating,
4260 SK_IntegralComplex,
4261 SK_FloatingComplex
4262};
4263static ScalarKind ClassifyScalarType(QualType QT) {
4264 assert(QT->isScalarType());
4265
4266 const Type *T = QT->getCanonicalTypeUnqualified().getTypePtr();
4267 if (T->hasPointerRepresentation())
4268 return SK_Pointer;
4269 if (T->isBooleanType())
4270 return SK_Bool;
4271 if (T->isRealFloatingType())
4272 return SK_Floating;
4273 if (const ComplexType *CT = dyn_cast<ComplexType>(T)) {
4274 if (CT->getElementType()->isRealFloatingType())
4275 return SK_FloatingComplex;
4276 return SK_IntegralComplex;
4277 }
4278 assert(T->isIntegerType());
4279 return SK_Integral;
4280}
4281
4282/// Prepares for a scalar cast, performing all the necessary stages
4283/// except the final cast and returning the kind required.
4284static CastKind PrepareScalarCast(Sema &S, Expr *&Src, QualType DestTy) {
4285 // Both Src and Dest are scalar types, i.e. arithmetic or pointer.
4286 // Also, callers should have filtered out the invalid cases with
4287 // pointers. Everything else should be possible.
4288
John McCall404cd162010-11-13 01:35:44 +00004289 QualType SrcTy = Src->getType();
John McCallf3ea8cf2010-11-14 08:17:51 +00004290 if (S.Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(SrcTy, DestTy))
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004291 return CK_NoOp;
Anders Carlsson82debc72009-10-18 18:12:03 +00004292
John McCallf3ea8cf2010-11-14 08:17:51 +00004293 switch (ClassifyScalarType(SrcTy)) {
4294 case SK_Pointer:
Anders Carlsson82debc72009-10-18 18:12:03 +00004295 if (DestTy->isIntegerType())
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004296 return CK_PointerToIntegral;
John McCallf3ea8cf2010-11-14 08:17:51 +00004297 assert(DestTy->hasPointerRepresentation());
4298 return DestTy->isObjCObjectPointerType() ?
4299 CK_AnyPointerToObjCPointerCast :
4300 CK_BitCast;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004301
John McCallf3ea8cf2010-11-14 08:17:51 +00004302 case SK_Bool: // casting from bool is like casting from an integer
4303 case SK_Integral:
4304 switch (ClassifyScalarType(DestTy)) {
4305 case SK_Pointer:
4306 if (Src->isNullPointerConstant(S.Context, Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNull))
John McCall404cd162010-11-13 01:35:44 +00004307 return CK_NullToPointer;
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004308 return CK_IntegralToPointer;
John McCallf3ea8cf2010-11-14 08:17:51 +00004309
4310 case SK_Bool: // TODO: there should be an int->bool cast kind
4311 case SK_Integral:
4312 return CK_IntegralCast;
4313 case SK_Floating:
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004314 return CK_IntegralToFloating;
John McCallf3ea8cf2010-11-14 08:17:51 +00004315 case SK_IntegralComplex:
4316 return CK_IntegralRealToComplex;
4317 case SK_FloatingComplex:
4318 S.ImpCastExprToType(Src, cast<ComplexType>(DestTy)->getElementType(),
4319 CK_IntegralToFloating);
4320 return CK_FloatingRealToComplex;
4321 }
4322 break;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004323
John McCallf3ea8cf2010-11-14 08:17:51 +00004324 case SK_Floating:
4325 switch (ClassifyScalarType(DestTy)) {
4326 case SK_Floating:
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004327 return CK_FloatingCast;
John McCallf3ea8cf2010-11-14 08:17:51 +00004328 case SK_Bool: // TODO: there should be a float->bool cast kind
4329 case SK_Integral:
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004330 return CK_FloatingToIntegral;
John McCallf3ea8cf2010-11-14 08:17:51 +00004331 case SK_FloatingComplex:
4332 return CK_FloatingRealToComplex;
4333 case SK_IntegralComplex:
4334 S.ImpCastExprToType(Src, cast<ComplexType>(DestTy)->getElementType(),
4335 CK_FloatingToIntegral);
4336 return CK_IntegralRealToComplex;
4337 case SK_Pointer: llvm_unreachable("valid float->pointer cast?");
4338 }
4339 break;
4340
4341 case SK_FloatingComplex:
4342 switch (ClassifyScalarType(DestTy)) {
4343 case SK_FloatingComplex:
4344 return CK_FloatingComplexCast;
4345 case SK_IntegralComplex:
4346 return CK_FloatingComplexToIntegralComplex;
4347 case SK_Floating:
4348 return CK_FloatingComplexToReal;
4349 case SK_Bool:
4350 return CK_FloatingComplexToBoolean;
4351 case SK_Integral:
4352 S.ImpCastExprToType(Src, cast<ComplexType>(SrcTy)->getElementType(),
4353 CK_FloatingComplexToReal);
4354 return CK_FloatingToIntegral;
4355 case SK_Pointer: llvm_unreachable("valid complex float->pointer cast?");
4356 }
4357 break;
4358
4359 case SK_IntegralComplex:
4360 switch (ClassifyScalarType(DestTy)) {
4361 case SK_FloatingComplex:
4362 return CK_IntegralComplexToFloatingComplex;
4363 case SK_IntegralComplex:
4364 return CK_IntegralComplexCast;
4365 case SK_Integral:
4366 return CK_IntegralComplexToReal;
4367 case SK_Bool:
4368 return CK_IntegralComplexToBoolean;
4369 case SK_Floating:
4370 S.ImpCastExprToType(Src, cast<ComplexType>(SrcTy)->getElementType(),
4371 CK_IntegralComplexToReal);
4372 return CK_IntegralToFloating;
4373 case SK_Pointer: llvm_unreachable("valid complex int->pointer cast?");
4374 }
4375 break;
Anders Carlsson82debc72009-10-18 18:12:03 +00004376 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004377
John McCallf3ea8cf2010-11-14 08:17:51 +00004378 llvm_unreachable("Unhandled scalar cast");
4379 return CK_BitCast;
Anders Carlsson82debc72009-10-18 18:12:03 +00004380}
4381
Argyrios Kyrtzidis6c2dc4d2008-08-16 20:27:34 +00004382/// CheckCastTypes - Check type constraints for casting between types.
Sebastian Redlef0cb8e2009-07-29 13:50:23 +00004383bool Sema::CheckCastTypes(SourceRange TyR, QualType castType, Expr *&castExpr,
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004384 CastKind& Kind,
John McCallf871d0c2010-08-07 06:22:56 +00004385 CXXCastPath &BasePath,
Fariborz Jahaniane9f42082009-08-26 18:55:36 +00004386 bool FunctionalStyle) {
Sebastian Redl9cc11e72009-07-25 15:41:38 +00004387 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus)
Douglas Gregor40749ee2010-11-03 00:35:38 +00004388 return CXXCheckCStyleCast(SourceRange(TyR.getBegin(),
4389 castExpr->getLocEnd()),
4390 castType, castExpr, Kind, BasePath,
Anders Carlsson5cf86ba2010-04-24 19:06:50 +00004391 FunctionalStyle);
Sebastian Redl9cc11e72009-07-25 15:41:38 +00004392
Douglas Gregora873dfc2010-02-03 00:27:59 +00004393 DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion(castExpr);
Argyrios Kyrtzidis6c2dc4d2008-08-16 20:27:34 +00004394
4395 // C99 6.5.4p2: the cast type needs to be void or scalar and the expression
4396 // type needs to be scalar.
4397 if (castType->isVoidType()) {
4398 // Cast to void allows any expr type.
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004399 Kind = CK_ToVoid;
Anders Carlssonebeaf202009-10-16 02:35:04 +00004400 return false;
4401 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004402
Eli Friedman8d438082010-07-17 20:43:49 +00004403 if (RequireCompleteType(TyR.getBegin(), castType,
4404 diag::err_typecheck_cast_to_incomplete))
4405 return true;
4406
Anders Carlssonebeaf202009-10-16 02:35:04 +00004407 if (!castType->isScalarType() && !castType->isVectorType()) {
Douglas Gregora4923eb2009-11-16 21:35:15 +00004408 if (Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(castType, castExpr->getType()) &&
Seo Sanghyeoneff2cd52009-01-15 04:51:39 +00004409 (castType->isStructureType() || castType->isUnionType())) {
4410 // GCC struct/union extension: allow cast to self.
Eli Friedmanb1d796d2009-03-23 00:24:07 +00004411 // FIXME: Check that the cast destination type is complete.
Seo Sanghyeoneff2cd52009-01-15 04:51:39 +00004412 Diag(TyR.getBegin(), diag::ext_typecheck_cast_nonscalar)
4413 << castType << castExpr->getSourceRange();
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004414 Kind = CK_NoOp;
Anders Carlssonc3516322009-10-16 02:48:28 +00004415 return false;
4416 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004417
Anders Carlssonc3516322009-10-16 02:48:28 +00004418 if (castType->isUnionType()) {
Seo Sanghyeoneff2cd52009-01-15 04:51:39 +00004419 // GCC cast to union extension
Ted Kremenek6217b802009-07-29 21:53:49 +00004420 RecordDecl *RD = castType->getAs<RecordType>()->getDecl();
Seo Sanghyeoneff2cd52009-01-15 04:51:39 +00004421 RecordDecl::field_iterator Field, FieldEnd;
Argyrios Kyrtzidis17945a02009-06-30 02:36:12 +00004422 for (Field = RD->field_begin(), FieldEnd = RD->field_end();
Seo Sanghyeoneff2cd52009-01-15 04:51:39 +00004423 Field != FieldEnd; ++Field) {
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004424 if (Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(Field->getType(),
Abramo Bagnara8c4bfe52010-10-07 21:20:44 +00004425 castExpr->getType()) &&
4426 !Field->isUnnamedBitfield()) {
Seo Sanghyeoneff2cd52009-01-15 04:51:39 +00004427 Diag(TyR.getBegin(), diag::ext_typecheck_cast_to_union)
4428 << castExpr->getSourceRange();
4429 break;
4430 }
4431 }
4432 if (Field == FieldEnd)
4433 return Diag(TyR.getBegin(), diag::err_typecheck_cast_to_union_no_type)
4434 << castExpr->getType() << castExpr->getSourceRange();
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004435 Kind = CK_ToUnion;
Anders Carlssonc3516322009-10-16 02:48:28 +00004436 return false;
Argyrios Kyrtzidis6c2dc4d2008-08-16 20:27:34 +00004437 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004438
Anders Carlssonc3516322009-10-16 02:48:28 +00004439 // Reject any other conversions to non-scalar types.
4440 return Diag(TyR.getBegin(), diag::err_typecheck_cond_expect_scalar)
4441 << castType << castExpr->getSourceRange();
4442 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004443
John McCallf3ea8cf2010-11-14 08:17:51 +00004444 // The type we're casting to is known to be a scalar or vector.
4445
4446 // Require the operand to be a scalar or vector.
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004447 if (!castExpr->getType()->isScalarType() &&
Anders Carlssonc3516322009-10-16 02:48:28 +00004448 !castExpr->getType()->isVectorType()) {
Chris Lattnerfa25bbb2008-11-19 05:08:23 +00004449 return Diag(castExpr->getLocStart(),
4450 diag::err_typecheck_expect_scalar_operand)
Chris Lattnerd1625842008-11-24 06:25:27 +00004451 << castExpr->getType() << castExpr->getSourceRange();
Anders Carlssonc3516322009-10-16 02:48:28 +00004452 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004453
4454 if (castType->isExtVectorType())
Anders Carlsson16a89042009-10-16 05:23:41 +00004455 return CheckExtVectorCast(TyR, castType, castExpr, Kind);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004456
Anders Carlssonc3516322009-10-16 02:48:28 +00004457 if (castType->isVectorType())
4458 return CheckVectorCast(TyR, castType, castExpr->getType(), Kind);
4459 if (castExpr->getType()->isVectorType())
4460 return CheckVectorCast(TyR, castExpr->getType(), castType, Kind);
4461
John McCallf3ea8cf2010-11-14 08:17:51 +00004462 // The source and target types are both scalars, i.e.
4463 // - arithmetic types (fundamental, enum, and complex)
4464 // - all kinds of pointers
4465 // Note that member pointers were filtered out with C++, above.
4466
Anders Carlsson16a89042009-10-16 05:23:41 +00004467 if (isa<ObjCSelectorExpr>(castExpr))
4468 return Diag(castExpr->getLocStart(), diag::err_cast_selector_expr);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004469
John McCallf3ea8cf2010-11-14 08:17:51 +00004470 // If either type is a pointer, the other type has to be either an
4471 // integer or a pointer.
Anders Carlssonc3516322009-10-16 02:48:28 +00004472 if (!castType->isArithmeticType()) {
Eli Friedman41826bb2009-05-01 02:23:58 +00004473 QualType castExprType = castExpr->getType();
Douglas Gregor9d3347a2010-06-16 00:35:25 +00004474 if (!castExprType->isIntegralType(Context) &&
Douglas Gregor2ade35e2010-06-16 00:17:44 +00004475 castExprType->isArithmeticType())
Eli Friedman41826bb2009-05-01 02:23:58 +00004476 return Diag(castExpr->getLocStart(),
4477 diag::err_cast_pointer_from_non_pointer_int)
4478 << castExprType << castExpr->getSourceRange();
4479 } else if (!castExpr->getType()->isArithmeticType()) {
Douglas Gregor9d3347a2010-06-16 00:35:25 +00004480 if (!castType->isIntegralType(Context) && castType->isArithmeticType())
Eli Friedman41826bb2009-05-01 02:23:58 +00004481 return Diag(castExpr->getLocStart(),
4482 diag::err_cast_pointer_to_non_pointer_int)
4483 << castType << castExpr->getSourceRange();
Argyrios Kyrtzidis6c2dc4d2008-08-16 20:27:34 +00004484 }
Anders Carlsson82debc72009-10-18 18:12:03 +00004485
John McCallf3ea8cf2010-11-14 08:17:51 +00004486 Kind = PrepareScalarCast(*this, castExpr, castType);
John McCallb7f4ffe2010-08-12 21:44:57 +00004487
John McCallf3ea8cf2010-11-14 08:17:51 +00004488 if (Kind == CK_BitCast)
John McCallb7f4ffe2010-08-12 21:44:57 +00004489 CheckCastAlign(castExpr, castType, TyR);
4490
Argyrios Kyrtzidis6c2dc4d2008-08-16 20:27:34 +00004491 return false;
4492}
4493
Anders Carlssonc3516322009-10-16 02:48:28 +00004494bool Sema::CheckVectorCast(SourceRange R, QualType VectorTy, QualType Ty,
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004495 CastKind &Kind) {
Anders Carlssona64db8f2007-11-27 05:51:55 +00004496 assert(VectorTy->isVectorType() && "Not a vector type!");
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004497
Anders Carlssona64db8f2007-11-27 05:51:55 +00004498 if (Ty->isVectorType() || Ty->isIntegerType()) {
Chris Lattner98be4942008-03-05 18:54:05 +00004499 if (Context.getTypeSize(VectorTy) != Context.getTypeSize(Ty))
Anders Carlssona64db8f2007-11-27 05:51:55 +00004500 return Diag(R.getBegin(),
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004501 Ty->isVectorType() ?
Anders Carlssona64db8f2007-11-27 05:51:55 +00004502 diag::err_invalid_conversion_between_vectors :
Chris Lattnerfa25bbb2008-11-19 05:08:23 +00004503 diag::err_invalid_conversion_between_vector_and_integer)
Chris Lattnerd1625842008-11-24 06:25:27 +00004504 << VectorTy << Ty << R;
Anders Carlssona64db8f2007-11-27 05:51:55 +00004505 } else
4506 return Diag(R.getBegin(),
Chris Lattnerfa25bbb2008-11-19 05:08:23 +00004507 diag::err_invalid_conversion_between_vector_and_scalar)
Chris Lattnerd1625842008-11-24 06:25:27 +00004508 << VectorTy << Ty << R;
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004509
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004510 Kind = CK_BitCast;
Anders Carlssona64db8f2007-11-27 05:51:55 +00004511 return false;
4512}
4513
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004514bool Sema::CheckExtVectorCast(SourceRange R, QualType DestTy, Expr *&CastExpr,
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004515 CastKind &Kind) {
Nate Begeman58d29a42009-06-26 00:50:28 +00004516 assert(DestTy->isExtVectorType() && "Not an extended vector type!");
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004517
Anders Carlsson16a89042009-10-16 05:23:41 +00004518 QualType SrcTy = CastExpr->getType();
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004519
Nate Begeman9b10da62009-06-27 22:05:55 +00004520 // If SrcTy is a VectorType, the total size must match to explicitly cast to
4521 // an ExtVectorType.
Nate Begeman58d29a42009-06-26 00:50:28 +00004522 if (SrcTy->isVectorType()) {
4523 if (Context.getTypeSize(DestTy) != Context.getTypeSize(SrcTy))
4524 return Diag(R.getBegin(),diag::err_invalid_conversion_between_ext_vectors)
4525 << DestTy << SrcTy << R;
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004526 Kind = CK_BitCast;
Nate Begeman58d29a42009-06-26 00:50:28 +00004527 return false;
4528 }
4529
Nate Begeman1bd1f6e2009-06-28 02:36:38 +00004530 // All non-pointer scalars can be cast to ExtVector type. The appropriate
Nate Begeman58d29a42009-06-26 00:50:28 +00004531 // conversion will take place first from scalar to elt type, and then
4532 // splat from elt type to vector.
Nate Begeman1bd1f6e2009-06-28 02:36:38 +00004533 if (SrcTy->isPointerType())
4534 return Diag(R.getBegin(),
4535 diag::err_invalid_conversion_between_vector_and_scalar)
4536 << DestTy << SrcTy << R;
Eli Friedman73c39ab2009-10-20 08:27:19 +00004537
4538 QualType DestElemTy = DestTy->getAs<ExtVectorType>()->getElementType();
4539 ImpCastExprToType(CastExpr, DestElemTy,
John McCallf3ea8cf2010-11-14 08:17:51 +00004540 PrepareScalarCast(*this, CastExpr, DestElemTy));
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004541
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004542 Kind = CK_VectorSplat;
Nate Begeman58d29a42009-06-26 00:50:28 +00004543 return false;
4544}
4545
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00004546ExprResult
John McCallb3d87482010-08-24 05:47:05 +00004547Sema::ActOnCastExpr(Scope *S, SourceLocation LParenLoc, ParsedType Ty,
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00004548 SourceLocation RParenLoc, Expr *castExpr) {
4549 assert((Ty != 0) && (castExpr != 0) &&
Sebastian Redlb8a6aca2009-01-19 22:31:54 +00004550 "ActOnCastExpr(): missing type or expr");
Steve Naroff16beff82007-07-16 23:25:18 +00004551
John McCall9d125032010-01-15 18:39:57 +00004552 TypeSourceInfo *castTInfo;
4553 QualType castType = GetTypeFromParser(Ty, &castTInfo);
4554 if (!castTInfo)
John McCall42f56b52010-01-18 19:35:47 +00004555 castTInfo = Context.getTrivialTypeSourceInfo(castType);
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004556
Nate Begeman2ef13e52009-08-10 23:49:36 +00004557 // If the Expr being casted is a ParenListExpr, handle it specially.
4558 if (isa<ParenListExpr>(castExpr))
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00004559 return ActOnCastOfParenListExpr(S, LParenLoc, RParenLoc, castExpr,
John McCall42f56b52010-01-18 19:35:47 +00004560 castTInfo);
John McCallb042fdf2010-01-15 18:56:44 +00004561
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00004562 return BuildCStyleCastExpr(LParenLoc, castTInfo, RParenLoc, castExpr);
John McCallb042fdf2010-01-15 18:56:44 +00004563}
4564
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00004565ExprResult
John McCallb042fdf2010-01-15 18:56:44 +00004566Sema::BuildCStyleCastExpr(SourceLocation LParenLoc, TypeSourceInfo *Ty,
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00004567 SourceLocation RParenLoc, Expr *castExpr) {
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004568 CastKind Kind = CK_Unknown;
John McCallf871d0c2010-08-07 06:22:56 +00004569 CXXCastPath BasePath;
John McCallb042fdf2010-01-15 18:56:44 +00004570 if (CheckCastTypes(SourceRange(LParenLoc, RParenLoc), Ty->getType(), castExpr,
Anders Carlsson5cf86ba2010-04-24 19:06:50 +00004571 Kind, BasePath))
Sebastian Redlb8a6aca2009-01-19 22:31:54 +00004572 return ExprError();
Anders Carlsson0aebc812009-09-09 21:33:21 +00004573
John McCallf871d0c2010-08-07 06:22:56 +00004574 return Owned(CStyleCastExpr::Create(Context,
Douglas Gregor63982352010-07-13 18:40:04 +00004575 Ty->getType().getNonLValueExprType(Context),
John McCallf871d0c2010-08-07 06:22:56 +00004576 Kind, castExpr, &BasePath, Ty,
4577 LParenLoc, RParenLoc));
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00004578}
4579
Nate Begeman2ef13e52009-08-10 23:49:36 +00004580/// This is not an AltiVec-style cast, so turn the ParenListExpr into a sequence
4581/// of comma binary operators.
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00004582ExprResult
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00004583Sema::MaybeConvertParenListExprToParenExpr(Scope *S, Expr *expr) {
Nate Begeman2ef13e52009-08-10 23:49:36 +00004584 ParenListExpr *E = dyn_cast<ParenListExpr>(expr);
4585 if (!E)
4586 return Owned(expr);
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004587
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00004588 ExprResult Result(E->getExpr(0));
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004589
Nate Begeman2ef13e52009-08-10 23:49:36 +00004590 for (unsigned i = 1, e = E->getNumExprs(); i != e && !Result.isInvalid(); ++i)
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00004591 Result = ActOnBinOp(S, E->getExprLoc(), tok::comma, Result.get(),
4592 E->getExpr(i));
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004593
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00004594 if (Result.isInvalid()) return ExprError();
4595
4596 return ActOnParenExpr(E->getLParenLoc(), E->getRParenLoc(), Result.get());
Nate Begeman2ef13e52009-08-10 23:49:36 +00004597}
4598
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00004599ExprResult
Nate Begeman2ef13e52009-08-10 23:49:36 +00004600Sema::ActOnCastOfParenListExpr(Scope *S, SourceLocation LParenLoc,
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00004601 SourceLocation RParenLoc, Expr *Op,
John McCall42f56b52010-01-18 19:35:47 +00004602 TypeSourceInfo *TInfo) {
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00004603 ParenListExpr *PE = cast<ParenListExpr>(Op);
John McCall42f56b52010-01-18 19:35:47 +00004604 QualType Ty = TInfo->getType();
John Thompson8bb59a82010-06-30 22:55:51 +00004605 bool isAltiVecLiteral = false;
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004606
John Thompson8bb59a82010-06-30 22:55:51 +00004607 // Check for an altivec literal,
4608 // i.e. all the elements are integer constants.
Nate Begeman2ef13e52009-08-10 23:49:36 +00004609 if (getLangOptions().AltiVec && Ty->isVectorType()) {
4610 if (PE->getNumExprs() == 0) {
4611 Diag(PE->getExprLoc(), diag::err_altivec_empty_initializer);
4612 return ExprError();
4613 }
John Thompson8bb59a82010-06-30 22:55:51 +00004614 if (PE->getNumExprs() == 1) {
4615 if (!PE->getExpr(0)->getType()->isVectorType())
4616 isAltiVecLiteral = true;
4617 }
4618 else
4619 isAltiVecLiteral = true;
4620 }
Nate Begeman2ef13e52009-08-10 23:49:36 +00004621
John Thompson8bb59a82010-06-30 22:55:51 +00004622 // If this is an altivec initializer, '(' type ')' '(' init, ..., init ')'
4623 // then handle it as such.
4624 if (isAltiVecLiteral) {
Nate Begeman2ef13e52009-08-10 23:49:36 +00004625 llvm::SmallVector<Expr *, 8> initExprs;
4626 for (unsigned i = 0, e = PE->getNumExprs(); i != e; ++i)
4627 initExprs.push_back(PE->getExpr(i));
4628
4629 // FIXME: This means that pretty-printing the final AST will produce curly
4630 // braces instead of the original commas.
Ted Kremenek709210f2010-04-13 23:39:13 +00004631 InitListExpr *E = new (Context) InitListExpr(Context, LParenLoc,
4632 &initExprs[0],
Nate Begeman2ef13e52009-08-10 23:49:36 +00004633 initExprs.size(), RParenLoc);
4634 E->setType(Ty);
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00004635 return BuildCompoundLiteralExpr(LParenLoc, TInfo, RParenLoc, E);
Nate Begeman2ef13e52009-08-10 23:49:36 +00004636 } else {
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004637 // This is not an AltiVec-style cast, so turn the ParenListExpr into a
Nate Begeman2ef13e52009-08-10 23:49:36 +00004638 // sequence of BinOp comma operators.
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00004639 ExprResult Result = MaybeConvertParenListExprToParenExpr(S, Op);
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00004640 if (Result.isInvalid()) return ExprError();
4641 return BuildCStyleCastExpr(LParenLoc, TInfo, RParenLoc, Result.take());
Nate Begeman2ef13e52009-08-10 23:49:36 +00004642 }
4643}
4644
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00004645ExprResult Sema::ActOnParenOrParenListExpr(SourceLocation L,
Nate Begeman2ef13e52009-08-10 23:49:36 +00004646 SourceLocation R,
Fariborz Jahanianf88f7ab2009-11-25 01:26:41 +00004647 MultiExprArg Val,
John McCallb3d87482010-08-24 05:47:05 +00004648 ParsedType TypeOfCast) {
Nate Begeman2ef13e52009-08-10 23:49:36 +00004649 unsigned nexprs = Val.size();
4650 Expr **exprs = reinterpret_cast<Expr**>(Val.release());
Fariborz Jahanianf88f7ab2009-11-25 01:26:41 +00004651 assert((exprs != 0) && "ActOnParenOrParenListExpr() missing expr list");
4652 Expr *expr;
4653 if (nexprs == 1 && TypeOfCast && !TypeIsVectorType(TypeOfCast))
4654 expr = new (Context) ParenExpr(L, R, exprs[0]);
4655 else
4656 expr = new (Context) ParenListExpr(Context, L, exprs, nexprs, R);
Nate Begeman2ef13e52009-08-10 23:49:36 +00004657 return Owned(expr);
4658}
4659
Sebastian Redl28507842009-02-26 14:39:58 +00004660/// Note that lhs is not null here, even if this is the gnu "x ?: y" extension.
4661/// In that case, lhs = cond.
Chris Lattnera119a3b2009-02-18 04:38:20 +00004662/// C99 6.5.15
4663QualType Sema::CheckConditionalOperands(Expr *&Cond, Expr *&LHS, Expr *&RHS,
Fariborz Jahanian1fb019b2010-09-18 19:38:38 +00004664 Expr *&SAVE,
Chris Lattnera119a3b2009-02-18 04:38:20 +00004665 SourceLocation QuestionLoc) {
Douglas Gregor7ad5d422010-11-09 21:07:58 +00004666 // If both LHS and RHS are overloaded functions, try to resolve them.
4667 if (Context.hasSameType(LHS->getType(), RHS->getType()) &&
4668 LHS->getType()->isSpecificBuiltinType(BuiltinType::Overload)) {
4669 ExprResult LHSResult = CheckPlaceholderExpr(LHS, QuestionLoc);
4670 if (LHSResult.isInvalid())
4671 return QualType();
4672
4673 ExprResult RHSResult = CheckPlaceholderExpr(RHS, QuestionLoc);
4674 if (RHSResult.isInvalid())
4675 return QualType();
4676
4677 LHS = LHSResult.take();
4678 RHS = RHSResult.take();
4679 }
4680
Sebastian Redl3201f6b2009-04-16 17:51:27 +00004681 // C++ is sufficiently different to merit its own checker.
4682 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus)
Fariborz Jahanian1fb019b2010-09-18 19:38:38 +00004683 return CXXCheckConditionalOperands(Cond, LHS, RHS, SAVE, QuestionLoc);
Sebastian Redl3201f6b2009-04-16 17:51:27 +00004684
Chris Lattnerefdc39d2009-02-18 04:28:32 +00004685 UsualUnaryConversions(Cond);
Fariborz Jahanian1fb019b2010-09-18 19:38:38 +00004686 if (SAVE) {
4687 SAVE = LHS = Cond;
4688 }
4689 else
4690 UsualUnaryConversions(LHS);
Chris Lattnerefdc39d2009-02-18 04:28:32 +00004691 UsualUnaryConversions(RHS);
4692 QualType CondTy = Cond->getType();
4693 QualType LHSTy = LHS->getType();
4694 QualType RHSTy = RHS->getType();
Steve Naroffc80b4ee2007-07-16 21:54:35 +00004695
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00004696 // first, check the condition.
Sebastian Redl3201f6b2009-04-16 17:51:27 +00004697 if (!CondTy->isScalarType()) { // C99 6.5.15p2
Nate Begeman6155d732010-09-20 22:41:17 +00004698 // OpenCL: Sec 6.3.i says the condition is allowed to be a vector or scalar.
4699 // Throw an error if its not either.
4700 if (getLangOptions().OpenCL) {
4701 if (!CondTy->isVectorType()) {
4702 Diag(Cond->getLocStart(),
4703 diag::err_typecheck_cond_expect_scalar_or_vector)
4704 << CondTy;
4705 return QualType();
4706 }
4707 }
4708 else {
4709 Diag(Cond->getLocStart(), diag::err_typecheck_cond_expect_scalar)
4710 << CondTy;
4711 return QualType();
4712 }
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00004713 }
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004714
Chris Lattner70d67a92008-01-06 22:42:25 +00004715 // Now check the two expressions.
Nate Begeman2ef13e52009-08-10 23:49:36 +00004716 if (LHSTy->isVectorType() || RHSTy->isVectorType())
4717 return CheckVectorOperands(QuestionLoc, LHS, RHS);
Douglas Gregor898574e2008-12-05 23:32:09 +00004718
Nate Begeman6155d732010-09-20 22:41:17 +00004719 // OpenCL: If the condition is a vector, and both operands are scalar,
4720 // attempt to implicity convert them to the vector type to act like the
4721 // built in select.
4722 if (getLangOptions().OpenCL && CondTy->isVectorType()) {
4723 // Both operands should be of scalar type.
4724 if (!LHSTy->isScalarType()) {
4725 Diag(LHS->getLocStart(), diag::err_typecheck_cond_expect_scalar)
4726 << CondTy;
4727 return QualType();
4728 }
4729 if (!RHSTy->isScalarType()) {
4730 Diag(RHS->getLocStart(), diag::err_typecheck_cond_expect_scalar)
4731 << CondTy;
4732 return QualType();
4733 }
4734 // Implicity convert these scalars to the type of the condition.
4735 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, CondTy, CK_IntegralCast);
4736 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, CondTy, CK_IntegralCast);
4737 }
4738
Chris Lattner70d67a92008-01-06 22:42:25 +00004739 // If both operands have arithmetic type, do the usual arithmetic conversions
4740 // to find a common type: C99 6.5.15p3,5.
Chris Lattnerefdc39d2009-02-18 04:28:32 +00004741 if (LHSTy->isArithmeticType() && RHSTy->isArithmeticType()) {
4742 UsualArithmeticConversions(LHS, RHS);
4743 return LHS->getType();
Steve Naroffa4332e22007-07-17 00:58:39 +00004744 }
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004745
Chris Lattner70d67a92008-01-06 22:42:25 +00004746 // If both operands are the same structure or union type, the result is that
4747 // type.
Ted Kremenek6217b802009-07-29 21:53:49 +00004748 if (const RecordType *LHSRT = LHSTy->getAs<RecordType>()) { // C99 6.5.15p3
4749 if (const RecordType *RHSRT = RHSTy->getAs<RecordType>())
Chris Lattnera21ddb32007-11-26 01:40:58 +00004750 if (LHSRT->getDecl() == RHSRT->getDecl())
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004751 // "If both the operands have structure or union type, the result has
Chris Lattner70d67a92008-01-06 22:42:25 +00004752 // that type." This implies that CV qualifiers are dropped.
Chris Lattnerefdc39d2009-02-18 04:28:32 +00004753 return LHSTy.getUnqualifiedType();
Eli Friedmanb1d796d2009-03-23 00:24:07 +00004754 // FIXME: Type of conditional expression must be complete in C mode.
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00004755 }
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00004756
Chris Lattner70d67a92008-01-06 22:42:25 +00004757 // C99 6.5.15p5: "If both operands have void type, the result has void type."
Steve Naroffe701c0a2008-05-12 21:44:38 +00004758 // The following || allows only one side to be void (a GCC-ism).
Chris Lattnerefdc39d2009-02-18 04:28:32 +00004759 if (LHSTy->isVoidType() || RHSTy->isVoidType()) {
4760 if (!LHSTy->isVoidType())
4761 Diag(RHS->getLocStart(), diag::ext_typecheck_cond_one_void)
4762 << RHS->getSourceRange();
4763 if (!RHSTy->isVoidType())
4764 Diag(LHS->getLocStart(), diag::ext_typecheck_cond_one_void)
4765 << LHS->getSourceRange();
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004766 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, Context.VoidTy, CK_ToVoid);
4767 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, Context.VoidTy, CK_ToVoid);
Eli Friedman0e724012008-06-04 19:47:51 +00004768 return Context.VoidTy;
Steve Naroffe701c0a2008-05-12 21:44:38 +00004769 }
Steve Naroffb6d54e52008-01-08 01:11:38 +00004770 // C99 6.5.15p6 - "if one operand is a null pointer constant, the result has
4771 // the type of the other operand."
Steve Naroff58f9f2c2009-07-14 18:25:06 +00004772 if ((LHSTy->isAnyPointerType() || LHSTy->isBlockPointerType()) &&
Douglas Gregorce940492009-09-25 04:25:58 +00004773 RHS->isNullPointerConstant(Context, Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNull)) {
Eli Friedman73c39ab2009-10-20 08:27:19 +00004774 // promote the null to a pointer.
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004775 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, LHSTy, CK_Unknown);
Chris Lattnerefdc39d2009-02-18 04:28:32 +00004776 return LHSTy;
Steve Naroffb6d54e52008-01-08 01:11:38 +00004777 }
Steve Naroff58f9f2c2009-07-14 18:25:06 +00004778 if ((RHSTy->isAnyPointerType() || RHSTy->isBlockPointerType()) &&
Douglas Gregorce940492009-09-25 04:25:58 +00004779 LHS->isNullPointerConstant(Context, Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNull)) {
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004780 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, RHSTy, CK_Unknown);
Chris Lattnerefdc39d2009-02-18 04:28:32 +00004781 return RHSTy;
Steve Naroffb6d54e52008-01-08 01:11:38 +00004782 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004783
Fariborz Jahanianeebc4752009-12-10 19:47:41 +00004784 // All objective-c pointer type analysis is done here.
4785 QualType compositeType = FindCompositeObjCPointerType(LHS, RHS,
4786 QuestionLoc);
4787 if (!compositeType.isNull())
4788 return compositeType;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004789
4790
Steve Naroff7154a772009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004791 // Handle block pointer types.
4792 if (LHSTy->isBlockPointerType() || RHSTy->isBlockPointerType()) {
4793 if (!LHSTy->isBlockPointerType() || !RHSTy->isBlockPointerType()) {
4794 if (LHSTy->isVoidPointerType() || RHSTy->isVoidPointerType()) {
4795 QualType destType = Context.getPointerType(Context.VoidTy);
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004796 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, destType, CK_BitCast);
4797 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, destType, CK_BitCast);
Steve Naroff7154a772009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004798 return destType;
4799 }
4800 Diag(QuestionLoc, diag::err_typecheck_cond_incompatible_operands)
Fariborz Jahanianeebc4752009-12-10 19:47:41 +00004801 << LHSTy << RHSTy << LHS->getSourceRange() << RHS->getSourceRange();
Steve Naroff7154a772009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004802 return QualType();
Mike Stumpdd3e1662009-05-07 03:14:14 +00004803 }
Steve Naroff7154a772009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004804 // We have 2 block pointer types.
4805 if (Context.getCanonicalType(LHSTy) == Context.getCanonicalType(RHSTy)) {
4806 // Two identical block pointer types are always compatible.
Mike Stumpdd3e1662009-05-07 03:14:14 +00004807 return LHSTy;
4808 }
Steve Naroff7154a772009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004809 // The block pointer types aren't identical, continue checking.
Ted Kremenek6217b802009-07-29 21:53:49 +00004810 QualType lhptee = LHSTy->getAs<BlockPointerType>()->getPointeeType();
4811 QualType rhptee = RHSTy->getAs<BlockPointerType>()->getPointeeType();
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004812
Steve Naroff7154a772009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004813 if (!Context.typesAreCompatible(lhptee.getUnqualifiedType(),
4814 rhptee.getUnqualifiedType())) {
Mike Stumpdd3e1662009-05-07 03:14:14 +00004815 Diag(QuestionLoc, diag::warn_typecheck_cond_incompatible_pointers)
Fariborz Jahanianeebc4752009-12-10 19:47:41 +00004816 << LHSTy << RHSTy << LHS->getSourceRange() << RHS->getSourceRange();
Mike Stumpdd3e1662009-05-07 03:14:14 +00004817 // In this situation, we assume void* type. No especially good
4818 // reason, but this is what gcc does, and we do have to pick
4819 // to get a consistent AST.
4820 QualType incompatTy = Context.getPointerType(Context.VoidTy);
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004821 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, incompatTy, CK_BitCast);
4822 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, incompatTy, CK_BitCast);
Mike Stumpdd3e1662009-05-07 03:14:14 +00004823 return incompatTy;
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00004824 }
Steve Naroff7154a772009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004825 // The block pointer types are compatible.
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004826 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, LHSTy, CK_BitCast);
4827 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, LHSTy, CK_BitCast);
Steve Naroff91588042009-04-08 17:05:15 +00004828 return LHSTy;
4829 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004830
Steve Naroff7154a772009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004831 // Check constraints for C object pointers types (C99 6.5.15p3,6).
4832 if (LHSTy->isPointerType() && RHSTy->isPointerType()) {
4833 // get the "pointed to" types
Ted Kremenek6217b802009-07-29 21:53:49 +00004834 QualType lhptee = LHSTy->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
4835 QualType rhptee = RHSTy->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
Steve Naroff7154a772009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004836
4837 // ignore qualifiers on void (C99 6.5.15p3, clause 6)
4838 if (lhptee->isVoidType() && rhptee->isIncompleteOrObjectType()) {
4839 // Figure out necessary qualifiers (C99 6.5.15p6)
John McCall0953e762009-09-24 19:53:00 +00004840 QualType destPointee
4841 = Context.getQualifiedType(lhptee, rhptee.getQualifiers());
Steve Naroff7154a772009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004842 QualType destType = Context.getPointerType(destPointee);
Eli Friedman73c39ab2009-10-20 08:27:19 +00004843 // Add qualifiers if necessary.
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004844 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, destType, CK_NoOp);
Eli Friedman73c39ab2009-10-20 08:27:19 +00004845 // Promote to void*.
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004846 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, destType, CK_BitCast);
Steve Naroff7154a772009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004847 return destType;
4848 }
4849 if (rhptee->isVoidType() && lhptee->isIncompleteOrObjectType()) {
John McCall0953e762009-09-24 19:53:00 +00004850 QualType destPointee
4851 = Context.getQualifiedType(rhptee, lhptee.getQualifiers());
Steve Naroff7154a772009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004852 QualType destType = Context.getPointerType(destPointee);
Eli Friedman73c39ab2009-10-20 08:27:19 +00004853 // Add qualifiers if necessary.
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004854 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, destType, CK_NoOp);
Eli Friedman73c39ab2009-10-20 08:27:19 +00004855 // Promote to void*.
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004856 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, destType, CK_BitCast);
Steve Naroff7154a772009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004857 return destType;
4858 }
4859
4860 if (Context.getCanonicalType(LHSTy) == Context.getCanonicalType(RHSTy)) {
4861 // Two identical pointer types are always compatible.
4862 return LHSTy;
4863 }
4864 if (!Context.typesAreCompatible(lhptee.getUnqualifiedType(),
4865 rhptee.getUnqualifiedType())) {
4866 Diag(QuestionLoc, diag::warn_typecheck_cond_incompatible_pointers)
4867 << LHSTy << RHSTy << LHS->getSourceRange() << RHS->getSourceRange();
4868 // In this situation, we assume void* type. No especially good
4869 // reason, but this is what gcc does, and we do have to pick
4870 // to get a consistent AST.
4871 QualType incompatTy = Context.getPointerType(Context.VoidTy);
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004872 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, incompatTy, CK_BitCast);
4873 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, incompatTy, CK_BitCast);
Steve Naroff7154a772009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004874 return incompatTy;
4875 }
4876 // The pointer types are compatible.
4877 // C99 6.5.15p6: If both operands are pointers to compatible types *or* to
4878 // differently qualified versions of compatible types, the result type is
4879 // a pointer to an appropriately qualified version of the *composite*
4880 // type.
4881 // FIXME: Need to calculate the composite type.
4882 // FIXME: Need to add qualifiers
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004883 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, LHSTy, CK_BitCast);
4884 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, LHSTy, CK_BitCast);
Steve Naroff7154a772009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004885 return LHSTy;
4886 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00004887
John McCall404cd162010-11-13 01:35:44 +00004888 // GCC compatibility: soften pointer/integer mismatch. Note that
4889 // null pointers have been filtered out by this point.
Steve Naroff7154a772009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004890 if (RHSTy->isPointerType() && LHSTy->isIntegerType()) {
4891 Diag(QuestionLoc, diag::warn_typecheck_cond_pointer_integer_mismatch)
4892 << LHSTy << RHSTy << LHS->getSourceRange() << RHS->getSourceRange();
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004893 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, RHSTy, CK_IntegralToPointer);
Steve Naroff7154a772009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004894 return RHSTy;
4895 }
4896 if (LHSTy->isPointerType() && RHSTy->isIntegerType()) {
4897 Diag(QuestionLoc, diag::warn_typecheck_cond_pointer_integer_mismatch)
4898 << LHSTy << RHSTy << LHS->getSourceRange() << RHS->getSourceRange();
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004899 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, LHSTy, CK_IntegralToPointer);
Steve Naroff7154a772009-07-01 14:36:47 +00004900 return LHSTy;
4901 }
Daniel Dunbar5e155f02008-09-11 23:12:46 +00004902
Chris Lattner70d67a92008-01-06 22:42:25 +00004903 // Otherwise, the operands are not compatible.
Chris Lattnerefdc39d2009-02-18 04:28:32 +00004904 Diag(QuestionLoc, diag::err_typecheck_cond_incompatible_operands)
4905 << LHSTy << RHSTy << LHS->getSourceRange() << RHS->getSourceRange();
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00004906 return QualType();
4907}
4908
Fariborz Jahanianeebc4752009-12-10 19:47:41 +00004909/// FindCompositeObjCPointerType - Helper method to find composite type of
4910/// two objective-c pointer types of the two input expressions.
4911QualType Sema::FindCompositeObjCPointerType(Expr *&LHS, Expr *&RHS,
4912 SourceLocation QuestionLoc) {
4913 QualType LHSTy = LHS->getType();
4914 QualType RHSTy = RHS->getType();
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004915
Fariborz Jahanianeebc4752009-12-10 19:47:41 +00004916 // Handle things like Class and struct objc_class*. Here we case the result
4917 // to the pseudo-builtin, because that will be implicitly cast back to the
4918 // redefinition type if an attempt is made to access its fields.
4919 if (LHSTy->isObjCClassType() &&
4920 (RHSTy.getDesugaredType() == Context.ObjCClassRedefinitionType)) {
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004921 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, LHSTy, CK_BitCast);
Fariborz Jahanianeebc4752009-12-10 19:47:41 +00004922 return LHSTy;
4923 }
4924 if (RHSTy->isObjCClassType() &&
4925 (LHSTy.getDesugaredType() == Context.ObjCClassRedefinitionType)) {
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004926 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, RHSTy, CK_BitCast);
Fariborz Jahanianeebc4752009-12-10 19:47:41 +00004927 return RHSTy;
4928 }
4929 // And the same for struct objc_object* / id
4930 if (LHSTy->isObjCIdType() &&
4931 (RHSTy.getDesugaredType() == Context.ObjCIdRedefinitionType)) {
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004932 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, LHSTy, CK_BitCast);
Fariborz Jahanianeebc4752009-12-10 19:47:41 +00004933 return LHSTy;
4934 }
4935 if (RHSTy->isObjCIdType() &&
4936 (LHSTy.getDesugaredType() == Context.ObjCIdRedefinitionType)) {
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004937 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, RHSTy, CK_BitCast);
Fariborz Jahanianeebc4752009-12-10 19:47:41 +00004938 return RHSTy;
4939 }
4940 // And the same for struct objc_selector* / SEL
4941 if (Context.isObjCSelType(LHSTy) &&
4942 (RHSTy.getDesugaredType() == Context.ObjCSelRedefinitionType)) {
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004943 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, LHSTy, CK_BitCast);
Fariborz Jahanianeebc4752009-12-10 19:47:41 +00004944 return LHSTy;
4945 }
4946 if (Context.isObjCSelType(RHSTy) &&
4947 (LHSTy.getDesugaredType() == Context.ObjCSelRedefinitionType)) {
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004948 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, RHSTy, CK_BitCast);
Fariborz Jahanianeebc4752009-12-10 19:47:41 +00004949 return RHSTy;
4950 }
4951 // Check constraints for Objective-C object pointers types.
4952 if (LHSTy->isObjCObjectPointerType() && RHSTy->isObjCObjectPointerType()) {
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004953
Fariborz Jahanianeebc4752009-12-10 19:47:41 +00004954 if (Context.getCanonicalType(LHSTy) == Context.getCanonicalType(RHSTy)) {
4955 // Two identical object pointer types are always compatible.
4956 return LHSTy;
4957 }
4958 const ObjCObjectPointerType *LHSOPT = LHSTy->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>();
4959 const ObjCObjectPointerType *RHSOPT = RHSTy->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>();
4960 QualType compositeType = LHSTy;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004961
Fariborz Jahanianeebc4752009-12-10 19:47:41 +00004962 // If both operands are interfaces and either operand can be
4963 // assigned to the other, use that type as the composite
4964 // type. This allows
4965 // xxx ? (A*) a : (B*) b
4966 // where B is a subclass of A.
4967 //
4968 // Additionally, as for assignment, if either type is 'id'
4969 // allow silent coercion. Finally, if the types are
4970 // incompatible then make sure to use 'id' as the composite
4971 // type so the result is acceptable for sending messages to.
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004972
Fariborz Jahanianeebc4752009-12-10 19:47:41 +00004973 // FIXME: Consider unifying with 'areComparableObjCPointerTypes'.
4974 // It could return the composite type.
4975 if (Context.canAssignObjCInterfaces(LHSOPT, RHSOPT)) {
4976 compositeType = RHSOPT->isObjCBuiltinType() ? RHSTy : LHSTy;
4977 } else if (Context.canAssignObjCInterfaces(RHSOPT, LHSOPT)) {
4978 compositeType = LHSOPT->isObjCBuiltinType() ? LHSTy : RHSTy;
4979 } else if ((LHSTy->isObjCQualifiedIdType() ||
4980 RHSTy->isObjCQualifiedIdType()) &&
4981 Context.ObjCQualifiedIdTypesAreCompatible(LHSTy, RHSTy, true)) {
4982 // Need to handle "id<xx>" explicitly.
4983 // GCC allows qualified id and any Objective-C type to devolve to
4984 // id. Currently localizing to here until clear this should be
4985 // part of ObjCQualifiedIdTypesAreCompatible.
4986 compositeType = Context.getObjCIdType();
4987 } else if (LHSTy->isObjCIdType() || RHSTy->isObjCIdType()) {
4988 compositeType = Context.getObjCIdType();
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00004989 } else if (!(compositeType =
Fariborz Jahanianeebc4752009-12-10 19:47:41 +00004990 Context.areCommonBaseCompatible(LHSOPT, RHSOPT)).isNull())
4991 ;
4992 else {
4993 Diag(QuestionLoc, diag::ext_typecheck_cond_incompatible_operands)
4994 << LHSTy << RHSTy
4995 << LHS->getSourceRange() << RHS->getSourceRange();
4996 QualType incompatTy = Context.getObjCIdType();
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00004997 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, incompatTy, CK_BitCast);
4998 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, incompatTy, CK_BitCast);
Fariborz Jahanianeebc4752009-12-10 19:47:41 +00004999 return incompatTy;
5000 }
5001 // The object pointer types are compatible.
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00005002 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, compositeType, CK_BitCast);
5003 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, compositeType, CK_BitCast);
Fariborz Jahanianeebc4752009-12-10 19:47:41 +00005004 return compositeType;
5005 }
5006 // Check Objective-C object pointer types and 'void *'
5007 if (LHSTy->isVoidPointerType() && RHSTy->isObjCObjectPointerType()) {
5008 QualType lhptee = LHSTy->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
5009 QualType rhptee = RHSTy->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>()->getPointeeType();
5010 QualType destPointee
5011 = Context.getQualifiedType(lhptee, rhptee.getQualifiers());
5012 QualType destType = Context.getPointerType(destPointee);
5013 // Add qualifiers if necessary.
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00005014 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, destType, CK_NoOp);
Fariborz Jahanianeebc4752009-12-10 19:47:41 +00005015 // Promote to void*.
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00005016 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, destType, CK_BitCast);
Fariborz Jahanianeebc4752009-12-10 19:47:41 +00005017 return destType;
5018 }
5019 if (LHSTy->isObjCObjectPointerType() && RHSTy->isVoidPointerType()) {
5020 QualType lhptee = LHSTy->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>()->getPointeeType();
5021 QualType rhptee = RHSTy->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
5022 QualType destPointee
5023 = Context.getQualifiedType(rhptee, lhptee.getQualifiers());
5024 QualType destType = Context.getPointerType(destPointee);
5025 // Add qualifiers if necessary.
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00005026 ImpCastExprToType(RHS, destType, CK_NoOp);
Fariborz Jahanianeebc4752009-12-10 19:47:41 +00005027 // Promote to void*.
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00005028 ImpCastExprToType(LHS, destType, CK_BitCast);
Fariborz Jahanianeebc4752009-12-10 19:47:41 +00005029 return destType;
5030 }
5031 return QualType();
5032}
5033
Steve Narofff69936d2007-09-16 03:34:24 +00005034/// ActOnConditionalOp - Parse a ?: operation. Note that 'LHS' may be null
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00005035/// in the case of a the GNU conditional expr extension.
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00005036ExprResult Sema::ActOnConditionalOp(SourceLocation QuestionLoc,
Sebastian Redlb8a6aca2009-01-19 22:31:54 +00005037 SourceLocation ColonLoc,
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00005038 Expr *CondExpr, Expr *LHSExpr,
5039 Expr *RHSExpr) {
Chris Lattnera21ddb32007-11-26 01:40:58 +00005040 // If this is the gnu "x ?: y" extension, analyze the types as though the LHS
5041 // was the condition.
5042 bool isLHSNull = LHSExpr == 0;
Fariborz Jahanianf9b949f2010-08-31 18:02:20 +00005043 Expr *SAVEExpr = 0;
5044 if (isLHSNull) {
5045 LHSExpr = SAVEExpr = CondExpr;
5046 }
Sebastian Redlb8a6aca2009-01-19 22:31:54 +00005047
Fariborz Jahanian1fb019b2010-09-18 19:38:38 +00005048 QualType result = CheckConditionalOperands(CondExpr, LHSExpr, RHSExpr,
5049 SAVEExpr, QuestionLoc);
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00005050 if (result.isNull())
Sebastian Redlb8a6aca2009-01-19 22:31:54 +00005051 return ExprError();
5052
Douglas Gregor47e1f7c2009-08-26 14:37:04 +00005053 return Owned(new (Context) ConditionalOperator(CondExpr, QuestionLoc,
Fariborz Jahanianf9b949f2010-08-31 18:02:20 +00005054 LHSExpr, ColonLoc,
5055 RHSExpr, SAVEExpr,
5056 result));
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00005057}
5058
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00005059// CheckPointerTypesForAssignment - This is a very tricky routine (despite
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005060// being closely modeled after the C99 spec:-). The odd characteristic of this
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00005061// routine is it effectively iqnores the qualifiers on the top level pointee.
5062// This circumvents the usual type rules specified in 6.2.7p1 & 6.7.5.[1-3].
5063// FIXME: add a couple examples in this comment.
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005064Sema::AssignConvertType
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00005065Sema::CheckPointerTypesForAssignment(QualType lhsType, QualType rhsType) {
5066 QualType lhptee, rhptee;
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005067
David Chisnall0f436562009-08-17 16:35:33 +00005068 if ((lhsType->isObjCClassType() &&
5069 (rhsType.getDesugaredType() == Context.ObjCClassRedefinitionType)) ||
5070 (rhsType->isObjCClassType() &&
5071 (lhsType.getDesugaredType() == Context.ObjCClassRedefinitionType))) {
5072 return Compatible;
5073 }
5074
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00005075 // get the "pointed to" type (ignoring qualifiers at the top level)
Ted Kremenek6217b802009-07-29 21:53:49 +00005076 lhptee = lhsType->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
5077 rhptee = rhsType->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005078
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00005079 // make sure we operate on the canonical type
Chris Lattnerb77792e2008-07-26 22:17:49 +00005080 lhptee = Context.getCanonicalType(lhptee);
5081 rhptee = Context.getCanonicalType(rhptee);
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00005082
Chris Lattner5cf216b2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00005083 AssignConvertType ConvTy = Compatible;
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005084
5085 // C99 6.5.16.1p1: This following citation is common to constraints
5086 // 3 & 4 (below). ...and the type *pointed to* by the left has all the
5087 // qualifiers of the type *pointed to* by the right;
Fariborz Jahanianf11284a2009-02-17 18:27:45 +00005088 // FIXME: Handle ExtQualType
Douglas Gregor98cd5992008-10-21 23:43:52 +00005089 if (!lhptee.isAtLeastAsQualifiedAs(rhptee))
Chris Lattner5cf216b2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00005090 ConvTy = CompatiblePointerDiscardsQualifiers;
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00005091
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005092 // C99 6.5.16.1p1 (constraint 4): If one operand is a pointer to an object or
5093 // incomplete type and the other is a pointer to a qualified or unqualified
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00005094 // version of void...
Chris Lattnerbfe639e2008-01-03 22:56:36 +00005095 if (lhptee->isVoidType()) {
Chris Lattnerd805bec2008-04-02 06:59:01 +00005096 if (rhptee->isIncompleteOrObjectType())
Chris Lattner5cf216b2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00005097 return ConvTy;
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005098
Chris Lattnerbfe639e2008-01-03 22:56:36 +00005099 // As an extension, we allow cast to/from void* to function pointer.
Chris Lattnerd805bec2008-04-02 06:59:01 +00005100 assert(rhptee->isFunctionType());
5101 return FunctionVoidPointer;
Chris Lattnerbfe639e2008-01-03 22:56:36 +00005102 }
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005103
Chris Lattnerbfe639e2008-01-03 22:56:36 +00005104 if (rhptee->isVoidType()) {
Chris Lattnerd805bec2008-04-02 06:59:01 +00005105 if (lhptee->isIncompleteOrObjectType())
Chris Lattner5cf216b2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00005106 return ConvTy;
Chris Lattnerbfe639e2008-01-03 22:56:36 +00005107
5108 // As an extension, we allow cast to/from void* to function pointer.
Chris Lattnerd805bec2008-04-02 06:59:01 +00005109 assert(lhptee->isFunctionType());
5110 return FunctionVoidPointer;
Chris Lattnerbfe639e2008-01-03 22:56:36 +00005111 }
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005112 // C99 6.5.16.1p1 (constraint 3): both operands are pointers to qualified or
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00005113 // unqualified versions of compatible types, ...
Eli Friedmanf05c05d2009-03-22 23:59:44 +00005114 lhptee = lhptee.getUnqualifiedType();
5115 rhptee = rhptee.getUnqualifiedType();
5116 if (!Context.typesAreCompatible(lhptee, rhptee)) {
5117 // Check if the pointee types are compatible ignoring the sign.
5118 // We explicitly check for char so that we catch "char" vs
5119 // "unsigned char" on systems where "char" is unsigned.
Chris Lattner6a2b9262009-10-17 20:33:28 +00005120 if (lhptee->isCharType())
Eli Friedmanf05c05d2009-03-22 23:59:44 +00005121 lhptee = Context.UnsignedCharTy;
Douglas Gregorf6094622010-07-23 15:58:24 +00005122 else if (lhptee->hasSignedIntegerRepresentation())
Eli Friedmanf05c05d2009-03-22 23:59:44 +00005123 lhptee = Context.getCorrespondingUnsignedType(lhptee);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00005124
Chris Lattner6a2b9262009-10-17 20:33:28 +00005125 if (rhptee->isCharType())
Eli Friedmanf05c05d2009-03-22 23:59:44 +00005126 rhptee = Context.UnsignedCharTy;
Douglas Gregorf6094622010-07-23 15:58:24 +00005127 else if (rhptee->hasSignedIntegerRepresentation())
Eli Friedmanf05c05d2009-03-22 23:59:44 +00005128 rhptee = Context.getCorrespondingUnsignedType(rhptee);
Chris Lattner6a2b9262009-10-17 20:33:28 +00005129
Eli Friedmanf05c05d2009-03-22 23:59:44 +00005130 if (lhptee == rhptee) {
5131 // Types are compatible ignoring the sign. Qualifier incompatibility
5132 // takes priority over sign incompatibility because the sign
5133 // warning can be disabled.
5134 if (ConvTy != Compatible)
5135 return ConvTy;
5136 return IncompatiblePointerSign;
5137 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00005138
Fariborz Jahanian36a862f2009-11-07 20:20:40 +00005139 // If we are a multi-level pointer, it's possible that our issue is simply
5140 // one of qualification - e.g. char ** -> const char ** is not allowed. If
5141 // the eventual target type is the same and the pointers have the same
5142 // level of indirection, this must be the issue.
5143 if (lhptee->isPointerType() && rhptee->isPointerType()) {
5144 do {
5145 lhptee = lhptee->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
5146 rhptee = rhptee->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType();
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00005147
Fariborz Jahanian36a862f2009-11-07 20:20:40 +00005148 lhptee = Context.getCanonicalType(lhptee);
5149 rhptee = Context.getCanonicalType(rhptee);
5150 } while (lhptee->isPointerType() && rhptee->isPointerType());
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00005151
Douglas Gregora4923eb2009-11-16 21:35:15 +00005152 if (Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(lhptee, rhptee))
Sean Huntc9132b62009-11-08 07:46:34 +00005153 return IncompatibleNestedPointerQualifiers;
Fariborz Jahanian36a862f2009-11-07 20:20:40 +00005154 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00005155
Eli Friedmanf05c05d2009-03-22 23:59:44 +00005156 // General pointer incompatibility takes priority over qualifiers.
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005157 return IncompatiblePointer;
Eli Friedmanf05c05d2009-03-22 23:59:44 +00005158 }
Chris Lattner5cf216b2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00005159 return ConvTy;
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00005160}
5161
Steve Naroff1c7d0672008-09-04 15:10:53 +00005162/// CheckBlockPointerTypesForAssignment - This routine determines whether two
5163/// block pointer types are compatible or whether a block and normal pointer
5164/// are compatible. It is more restrict than comparing two function pointer
5165// types.
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005166Sema::AssignConvertType
5167Sema::CheckBlockPointerTypesForAssignment(QualType lhsType,
Steve Naroff1c7d0672008-09-04 15:10:53 +00005168 QualType rhsType) {
5169 QualType lhptee, rhptee;
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005170
Steve Naroff1c7d0672008-09-04 15:10:53 +00005171 // get the "pointed to" type (ignoring qualifiers at the top level)
Ted Kremenek6217b802009-07-29 21:53:49 +00005172 lhptee = lhsType->getAs<BlockPointerType>()->getPointeeType();
5173 rhptee = rhsType->getAs<BlockPointerType>()->getPointeeType();
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005174
Steve Naroff1c7d0672008-09-04 15:10:53 +00005175 // make sure we operate on the canonical type
5176 lhptee = Context.getCanonicalType(lhptee);
5177 rhptee = Context.getCanonicalType(rhptee);
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005178
Steve Naroff1c7d0672008-09-04 15:10:53 +00005179 AssignConvertType ConvTy = Compatible;
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005180
Steve Naroff1c7d0672008-09-04 15:10:53 +00005181 // For blocks we enforce that qualifiers are identical.
Douglas Gregora4923eb2009-11-16 21:35:15 +00005182 if (lhptee.getLocalCVRQualifiers() != rhptee.getLocalCVRQualifiers())
Steve Naroff1c7d0672008-09-04 15:10:53 +00005183 ConvTy = CompatiblePointerDiscardsQualifiers;
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005184
Fariborz Jahanian132f2a22010-03-17 00:20:01 +00005185 if (!getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
5186 if (!Context.typesAreBlockPointerCompatible(lhsType, rhsType))
5187 return IncompatibleBlockPointer;
5188 }
5189 else if (!Context.typesAreCompatible(lhptee, rhptee))
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005190 return IncompatibleBlockPointer;
Steve Naroff1c7d0672008-09-04 15:10:53 +00005191 return ConvTy;
5192}
5193
Fariborz Jahanian52efc3f2009-12-08 18:24:49 +00005194/// CheckObjCPointerTypesForAssignment - Compares two objective-c pointer types
5195/// for assignment compatibility.
5196Sema::AssignConvertType
5197Sema::CheckObjCPointerTypesForAssignment(QualType lhsType, QualType rhsType) {
Fariborz Jahaniand4c60902010-03-19 18:06:10 +00005198 if (lhsType->isObjCBuiltinType()) {
5199 // Class is not compatible with ObjC object pointers.
Fariborz Jahanian528adb12010-03-24 21:00:27 +00005200 if (lhsType->isObjCClassType() && !rhsType->isObjCBuiltinType() &&
5201 !rhsType->isObjCQualifiedClassType())
Fariborz Jahaniand4c60902010-03-19 18:06:10 +00005202 return IncompatiblePointer;
Fariborz Jahanian52efc3f2009-12-08 18:24:49 +00005203 return Compatible;
Fariborz Jahaniand4c60902010-03-19 18:06:10 +00005204 }
5205 if (rhsType->isObjCBuiltinType()) {
5206 // Class is not compatible with ObjC object pointers.
Fariborz Jahanian528adb12010-03-24 21:00:27 +00005207 if (rhsType->isObjCClassType() && !lhsType->isObjCBuiltinType() &&
5208 !lhsType->isObjCQualifiedClassType())
Fariborz Jahaniand4c60902010-03-19 18:06:10 +00005209 return IncompatiblePointer;
5210 return Compatible;
5211 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00005212 QualType lhptee =
Fariborz Jahanian52efc3f2009-12-08 18:24:49 +00005213 lhsType->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>()->getPointeeType();
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00005214 QualType rhptee =
Fariborz Jahanian52efc3f2009-12-08 18:24:49 +00005215 rhsType->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>()->getPointeeType();
5216 // make sure we operate on the canonical type
5217 lhptee = Context.getCanonicalType(lhptee);
5218 rhptee = Context.getCanonicalType(rhptee);
5219 if (!lhptee.isAtLeastAsQualifiedAs(rhptee))
5220 return CompatiblePointerDiscardsQualifiers;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00005221
Fariborz Jahanian52efc3f2009-12-08 18:24:49 +00005222 if (Context.typesAreCompatible(lhsType, rhsType))
5223 return Compatible;
5224 if (lhsType->isObjCQualifiedIdType() || rhsType->isObjCQualifiedIdType())
5225 return IncompatibleObjCQualifiedId;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00005226 return IncompatiblePointer;
Fariborz Jahanian52efc3f2009-12-08 18:24:49 +00005227}
5228
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005229/// CheckAssignmentConstraints (C99 6.5.16) - This routine currently
5230/// has code to accommodate several GCC extensions when type checking
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00005231/// pointers. Here are some objectionable examples that GCC considers warnings:
5232///
5233/// int a, *pint;
5234/// short *pshort;
5235/// struct foo *pfoo;
5236///
5237/// pint = pshort; // warning: assignment from incompatible pointer type
5238/// a = pint; // warning: assignment makes integer from pointer without a cast
5239/// pint = a; // warning: assignment makes pointer from integer without a cast
5240/// pint = pfoo; // warning: assignment from incompatible pointer type
5241///
5242/// As a result, the code for dealing with pointers is more complex than the
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005243/// C99 spec dictates.
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00005244///
Chris Lattner5cf216b2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00005245Sema::AssignConvertType
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00005246Sema::CheckAssignmentConstraints(QualType lhsType, QualType rhsType) {
Chris Lattnerfc144e22008-01-04 23:18:45 +00005247 // Get canonical types. We're not formatting these types, just comparing
5248 // them.
Chris Lattnerb77792e2008-07-26 22:17:49 +00005249 lhsType = Context.getCanonicalType(lhsType).getUnqualifiedType();
5250 rhsType = Context.getCanonicalType(rhsType).getUnqualifiedType();
Eli Friedmanf8f873d2008-05-30 18:07:22 +00005251
5252 if (lhsType == rhsType)
Chris Lattnerd2656dd2008-01-07 17:51:46 +00005253 return Compatible; // Common case: fast path an exact match.
Steve Naroff700204c2007-07-24 21:46:40 +00005254
David Chisnall0f436562009-08-17 16:35:33 +00005255 if ((lhsType->isObjCClassType() &&
5256 (rhsType.getDesugaredType() == Context.ObjCClassRedefinitionType)) ||
5257 (rhsType->isObjCClassType() &&
5258 (lhsType.getDesugaredType() == Context.ObjCClassRedefinitionType))) {
5259 return Compatible;
5260 }
5261
Douglas Gregor9d293df2008-10-28 00:22:11 +00005262 // If the left-hand side is a reference type, then we are in a
5263 // (rare!) case where we've allowed the use of references in C,
5264 // e.g., as a parameter type in a built-in function. In this case,
5265 // just make sure that the type referenced is compatible with the
5266 // right-hand side type. The caller is responsible for adjusting
5267 // lhsType so that the resulting expression does not have reference
5268 // type.
Ted Kremenek6217b802009-07-29 21:53:49 +00005269 if (const ReferenceType *lhsTypeRef = lhsType->getAs<ReferenceType>()) {
Douglas Gregor9d293df2008-10-28 00:22:11 +00005270 if (Context.typesAreCompatible(lhsTypeRef->getPointeeType(), rhsType))
Anders Carlsson793680e2007-10-12 23:56:29 +00005271 return Compatible;
Chris Lattnerfc144e22008-01-04 23:18:45 +00005272 return Incompatible;
Fariborz Jahanian411f3732007-12-19 17:45:58 +00005273 }
Nate Begeman1bd1f6e2009-06-28 02:36:38 +00005274 // Allow scalar to ExtVector assignments, and assignments of an ExtVector type
5275 // to the same ExtVector type.
5276 if (lhsType->isExtVectorType()) {
5277 if (rhsType->isExtVectorType())
5278 return lhsType == rhsType ? Compatible : Incompatible;
Douglas Gregor00619622010-06-22 23:41:02 +00005279 if (rhsType->isArithmeticType())
Nate Begeman1bd1f6e2009-06-28 02:36:38 +00005280 return Compatible;
5281 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005282
Nate Begemanbe2341d2008-07-14 18:02:46 +00005283 if (lhsType->isVectorType() || rhsType->isVectorType()) {
Douglas Gregor255210e2010-08-06 10:14:59 +00005284 if (lhsType->isVectorType() && rhsType->isVectorType()) {
5285 // If we are allowing lax vector conversions, and LHS and RHS are both
5286 // vectors, the total size only needs to be the same. This is a bitcast;
5287 // no bits are changed but the result type is different.
5288 if (getLangOptions().LaxVectorConversions &&
5289 (Context.getTypeSize(lhsType) == Context.getTypeSize(rhsType)))
Anders Carlssonb0f90cc2009-01-30 23:17:46 +00005290 return IncompatibleVectors;
Douglas Gregor255210e2010-08-06 10:14:59 +00005291
5292 // Allow assignments of an AltiVec vector type to an equivalent GCC
5293 // vector type and vice versa
5294 if (Context.areCompatibleVectorTypes(lhsType, rhsType))
5295 return Compatible;
Chris Lattnere8b3e962008-01-04 23:32:24 +00005296 }
5297 return Incompatible;
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005298 }
Eli Friedmanf8f873d2008-05-30 18:07:22 +00005299
Douglas Gregor88623ad2010-05-23 21:53:47 +00005300 if (lhsType->isArithmeticType() && rhsType->isArithmeticType() &&
5301 !(getLangOptions().CPlusPlus && lhsType->isEnumeralType()))
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00005302 return Compatible;
Eli Friedmanf8f873d2008-05-30 18:07:22 +00005303
Chris Lattner78eca282008-04-07 06:49:41 +00005304 if (isa<PointerType>(lhsType)) {
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00005305 if (rhsType->isIntegerType())
Chris Lattnerb7b61152008-01-04 18:22:42 +00005306 return IntToPointer;
Eli Friedmanf8f873d2008-05-30 18:07:22 +00005307
Chris Lattner78eca282008-04-07 06:49:41 +00005308 if (isa<PointerType>(rhsType))
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00005309 return CheckPointerTypesForAssignment(lhsType, rhsType);
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005310
Steve Naroff67ef8ea2009-07-20 17:56:53 +00005311 // In general, C pointers are not compatible with ObjC object pointers.
Steve Naroff14108da2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00005312 if (isa<ObjCObjectPointerType>(rhsType)) {
Steve Naroff67ef8ea2009-07-20 17:56:53 +00005313 if (lhsType->isVoidPointerType()) // an exception to the rule.
5314 return Compatible;
5315 return IncompatiblePointer;
Steve Naroff14108da2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00005316 }
Ted Kremenek6217b802009-07-29 21:53:49 +00005317 if (rhsType->getAs<BlockPointerType>()) {
5318 if (lhsType->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType()->isVoidType())
Douglas Gregor63a94902008-11-27 00:44:28 +00005319 return Compatible;
Steve Naroffb4406862008-09-29 18:10:17 +00005320
5321 // Treat block pointers as objects.
Steve Naroff14108da2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00005322 if (getLangOptions().ObjC1 && lhsType->isObjCIdType())
Steve Naroffb4406862008-09-29 18:10:17 +00005323 return Compatible;
5324 }
Steve Naroff1c7d0672008-09-04 15:10:53 +00005325 return Incompatible;
5326 }
5327
5328 if (isa<BlockPointerType>(lhsType)) {
5329 if (rhsType->isIntegerType())
Eli Friedmand8f4f432009-02-25 04:20:42 +00005330 return IntToBlockPointer;
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005331
Steve Naroffb4406862008-09-29 18:10:17 +00005332 // Treat block pointers as objects.
Steve Naroff14108da2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00005333 if (getLangOptions().ObjC1 && rhsType->isObjCIdType())
Steve Naroffb4406862008-09-29 18:10:17 +00005334 return Compatible;
5335
Steve Naroff1c7d0672008-09-04 15:10:53 +00005336 if (rhsType->isBlockPointerType())
5337 return CheckBlockPointerTypesForAssignment(lhsType, rhsType);
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005338
Ted Kremenek6217b802009-07-29 21:53:49 +00005339 if (const PointerType *RHSPT = rhsType->getAs<PointerType>()) {
Steve Naroff1c7d0672008-09-04 15:10:53 +00005340 if (RHSPT->getPointeeType()->isVoidType())
Douglas Gregor63a94902008-11-27 00:44:28 +00005341 return Compatible;
Steve Naroff1c7d0672008-09-04 15:10:53 +00005342 }
Chris Lattnerfc144e22008-01-04 23:18:45 +00005343 return Incompatible;
5344 }
5345
Steve Naroff14108da2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00005346 if (isa<ObjCObjectPointerType>(lhsType)) {
5347 if (rhsType->isIntegerType())
5348 return IntToPointer;
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005349
Steve Naroff67ef8ea2009-07-20 17:56:53 +00005350 // In general, C pointers are not compatible with ObjC object pointers.
Steve Naroff14108da2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00005351 if (isa<PointerType>(rhsType)) {
Steve Naroff67ef8ea2009-07-20 17:56:53 +00005352 if (rhsType->isVoidPointerType()) // an exception to the rule.
5353 return Compatible;
5354 return IncompatiblePointer;
Steve Naroff14108da2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00005355 }
5356 if (rhsType->isObjCObjectPointerType()) {
Fariborz Jahanian52efc3f2009-12-08 18:24:49 +00005357 return CheckObjCPointerTypesForAssignment(lhsType, rhsType);
Steve Naroff14108da2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00005358 }
Ted Kremenek6217b802009-07-29 21:53:49 +00005359 if (const PointerType *RHSPT = rhsType->getAs<PointerType>()) {
Steve Naroff14108da2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00005360 if (RHSPT->getPointeeType()->isVoidType())
5361 return Compatible;
5362 }
5363 // Treat block pointers as objects.
5364 if (rhsType->isBlockPointerType())
5365 return Compatible;
5366 return Incompatible;
5367 }
Chris Lattner78eca282008-04-07 06:49:41 +00005368 if (isa<PointerType>(rhsType)) {
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00005369 // C99 6.5.16.1p1: the left operand is _Bool and the right is a pointer.
Eli Friedmanf8f873d2008-05-30 18:07:22 +00005370 if (lhsType == Context.BoolTy)
5371 return Compatible;
5372
5373 if (lhsType->isIntegerType())
Chris Lattnerb7b61152008-01-04 18:22:42 +00005374 return PointerToInt;
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00005375
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005376 if (isa<PointerType>(lhsType))
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00005377 return CheckPointerTypesForAssignment(lhsType, rhsType);
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005378
5379 if (isa<BlockPointerType>(lhsType) &&
Ted Kremenek6217b802009-07-29 21:53:49 +00005380 rhsType->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType()->isVoidType())
Douglas Gregor63a94902008-11-27 00:44:28 +00005381 return Compatible;
Chris Lattnerfc144e22008-01-04 23:18:45 +00005382 return Incompatible;
Chris Lattnerfc144e22008-01-04 23:18:45 +00005383 }
Steve Naroff14108da2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00005384 if (isa<ObjCObjectPointerType>(rhsType)) {
5385 // C99 6.5.16.1p1: the left operand is _Bool and the right is a pointer.
5386 if (lhsType == Context.BoolTy)
5387 return Compatible;
5388
5389 if (lhsType->isIntegerType())
5390 return PointerToInt;
5391
Steve Naroff67ef8ea2009-07-20 17:56:53 +00005392 // In general, C pointers are not compatible with ObjC object pointers.
Steve Naroff14108da2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00005393 if (isa<PointerType>(lhsType)) {
Steve Naroff67ef8ea2009-07-20 17:56:53 +00005394 if (lhsType->isVoidPointerType()) // an exception to the rule.
5395 return Compatible;
5396 return IncompatiblePointer;
Steve Naroff14108da2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00005397 }
5398 if (isa<BlockPointerType>(lhsType) &&
Ted Kremenek6217b802009-07-29 21:53:49 +00005399 rhsType->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType()->isVoidType())
Steve Naroff14108da2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00005400 return Compatible;
5401 return Incompatible;
5402 }
Eli Friedmanf8f873d2008-05-30 18:07:22 +00005403
Chris Lattnerfc144e22008-01-04 23:18:45 +00005404 if (isa<TagType>(lhsType) && isa<TagType>(rhsType)) {
Chris Lattner78eca282008-04-07 06:49:41 +00005405 if (Context.typesAreCompatible(lhsType, rhsType))
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00005406 return Compatible;
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00005407 }
5408 return Incompatible;
5409}
5410
Douglas Gregor0c74e8a2009-04-29 22:16:16 +00005411/// \brief Constructs a transparent union from an expression that is
5412/// used to initialize the transparent union.
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005413static void ConstructTransparentUnion(ASTContext &C, Expr *&E,
Douglas Gregor0c74e8a2009-04-29 22:16:16 +00005414 QualType UnionType, FieldDecl *Field) {
5415 // Build an initializer list that designates the appropriate member
5416 // of the transparent union.
Ted Kremenek709210f2010-04-13 23:39:13 +00005417 InitListExpr *Initializer = new (C) InitListExpr(C, SourceLocation(),
Ted Kremenekba7bc552010-02-19 01:50:18 +00005418 &E, 1,
Douglas Gregor0c74e8a2009-04-29 22:16:16 +00005419 SourceLocation());
5420 Initializer->setType(UnionType);
5421 Initializer->setInitializedFieldInUnion(Field);
5422
5423 // Build a compound literal constructing a value of the transparent
5424 // union type from this initializer list.
John McCall42f56b52010-01-18 19:35:47 +00005425 TypeSourceInfo *unionTInfo = C.getTrivialTypeSourceInfo(UnionType);
John McCall1d7d8d62010-01-19 22:33:45 +00005426 E = new (C) CompoundLiteralExpr(SourceLocation(), unionTInfo, UnionType,
John McCall42f56b52010-01-18 19:35:47 +00005427 Initializer, false);
Douglas Gregor0c74e8a2009-04-29 22:16:16 +00005428}
5429
5430Sema::AssignConvertType
5431Sema::CheckTransparentUnionArgumentConstraints(QualType ArgType, Expr *&rExpr) {
5432 QualType FromType = rExpr->getType();
5433
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005434 // If the ArgType is a Union type, we want to handle a potential
Douglas Gregor0c74e8a2009-04-29 22:16:16 +00005435 // transparent_union GCC extension.
5436 const RecordType *UT = ArgType->getAsUnionType();
Argyrios Kyrtzidis40b598e2009-06-30 02:34:44 +00005437 if (!UT || !UT->getDecl()->hasAttr<TransparentUnionAttr>())
Douglas Gregor0c74e8a2009-04-29 22:16:16 +00005438 return Incompatible;
5439
5440 // The field to initialize within the transparent union.
5441 RecordDecl *UD = UT->getDecl();
5442 FieldDecl *InitField = 0;
5443 // It's compatible if the expression matches any of the fields.
Argyrios Kyrtzidis17945a02009-06-30 02:36:12 +00005444 for (RecordDecl::field_iterator it = UD->field_begin(),
5445 itend = UD->field_end();
Douglas Gregor0c74e8a2009-04-29 22:16:16 +00005446 it != itend; ++it) {
5447 if (it->getType()->isPointerType()) {
5448 // If the transparent union contains a pointer type, we allow:
5449 // 1) void pointer
5450 // 2) null pointer constant
5451 if (FromType->isPointerType())
Ted Kremenek6217b802009-07-29 21:53:49 +00005452 if (FromType->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType()->isVoidType()) {
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00005453 ImpCastExprToType(rExpr, it->getType(), CK_BitCast);
Douglas Gregor0c74e8a2009-04-29 22:16:16 +00005454 InitField = *it;
5455 break;
5456 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005457
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00005458 if (rExpr->isNullPointerConstant(Context,
Douglas Gregorce940492009-09-25 04:25:58 +00005459 Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNull)) {
John McCall404cd162010-11-13 01:35:44 +00005460 ImpCastExprToType(rExpr, it->getType(), CK_NullToPointer);
Douglas Gregor0c74e8a2009-04-29 22:16:16 +00005461 InitField = *it;
5462 break;
5463 }
5464 }
5465
5466 if (CheckAssignmentConstraints(it->getType(), rExpr->getType())
5467 == Compatible) {
Daniel Dunbar41e11a92010-09-17 23:21:43 +00005468 ImpCastExprToType(rExpr, it->getType(), CK_Unknown);
Douglas Gregor0c74e8a2009-04-29 22:16:16 +00005469 InitField = *it;
5470 break;
5471 }
5472 }
5473
5474 if (!InitField)
5475 return Incompatible;
5476
5477 ConstructTransparentUnion(Context, rExpr, ArgType, InitField);
5478 return Compatible;
5479}
5480
Chris Lattner5cf216b2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00005481Sema::AssignConvertType
Steve Naroff90045e82007-07-13 23:32:42 +00005482Sema::CheckSingleAssignmentConstraints(QualType lhsType, Expr *&rExpr) {
Douglas Gregor98cd5992008-10-21 23:43:52 +00005483 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
5484 if (!lhsType->isRecordType()) {
5485 // C++ 5.17p3: If the left operand is not of class type, the
5486 // expression is implicitly converted (C++ 4) to the
5487 // cv-unqualified type of the left operand.
Douglas Gregor45920e82008-12-19 17:40:08 +00005488 if (PerformImplicitConversion(rExpr, lhsType.getUnqualifiedType(),
Douglas Gregor68647482009-12-16 03:45:30 +00005489 AA_Assigning))
Douglas Gregor98cd5992008-10-21 23:43:52 +00005490 return Incompatible;
Chris Lattner2c4463f2009-04-12 09:02:39 +00005491 return Compatible;
Douglas Gregor98cd5992008-10-21 23:43:52 +00005492 }
5493
5494 // FIXME: Currently, we fall through and treat C++ classes like C
5495 // structures.
5496 }
5497
Steve Naroff529a4ad2007-11-27 17:58:44 +00005498 // C99 6.5.16.1p1: the left operand is a pointer and the right is
5499 // a null pointer constant.
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005500 if ((lhsType->isPointerType() ||
5501 lhsType->isObjCObjectPointerType() ||
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005502 lhsType->isBlockPointerType())
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00005503 && rExpr->isNullPointerConstant(Context,
Douglas Gregorce940492009-09-25 04:25:58 +00005504 Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNull)) {
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00005505 ImpCastExprToType(rExpr, lhsType, CK_Unknown);
Steve Naroff529a4ad2007-11-27 17:58:44 +00005506 return Compatible;
5507 }
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005508
Chris Lattner943140e2007-10-16 02:55:40 +00005509 // This check seems unnatural, however it is necessary to ensure the proper
Steve Naroff90045e82007-07-13 23:32:42 +00005510 // conversion of functions/arrays. If the conversion were done for all
Douglas Gregor02a24ee2009-11-03 16:56:39 +00005511 // DeclExpr's (created by ActOnIdExpression), it would mess up the unary
Nick Lewyckyc133e9e2010-08-05 06:27:49 +00005512 // expressions that suppress this implicit conversion (&, sizeof).
Chris Lattner943140e2007-10-16 02:55:40 +00005513 //
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005514 // Suppress this for references: C++ 8.5.3p5.
Chris Lattner943140e2007-10-16 02:55:40 +00005515 if (!lhsType->isReferenceType())
Douglas Gregora873dfc2010-02-03 00:27:59 +00005516 DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion(rExpr);
Steve Narofff1120de2007-08-24 22:33:52 +00005517
Chris Lattner5cf216b2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00005518 Sema::AssignConvertType result =
5519 CheckAssignmentConstraints(lhsType, rExpr->getType());
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005520
Steve Narofff1120de2007-08-24 22:33:52 +00005521 // C99 6.5.16.1p2: The value of the right operand is converted to the
5522 // type of the assignment expression.
Douglas Gregor9d293df2008-10-28 00:22:11 +00005523 // CheckAssignmentConstraints allows the left-hand side to be a reference,
5524 // so that we can use references in built-in functions even in C.
5525 // The getNonReferenceType() call makes sure that the resulting expression
5526 // does not have reference type.
Douglas Gregor0c74e8a2009-04-29 22:16:16 +00005527 if (result != Incompatible && rExpr->getType() != lhsType)
Douglas Gregor63982352010-07-13 18:40:04 +00005528 ImpCastExprToType(rExpr, lhsType.getNonLValueExprType(Context),
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00005529 CK_Unknown);
Steve Narofff1120de2007-08-24 22:33:52 +00005530 return result;
Steve Naroff90045e82007-07-13 23:32:42 +00005531}
5532
Chris Lattner29a1cfb2008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005533QualType Sema::InvalidOperands(SourceLocation Loc, Expr *&lex, Expr *&rex) {
Chris Lattnerc9c7c4e2008-11-18 22:52:51 +00005534 Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_invalid_operands)
Chris Lattner22caddc2008-11-23 09:13:29 +00005535 << lex->getType() << rex->getType()
Chris Lattnerc9c7c4e2008-11-18 22:52:51 +00005536 << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
Chris Lattnerca5eede2007-12-12 05:47:28 +00005537 return QualType();
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00005538}
5539
Chris Lattner7ef655a2010-01-12 21:23:57 +00005540QualType Sema::CheckVectorOperands(SourceLocation Loc, Expr *&lex, Expr *&rex) {
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005541 // For conversion purposes, we ignore any qualifiers.
Nate Begeman1330b0e2008-04-04 01:30:25 +00005542 // For example, "const float" and "float" are equivalent.
Chris Lattnerb77792e2008-07-26 22:17:49 +00005543 QualType lhsType =
5544 Context.getCanonicalType(lex->getType()).getUnqualifiedType();
5545 QualType rhsType =
5546 Context.getCanonicalType(rex->getType()).getUnqualifiedType();
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005547
Nate Begemanbe2341d2008-07-14 18:02:46 +00005548 // If the vector types are identical, return.
Nate Begeman1330b0e2008-04-04 01:30:25 +00005549 if (lhsType == rhsType)
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00005550 return lhsType;
Nate Begeman4119d1a2007-12-30 02:59:45 +00005551
Nate Begemanbe2341d2008-07-14 18:02:46 +00005552 // Handle the case of a vector & extvector type of the same size and element
5553 // type. It would be nice if we only had one vector type someday.
Anders Carlssonb0f90cc2009-01-30 23:17:46 +00005554 if (getLangOptions().LaxVectorConversions) {
John McCall183700f2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00005555 if (const VectorType *LV = lhsType->getAs<VectorType>()) {
Chandler Carruth629f9e42010-08-30 07:36:24 +00005556 if (const VectorType *RV = rhsType->getAs<VectorType>()) {
Nate Begemanbe2341d2008-07-14 18:02:46 +00005557 if (LV->getElementType() == RV->getElementType() &&
Anders Carlssonb0f90cc2009-01-30 23:17:46 +00005558 LV->getNumElements() == RV->getNumElements()) {
Douglas Gregor26bcf672010-05-19 03:21:00 +00005559 if (lhsType->isExtVectorType()) {
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00005560 ImpCastExprToType(rex, lhsType, CK_BitCast);
Douglas Gregor26bcf672010-05-19 03:21:00 +00005561 return lhsType;
5562 }
5563
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00005564 ImpCastExprToType(lex, rhsType, CK_BitCast);
Douglas Gregor26bcf672010-05-19 03:21:00 +00005565 return rhsType;
Eric Christophere84f9eb2010-08-26 00:42:16 +00005566 } else if (Context.getTypeSize(lhsType) ==Context.getTypeSize(rhsType)){
5567 // If we are allowing lax vector conversions, and LHS and RHS are both
5568 // vectors, the total size only needs to be the same. This is a
5569 // bitcast; no bits are changed but the result type is different.
5570 ImpCastExprToType(rex, lhsType, CK_BitCast);
5571 return lhsType;
Anders Carlssonb0f90cc2009-01-30 23:17:46 +00005572 }
Eric Christophere84f9eb2010-08-26 00:42:16 +00005573 }
Chandler Carruth629f9e42010-08-30 07:36:24 +00005574 }
Anders Carlssonb0f90cc2009-01-30 23:17:46 +00005575 }
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005576
Douglas Gregor255210e2010-08-06 10:14:59 +00005577 // Handle the case of equivalent AltiVec and GCC vector types
5578 if (lhsType->isVectorType() && rhsType->isVectorType() &&
5579 Context.areCompatibleVectorTypes(lhsType, rhsType)) {
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00005580 ImpCastExprToType(lex, rhsType, CK_BitCast);
Douglas Gregor255210e2010-08-06 10:14:59 +00005581 return rhsType;
5582 }
5583
Nate Begeman1bd1f6e2009-06-28 02:36:38 +00005584 // Canonicalize the ExtVector to the LHS, remember if we swapped so we can
5585 // swap back (so that we don't reverse the inputs to a subtract, for instance.
5586 bool swapped = false;
5587 if (rhsType->isExtVectorType()) {
5588 swapped = true;
5589 std::swap(rex, lex);
5590 std::swap(rhsType, lhsType);
5591 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005592
Nate Begemandde25982009-06-28 19:12:57 +00005593 // Handle the case of an ext vector and scalar.
John McCall183700f2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00005594 if (const ExtVectorType *LV = lhsType->getAs<ExtVectorType>()) {
Nate Begeman1bd1f6e2009-06-28 02:36:38 +00005595 QualType EltTy = LV->getElementType();
Douglas Gregor9d3347a2010-06-16 00:35:25 +00005596 if (EltTy->isIntegralType(Context) && rhsType->isIntegralType(Context)) {
Nate Begeman1bd1f6e2009-06-28 02:36:38 +00005597 if (Context.getIntegerTypeOrder(EltTy, rhsType) >= 0) {
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00005598 ImpCastExprToType(rex, lhsType, CK_IntegralCast);
Nate Begeman1bd1f6e2009-06-28 02:36:38 +00005599 if (swapped) std::swap(rex, lex);
5600 return lhsType;
5601 }
5602 }
5603 if (EltTy->isRealFloatingType() && rhsType->isScalarType() &&
5604 rhsType->isRealFloatingType()) {
5605 if (Context.getFloatingTypeOrder(EltTy, rhsType) >= 0) {
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00005606 ImpCastExprToType(rex, lhsType, CK_FloatingCast);
Nate Begeman1bd1f6e2009-06-28 02:36:38 +00005607 if (swapped) std::swap(rex, lex);
5608 return lhsType;
5609 }
Nate Begeman4119d1a2007-12-30 02:59:45 +00005610 }
5611 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005612
Nate Begemandde25982009-06-28 19:12:57 +00005613 // Vectors of different size or scalar and non-ext-vector are errors.
Chris Lattnerc9c7c4e2008-11-18 22:52:51 +00005614 Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_vector_not_convertable)
Chris Lattnerd1625842008-11-24 06:25:27 +00005615 << lex->getType() << rex->getType()
Chris Lattnerc9c7c4e2008-11-18 22:52:51 +00005616 << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00005617 return QualType();
Sebastian Redl22460502009-02-07 00:15:38 +00005618}
5619
Chris Lattner7ef655a2010-01-12 21:23:57 +00005620QualType Sema::CheckMultiplyDivideOperands(
5621 Expr *&lex, Expr *&rex, SourceLocation Loc, bool isCompAssign, bool isDiv) {
Daniel Dunbar69d1d002009-01-05 22:42:10 +00005622 if (lex->getType()->isVectorType() || rex->getType()->isVectorType())
Chris Lattner29a1cfb2008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005623 return CheckVectorOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005624
Steve Naroff9f5fa9b2007-08-24 19:07:16 +00005625 QualType compType = UsualArithmeticConversions(lex, rex, isCompAssign);
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005626
Chris Lattner7ef655a2010-01-12 21:23:57 +00005627 if (!lex->getType()->isArithmeticType() ||
5628 !rex->getType()->isArithmeticType())
5629 return InvalidOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00005630
Chris Lattner7ef655a2010-01-12 21:23:57 +00005631 // Check for division by zero.
5632 if (isDiv &&
5633 rex->isNullPointerConstant(Context, Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNotNull))
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00005634 DiagRuntimeBehavior(Loc, PDiag(diag::warn_division_by_zero)
Chris Lattnercb329c52010-01-12 21:30:55 +00005635 << rex->getSourceRange());
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00005636
Chris Lattner7ef655a2010-01-12 21:23:57 +00005637 return compType;
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00005638}
5639
Chris Lattner7ef655a2010-01-12 21:23:57 +00005640QualType Sema::CheckRemainderOperands(
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005641 Expr *&lex, Expr *&rex, SourceLocation Loc, bool isCompAssign) {
Daniel Dunbar523aa602009-01-05 22:55:36 +00005642 if (lex->getType()->isVectorType() || rex->getType()->isVectorType()) {
Douglas Gregorf6094622010-07-23 15:58:24 +00005643 if (lex->getType()->hasIntegerRepresentation() &&
5644 rex->getType()->hasIntegerRepresentation())
Daniel Dunbar523aa602009-01-05 22:55:36 +00005645 return CheckVectorOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
5646 return InvalidOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
5647 }
Steve Naroff90045e82007-07-13 23:32:42 +00005648
Steve Naroff9f5fa9b2007-08-24 19:07:16 +00005649 QualType compType = UsualArithmeticConversions(lex, rex, isCompAssign);
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005650
Chris Lattner7ef655a2010-01-12 21:23:57 +00005651 if (!lex->getType()->isIntegerType() || !rex->getType()->isIntegerType())
5652 return InvalidOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00005653
Chris Lattner7ef655a2010-01-12 21:23:57 +00005654 // Check for remainder by zero.
5655 if (rex->isNullPointerConstant(Context, Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNotNull))
Chris Lattnercb329c52010-01-12 21:30:55 +00005656 DiagRuntimeBehavior(Loc, PDiag(diag::warn_remainder_by_zero)
5657 << rex->getSourceRange());
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00005658
Chris Lattner7ef655a2010-01-12 21:23:57 +00005659 return compType;
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00005660}
5661
Chris Lattner7ef655a2010-01-12 21:23:57 +00005662QualType Sema::CheckAdditionOperands( // C99 6.5.6
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005663 Expr *&lex, Expr *&rex, SourceLocation Loc, QualType* CompLHSTy) {
Eli Friedmanab3a8522009-03-28 01:22:36 +00005664 if (lex->getType()->isVectorType() || rex->getType()->isVectorType()) {
5665 QualType compType = CheckVectorOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
5666 if (CompLHSTy) *CompLHSTy = compType;
5667 return compType;
5668 }
Steve Naroff49b45262007-07-13 16:58:59 +00005669
Eli Friedmanab3a8522009-03-28 01:22:36 +00005670 QualType compType = UsualArithmeticConversions(lex, rex, CompLHSTy);
Eli Friedmand72d16e2008-05-18 18:08:51 +00005671
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00005672 // handle the common case first (both operands are arithmetic).
Eli Friedmanab3a8522009-03-28 01:22:36 +00005673 if (lex->getType()->isArithmeticType() &&
5674 rex->getType()->isArithmeticType()) {
5675 if (CompLHSTy) *CompLHSTy = compType;
Steve Naroff9f5fa9b2007-08-24 19:07:16 +00005676 return compType;
Eli Friedmanab3a8522009-03-28 01:22:36 +00005677 }
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00005678
Eli Friedmand72d16e2008-05-18 18:08:51 +00005679 // Put any potential pointer into PExp
5680 Expr* PExp = lex, *IExp = rex;
Steve Naroff58f9f2c2009-07-14 18:25:06 +00005681 if (IExp->getType()->isAnyPointerType())
Eli Friedmand72d16e2008-05-18 18:08:51 +00005682 std::swap(PExp, IExp);
5683
Steve Naroff58f9f2c2009-07-14 18:25:06 +00005684 if (PExp->getType()->isAnyPointerType()) {
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005685
Eli Friedmand72d16e2008-05-18 18:08:51 +00005686 if (IExp->getType()->isIntegerType()) {
Steve Naroff760e3c42009-07-13 21:20:41 +00005687 QualType PointeeTy = PExp->getType()->getPointeeType();
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005688
Chris Lattnerb5f15622009-04-24 23:50:08 +00005689 // Check for arithmetic on pointers to incomplete types.
5690 if (PointeeTy->isVoidType()) {
Douglas Gregore7450f52009-03-24 19:52:54 +00005691 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
5692 Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_pointer_arith_void_type)
Chris Lattnerfa25bbb2008-11-19 05:08:23 +00005693 << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
Douglas Gregor4ec339f2009-01-19 19:26:10 +00005694 return QualType();
Eli Friedmand72d16e2008-05-18 18:08:51 +00005695 }
Douglas Gregore7450f52009-03-24 19:52:54 +00005696
5697 // GNU extension: arithmetic on pointer to void
5698 Diag(Loc, diag::ext_gnu_void_ptr)
5699 << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
Chris Lattnerb5f15622009-04-24 23:50:08 +00005700 } else if (PointeeTy->isFunctionType()) {
Douglas Gregore7450f52009-03-24 19:52:54 +00005701 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
5702 Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_pointer_arith_function_type)
5703 << lex->getType() << lex->getSourceRange();
5704 return QualType();
5705 }
5706
5707 // GNU extension: arithmetic on pointer to function
5708 Diag(Loc, diag::ext_gnu_ptr_func_arith)
5709 << lex->getType() << lex->getSourceRange();
Steve Naroff9deaeca2009-07-13 21:32:29 +00005710 } else {
Steve Naroff760e3c42009-07-13 21:20:41 +00005711 // Check if we require a complete type.
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005712 if (((PExp->getType()->isPointerType() &&
Steve Naroff9deaeca2009-07-13 21:32:29 +00005713 !PExp->getType()->isDependentType()) ||
Steve Naroff760e3c42009-07-13 21:20:41 +00005714 PExp->getType()->isObjCObjectPointerType()) &&
5715 RequireCompleteType(Loc, PointeeTy,
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005716 PDiag(diag::err_typecheck_arithmetic_incomplete_type)
5717 << PExp->getSourceRange()
Anders Carlssond497ba72009-08-26 22:59:12 +00005718 << PExp->getType()))
Steve Naroff760e3c42009-07-13 21:20:41 +00005719 return QualType();
5720 }
Chris Lattnerb5f15622009-04-24 23:50:08 +00005721 // Diagnose bad cases where we step over interface counts.
John McCallc12c5bb2010-05-15 11:32:37 +00005722 if (PointeeTy->isObjCObjectType() && LangOpts.ObjCNonFragileABI) {
Chris Lattnerb5f15622009-04-24 23:50:08 +00005723 Diag(Loc, diag::err_arithmetic_nonfragile_interface)
5724 << PointeeTy << PExp->getSourceRange();
5725 return QualType();
5726 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005727
Eli Friedmanab3a8522009-03-28 01:22:36 +00005728 if (CompLHSTy) {
Eli Friedman04e83572009-08-20 04:21:42 +00005729 QualType LHSTy = Context.isPromotableBitField(lex);
5730 if (LHSTy.isNull()) {
5731 LHSTy = lex->getType();
5732 if (LHSTy->isPromotableIntegerType())
5733 LHSTy = Context.getPromotedIntegerType(LHSTy);
Douglas Gregor2d833e32009-05-02 00:36:19 +00005734 }
Eli Friedmanab3a8522009-03-28 01:22:36 +00005735 *CompLHSTy = LHSTy;
5736 }
Eli Friedmand72d16e2008-05-18 18:08:51 +00005737 return PExp->getType();
5738 }
5739 }
5740
Chris Lattner29a1cfb2008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005741 return InvalidOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00005742}
5743
Chris Lattnereca7be62008-04-07 05:30:13 +00005744// C99 6.5.6
5745QualType Sema::CheckSubtractionOperands(Expr *&lex, Expr *&rex,
Eli Friedmanab3a8522009-03-28 01:22:36 +00005746 SourceLocation Loc, QualType* CompLHSTy) {
5747 if (lex->getType()->isVectorType() || rex->getType()->isVectorType()) {
5748 QualType compType = CheckVectorOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
5749 if (CompLHSTy) *CompLHSTy = compType;
5750 return compType;
5751 }
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005752
Eli Friedmanab3a8522009-03-28 01:22:36 +00005753 QualType compType = UsualArithmeticConversions(lex, rex, CompLHSTy);
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005754
Chris Lattner6e4ab612007-12-09 21:53:25 +00005755 // Enforce type constraints: C99 6.5.6p3.
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005756
Chris Lattner6e4ab612007-12-09 21:53:25 +00005757 // Handle the common case first (both operands are arithmetic).
Mike Stumpaf199f32009-05-07 18:43:07 +00005758 if (lex->getType()->isArithmeticType()
5759 && rex->getType()->isArithmeticType()) {
Eli Friedmanab3a8522009-03-28 01:22:36 +00005760 if (CompLHSTy) *CompLHSTy = compType;
Steve Naroff9f5fa9b2007-08-24 19:07:16 +00005761 return compType;
Eli Friedmanab3a8522009-03-28 01:22:36 +00005762 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005763
Chris Lattner6e4ab612007-12-09 21:53:25 +00005764 // Either ptr - int or ptr - ptr.
Steve Naroff58f9f2c2009-07-14 18:25:06 +00005765 if (lex->getType()->isAnyPointerType()) {
Steve Naroff430ee5a2009-07-13 17:19:15 +00005766 QualType lpointee = lex->getType()->getPointeeType();
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005767
Douglas Gregore7450f52009-03-24 19:52:54 +00005768 // The LHS must be an completely-defined object type.
Douglas Gregorc983b862009-01-23 00:36:41 +00005769
Douglas Gregore7450f52009-03-24 19:52:54 +00005770 bool ComplainAboutVoid = false;
5771 Expr *ComplainAboutFunc = 0;
5772 if (lpointee->isVoidType()) {
5773 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
5774 Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_pointer_arith_void_type)
5775 << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
5776 return QualType();
5777 }
5778
5779 // GNU C extension: arithmetic on pointer to void
5780 ComplainAboutVoid = true;
5781 } else if (lpointee->isFunctionType()) {
5782 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
5783 Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_pointer_arith_function_type)
Chris Lattnerd1625842008-11-24 06:25:27 +00005784 << lex->getType() << lex->getSourceRange();
Chris Lattner6e4ab612007-12-09 21:53:25 +00005785 return QualType();
5786 }
Douglas Gregore7450f52009-03-24 19:52:54 +00005787
5788 // GNU C extension: arithmetic on pointer to function
5789 ComplainAboutFunc = lex;
5790 } else if (!lpointee->isDependentType() &&
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005791 RequireCompleteType(Loc, lpointee,
Anders Carlssond497ba72009-08-26 22:59:12 +00005792 PDiag(diag::err_typecheck_sub_ptr_object)
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005793 << lex->getSourceRange()
Anders Carlssond497ba72009-08-26 22:59:12 +00005794 << lex->getType()))
Douglas Gregore7450f52009-03-24 19:52:54 +00005795 return QualType();
Chris Lattner6e4ab612007-12-09 21:53:25 +00005796
Chris Lattnerb5f15622009-04-24 23:50:08 +00005797 // Diagnose bad cases where we step over interface counts.
John McCallc12c5bb2010-05-15 11:32:37 +00005798 if (lpointee->isObjCObjectType() && LangOpts.ObjCNonFragileABI) {
Chris Lattnerb5f15622009-04-24 23:50:08 +00005799 Diag(Loc, diag::err_arithmetic_nonfragile_interface)
5800 << lpointee << lex->getSourceRange();
5801 return QualType();
5802 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005803
Chris Lattner6e4ab612007-12-09 21:53:25 +00005804 // The result type of a pointer-int computation is the pointer type.
Douglas Gregore7450f52009-03-24 19:52:54 +00005805 if (rex->getType()->isIntegerType()) {
5806 if (ComplainAboutVoid)
5807 Diag(Loc, diag::ext_gnu_void_ptr)
5808 << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
5809 if (ComplainAboutFunc)
5810 Diag(Loc, diag::ext_gnu_ptr_func_arith)
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005811 << ComplainAboutFunc->getType()
Douglas Gregore7450f52009-03-24 19:52:54 +00005812 << ComplainAboutFunc->getSourceRange();
5813
Eli Friedmanab3a8522009-03-28 01:22:36 +00005814 if (CompLHSTy) *CompLHSTy = lex->getType();
Chris Lattner6e4ab612007-12-09 21:53:25 +00005815 return lex->getType();
Douglas Gregore7450f52009-03-24 19:52:54 +00005816 }
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005817
Chris Lattner6e4ab612007-12-09 21:53:25 +00005818 // Handle pointer-pointer subtractions.
Ted Kremenek6217b802009-07-29 21:53:49 +00005819 if (const PointerType *RHSPTy = rex->getType()->getAs<PointerType>()) {
Eli Friedman8e54ad02008-02-08 01:19:44 +00005820 QualType rpointee = RHSPTy->getPointeeType();
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005821
Douglas Gregore7450f52009-03-24 19:52:54 +00005822 // RHS must be a completely-type object type.
5823 // Handle the GNU void* extension.
5824 if (rpointee->isVoidType()) {
5825 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
5826 Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_pointer_arith_void_type)
5827 << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
5828 return QualType();
5829 }
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005830
Douglas Gregore7450f52009-03-24 19:52:54 +00005831 ComplainAboutVoid = true;
5832 } else if (rpointee->isFunctionType()) {
5833 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
5834 Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_pointer_arith_function_type)
Chris Lattnerd1625842008-11-24 06:25:27 +00005835 << rex->getType() << rex->getSourceRange();
Chris Lattner6e4ab612007-12-09 21:53:25 +00005836 return QualType();
5837 }
Douglas Gregore7450f52009-03-24 19:52:54 +00005838
5839 // GNU extension: arithmetic on pointer to function
5840 if (!ComplainAboutFunc)
5841 ComplainAboutFunc = rex;
5842 } else if (!rpointee->isDependentType() &&
5843 RequireCompleteType(Loc, rpointee,
Anders Carlssond497ba72009-08-26 22:59:12 +00005844 PDiag(diag::err_typecheck_sub_ptr_object)
5845 << rex->getSourceRange()
5846 << rex->getType()))
Douglas Gregore7450f52009-03-24 19:52:54 +00005847 return QualType();
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005848
Eli Friedman88d936b2009-05-16 13:54:38 +00005849 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
5850 // Pointee types must be the same: C++ [expr.add]
5851 if (!Context.hasSameUnqualifiedType(lpointee, rpointee)) {
5852 Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_sub_ptr_compatible)
5853 << lex->getType() << rex->getType()
5854 << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
5855 return QualType();
5856 }
5857 } else {
5858 // Pointee types must be compatible C99 6.5.6p3
5859 if (!Context.typesAreCompatible(
5860 Context.getCanonicalType(lpointee).getUnqualifiedType(),
5861 Context.getCanonicalType(rpointee).getUnqualifiedType())) {
5862 Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_sub_ptr_compatible)
5863 << lex->getType() << rex->getType()
5864 << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
5865 return QualType();
5866 }
Chris Lattner6e4ab612007-12-09 21:53:25 +00005867 }
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005868
Douglas Gregore7450f52009-03-24 19:52:54 +00005869 if (ComplainAboutVoid)
5870 Diag(Loc, diag::ext_gnu_void_ptr)
5871 << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
5872 if (ComplainAboutFunc)
5873 Diag(Loc, diag::ext_gnu_ptr_func_arith)
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00005874 << ComplainAboutFunc->getType()
Douglas Gregore7450f52009-03-24 19:52:54 +00005875 << ComplainAboutFunc->getSourceRange();
Eli Friedmanab3a8522009-03-28 01:22:36 +00005876
5877 if (CompLHSTy) *CompLHSTy = lex->getType();
Chris Lattner6e4ab612007-12-09 21:53:25 +00005878 return Context.getPointerDiffType();
5879 }
5880 }
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005881
Chris Lattner29a1cfb2008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005882 return InvalidOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00005883}
5884
Douglas Gregor1274ccd2010-10-08 23:50:27 +00005885static bool isScopedEnumerationType(QualType T) {
5886 if (const EnumType *ET = dyn_cast<EnumType>(T))
5887 return ET->getDecl()->isScoped();
5888 return false;
5889}
5890
Chris Lattnereca7be62008-04-07 05:30:13 +00005891// C99 6.5.7
Chris Lattner29a1cfb2008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005892QualType Sema::CheckShiftOperands(Expr *&lex, Expr *&rex, SourceLocation Loc,
Chris Lattnereca7be62008-04-07 05:30:13 +00005893 bool isCompAssign) {
Chris Lattnerca5eede2007-12-12 05:47:28 +00005894 // C99 6.5.7p2: Each of the operands shall have integer type.
Douglas Gregorf6094622010-07-23 15:58:24 +00005895 if (!lex->getType()->hasIntegerRepresentation() ||
5896 !rex->getType()->hasIntegerRepresentation())
Chris Lattner29a1cfb2008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005897 return InvalidOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005898
Douglas Gregor1274ccd2010-10-08 23:50:27 +00005899 // C++0x: Don't allow scoped enums. FIXME: Use something better than
5900 // hasIntegerRepresentation() above instead of this.
5901 if (isScopedEnumerationType(lex->getType()) ||
5902 isScopedEnumerationType(rex->getType())) {
5903 return InvalidOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
5904 }
5905
Nate Begeman2207d792009-10-25 02:26:48 +00005906 // Vector shifts promote their scalar inputs to vector type.
5907 if (lex->getType()->isVectorType() || rex->getType()->isVectorType())
5908 return CheckVectorOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
5909
Chris Lattnerca5eede2007-12-12 05:47:28 +00005910 // Shifts don't perform usual arithmetic conversions, they just do integer
5911 // promotions on each operand. C99 6.5.7p3
Eli Friedman04e83572009-08-20 04:21:42 +00005912 QualType LHSTy = Context.isPromotableBitField(lex);
5913 if (LHSTy.isNull()) {
5914 LHSTy = lex->getType();
5915 if (LHSTy->isPromotableIntegerType())
5916 LHSTy = Context.getPromotedIntegerType(LHSTy);
Douglas Gregor2d833e32009-05-02 00:36:19 +00005917 }
Chris Lattner1dcf2c82007-12-13 07:28:16 +00005918 if (!isCompAssign)
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00005919 ImpCastExprToType(lex, LHSTy, CK_IntegralCast);
Eli Friedmanab3a8522009-03-28 01:22:36 +00005920
Chris Lattnerca5eede2007-12-12 05:47:28 +00005921 UsualUnaryConversions(rex);
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005922
Ryan Flynnd0439682009-08-07 16:20:20 +00005923 // Sanity-check shift operands
5924 llvm::APSInt Right;
5925 // Check right/shifter operand
Daniel Dunbar3f180c62009-09-17 06:31:27 +00005926 if (!rex->isValueDependent() &&
5927 rex->isIntegerConstantExpr(Right, Context)) {
Ryan Flynn8045c732009-08-08 19:18:23 +00005928 if (Right.isNegative())
Ryan Flynnd0439682009-08-07 16:20:20 +00005929 Diag(Loc, diag::warn_shift_negative) << rex->getSourceRange();
5930 else {
5931 llvm::APInt LeftBits(Right.getBitWidth(),
5932 Context.getTypeSize(lex->getType()));
5933 if (Right.uge(LeftBits))
5934 Diag(Loc, diag::warn_shift_gt_typewidth) << rex->getSourceRange();
5935 }
5936 }
5937
Chris Lattnerca5eede2007-12-12 05:47:28 +00005938 // "The type of the result is that of the promoted left operand."
Eli Friedmanab3a8522009-03-28 01:22:36 +00005939 return LHSTy;
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00005940}
5941
Chandler Carruth99919472010-07-10 12:30:03 +00005942static bool IsWithinTemplateSpecialization(Decl *D) {
5943 if (DeclContext *DC = D->getDeclContext()) {
5944 if (isa<ClassTemplateSpecializationDecl>(DC))
5945 return true;
5946 if (FunctionDecl *FD = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(DC))
5947 return FD->isFunctionTemplateSpecialization();
5948 }
5949 return false;
5950}
5951
Douglas Gregor0c6db942009-05-04 06:07:12 +00005952// C99 6.5.8, C++ [expr.rel]
Chris Lattner29a1cfb2008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005953QualType Sema::CheckCompareOperands(Expr *&lex, Expr *&rex, SourceLocation Loc,
Douglas Gregora86b8322009-04-06 18:45:53 +00005954 unsigned OpaqueOpc, bool isRelational) {
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00005955 BinaryOperatorKind Opc = (BinaryOperatorKind) OpaqueOpc;
Douglas Gregora86b8322009-04-06 18:45:53 +00005956
Chris Lattner02dd4b12009-12-05 05:40:13 +00005957 // Handle vector comparisons separately.
Nate Begemanbe2341d2008-07-14 18:02:46 +00005958 if (lex->getType()->isVectorType() || rex->getType()->isVectorType())
Chris Lattner29a1cfb2008-11-18 01:30:42 +00005959 return CheckVectorCompareOperands(lex, rex, Loc, isRelational);
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005960
Steve Naroffc80b4ee2007-07-16 21:54:35 +00005961 QualType lType = lex->getType();
5962 QualType rType = rex->getType();
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00005963
Douglas Gregor8eee1192010-06-22 22:12:46 +00005964 if (!lType->hasFloatingRepresentation() &&
Ted Kremenekfbcb0eb2010-09-16 00:03:01 +00005965 !(lType->isBlockPointerType() && isRelational) &&
5966 !lex->getLocStart().isMacroID() &&
5967 !rex->getLocStart().isMacroID()) {
Chris Lattner55660a72009-03-08 19:39:53 +00005968 // For non-floating point types, check for self-comparisons of the form
5969 // x == x, x != x, x < x, etc. These always evaluate to a constant, and
5970 // often indicate logic errors in the program.
Chandler Carruth64d092c2010-07-12 06:23:38 +00005971 //
5972 // NOTE: Don't warn about comparison expressions resulting from macro
5973 // expansion. Also don't warn about comparisons which are only self
5974 // comparisons within a template specialization. The warnings should catch
5975 // obvious cases in the definition of the template anyways. The idea is to
5976 // warn when the typed comparison operator will always evaluate to the same
5977 // result.
Chris Lattner55660a72009-03-08 19:39:53 +00005978 Expr *LHSStripped = lex->IgnoreParens();
5979 Expr *RHSStripped = rex->IgnoreParens();
Chandler Carruth99919472010-07-10 12:30:03 +00005980 if (DeclRefExpr* DRL = dyn_cast<DeclRefExpr>(LHSStripped)) {
Douglas Gregord64fdd02010-06-08 19:50:34 +00005981 if (DeclRefExpr* DRR = dyn_cast<DeclRefExpr>(RHSStripped)) {
Ted Kremenekfbcb0eb2010-09-16 00:03:01 +00005982 if (DRL->getDecl() == DRR->getDecl() &&
Chandler Carruth99919472010-07-10 12:30:03 +00005983 !IsWithinTemplateSpecialization(DRL->getDecl())) {
Douglas Gregord64fdd02010-06-08 19:50:34 +00005984 DiagRuntimeBehavior(Loc, PDiag(diag::warn_comparison_always)
5985 << 0 // self-
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00005986 << (Opc == BO_EQ
5987 || Opc == BO_LE
5988 || Opc == BO_GE));
Douglas Gregord64fdd02010-06-08 19:50:34 +00005989 } else if (lType->isArrayType() && rType->isArrayType() &&
5990 !DRL->getDecl()->getType()->isReferenceType() &&
5991 !DRR->getDecl()->getType()->isReferenceType()) {
5992 // what is it always going to eval to?
5993 char always_evals_to;
5994 switch(Opc) {
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00005995 case BO_EQ: // e.g. array1 == array2
Douglas Gregord64fdd02010-06-08 19:50:34 +00005996 always_evals_to = 0; // false
5997 break;
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00005998 case BO_NE: // e.g. array1 != array2
Douglas Gregord64fdd02010-06-08 19:50:34 +00005999 always_evals_to = 1; // true
6000 break;
6001 default:
6002 // best we can say is 'a constant'
6003 always_evals_to = 2; // e.g. array1 <= array2
6004 break;
6005 }
6006 DiagRuntimeBehavior(Loc, PDiag(diag::warn_comparison_always)
6007 << 1 // array
6008 << always_evals_to);
6009 }
6010 }
Chandler Carruth99919472010-07-10 12:30:03 +00006011 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006012
Chris Lattner55660a72009-03-08 19:39:53 +00006013 if (isa<CastExpr>(LHSStripped))
6014 LHSStripped = LHSStripped->IgnoreParenCasts();
6015 if (isa<CastExpr>(RHSStripped))
6016 RHSStripped = RHSStripped->IgnoreParenCasts();
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006017
Chris Lattner55660a72009-03-08 19:39:53 +00006018 // Warn about comparisons against a string constant (unless the other
6019 // operand is null), the user probably wants strcmp.
Douglas Gregora86b8322009-04-06 18:45:53 +00006020 Expr *literalString = 0;
6021 Expr *literalStringStripped = 0;
Chris Lattner55660a72009-03-08 19:39:53 +00006022 if ((isa<StringLiteral>(LHSStripped) || isa<ObjCEncodeExpr>(LHSStripped)) &&
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00006023 !RHSStripped->isNullPointerConstant(Context,
Douglas Gregorce940492009-09-25 04:25:58 +00006024 Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNull)) {
Douglas Gregora86b8322009-04-06 18:45:53 +00006025 literalString = lex;
6026 literalStringStripped = LHSStripped;
Mike Stumpac5fc7c2009-08-04 21:02:39 +00006027 } else if ((isa<StringLiteral>(RHSStripped) ||
6028 isa<ObjCEncodeExpr>(RHSStripped)) &&
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00006029 !LHSStripped->isNullPointerConstant(Context,
Douglas Gregorce940492009-09-25 04:25:58 +00006030 Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNull)) {
Douglas Gregora86b8322009-04-06 18:45:53 +00006031 literalString = rex;
6032 literalStringStripped = RHSStripped;
6033 }
6034
6035 if (literalString) {
6036 std::string resultComparison;
6037 switch (Opc) {
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006038 case BO_LT: resultComparison = ") < 0"; break;
6039 case BO_GT: resultComparison = ") > 0"; break;
6040 case BO_LE: resultComparison = ") <= 0"; break;
6041 case BO_GE: resultComparison = ") >= 0"; break;
6042 case BO_EQ: resultComparison = ") == 0"; break;
6043 case BO_NE: resultComparison = ") != 0"; break;
Douglas Gregora86b8322009-04-06 18:45:53 +00006044 default: assert(false && "Invalid comparison operator");
6045 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00006046
Douglas Gregord1e4d9b2010-01-12 23:18:54 +00006047 DiagRuntimeBehavior(Loc,
6048 PDiag(diag::warn_stringcompare)
6049 << isa<ObjCEncodeExpr>(literalStringStripped)
Ted Kremenek03a4bee2010-04-09 20:26:53 +00006050 << literalString->getSourceRange());
Douglas Gregora86b8322009-04-06 18:45:53 +00006051 }
Ted Kremenek3ca0bf22007-10-29 16:58:49 +00006052 }
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006053
Douglas Gregord64fdd02010-06-08 19:50:34 +00006054 // C99 6.5.8p3 / C99 6.5.9p4
6055 if (lex->getType()->isArithmeticType() && rex->getType()->isArithmeticType())
6056 UsualArithmeticConversions(lex, rex);
6057 else {
6058 UsualUnaryConversions(lex);
6059 UsualUnaryConversions(rex);
6060 }
6061
6062 lType = lex->getType();
6063 rType = rex->getType();
6064
Douglas Gregor447b69e2008-11-19 03:25:36 +00006065 // The result of comparisons is 'bool' in C++, 'int' in C.
Chris Lattner02dd4b12009-12-05 05:40:13 +00006066 QualType ResultTy = getLangOptions().CPlusPlus ? Context.BoolTy:Context.IntTy;
Douglas Gregor447b69e2008-11-19 03:25:36 +00006067
Chris Lattnera5937dd2007-08-26 01:18:55 +00006068 if (isRelational) {
6069 if (lType->isRealType() && rType->isRealType())
Douglas Gregor447b69e2008-11-19 03:25:36 +00006070 return ResultTy;
Chris Lattnera5937dd2007-08-26 01:18:55 +00006071 } else {
Ted Kremenek72cb1ae2007-10-29 17:13:39 +00006072 // Check for comparisons of floating point operands using != and ==.
Douglas Gregor8eee1192010-06-22 22:12:46 +00006073 if (lType->hasFloatingRepresentation())
Chris Lattner29a1cfb2008-11-18 01:30:42 +00006074 CheckFloatComparison(Loc,lex,rex);
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006075
Chris Lattnera5937dd2007-08-26 01:18:55 +00006076 if (lType->isArithmeticType() && rType->isArithmeticType())
Douglas Gregor447b69e2008-11-19 03:25:36 +00006077 return ResultTy;
Chris Lattnera5937dd2007-08-26 01:18:55 +00006078 }
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006079
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00006080 bool LHSIsNull = lex->isNullPointerConstant(Context,
Douglas Gregorce940492009-09-25 04:25:58 +00006081 Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNull);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00006082 bool RHSIsNull = rex->isNullPointerConstant(Context,
Douglas Gregorce940492009-09-25 04:25:58 +00006083 Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNull);
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006084
Douglas Gregor6e5122c2010-06-15 21:38:40 +00006085 // All of the following pointer-related warnings are GCC extensions, except
6086 // when handling null pointer constants.
Steve Naroff77878cc2007-08-27 04:08:11 +00006087 if (lType->isPointerType() && rType->isPointerType()) { // C99 6.5.8p2
Chris Lattnerbc896f52008-04-03 05:07:25 +00006088 QualType LCanPointeeTy =
Ted Kremenek6217b802009-07-29 21:53:49 +00006089 Context.getCanonicalType(lType->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType());
Chris Lattnerbc896f52008-04-03 05:07:25 +00006090 QualType RCanPointeeTy =
Ted Kremenek6217b802009-07-29 21:53:49 +00006091 Context.getCanonicalType(rType->getAs<PointerType>()->getPointeeType());
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006092
Douglas Gregor0c6db942009-05-04 06:07:12 +00006093 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
Eli Friedman3075e762009-08-23 00:27:47 +00006094 if (LCanPointeeTy == RCanPointeeTy)
6095 return ResultTy;
Fariborz Jahanian51874dd2009-12-21 18:19:17 +00006096 if (!isRelational &&
6097 (LCanPointeeTy->isVoidType() || RCanPointeeTy->isVoidType())) {
6098 // Valid unless comparison between non-null pointer and function pointer
6099 // This is a gcc extension compatibility comparison.
Douglas Gregor6e5122c2010-06-15 21:38:40 +00006100 // In a SFINAE context, we treat this as a hard error to maintain
6101 // conformance with the C++ standard.
Fariborz Jahanian51874dd2009-12-21 18:19:17 +00006102 if ((LCanPointeeTy->isFunctionType() || RCanPointeeTy->isFunctionType())
6103 && !LHSIsNull && !RHSIsNull) {
Douglas Gregor6e5122c2010-06-15 21:38:40 +00006104 Diag(Loc,
6105 isSFINAEContext()?
6106 diag::err_typecheck_comparison_of_fptr_to_void
6107 : diag::ext_typecheck_comparison_of_fptr_to_void)
Fariborz Jahanian51874dd2009-12-21 18:19:17 +00006108 << lType << rType << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
Douglas Gregor6e5122c2010-06-15 21:38:40 +00006109
6110 if (isSFINAEContext())
6111 return QualType();
6112
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006113 ImpCastExprToType(rex, lType, CK_BitCast);
Fariborz Jahanian51874dd2009-12-21 18:19:17 +00006114 return ResultTy;
6115 }
6116 }
Anders Carlsson0c8209e2010-11-04 03:17:43 +00006117
Douglas Gregor0c6db942009-05-04 06:07:12 +00006118 // C++ [expr.rel]p2:
6119 // [...] Pointer conversions (4.10) and qualification
6120 // conversions (4.4) are performed on pointer operands (or on
6121 // a pointer operand and a null pointer constant) to bring
6122 // them to their composite pointer type. [...]
6123 //
Douglas Gregor20b3e992009-08-24 17:42:35 +00006124 // C++ [expr.eq]p1 uses the same notion for (in)equality
Douglas Gregor0c6db942009-05-04 06:07:12 +00006125 // comparisons of pointers.
Douglas Gregorb2cb1cb2010-02-25 22:29:57 +00006126 bool NonStandardCompositeType = false;
Douglas Gregor8f00dcf2010-04-16 23:20:25 +00006127 QualType T = FindCompositePointerType(Loc, lex, rex,
Douglas Gregorb2cb1cb2010-02-25 22:29:57 +00006128 isSFINAEContext()? 0 : &NonStandardCompositeType);
Douglas Gregor0c6db942009-05-04 06:07:12 +00006129 if (T.isNull()) {
6130 Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_comparison_of_distinct_pointers)
6131 << lType << rType << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
6132 return QualType();
Douglas Gregorb2cb1cb2010-02-25 22:29:57 +00006133 } else if (NonStandardCompositeType) {
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00006134 Diag(Loc,
Douglas Gregorb2cb1cb2010-02-25 22:29:57 +00006135 diag::ext_typecheck_comparison_of_distinct_pointers_nonstandard)
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00006136 << lType << rType << T
Douglas Gregorb2cb1cb2010-02-25 22:29:57 +00006137 << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
Douglas Gregor0c6db942009-05-04 06:07:12 +00006138 }
6139
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006140 ImpCastExprToType(lex, T, CK_BitCast);
6141 ImpCastExprToType(rex, T, CK_BitCast);
Douglas Gregor0c6db942009-05-04 06:07:12 +00006142 return ResultTy;
6143 }
Eli Friedman3075e762009-08-23 00:27:47 +00006144 // C99 6.5.9p2 and C99 6.5.8p2
6145 if (Context.typesAreCompatible(LCanPointeeTy.getUnqualifiedType(),
6146 RCanPointeeTy.getUnqualifiedType())) {
6147 // Valid unless a relational comparison of function pointers
6148 if (isRelational && LCanPointeeTy->isFunctionType()) {
6149 Diag(Loc, diag::ext_typecheck_ordered_comparison_of_function_pointers)
6150 << lType << rType << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
6151 }
6152 } else if (!isRelational &&
6153 (LCanPointeeTy->isVoidType() || RCanPointeeTy->isVoidType())) {
6154 // Valid unless comparison between non-null pointer and function pointer
6155 if ((LCanPointeeTy->isFunctionType() || RCanPointeeTy->isFunctionType())
6156 && !LHSIsNull && !RHSIsNull) {
6157 Diag(Loc, diag::ext_typecheck_comparison_of_fptr_to_void)
6158 << lType << rType << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
6159 }
6160 } else {
6161 // Invalid
Chris Lattnerc9c7c4e2008-11-18 22:52:51 +00006162 Diag(Loc, diag::ext_typecheck_comparison_of_distinct_pointers)
Chris Lattnerd1625842008-11-24 06:25:27 +00006163 << lType << rType << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006164 }
Eli Friedman3075e762009-08-23 00:27:47 +00006165 if (LCanPointeeTy != RCanPointeeTy)
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006166 ImpCastExprToType(rex, lType, CK_BitCast);
Douglas Gregor447b69e2008-11-19 03:25:36 +00006167 return ResultTy;
Steve Naroffe77fd3c2007-08-16 21:48:38 +00006168 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006169
Sebastian Redl6e8ed162009-05-10 18:38:11 +00006170 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
Anders Carlsson0c8209e2010-11-04 03:17:43 +00006171 // Comparison of nullptr_t with itself.
6172 if (lType->isNullPtrType() && rType->isNullPtrType())
6173 return ResultTy;
6174
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006175 // Comparison of pointers with null pointer constants and equality
Douglas Gregor20b3e992009-08-24 17:42:35 +00006176 // comparisons of member pointers to null pointer constants.
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006177 if (RHSIsNull &&
Anders Carlsson0c8209e2010-11-04 03:17:43 +00006178 ((lType->isPointerType() || lType->isNullPtrType()) ||
Douglas Gregor20b3e992009-08-24 17:42:35 +00006179 (!isRelational && lType->isMemberPointerType()))) {
Douglas Gregor443c2122010-08-07 13:36:37 +00006180 ImpCastExprToType(rex, lType,
6181 lType->isMemberPointerType()
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006182 ? CK_NullToMemberPointer
John McCall404cd162010-11-13 01:35:44 +00006183 : CK_NullToPointer);
Sebastian Redl6e8ed162009-05-10 18:38:11 +00006184 return ResultTy;
6185 }
Douglas Gregor20b3e992009-08-24 17:42:35 +00006186 if (LHSIsNull &&
Anders Carlsson0c8209e2010-11-04 03:17:43 +00006187 ((rType->isPointerType() || rType->isNullPtrType()) ||
Douglas Gregor20b3e992009-08-24 17:42:35 +00006188 (!isRelational && rType->isMemberPointerType()))) {
Douglas Gregor443c2122010-08-07 13:36:37 +00006189 ImpCastExprToType(lex, rType,
6190 rType->isMemberPointerType()
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006191 ? CK_NullToMemberPointer
John McCall404cd162010-11-13 01:35:44 +00006192 : CK_NullToPointer);
Sebastian Redl6e8ed162009-05-10 18:38:11 +00006193 return ResultTy;
6194 }
Douglas Gregor20b3e992009-08-24 17:42:35 +00006195
6196 // Comparison of member pointers.
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006197 if (!isRelational &&
Douglas Gregor20b3e992009-08-24 17:42:35 +00006198 lType->isMemberPointerType() && rType->isMemberPointerType()) {
6199 // C++ [expr.eq]p2:
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006200 // In addition, pointers to members can be compared, or a pointer to
6201 // member and a null pointer constant. Pointer to member conversions
6202 // (4.11) and qualification conversions (4.4) are performed to bring
6203 // them to a common type. If one operand is a null pointer constant,
6204 // the common type is the type of the other operand. Otherwise, the
6205 // common type is a pointer to member type similar (4.4) to the type
6206 // of one of the operands, with a cv-qualification signature (4.4)
6207 // that is the union of the cv-qualification signatures of the operand
Douglas Gregor20b3e992009-08-24 17:42:35 +00006208 // types.
Douglas Gregorb2cb1cb2010-02-25 22:29:57 +00006209 bool NonStandardCompositeType = false;
Douglas Gregor8f00dcf2010-04-16 23:20:25 +00006210 QualType T = FindCompositePointerType(Loc, lex, rex,
Douglas Gregorb2cb1cb2010-02-25 22:29:57 +00006211 isSFINAEContext()? 0 : &NonStandardCompositeType);
Douglas Gregor20b3e992009-08-24 17:42:35 +00006212 if (T.isNull()) {
6213 Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_comparison_of_distinct_pointers)
Douglas Gregorb2cb1cb2010-02-25 22:29:57 +00006214 << lType << rType << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
Douglas Gregor20b3e992009-08-24 17:42:35 +00006215 return QualType();
Douglas Gregorb2cb1cb2010-02-25 22:29:57 +00006216 } else if (NonStandardCompositeType) {
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00006217 Diag(Loc,
Douglas Gregorb2cb1cb2010-02-25 22:29:57 +00006218 diag::ext_typecheck_comparison_of_distinct_pointers_nonstandard)
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00006219 << lType << rType << T
Douglas Gregorb2cb1cb2010-02-25 22:29:57 +00006220 << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
Douglas Gregor20b3e992009-08-24 17:42:35 +00006221 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006222
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006223 ImpCastExprToType(lex, T, CK_BitCast);
6224 ImpCastExprToType(rex, T, CK_BitCast);
Douglas Gregor20b3e992009-08-24 17:42:35 +00006225 return ResultTy;
6226 }
Sebastian Redl6e8ed162009-05-10 18:38:11 +00006227 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006228
Steve Naroff1c7d0672008-09-04 15:10:53 +00006229 // Handle block pointer types.
Mike Stumpdd3e1662009-05-07 03:14:14 +00006230 if (!isRelational && lType->isBlockPointerType() && rType->isBlockPointerType()) {
Ted Kremenek6217b802009-07-29 21:53:49 +00006231 QualType lpointee = lType->getAs<BlockPointerType>()->getPointeeType();
6232 QualType rpointee = rType->getAs<BlockPointerType>()->getPointeeType();
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006233
Steve Naroff1c7d0672008-09-04 15:10:53 +00006234 if (!LHSIsNull && !RHSIsNull &&
Eli Friedman26784c12009-06-08 05:08:54 +00006235 !Context.typesAreCompatible(lpointee, rpointee)) {
Chris Lattnerc9c7c4e2008-11-18 22:52:51 +00006236 Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_comparison_of_distinct_blocks)
Chris Lattnerd1625842008-11-24 06:25:27 +00006237 << lType << rType << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
Steve Naroff1c7d0672008-09-04 15:10:53 +00006238 }
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006239 ImpCastExprToType(rex, lType, CK_BitCast);
Douglas Gregor447b69e2008-11-19 03:25:36 +00006240 return ResultTy;
Steve Naroff1c7d0672008-09-04 15:10:53 +00006241 }
Steve Naroff59f53942008-09-28 01:11:11 +00006242 // Allow block pointers to be compared with null pointer constants.
Mike Stumpdd3e1662009-05-07 03:14:14 +00006243 if (!isRelational
6244 && ((lType->isBlockPointerType() && rType->isPointerType())
6245 || (lType->isPointerType() && rType->isBlockPointerType()))) {
Steve Naroff59f53942008-09-28 01:11:11 +00006246 if (!LHSIsNull && !RHSIsNull) {
Ted Kremenek6217b802009-07-29 21:53:49 +00006247 if (!((rType->isPointerType() && rType->getAs<PointerType>()
Mike Stumpdd3e1662009-05-07 03:14:14 +00006248 ->getPointeeType()->isVoidType())
Ted Kremenek6217b802009-07-29 21:53:49 +00006249 || (lType->isPointerType() && lType->getAs<PointerType>()
Mike Stumpdd3e1662009-05-07 03:14:14 +00006250 ->getPointeeType()->isVoidType())))
6251 Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_comparison_of_distinct_blocks)
6252 << lType << rType << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
Steve Naroff59f53942008-09-28 01:11:11 +00006253 }
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006254 ImpCastExprToType(rex, lType, CK_BitCast);
Douglas Gregor447b69e2008-11-19 03:25:36 +00006255 return ResultTy;
Steve Naroff59f53942008-09-28 01:11:11 +00006256 }
Steve Naroff1c7d0672008-09-04 15:10:53 +00006257
Steve Naroff14108da2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00006258 if ((lType->isObjCObjectPointerType() || rType->isObjCObjectPointerType())) {
Steve Naroffa5ad8632008-10-27 10:33:19 +00006259 if (lType->isPointerType() || rType->isPointerType()) {
Ted Kremenek6217b802009-07-29 21:53:49 +00006260 const PointerType *LPT = lType->getAs<PointerType>();
6261 const PointerType *RPT = rType->getAs<PointerType>();
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006262 bool LPtrToVoid = LPT ?
Steve Naroffa8069f12008-11-17 19:49:16 +00006263 Context.getCanonicalType(LPT->getPointeeType())->isVoidType() : false;
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006264 bool RPtrToVoid = RPT ?
Steve Naroffa8069f12008-11-17 19:49:16 +00006265 Context.getCanonicalType(RPT->getPointeeType())->isVoidType() : false;
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006266
Steve Naroffa8069f12008-11-17 19:49:16 +00006267 if (!LPtrToVoid && !RPtrToVoid &&
6268 !Context.typesAreCompatible(lType, rType)) {
Chris Lattnerc9c7c4e2008-11-18 22:52:51 +00006269 Diag(Loc, diag::ext_typecheck_comparison_of_distinct_pointers)
Chris Lattnerd1625842008-11-24 06:25:27 +00006270 << lType << rType << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
Steve Naroffa5ad8632008-10-27 10:33:19 +00006271 }
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006272 ImpCastExprToType(rex, lType, CK_BitCast);
Douglas Gregor447b69e2008-11-19 03:25:36 +00006273 return ResultTy;
Steve Naroff87f3b932008-10-20 18:19:10 +00006274 }
Steve Naroff14108da2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00006275 if (lType->isObjCObjectPointerType() && rType->isObjCObjectPointerType()) {
Chris Lattner6365e3e2009-08-22 18:58:31 +00006276 if (!Context.areComparableObjCPointerTypes(lType, rType))
Steve Naroff14108da2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00006277 Diag(Loc, diag::ext_typecheck_comparison_of_distinct_pointers)
6278 << lType << rType << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006279 ImpCastExprToType(rex, lType, CK_BitCast);
Douglas Gregor447b69e2008-11-19 03:25:36 +00006280 return ResultTy;
Steve Naroff20373222008-06-03 14:04:54 +00006281 }
Fariborz Jahanian7359f042007-12-20 01:06:58 +00006282 }
Douglas Gregor6e5122c2010-06-15 21:38:40 +00006283 if ((lType->isAnyPointerType() && rType->isIntegerType()) ||
6284 (lType->isIntegerType() && rType->isAnyPointerType())) {
Chris Lattner06c0f5b2009-08-23 00:03:44 +00006285 unsigned DiagID = 0;
Douglas Gregor6e5122c2010-06-15 21:38:40 +00006286 bool isError = false;
6287 if ((LHSIsNull && lType->isIntegerType()) ||
6288 (RHSIsNull && rType->isIntegerType())) {
6289 if (isRelational && !getLangOptions().CPlusPlus)
Chris Lattner06c0f5b2009-08-23 00:03:44 +00006290 DiagID = diag::ext_typecheck_ordered_comparison_of_pointer_and_zero;
Douglas Gregor6e5122c2010-06-15 21:38:40 +00006291 } else if (isRelational && !getLangOptions().CPlusPlus)
Chris Lattner06c0f5b2009-08-23 00:03:44 +00006292 DiagID = diag::ext_typecheck_ordered_comparison_of_pointer_integer;
Douglas Gregor6e5122c2010-06-15 21:38:40 +00006293 else if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
6294 DiagID = diag::err_typecheck_comparison_of_pointer_integer;
6295 isError = true;
6296 } else
Chris Lattner06c0f5b2009-08-23 00:03:44 +00006297 DiagID = diag::ext_typecheck_comparison_of_pointer_integer;
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006298
Chris Lattner06c0f5b2009-08-23 00:03:44 +00006299 if (DiagID) {
Chris Lattner6365e3e2009-08-22 18:58:31 +00006300 Diag(Loc, DiagID)
Chris Lattner149f1382009-06-30 06:24:05 +00006301 << lType << rType << lex->getSourceRange() << rex->getSourceRange();
Douglas Gregor6e5122c2010-06-15 21:38:40 +00006302 if (isError)
6303 return QualType();
Chris Lattner6365e3e2009-08-22 18:58:31 +00006304 }
Douglas Gregor6e5122c2010-06-15 21:38:40 +00006305
6306 if (lType->isIntegerType())
John McCall404cd162010-11-13 01:35:44 +00006307 ImpCastExprToType(lex, rType,
6308 LHSIsNull ? CK_NullToPointer : CK_IntegralToPointer);
Chris Lattner06c0f5b2009-08-23 00:03:44 +00006309 else
John McCall404cd162010-11-13 01:35:44 +00006310 ImpCastExprToType(rex, lType,
6311 RHSIsNull ? CK_NullToPointer : CK_IntegralToPointer);
Douglas Gregor447b69e2008-11-19 03:25:36 +00006312 return ResultTy;
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006313 }
Douglas Gregor6e5122c2010-06-15 21:38:40 +00006314
Steve Naroff39218df2008-09-04 16:56:14 +00006315 // Handle block pointers.
Mike Stumpaf199f32009-05-07 18:43:07 +00006316 if (!isRelational && RHSIsNull
6317 && lType->isBlockPointerType() && rType->isIntegerType()) {
John McCall404cd162010-11-13 01:35:44 +00006318 ImpCastExprToType(rex, lType, CK_NullToPointer);
Douglas Gregor447b69e2008-11-19 03:25:36 +00006319 return ResultTy;
Steve Naroff39218df2008-09-04 16:56:14 +00006320 }
Mike Stumpaf199f32009-05-07 18:43:07 +00006321 if (!isRelational && LHSIsNull
6322 && lType->isIntegerType() && rType->isBlockPointerType()) {
John McCall404cd162010-11-13 01:35:44 +00006323 ImpCastExprToType(lex, rType, CK_NullToPointer);
Douglas Gregor447b69e2008-11-19 03:25:36 +00006324 return ResultTy;
Steve Naroff39218df2008-09-04 16:56:14 +00006325 }
Chris Lattner29a1cfb2008-11-18 01:30:42 +00006326 return InvalidOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006327}
6328
Nate Begemanbe2341d2008-07-14 18:02:46 +00006329/// CheckVectorCompareOperands - vector comparisons are a clang extension that
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006330/// operates on extended vector types. Instead of producing an IntTy result,
Nate Begemanbe2341d2008-07-14 18:02:46 +00006331/// like a scalar comparison, a vector comparison produces a vector of integer
6332/// types.
6333QualType Sema::CheckVectorCompareOperands(Expr *&lex, Expr *&rex,
Chris Lattner29a1cfb2008-11-18 01:30:42 +00006334 SourceLocation Loc,
Nate Begemanbe2341d2008-07-14 18:02:46 +00006335 bool isRelational) {
6336 // Check to make sure we're operating on vectors of the same type and width,
6337 // Allowing one side to be a scalar of element type.
Chris Lattner29a1cfb2008-11-18 01:30:42 +00006338 QualType vType = CheckVectorOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
Nate Begemanbe2341d2008-07-14 18:02:46 +00006339 if (vType.isNull())
6340 return vType;
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006341
Nate Begemanbe2341d2008-07-14 18:02:46 +00006342 QualType lType = lex->getType();
6343 QualType rType = rex->getType();
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006344
Nate Begemanbe2341d2008-07-14 18:02:46 +00006345 // For non-floating point types, check for self-comparisons of the form
6346 // x == x, x != x, x < x, etc. These always evaluate to a constant, and
6347 // often indicate logic errors in the program.
Douglas Gregor8eee1192010-06-22 22:12:46 +00006348 if (!lType->hasFloatingRepresentation()) {
Nate Begemanbe2341d2008-07-14 18:02:46 +00006349 if (DeclRefExpr* DRL = dyn_cast<DeclRefExpr>(lex->IgnoreParens()))
6350 if (DeclRefExpr* DRR = dyn_cast<DeclRefExpr>(rex->IgnoreParens()))
6351 if (DRL->getDecl() == DRR->getDecl())
Douglas Gregord64fdd02010-06-08 19:50:34 +00006352 DiagRuntimeBehavior(Loc,
6353 PDiag(diag::warn_comparison_always)
6354 << 0 // self-
6355 << 2 // "a constant"
6356 );
Nate Begemanbe2341d2008-07-14 18:02:46 +00006357 }
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006358
Nate Begemanbe2341d2008-07-14 18:02:46 +00006359 // Check for comparisons of floating point operands using != and ==.
Douglas Gregor8eee1192010-06-22 22:12:46 +00006360 if (!isRelational && lType->hasFloatingRepresentation()) {
6361 assert (rType->hasFloatingRepresentation());
Chris Lattner29a1cfb2008-11-18 01:30:42 +00006362 CheckFloatComparison(Loc,lex,rex);
Nate Begemanbe2341d2008-07-14 18:02:46 +00006363 }
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006364
Nate Begemanbe2341d2008-07-14 18:02:46 +00006365 // Return the type for the comparison, which is the same as vector type for
6366 // integer vectors, or an integer type of identical size and number of
6367 // elements for floating point vectors.
Douglas Gregorf6094622010-07-23 15:58:24 +00006368 if (lType->hasIntegerRepresentation())
Nate Begemanbe2341d2008-07-14 18:02:46 +00006369 return lType;
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006370
John McCall183700f2009-09-21 23:43:11 +00006371 const VectorType *VTy = lType->getAs<VectorType>();
Nate Begemanbe2341d2008-07-14 18:02:46 +00006372 unsigned TypeSize = Context.getTypeSize(VTy->getElementType());
Nate Begeman59b5da62009-01-18 03:20:47 +00006373 if (TypeSize == Context.getTypeSize(Context.IntTy))
Nate Begemanbe2341d2008-07-14 18:02:46 +00006374 return Context.getExtVectorType(Context.IntTy, VTy->getNumElements());
Chris Lattnerd013aa12009-03-31 07:46:52 +00006375 if (TypeSize == Context.getTypeSize(Context.LongTy))
Nate Begeman59b5da62009-01-18 03:20:47 +00006376 return Context.getExtVectorType(Context.LongTy, VTy->getNumElements());
6377
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006378 assert(TypeSize == Context.getTypeSize(Context.LongLongTy) &&
Nate Begeman59b5da62009-01-18 03:20:47 +00006379 "Unhandled vector element size in vector compare");
Nate Begemanbe2341d2008-07-14 18:02:46 +00006380 return Context.getExtVectorType(Context.LongLongTy, VTy->getNumElements());
6381}
6382
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006383inline QualType Sema::CheckBitwiseOperands(
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006384 Expr *&lex, Expr *&rex, SourceLocation Loc, bool isCompAssign) {
Douglas Gregorf6094622010-07-23 15:58:24 +00006385 if (lex->getType()->isVectorType() || rex->getType()->isVectorType()) {
6386 if (lex->getType()->hasIntegerRepresentation() &&
6387 rex->getType()->hasIntegerRepresentation())
6388 return CheckVectorOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
6389
6390 return InvalidOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
6391 }
Steve Naroff90045e82007-07-13 23:32:42 +00006392
Steve Naroff9f5fa9b2007-08-24 19:07:16 +00006393 QualType compType = UsualArithmeticConversions(lex, rex, isCompAssign);
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006394
Douglas Gregor1274ccd2010-10-08 23:50:27 +00006395 if (lex->getType()->isIntegralOrUnscopedEnumerationType() &&
6396 rex->getType()->isIntegralOrUnscopedEnumerationType())
Steve Naroff9f5fa9b2007-08-24 19:07:16 +00006397 return compType;
Chris Lattner29a1cfb2008-11-18 01:30:42 +00006398 return InvalidOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006399}
6400
6401inline QualType Sema::CheckLogicalOperands( // C99 6.5.[13,14]
Chris Lattner90a8f272010-07-13 19:41:32 +00006402 Expr *&lex, Expr *&rex, SourceLocation Loc, unsigned Opc) {
6403
6404 // Diagnose cases where the user write a logical and/or but probably meant a
6405 // bitwise one. We do this when the LHS is a non-bool integer and the RHS
6406 // is a constant.
6407 if (lex->getType()->isIntegerType() && !lex->getType()->isBooleanType() &&
Eli Friedman787b0942010-07-27 19:14:53 +00006408 rex->getType()->isIntegerType() && !rex->isValueDependent() &&
Chris Lattner23ef3e42010-07-15 00:26:43 +00006409 // Don't warn in macros.
Chris Lattnerb7690b42010-07-24 01:10:11 +00006410 !Loc.isMacroID()) {
6411 // If the RHS can be constant folded, and if it constant folds to something
6412 // that isn't 0 or 1 (which indicate a potential logical operation that
6413 // happened to fold to true/false) then warn.
6414 Expr::EvalResult Result;
6415 if (rex->Evaluate(Result, Context) && !Result.HasSideEffects &&
6416 Result.Val.getInt() != 0 && Result.Val.getInt() != 1) {
6417 Diag(Loc, diag::warn_logical_instead_of_bitwise)
6418 << rex->getSourceRange()
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006419 << (Opc == BO_LAnd ? "&&" : "||")
6420 << (Opc == BO_LAnd ? "&" : "|");
Chris Lattnerb7690b42010-07-24 01:10:11 +00006421 }
6422 }
Chris Lattner90a8f272010-07-13 19:41:32 +00006423
Anders Carlssona4c98cd2009-11-23 21:47:44 +00006424 if (!Context.getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
6425 UsualUnaryConversions(lex);
6426 UsualUnaryConversions(rex);
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006427
Anders Carlssona4c98cd2009-11-23 21:47:44 +00006428 if (!lex->getType()->isScalarType() || !rex->getType()->isScalarType())
6429 return InvalidOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00006430
Anders Carlssona4c98cd2009-11-23 21:47:44 +00006431 return Context.IntTy;
Anders Carlsson04905012009-10-16 01:44:21 +00006432 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00006433
John McCall75f7c0f2010-06-04 00:29:51 +00006434 // The following is safe because we only use this method for
6435 // non-overloadable operands.
6436
Anders Carlssona4c98cd2009-11-23 21:47:44 +00006437 // C++ [expr.log.and]p1
6438 // C++ [expr.log.or]p1
John McCall75f7c0f2010-06-04 00:29:51 +00006439 // The operands are both contextually converted to type bool.
6440 if (PerformContextuallyConvertToBool(lex) ||
6441 PerformContextuallyConvertToBool(rex))
Anders Carlssona4c98cd2009-11-23 21:47:44 +00006442 return InvalidOperands(Loc, lex, rex);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00006443
Anders Carlssona4c98cd2009-11-23 21:47:44 +00006444 // C++ [expr.log.and]p2
6445 // C++ [expr.log.or]p2
6446 // The result is a bool.
6447 return Context.BoolTy;
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006448}
6449
Fariborz Jahaniand1fa6442009-01-12 19:55:42 +00006450/// IsReadonlyProperty - Verify that otherwise a valid l-value expression
6451/// is a read-only property; return true if so. A readonly property expression
6452/// depends on various declarations and thus must be treated specially.
6453///
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006454static bool IsReadonlyProperty(Expr *E, Sema &S) {
Fariborz Jahaniand1fa6442009-01-12 19:55:42 +00006455 if (E->getStmtClass() == Expr::ObjCPropertyRefExprClass) {
6456 const ObjCPropertyRefExpr* PropExpr = cast<ObjCPropertyRefExpr>(E);
6457 if (ObjCPropertyDecl *PDecl = PropExpr->getProperty()) {
Fariborz Jahanian8ac2d442010-10-14 16:04:05 +00006458 QualType BaseType = PropExpr->isSuperReceiver() ?
6459 PropExpr->getSuperType() :
6460 PropExpr->getBase()->getType();
6461
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006462 if (const ObjCObjectPointerType *OPT =
Steve Naroff14108da2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00006463 BaseType->getAsObjCInterfacePointerType())
6464 if (ObjCInterfaceDecl *IFace = OPT->getInterfaceDecl())
6465 if (S.isPropertyReadonly(PDecl, IFace))
6466 return true;
Fariborz Jahaniand1fa6442009-01-12 19:55:42 +00006467 }
6468 }
6469 return false;
6470}
6471
Chris Lattnerf67bd9f2008-11-18 01:22:49 +00006472/// CheckForModifiableLvalue - Verify that E is a modifiable lvalue. If not,
6473/// emit an error and return true. If so, return false.
6474static bool CheckForModifiableLvalue(Expr *E, SourceLocation Loc, Sema &S) {
Daniel Dunbar44e35f72009-04-15 00:08:05 +00006475 SourceLocation OrigLoc = Loc;
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006476 Expr::isModifiableLvalueResult IsLV = E->isModifiableLvalue(S.Context,
Daniel Dunbar44e35f72009-04-15 00:08:05 +00006477 &Loc);
Fariborz Jahaniand1fa6442009-01-12 19:55:42 +00006478 if (IsLV == Expr::MLV_Valid && IsReadonlyProperty(E, S))
6479 IsLV = Expr::MLV_ReadonlyProperty;
Chris Lattnerf67bd9f2008-11-18 01:22:49 +00006480 if (IsLV == Expr::MLV_Valid)
6481 return false;
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006482
Chris Lattnerf67bd9f2008-11-18 01:22:49 +00006483 unsigned Diag = 0;
6484 bool NeedType = false;
6485 switch (IsLV) { // C99 6.5.16p2
Chris Lattnerf67bd9f2008-11-18 01:22:49 +00006486 case Expr::MLV_ConstQualified: Diag = diag::err_typecheck_assign_const; break;
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006487 case Expr::MLV_ArrayType:
Chris Lattnerf67bd9f2008-11-18 01:22:49 +00006488 Diag = diag::err_typecheck_array_not_modifiable_lvalue;
6489 NeedType = true;
6490 break;
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006491 case Expr::MLV_NotObjectType:
Chris Lattnerf67bd9f2008-11-18 01:22:49 +00006492 Diag = diag::err_typecheck_non_object_not_modifiable_lvalue;
6493 NeedType = true;
6494 break;
Chris Lattnerca354fa2008-11-17 19:51:54 +00006495 case Expr::MLV_LValueCast:
Chris Lattnerf67bd9f2008-11-18 01:22:49 +00006496 Diag = diag::err_typecheck_lvalue_casts_not_supported;
6497 break;
Douglas Gregore873fb72010-02-16 21:39:57 +00006498 case Expr::MLV_Valid:
6499 llvm_unreachable("did not take early return for MLV_Valid");
Chris Lattner5cf216b2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00006500 case Expr::MLV_InvalidExpression:
Douglas Gregore873fb72010-02-16 21:39:57 +00006501 case Expr::MLV_MemberFunction:
6502 case Expr::MLV_ClassTemporary:
Chris Lattnerf67bd9f2008-11-18 01:22:49 +00006503 Diag = diag::err_typecheck_expression_not_modifiable_lvalue;
6504 break;
Chris Lattner5cf216b2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00006505 case Expr::MLV_IncompleteType:
6506 case Expr::MLV_IncompleteVoidType:
Douglas Gregor86447ec2009-03-09 16:13:40 +00006507 return S.RequireCompleteType(Loc, E->getType(),
Douglas Gregorfe6b2d42010-03-29 23:34:08 +00006508 S.PDiag(diag::err_typecheck_incomplete_type_not_modifiable_lvalue)
Anders Carlssonb7906612009-08-26 23:45:07 +00006509 << E->getSourceRange());
Chris Lattner5cf216b2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00006510 case Expr::MLV_DuplicateVectorComponents:
Chris Lattnerf67bd9f2008-11-18 01:22:49 +00006511 Diag = diag::err_typecheck_duplicate_vector_components_not_mlvalue;
6512 break;
Steve Naroff4f6a7d72008-09-26 14:41:28 +00006513 case Expr::MLV_NotBlockQualified:
Chris Lattnerf67bd9f2008-11-18 01:22:49 +00006514 Diag = diag::err_block_decl_ref_not_modifiable_lvalue;
6515 break;
Fariborz Jahanian5daf5702008-11-22 18:39:36 +00006516 case Expr::MLV_ReadonlyProperty:
6517 Diag = diag::error_readonly_property_assignment;
6518 break;
Fariborz Jahanianba8d2d62008-11-22 20:25:50 +00006519 case Expr::MLV_NoSetterProperty:
6520 Diag = diag::error_nosetter_property_assignment;
6521 break;
Fariborz Jahanian2514a302009-12-15 23:59:41 +00006522 case Expr::MLV_SubObjCPropertySetting:
6523 Diag = diag::error_no_subobject_property_setting;
6524 break;
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006525 }
Steve Naroffd1861fd2007-07-31 12:34:36 +00006526
Daniel Dunbar44e35f72009-04-15 00:08:05 +00006527 SourceRange Assign;
6528 if (Loc != OrigLoc)
6529 Assign = SourceRange(OrigLoc, OrigLoc);
Chris Lattnerf67bd9f2008-11-18 01:22:49 +00006530 if (NeedType)
Daniel Dunbar44e35f72009-04-15 00:08:05 +00006531 S.Diag(Loc, Diag) << E->getType() << E->getSourceRange() << Assign;
Chris Lattnerf67bd9f2008-11-18 01:22:49 +00006532 else
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006533 S.Diag(Loc, Diag) << E->getSourceRange() << Assign;
Chris Lattnerf67bd9f2008-11-18 01:22:49 +00006534 return true;
6535}
6536
6537
6538
6539// C99 6.5.16.1
Chris Lattner29a1cfb2008-11-18 01:30:42 +00006540QualType Sema::CheckAssignmentOperands(Expr *LHS, Expr *&RHS,
6541 SourceLocation Loc,
6542 QualType CompoundType) {
6543 // Verify that LHS is a modifiable lvalue, and emit error if not.
6544 if (CheckForModifiableLvalue(LHS, Loc, *this))
Chris Lattnerf67bd9f2008-11-18 01:22:49 +00006545 return QualType();
Chris Lattner29a1cfb2008-11-18 01:30:42 +00006546
6547 QualType LHSType = LHS->getType();
6548 QualType RHSType = CompoundType.isNull() ? RHS->getType() : CompoundType;
Chris Lattner5cf216b2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00006549 AssignConvertType ConvTy;
Chris Lattner29a1cfb2008-11-18 01:30:42 +00006550 if (CompoundType.isNull()) {
Fariborz Jahaniane2a901a2010-06-07 22:02:01 +00006551 QualType LHSTy(LHSType);
Chris Lattner2c156472008-08-21 18:04:13 +00006552 // Simple assignment "x = y".
Fariborz Jahanianc4e1a682010-09-14 23:02:38 +00006553 ConvertPropertyAssignment(LHS, RHS, LHSTy);
Fariborz Jahaniane2a901a2010-06-07 22:02:01 +00006554 ConvTy = CheckSingleAssignmentConstraints(LHSTy, RHS);
Fariborz Jahanianfa23c1d2009-01-13 23:34:40 +00006555 // Special case of NSObject attributes on c-style pointer types.
6556 if (ConvTy == IncompatiblePointer &&
6557 ((Context.isObjCNSObjectType(LHSType) &&
Steve Narofff4954562009-07-16 15:41:00 +00006558 RHSType->isObjCObjectPointerType()) ||
Fariborz Jahanianfa23c1d2009-01-13 23:34:40 +00006559 (Context.isObjCNSObjectType(RHSType) &&
Steve Narofff4954562009-07-16 15:41:00 +00006560 LHSType->isObjCObjectPointerType())))
Fariborz Jahanianfa23c1d2009-01-13 23:34:40 +00006561 ConvTy = Compatible;
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006562
Chris Lattner2c156472008-08-21 18:04:13 +00006563 // If the RHS is a unary plus or minus, check to see if they = and + are
6564 // right next to each other. If so, the user may have typo'd "x =+ 4"
6565 // instead of "x += 4".
Chris Lattner29a1cfb2008-11-18 01:30:42 +00006566 Expr *RHSCheck = RHS;
Chris Lattner2c156472008-08-21 18:04:13 +00006567 if (ImplicitCastExpr *ICE = dyn_cast<ImplicitCastExpr>(RHSCheck))
6568 RHSCheck = ICE->getSubExpr();
6569 if (UnaryOperator *UO = dyn_cast<UnaryOperator>(RHSCheck)) {
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006570 if ((UO->getOpcode() == UO_Plus ||
6571 UO->getOpcode() == UO_Minus) &&
Chris Lattner29a1cfb2008-11-18 01:30:42 +00006572 Loc.isFileID() && UO->getOperatorLoc().isFileID() &&
Chris Lattner2c156472008-08-21 18:04:13 +00006573 // Only if the two operators are exactly adjacent.
Chris Lattner399bd1b2009-03-08 06:51:10 +00006574 Loc.getFileLocWithOffset(1) == UO->getOperatorLoc() &&
6575 // And there is a space or other character before the subexpr of the
6576 // unary +/-. We don't want to warn on "x=-1".
Chris Lattner3e872092009-03-09 07:11:10 +00006577 Loc.getFileLocWithOffset(2) != UO->getSubExpr()->getLocStart() &&
6578 UO->getSubExpr()->getLocStart().isFileID()) {
Chris Lattnerd3a94e22008-11-20 06:06:08 +00006579 Diag(Loc, diag::warn_not_compound_assign)
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006580 << (UO->getOpcode() == UO_Plus ? "+" : "-")
Chris Lattnerd3a94e22008-11-20 06:06:08 +00006581 << SourceRange(UO->getOperatorLoc(), UO->getOperatorLoc());
Chris Lattner399bd1b2009-03-08 06:51:10 +00006582 }
Chris Lattner2c156472008-08-21 18:04:13 +00006583 }
6584 } else {
6585 // Compound assignment "x += y"
Eli Friedman623712b2009-05-16 05:56:02 +00006586 ConvTy = CheckAssignmentConstraints(LHSType, RHSType);
Chris Lattner2c156472008-08-21 18:04:13 +00006587 }
Chris Lattner5cf216b2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00006588
Chris Lattner29a1cfb2008-11-18 01:30:42 +00006589 if (DiagnoseAssignmentResult(ConvTy, Loc, LHSType, RHSType,
Douglas Gregor68647482009-12-16 03:45:30 +00006590 RHS, AA_Assigning))
Chris Lattner5cf216b2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00006591 return QualType();
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006592
Chris Lattner8b5dec32010-07-07 06:14:23 +00006593
6594 // Check to see if the destination operand is a dereferenced null pointer. If
6595 // so, and if not volatile-qualified, this is undefined behavior that the
6596 // optimizer will delete, so warn about it. People sometimes try to use this
6597 // to get a deterministic trap and are surprised by clang's behavior. This
6598 // only handles the pattern "*null = whatever", which is a very syntactic
6599 // check.
6600 if (UnaryOperator *UO = dyn_cast<UnaryOperator>(LHS->IgnoreParenCasts()))
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006601 if (UO->getOpcode() == UO_Deref &&
Chris Lattner8b5dec32010-07-07 06:14:23 +00006602 UO->getSubExpr()->IgnoreParenCasts()->
6603 isNullPointerConstant(Context, Expr::NPC_ValueDependentIsNotNull) &&
6604 !UO->getType().isVolatileQualified()) {
6605 Diag(UO->getOperatorLoc(), diag::warn_indirection_through_null)
6606 << UO->getSubExpr()->getSourceRange();
6607 Diag(UO->getOperatorLoc(), diag::note_indirection_through_null);
6608 }
6609
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006610 // C99 6.5.16p3: The type of an assignment expression is the type of the
6611 // left operand unless the left operand has qualified type, in which case
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006612 // it is the unqualified version of the type of the left operand.
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006613 // C99 6.5.16.1p2: In simple assignment, the value of the right operand
6614 // is converted to the type of the assignment expression (above).
Chris Lattner73d0d4f2007-08-30 17:45:32 +00006615 // C++ 5.17p1: the type of the assignment expression is that of its left
Douglas Gregor2d833e32009-05-02 00:36:19 +00006616 // operand.
John McCall2bf6f492010-10-12 02:19:57 +00006617 return (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus
6618 ? LHSType : LHSType.getUnqualifiedType());
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006619}
6620
Chris Lattner29a1cfb2008-11-18 01:30:42 +00006621// C99 6.5.17
6622QualType Sema::CheckCommaOperands(Expr *LHS, Expr *&RHS, SourceLocation Loc) {
Argyrios Kyrtzidis25973452010-06-30 10:53:14 +00006623 DiagnoseUnusedExprResult(LHS);
6624
Douglas Gregor7ad5d422010-11-09 21:07:58 +00006625 ExprResult LHSResult = CheckPlaceholderExpr(LHS, Loc);
6626 if (LHSResult.isInvalid())
6627 return QualType();
6628
6629 ExprResult RHSResult = CheckPlaceholderExpr(RHS, Loc);
6630 if (RHSResult.isInvalid())
6631 return QualType();
6632 RHS = RHSResult.take();
6633
John McCallcf2e5062010-10-12 07:14:40 +00006634 // C's comma performs lvalue conversion (C99 6.3.2.1) on both its
6635 // operands, but not unary promotions.
6636 // C++'s comma does not do any conversions at all (C++ [expr.comma]p1).
6637 if (!getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
6638 DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion(LHS);
6639 if (!LHS->getType()->isVoidType())
6640 RequireCompleteType(Loc, LHS->getType(), diag::err_incomplete_type);
Eli Friedmanb1d796d2009-03-23 00:24:07 +00006641
John McCallcf2e5062010-10-12 07:14:40 +00006642 DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion(RHS);
6643 if (!RHS->getType()->isVoidType())
6644 RequireCompleteType(Loc, RHS->getType(), diag::err_incomplete_type);
6645 }
Eli Friedmanb1d796d2009-03-23 00:24:07 +00006646
Chris Lattner29a1cfb2008-11-18 01:30:42 +00006647 return RHS->getType();
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006648}
6649
Steve Naroff49b45262007-07-13 16:58:59 +00006650/// CheckIncrementDecrementOperand - unlike most "Check" methods, this routine
6651/// doesn't need to call UsualUnaryConversions or UsualArithmeticConversions.
Sebastian Redle6d5a4a2008-12-20 09:35:34 +00006652QualType Sema::CheckIncrementDecrementOperand(Expr *Op, SourceLocation OpLoc,
Sean Hunt1e3f5ba2010-04-28 23:02:27 +00006653 bool isInc, bool isPrefix) {
Sebastian Redl28507842009-02-26 14:39:58 +00006654 if (Op->isTypeDependent())
6655 return Context.DependentTy;
6656
Chris Lattner3528d352008-11-21 07:05:48 +00006657 QualType ResType = Op->getType();
6658 assert(!ResType.isNull() && "no type for increment/decrement expression");
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006659
Sebastian Redle6d5a4a2008-12-20 09:35:34 +00006660 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus && ResType->isBooleanType()) {
6661 // Decrement of bool is not allowed.
6662 if (!isInc) {
6663 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_decrement_bool) << Op->getSourceRange();
6664 return QualType();
6665 }
6666 // Increment of bool sets it to true, but is deprecated.
6667 Diag(OpLoc, diag::warn_increment_bool) << Op->getSourceRange();
6668 } else if (ResType->isRealType()) {
Chris Lattner3528d352008-11-21 07:05:48 +00006669 // OK!
Steve Naroff58f9f2c2009-07-14 18:25:06 +00006670 } else if (ResType->isAnyPointerType()) {
6671 QualType PointeeTy = ResType->getPointeeType();
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006672
Chris Lattner3528d352008-11-21 07:05:48 +00006673 // C99 6.5.2.4p2, 6.5.6p2
Steve Naroff14108da2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00006674 if (PointeeTy->isVoidType()) {
Douglas Gregorc983b862009-01-23 00:36:41 +00006675 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
6676 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_pointer_arith_void_type)
6677 << Op->getSourceRange();
6678 return QualType();
6679 }
6680
6681 // Pointer to void is a GNU extension in C.
Chris Lattner3528d352008-11-21 07:05:48 +00006682 Diag(OpLoc, diag::ext_gnu_void_ptr) << Op->getSourceRange();
Steve Naroff14108da2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00006683 } else if (PointeeTy->isFunctionType()) {
Douglas Gregorc983b862009-01-23 00:36:41 +00006684 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
6685 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_pointer_arith_function_type)
6686 << Op->getType() << Op->getSourceRange();
6687 return QualType();
6688 }
6689
6690 Diag(OpLoc, diag::ext_gnu_ptr_func_arith)
Chris Lattnerd1625842008-11-24 06:25:27 +00006691 << ResType << Op->getSourceRange();
Steve Naroff14108da2009-07-10 23:34:53 +00006692 } else if (RequireCompleteType(OpLoc, PointeeTy,
Anders Carlssond497ba72009-08-26 22:59:12 +00006693 PDiag(diag::err_typecheck_arithmetic_incomplete_type)
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006694 << Op->getSourceRange()
Anders Carlssond497ba72009-08-26 22:59:12 +00006695 << ResType))
Douglas Gregor4ec339f2009-01-19 19:26:10 +00006696 return QualType();
Fariborz Jahanian9f8a04f2009-07-16 17:59:14 +00006697 // Diagnose bad cases where we step over interface counts.
John McCallc12c5bb2010-05-15 11:32:37 +00006698 else if (PointeeTy->isObjCObjectType() && LangOpts.ObjCNonFragileABI) {
Fariborz Jahanian9f8a04f2009-07-16 17:59:14 +00006699 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_arithmetic_nonfragile_interface)
6700 << PointeeTy << Op->getSourceRange();
6701 return QualType();
6702 }
Eli Friedman5b088a12010-01-03 00:20:48 +00006703 } else if (ResType->isAnyComplexType()) {
Chris Lattner3528d352008-11-21 07:05:48 +00006704 // C99 does not support ++/-- on complex types, we allow as an extension.
6705 Diag(OpLoc, diag::ext_integer_increment_complex)
Chris Lattnerd1625842008-11-24 06:25:27 +00006706 << ResType << Op->getSourceRange();
John McCall2cd11fe2010-10-12 02:09:17 +00006707 } else if (ResType->isPlaceholderType()) {
6708 ExprResult PR = CheckPlaceholderExpr(Op, OpLoc);
6709 if (PR.isInvalid()) return QualType();
6710 return CheckIncrementDecrementOperand(PR.take(), OpLoc, isInc, isPrefix);
Chris Lattner3528d352008-11-21 07:05:48 +00006711 } else {
6712 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_illegal_increment_decrement)
Douglas Gregor5cc07df2009-12-15 16:44:32 +00006713 << ResType << int(isInc) << Op->getSourceRange();
Chris Lattner3528d352008-11-21 07:05:48 +00006714 return QualType();
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006715 }
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006716 // At this point, we know we have a real, complex or pointer type.
Steve Naroffdd10e022007-08-23 21:37:33 +00006717 // Now make sure the operand is a modifiable lvalue.
Chris Lattner3528d352008-11-21 07:05:48 +00006718 if (CheckForModifiableLvalue(Op, OpLoc, *this))
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006719 return QualType();
Sean Hunt1e3f5ba2010-04-28 23:02:27 +00006720 // In C++, a prefix increment is the same type as the operand. Otherwise
6721 // (in C or with postfix), the increment is the unqualified type of the
6722 // operand.
6723 return isPrefix && getLangOptions().CPlusPlus
6724 ? ResType : ResType.getUnqualifiedType();
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006725}
6726
Fariborz Jahanianc4e1a682010-09-14 23:02:38 +00006727void Sema::ConvertPropertyAssignment(Expr *LHS, Expr *&RHS, QualType& LHSTy) {
6728 bool copyInit = false;
6729 if (const ObjCImplicitSetterGetterRefExpr *OISGE =
6730 dyn_cast<ObjCImplicitSetterGetterRefExpr>(LHS)) {
6731 // If using property-dot syntax notation for assignment, and there is a
6732 // setter, RHS expression is being passed to the setter argument. So,
6733 // type conversion (and comparison) is RHS to setter's argument type.
6734 if (const ObjCMethodDecl *SetterMD = OISGE->getSetterMethod()) {
6735 ObjCMethodDecl::param_iterator P = SetterMD->param_begin();
6736 LHSTy = (*P)->getType();
6737 }
6738 copyInit = (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus && LHSTy->isRecordType());
6739 }
6740 else
6741 copyInit = (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus && isa<ObjCPropertyRefExpr>(LHS) &&
6742 LHSTy->isRecordType());
6743 if (copyInit) {
6744 InitializedEntity Entity =
Fariborz Jahanian745da3a2010-09-24 17:30:16 +00006745 InitializedEntity::InitializeParameter(Context, LHSTy);
Fariborz Jahanianc4e1a682010-09-14 23:02:38 +00006746 Expr *Arg = RHS;
6747 ExprResult ArgE = PerformCopyInitialization(Entity, SourceLocation(),
6748 Owned(Arg));
6749 if (!ArgE.isInvalid())
Fariborz Jahanian745da3a2010-09-24 17:30:16 +00006750 RHS = ArgE.takeAs<Expr>();
Fariborz Jahanianc4e1a682010-09-14 23:02:38 +00006751 }
6752}
6753
6754
Anders Carlsson369dee42008-02-01 07:15:58 +00006755/// getPrimaryDecl - Helper function for CheckAddressOfOperand().
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006756/// This routine allows us to typecheck complex/recursive expressions
Daniel Dunbar1e76ce62008-08-04 20:02:37 +00006757/// where the declaration is needed for type checking. We only need to
6758/// handle cases when the expression references a function designator
6759/// or is an lvalue. Here are some examples:
6760/// - &(x) => x
6761/// - &*****f => f for f a function designator.
6762/// - &s.xx => s
6763/// - &s.zz[1].yy -> s, if zz is an array
6764/// - *(x + 1) -> x, if x is an array
6765/// - &"123"[2] -> 0
6766/// - & __real__ x -> x
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00006767static NamedDecl *getPrimaryDecl(Expr *E) {
Chris Lattnerf0467b32008-04-02 04:24:33 +00006768 switch (E->getStmtClass()) {
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006769 case Stmt::DeclRefExprClass:
Chris Lattnerf0467b32008-04-02 04:24:33 +00006770 return cast<DeclRefExpr>(E)->getDecl();
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006771 case Stmt::MemberExprClass:
Eli Friedman23d58ce2009-04-20 08:23:18 +00006772 // If this is an arrow operator, the address is an offset from
6773 // the base's value, so the object the base refers to is
6774 // irrelevant.
Chris Lattnerf0467b32008-04-02 04:24:33 +00006775 if (cast<MemberExpr>(E)->isArrow())
Chris Lattnerf82228f2007-11-16 17:46:48 +00006776 return 0;
Eli Friedman23d58ce2009-04-20 08:23:18 +00006777 // Otherwise, the expression refers to a part of the base
Chris Lattnerf0467b32008-04-02 04:24:33 +00006778 return getPrimaryDecl(cast<MemberExpr>(E)->getBase());
Anders Carlsson369dee42008-02-01 07:15:58 +00006779 case Stmt::ArraySubscriptExprClass: {
Mike Stump390b4cc2009-05-16 07:39:55 +00006780 // FIXME: This code shouldn't be necessary! We should catch the implicit
6781 // promotion of register arrays earlier.
Eli Friedman23d58ce2009-04-20 08:23:18 +00006782 Expr* Base = cast<ArraySubscriptExpr>(E)->getBase();
6783 if (ImplicitCastExpr* ICE = dyn_cast<ImplicitCastExpr>(Base)) {
6784 if (ICE->getSubExpr()->getType()->isArrayType())
6785 return getPrimaryDecl(ICE->getSubExpr());
6786 }
6787 return 0;
Anders Carlsson369dee42008-02-01 07:15:58 +00006788 }
Daniel Dunbar1e76ce62008-08-04 20:02:37 +00006789 case Stmt::UnaryOperatorClass: {
6790 UnaryOperator *UO = cast<UnaryOperator>(E);
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006791
Daniel Dunbar1e76ce62008-08-04 20:02:37 +00006792 switch(UO->getOpcode()) {
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006793 case UO_Real:
6794 case UO_Imag:
6795 case UO_Extension:
Daniel Dunbar1e76ce62008-08-04 20:02:37 +00006796 return getPrimaryDecl(UO->getSubExpr());
6797 default:
6798 return 0;
6799 }
6800 }
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006801 case Stmt::ParenExprClass:
Chris Lattnerf0467b32008-04-02 04:24:33 +00006802 return getPrimaryDecl(cast<ParenExpr>(E)->getSubExpr());
Chris Lattnerf82228f2007-11-16 17:46:48 +00006803 case Stmt::ImplicitCastExprClass:
Eli Friedman23d58ce2009-04-20 08:23:18 +00006804 // If the result of an implicit cast is an l-value, we care about
6805 // the sub-expression; otherwise, the result here doesn't matter.
Chris Lattnerf0467b32008-04-02 04:24:33 +00006806 return getPrimaryDecl(cast<ImplicitCastExpr>(E)->getSubExpr());
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006807 default:
6808 return 0;
6809 }
6810}
6811
6812/// CheckAddressOfOperand - The operand of & must be either a function
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006813/// designator or an lvalue designating an object. If it is an lvalue, the
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006814/// object cannot be declared with storage class register or be a bit field.
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006815/// Note: The usual conversions are *not* applied to the operand of the &
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006816/// operator (C99 6.3.2.1p[2-4]), and its result is never an lvalue.
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006817/// In C++, the operand might be an overloaded function name, in which case
Douglas Gregor904eed32008-11-10 20:40:00 +00006818/// we allow the '&' but retain the overloaded-function type.
John McCall9c72c602010-08-27 09:08:28 +00006819QualType Sema::CheckAddressOfOperand(Expr *OrigOp, SourceLocation OpLoc) {
6820 if (OrigOp->isTypeDependent())
Douglas Gregor9103bb22008-12-17 22:52:20 +00006821 return Context.DependentTy;
John McCall9c72c602010-08-27 09:08:28 +00006822 if (OrigOp->getType() == Context.OverloadTy)
6823 return Context.OverloadTy;
6824
John McCall2cd11fe2010-10-12 02:09:17 +00006825 ExprResult PR = CheckPlaceholderExpr(OrigOp, OpLoc);
6826 if (PR.isInvalid()) return QualType();
6827 OrigOp = PR.take();
6828
John McCall9c72c602010-08-27 09:08:28 +00006829 // Make sure to ignore parentheses in subsequent checks
6830 Expr *op = OrigOp->IgnoreParens();
Douglas Gregor9103bb22008-12-17 22:52:20 +00006831
Steve Naroff08f19672008-01-13 17:10:08 +00006832 if (getLangOptions().C99) {
6833 // Implement C99-only parts of addressof rules.
6834 if (UnaryOperator* uOp = dyn_cast<UnaryOperator>(op)) {
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006835 if (uOp->getOpcode() == UO_Deref)
Steve Naroff08f19672008-01-13 17:10:08 +00006836 // Per C99 6.5.3.2, the address of a deref always returns a valid result
6837 // (assuming the deref expression is valid).
6838 return uOp->getSubExpr()->getType();
6839 }
6840 // Technically, there should be a check for array subscript
6841 // expressions here, but the result of one is always an lvalue anyway.
6842 }
Douglas Gregor8e9bebd2008-10-21 16:13:35 +00006843 NamedDecl *dcl = getPrimaryDecl(op);
Chris Lattner28be73f2008-07-26 21:30:36 +00006844 Expr::isLvalueResult lval = op->isLvalue(Context);
Nuno Lopes6b6609f2008-12-16 22:59:47 +00006845
Chris Lattnerfd79a9d2010-07-05 19:17:26 +00006846 if (lval == Expr::LV_ClassTemporary) {
Douglas Gregore873fb72010-02-16 21:39:57 +00006847 Diag(OpLoc, isSFINAEContext()? diag::err_typecheck_addrof_class_temporary
6848 : diag::ext_typecheck_addrof_class_temporary)
6849 << op->getType() << op->getSourceRange();
6850 if (isSFINAEContext())
6851 return QualType();
John McCall9c72c602010-08-27 09:08:28 +00006852 } else if (isa<ObjCSelectorExpr>(op)) {
Chris Lattnerfd79a9d2010-07-05 19:17:26 +00006853 return Context.getPointerType(op->getType());
John McCall9c72c602010-08-27 09:08:28 +00006854 } else if (lval == Expr::LV_MemberFunction) {
6855 // If it's an instance method, make a member pointer.
6856 // The expression must have exactly the form &A::foo.
6857
6858 // If the underlying expression isn't a decl ref, give up.
6859 if (!isa<DeclRefExpr>(op)) {
6860 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_invalid_form_pointer_member_function)
6861 << OrigOp->getSourceRange();
6862 return QualType();
6863 }
6864 DeclRefExpr *DRE = cast<DeclRefExpr>(op);
6865 CXXMethodDecl *MD = cast<CXXMethodDecl>(DRE->getDecl());
6866
6867 // The id-expression was parenthesized.
6868 if (OrigOp != DRE) {
6869 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_parens_pointer_member_function)
6870 << OrigOp->getSourceRange();
6871
6872 // The method was named without a qualifier.
6873 } else if (!DRE->getQualifier()) {
6874 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_unqualified_pointer_member_function)
6875 << op->getSourceRange();
6876 }
6877
6878 return Context.getMemberPointerType(op->getType(),
6879 Context.getTypeDeclType(MD->getParent()).getTypePtr());
6880 } else if (lval != Expr::LV_Valid && lval != Expr::LV_IncompleteVoidType) {
Eli Friedman441cf102009-05-16 23:27:50 +00006881 // C99 6.5.3.2p1
Eli Friedman23d58ce2009-04-20 08:23:18 +00006882 // The operand must be either an l-value or a function designator
Eli Friedman441cf102009-05-16 23:27:50 +00006883 if (!op->getType()->isFunctionType()) {
Chris Lattnerf82228f2007-11-16 17:46:48 +00006884 // FIXME: emit more specific diag...
Chris Lattnerdcd5ef12008-11-19 05:27:50 +00006885 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_invalid_lvalue_addrof)
6886 << op->getSourceRange();
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006887 return QualType();
6888 }
Douglas Gregor33bbbc52009-05-02 02:18:30 +00006889 } else if (op->getBitField()) { // C99 6.5.3.2p1
Eli Friedman23d58ce2009-04-20 08:23:18 +00006890 // The operand cannot be a bit-field
6891 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_address_of)
6892 << "bit-field" << op->getSourceRange();
Douglas Gregor86f19402008-12-20 23:49:58 +00006893 return QualType();
Anders Carlsson09380262010-01-31 17:18:49 +00006894 } else if (op->refersToVectorElement()) {
Eli Friedman23d58ce2009-04-20 08:23:18 +00006895 // The operand cannot be an element of a vector
Chris Lattnerd3a94e22008-11-20 06:06:08 +00006896 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_address_of)
Nate Begemanb104b1f2009-02-15 22:45:20 +00006897 << "vector element" << op->getSourceRange();
Steve Naroffbcb2b612008-02-29 23:30:25 +00006898 return QualType();
Fariborz Jahanian0337f212009-07-07 18:50:52 +00006899 } else if (isa<ObjCPropertyRefExpr>(op)) {
6900 // cannot take address of a property expression.
6901 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_address_of)
6902 << "property expression" << op->getSourceRange();
6903 return QualType();
Anders Carlsson1d524c32009-09-14 23:15:26 +00006904 } else if (ConditionalOperator *CO = dyn_cast<ConditionalOperator>(op)) {
6905 // FIXME: Can LHS ever be null here?
Anders Carlsson474e1022009-09-15 16:03:44 +00006906 if (!CheckAddressOfOperand(CO->getTrueExpr(), OpLoc).isNull())
6907 return CheckAddressOfOperand(CO->getFalseExpr(), OpLoc);
Steve Naroffbcb2b612008-02-29 23:30:25 +00006908 } else if (dcl) { // C99 6.5.3.2p1
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006909 // We have an lvalue with a decl. Make sure the decl is not declared
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006910 // with the register storage-class specifier.
6911 if (const VarDecl *vd = dyn_cast<VarDecl>(dcl)) {
Fariborz Jahanian4020f872010-08-24 22:21:48 +00006912 // in C++ it is not error to take address of a register
6913 // variable (c++03 7.1.1P3)
John McCalld931b082010-08-26 03:08:43 +00006914 if (vd->getStorageClass() == SC_Register &&
Fariborz Jahanian4020f872010-08-24 22:21:48 +00006915 !getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
Chris Lattnerd3a94e22008-11-20 06:06:08 +00006916 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_address_of)
6917 << "register variable" << op->getSourceRange();
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006918 return QualType();
6919 }
John McCallba135432009-11-21 08:51:07 +00006920 } else if (isa<FunctionTemplateDecl>(dcl)) {
Douglas Gregor904eed32008-11-10 20:40:00 +00006921 return Context.OverloadTy;
Anders Carlssonf9e48bd2009-07-08 21:45:58 +00006922 } else if (FieldDecl *FD = dyn_cast<FieldDecl>(dcl)) {
Douglas Gregor29882052008-12-10 21:26:49 +00006923 // Okay: we can take the address of a field.
Sebastian Redlebc07d52009-02-03 20:19:35 +00006924 // Could be a pointer to member, though, if there is an explicit
6925 // scope qualifier for the class.
Douglas Gregora2813ce2009-10-23 18:54:35 +00006926 if (isa<DeclRefExpr>(op) && cast<DeclRefExpr>(op)->getQualifier()) {
Sebastian Redlebc07d52009-02-03 20:19:35 +00006927 DeclContext *Ctx = dcl->getDeclContext();
Anders Carlssonf9e48bd2009-07-08 21:45:58 +00006928 if (Ctx && Ctx->isRecord()) {
6929 if (FD->getType()->isReferenceType()) {
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006930 Diag(OpLoc,
Anders Carlssonf9e48bd2009-07-08 21:45:58 +00006931 diag::err_cannot_form_pointer_to_member_of_reference_type)
6932 << FD->getDeclName() << FD->getType();
6933 return QualType();
6934 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00006935
Sebastian Redlebc07d52009-02-03 20:19:35 +00006936 return Context.getMemberPointerType(op->getType(),
6937 Context.getTypeDeclType(cast<RecordDecl>(Ctx)).getTypePtr());
Anders Carlssonf9e48bd2009-07-08 21:45:58 +00006938 }
Sebastian Redlebc07d52009-02-03 20:19:35 +00006939 }
Anders Carlsson196f7d02009-05-16 21:43:42 +00006940 } else if (!isa<FunctionDecl>(dcl))
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006941 assert(0 && "Unknown/unexpected decl type");
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006942 }
Sebastian Redl33b399a2009-02-04 21:23:32 +00006943
Eli Friedman441cf102009-05-16 23:27:50 +00006944 if (lval == Expr::LV_IncompleteVoidType) {
6945 // Taking the address of a void variable is technically illegal, but we
6946 // allow it in cases which are otherwise valid.
6947 // Example: "extern void x; void* y = &x;".
6948 Diag(OpLoc, diag::ext_typecheck_addrof_void) << op->getSourceRange();
6949 }
6950
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006951 // If the operand has type "type", the result has type "pointer to type".
Douglas Gregor8f70ddb2010-07-29 16:05:45 +00006952 if (op->getType()->isObjCObjectType())
6953 return Context.getObjCObjectPointerType(op->getType());
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006954 return Context.getPointerType(op->getType());
6955}
6956
Chris Lattnerfd79a9d2010-07-05 19:17:26 +00006957/// CheckIndirectionOperand - Type check unary indirection (prefix '*').
Chris Lattner22caddc2008-11-23 09:13:29 +00006958QualType Sema::CheckIndirectionOperand(Expr *Op, SourceLocation OpLoc) {
Sebastian Redl28507842009-02-26 14:39:58 +00006959 if (Op->isTypeDependent())
6960 return Context.DependentTy;
6961
Chris Lattner22caddc2008-11-23 09:13:29 +00006962 UsualUnaryConversions(Op);
Chris Lattnerfd79a9d2010-07-05 19:17:26 +00006963 QualType OpTy = Op->getType();
6964 QualType Result;
6965
6966 // Note that per both C89 and C99, indirection is always legal, even if OpTy
6967 // is an incomplete type or void. It would be possible to warn about
6968 // dereferencing a void pointer, but it's completely well-defined, and such a
6969 // warning is unlikely to catch any mistakes.
6970 if (const PointerType *PT = OpTy->getAs<PointerType>())
6971 Result = PT->getPointeeType();
6972 else if (const ObjCObjectPointerType *OPT =
6973 OpTy->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>())
6974 Result = OPT->getPointeeType();
John McCall2cd11fe2010-10-12 02:09:17 +00006975 else {
6976 ExprResult PR = CheckPlaceholderExpr(Op, OpLoc);
6977 if (PR.isInvalid()) return QualType();
6978 if (PR.take() != Op) return CheckIndirectionOperand(PR.take(), OpLoc);
6979 }
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00006980
Chris Lattnerfd79a9d2010-07-05 19:17:26 +00006981 if (Result.isNull()) {
6982 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_indirection_requires_pointer)
6983 << OpTy << Op->getSourceRange();
6984 return QualType();
6985 }
6986
6987 return Result;
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006988}
6989
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006990static inline BinaryOperatorKind ConvertTokenKindToBinaryOpcode(
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006991 tok::TokenKind Kind) {
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006992 BinaryOperatorKind Opc;
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00006993 switch (Kind) {
6994 default: assert(0 && "Unknown binop!");
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00006995 case tok::periodstar: Opc = BO_PtrMemD; break;
6996 case tok::arrowstar: Opc = BO_PtrMemI; break;
6997 case tok::star: Opc = BO_Mul; break;
6998 case tok::slash: Opc = BO_Div; break;
6999 case tok::percent: Opc = BO_Rem; break;
7000 case tok::plus: Opc = BO_Add; break;
7001 case tok::minus: Opc = BO_Sub; break;
7002 case tok::lessless: Opc = BO_Shl; break;
7003 case tok::greatergreater: Opc = BO_Shr; break;
7004 case tok::lessequal: Opc = BO_LE; break;
7005 case tok::less: Opc = BO_LT; break;
7006 case tok::greaterequal: Opc = BO_GE; break;
7007 case tok::greater: Opc = BO_GT; break;
7008 case tok::exclaimequal: Opc = BO_NE; break;
7009 case tok::equalequal: Opc = BO_EQ; break;
7010 case tok::amp: Opc = BO_And; break;
7011 case tok::caret: Opc = BO_Xor; break;
7012 case tok::pipe: Opc = BO_Or; break;
7013 case tok::ampamp: Opc = BO_LAnd; break;
7014 case tok::pipepipe: Opc = BO_LOr; break;
7015 case tok::equal: Opc = BO_Assign; break;
7016 case tok::starequal: Opc = BO_MulAssign; break;
7017 case tok::slashequal: Opc = BO_DivAssign; break;
7018 case tok::percentequal: Opc = BO_RemAssign; break;
7019 case tok::plusequal: Opc = BO_AddAssign; break;
7020 case tok::minusequal: Opc = BO_SubAssign; break;
7021 case tok::lesslessequal: Opc = BO_ShlAssign; break;
7022 case tok::greatergreaterequal: Opc = BO_ShrAssign; break;
7023 case tok::ampequal: Opc = BO_AndAssign; break;
7024 case tok::caretequal: Opc = BO_XorAssign; break;
7025 case tok::pipeequal: Opc = BO_OrAssign; break;
7026 case tok::comma: Opc = BO_Comma; break;
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00007027 }
7028 return Opc;
7029}
7030
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00007031static inline UnaryOperatorKind ConvertTokenKindToUnaryOpcode(
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00007032 tok::TokenKind Kind) {
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00007033 UnaryOperatorKind Opc;
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00007034 switch (Kind) {
7035 default: assert(0 && "Unknown unary op!");
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00007036 case tok::plusplus: Opc = UO_PreInc; break;
7037 case tok::minusminus: Opc = UO_PreDec; break;
7038 case tok::amp: Opc = UO_AddrOf; break;
7039 case tok::star: Opc = UO_Deref; break;
7040 case tok::plus: Opc = UO_Plus; break;
7041 case tok::minus: Opc = UO_Minus; break;
7042 case tok::tilde: Opc = UO_Not; break;
7043 case tok::exclaim: Opc = UO_LNot; break;
7044 case tok::kw___real: Opc = UO_Real; break;
7045 case tok::kw___imag: Opc = UO_Imag; break;
7046 case tok::kw___extension__: Opc = UO_Extension; break;
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00007047 }
7048 return Opc;
7049}
7050
Douglas Gregoreaebc752008-11-06 23:29:22 +00007051/// CreateBuiltinBinOp - Creates a new built-in binary operation with
7052/// operator @p Opc at location @c TokLoc. This routine only supports
7053/// built-in operations; ActOnBinOp handles overloaded operators.
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00007054ExprResult Sema::CreateBuiltinBinOp(SourceLocation OpLoc,
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00007055 unsigned Op,
7056 Expr *lhs, Expr *rhs) {
Eli Friedmanab3a8522009-03-28 01:22:36 +00007057 QualType ResultTy; // Result type of the binary operator.
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00007058 BinaryOperatorKind Opc = (BinaryOperatorKind) Op;
Eli Friedmanab3a8522009-03-28 01:22:36 +00007059 // The following two variables are used for compound assignment operators
7060 QualType CompLHSTy; // Type of LHS after promotions for computation
7061 QualType CompResultTy; // Type of computation result
Douglas Gregoreaebc752008-11-06 23:29:22 +00007062
7063 switch (Opc) {
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00007064 case BO_Assign:
Douglas Gregoreaebc752008-11-06 23:29:22 +00007065 ResultTy = CheckAssignmentOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, QualType());
7066 break;
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00007067 case BO_PtrMemD:
7068 case BO_PtrMemI:
Sebastian Redl22460502009-02-07 00:15:38 +00007069 ResultTy = CheckPointerToMemberOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc,
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00007070 Opc == BO_PtrMemI);
Sebastian Redl22460502009-02-07 00:15:38 +00007071 break;
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00007072 case BO_Mul:
7073 case BO_Div:
Chris Lattner7ef655a2010-01-12 21:23:57 +00007074 ResultTy = CheckMultiplyDivideOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, false,
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00007075 Opc == BO_Div);
Douglas Gregoreaebc752008-11-06 23:29:22 +00007076 break;
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00007077 case BO_Rem:
Douglas Gregoreaebc752008-11-06 23:29:22 +00007078 ResultTy = CheckRemainderOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc);
7079 break;
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00007080 case BO_Add:
Douglas Gregoreaebc752008-11-06 23:29:22 +00007081 ResultTy = CheckAdditionOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc);
7082 break;
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00007083 case BO_Sub:
Douglas Gregoreaebc752008-11-06 23:29:22 +00007084 ResultTy = CheckSubtractionOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc);
7085 break;
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00007086 case BO_Shl:
7087 case BO_Shr:
Douglas Gregoreaebc752008-11-06 23:29:22 +00007088 ResultTy = CheckShiftOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc);
7089 break;
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00007090 case BO_LE:
7091 case BO_LT:
7092 case BO_GE:
7093 case BO_GT:
Douglas Gregora86b8322009-04-06 18:45:53 +00007094 ResultTy = CheckCompareOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, Opc, true);
Douglas Gregoreaebc752008-11-06 23:29:22 +00007095 break;
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00007096 case BO_EQ:
7097 case BO_NE:
Douglas Gregora86b8322009-04-06 18:45:53 +00007098 ResultTy = CheckCompareOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, Opc, false);
Douglas Gregoreaebc752008-11-06 23:29:22 +00007099 break;
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00007100 case BO_And:
7101 case BO_Xor:
7102 case BO_Or:
Douglas Gregoreaebc752008-11-06 23:29:22 +00007103 ResultTy = CheckBitwiseOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc);
7104 break;
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00007105 case BO_LAnd:
7106 case BO_LOr:
Chris Lattner90a8f272010-07-13 19:41:32 +00007107 ResultTy = CheckLogicalOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, Opc);
Douglas Gregoreaebc752008-11-06 23:29:22 +00007108 break;
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00007109 case BO_MulAssign:
7110 case BO_DivAssign:
Chris Lattner7ef655a2010-01-12 21:23:57 +00007111 CompResultTy = CheckMultiplyDivideOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, true,
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00007112 Opc == BO_DivAssign);
Eli Friedmanab3a8522009-03-28 01:22:36 +00007113 CompLHSTy = CompResultTy;
7114 if (!CompResultTy.isNull())
7115 ResultTy = CheckAssignmentOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, CompResultTy);
Douglas Gregoreaebc752008-11-06 23:29:22 +00007116 break;
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00007117 case BO_RemAssign:
Eli Friedmanab3a8522009-03-28 01:22:36 +00007118 CompResultTy = CheckRemainderOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, true);
7119 CompLHSTy = CompResultTy;
7120 if (!CompResultTy.isNull())
7121 ResultTy = CheckAssignmentOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, CompResultTy);
Douglas Gregoreaebc752008-11-06 23:29:22 +00007122 break;
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00007123 case BO_AddAssign:
Eli Friedmanab3a8522009-03-28 01:22:36 +00007124 CompResultTy = CheckAdditionOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, &CompLHSTy);
7125 if (!CompResultTy.isNull())
7126 ResultTy = CheckAssignmentOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, CompResultTy);
Douglas Gregoreaebc752008-11-06 23:29:22 +00007127 break;
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00007128 case BO_SubAssign:
Eli Friedmanab3a8522009-03-28 01:22:36 +00007129 CompResultTy = CheckSubtractionOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, &CompLHSTy);
7130 if (!CompResultTy.isNull())
7131 ResultTy = CheckAssignmentOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, CompResultTy);
Douglas Gregoreaebc752008-11-06 23:29:22 +00007132 break;
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00007133 case BO_ShlAssign:
7134 case BO_ShrAssign:
Eli Friedmanab3a8522009-03-28 01:22:36 +00007135 CompResultTy = CheckShiftOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, true);
7136 CompLHSTy = CompResultTy;
7137 if (!CompResultTy.isNull())
7138 ResultTy = CheckAssignmentOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, CompResultTy);
Douglas Gregoreaebc752008-11-06 23:29:22 +00007139 break;
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00007140 case BO_AndAssign:
7141 case BO_XorAssign:
7142 case BO_OrAssign:
Eli Friedmanab3a8522009-03-28 01:22:36 +00007143 CompResultTy = CheckBitwiseOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, true);
7144 CompLHSTy = CompResultTy;
7145 if (!CompResultTy.isNull())
7146 ResultTy = CheckAssignmentOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc, CompResultTy);
Douglas Gregoreaebc752008-11-06 23:29:22 +00007147 break;
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00007148 case BO_Comma:
Douglas Gregoreaebc752008-11-06 23:29:22 +00007149 ResultTy = CheckCommaOperands(lhs, rhs, OpLoc);
7150 break;
7151 }
7152 if (ResultTy.isNull())
Sebastian Redlb8a6aca2009-01-19 22:31:54 +00007153 return ExprError();
Fariborz Jahanian57dae1a2010-08-16 21:51:12 +00007154 if (ResultTy->isObjCObjectType() && LangOpts.ObjCNonFragileABI) {
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00007155 if (Opc >= BO_Assign && Opc <= BO_OrAssign)
Fariborz Jahanian57dae1a2010-08-16 21:51:12 +00007156 Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_assignment_requires_nonfragile_object)
7157 << ResultTy;
7158 }
Eli Friedmanab3a8522009-03-28 01:22:36 +00007159 if (CompResultTy.isNull())
Steve Naroff6ece14c2009-01-21 00:14:39 +00007160 return Owned(new (Context) BinaryOperator(lhs, rhs, Opc, ResultTy, OpLoc));
7161 else
7162 return Owned(new (Context) CompoundAssignOperator(lhs, rhs, Opc, ResultTy,
Eli Friedmanab3a8522009-03-28 01:22:36 +00007163 CompLHSTy, CompResultTy,
7164 OpLoc));
Douglas Gregoreaebc752008-11-06 23:29:22 +00007165}
7166
Sebastian Redlaee3c932009-10-27 12:10:02 +00007167/// SuggestParentheses - Emit a diagnostic together with a fixit hint that wraps
7168/// ParenRange in parentheses.
Sebastian Redl6b169ac2009-10-26 17:01:32 +00007169static void SuggestParentheses(Sema &Self, SourceLocation Loc,
7170 const PartialDiagnostic &PD,
Douglas Gregor55b38842010-04-14 16:09:52 +00007171 const PartialDiagnostic &FirstNote,
7172 SourceRange FirstParenRange,
7173 const PartialDiagnostic &SecondNote,
Douglas Gregorfe6b2d42010-03-29 23:34:08 +00007174 SourceRange SecondParenRange) {
Douglas Gregor55b38842010-04-14 16:09:52 +00007175 Self.Diag(Loc, PD);
7176
7177 if (!FirstNote.getDiagID())
7178 return;
7179
7180 SourceLocation EndLoc = Self.PP.getLocForEndOfToken(FirstParenRange.getEnd());
7181 if (!FirstParenRange.getEnd().isFileID() || EndLoc.isInvalid()) {
7182 // We can't display the parentheses, so just return.
Sebastian Redl6b169ac2009-10-26 17:01:32 +00007183 return;
7184 }
7185
Douglas Gregor55b38842010-04-14 16:09:52 +00007186 Self.Diag(Loc, FirstNote)
7187 << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(FirstParenRange.getBegin(), "(")
Douglas Gregor849b2432010-03-31 17:46:05 +00007188 << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(EndLoc, ")");
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007189
Douglas Gregor55b38842010-04-14 16:09:52 +00007190 if (!SecondNote.getDiagID())
Douglas Gregor827feec2010-01-08 00:20:23 +00007191 return;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007192
Douglas Gregor827feec2010-01-08 00:20:23 +00007193 EndLoc = Self.PP.getLocForEndOfToken(SecondParenRange.getEnd());
7194 if (!SecondParenRange.getEnd().isFileID() || EndLoc.isInvalid()) {
7195 // We can't display the parentheses, so just dig the
7196 // warning/error and return.
Douglas Gregor55b38842010-04-14 16:09:52 +00007197 Self.Diag(Loc, SecondNote);
Douglas Gregor827feec2010-01-08 00:20:23 +00007198 return;
7199 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007200
Douglas Gregor55b38842010-04-14 16:09:52 +00007201 Self.Diag(Loc, SecondNote)
Douglas Gregor849b2432010-03-31 17:46:05 +00007202 << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(SecondParenRange.getBegin(), "(")
7203 << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(EndLoc, ")");
Sebastian Redl6b169ac2009-10-26 17:01:32 +00007204}
7205
Sebastian Redlaee3c932009-10-27 12:10:02 +00007206/// DiagnoseBitwisePrecedence - Emit a warning when bitwise and comparison
7207/// operators are mixed in a way that suggests that the programmer forgot that
7208/// comparison operators have higher precedence. The most typical example of
7209/// such code is "flags & 0x0020 != 0", which is equivalent to "flags & 1".
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00007210static void DiagnoseBitwisePrecedence(Sema &Self, BinaryOperatorKind Opc,
Sebastian Redl9e1d29b2009-10-26 15:24:15 +00007211 SourceLocation OpLoc,Expr *lhs,Expr *rhs){
Sebastian Redlaee3c932009-10-27 12:10:02 +00007212 typedef BinaryOperator BinOp;
7213 BinOp::Opcode lhsopc = static_cast<BinOp::Opcode>(-1),
7214 rhsopc = static_cast<BinOp::Opcode>(-1);
7215 if (BinOp *BO = dyn_cast<BinOp>(lhs))
Sebastian Redl9e1d29b2009-10-26 15:24:15 +00007216 lhsopc = BO->getOpcode();
Sebastian Redlaee3c932009-10-27 12:10:02 +00007217 if (BinOp *BO = dyn_cast<BinOp>(rhs))
Sebastian Redl9e1d29b2009-10-26 15:24:15 +00007218 rhsopc = BO->getOpcode();
7219
7220 // Subs are not binary operators.
7221 if (lhsopc == -1 && rhsopc == -1)
7222 return;
7223
7224 // Bitwise operations are sometimes used as eager logical ops.
7225 // Don't diagnose this.
Sebastian Redlaee3c932009-10-27 12:10:02 +00007226 if ((BinOp::isComparisonOp(lhsopc) || BinOp::isBitwiseOp(lhsopc)) &&
7227 (BinOp::isComparisonOp(rhsopc) || BinOp::isBitwiseOp(rhsopc)))
Sebastian Redl9e1d29b2009-10-26 15:24:15 +00007228 return;
7229
Sebastian Redlaee3c932009-10-27 12:10:02 +00007230 if (BinOp::isComparisonOp(lhsopc))
Sebastian Redl6b169ac2009-10-26 17:01:32 +00007231 SuggestParentheses(Self, OpLoc,
Douglas Gregorfe6b2d42010-03-29 23:34:08 +00007232 Self.PDiag(diag::warn_precedence_bitwise_rel)
Sebastian Redlaee3c932009-10-27 12:10:02 +00007233 << SourceRange(lhs->getLocStart(), OpLoc)
7234 << BinOp::getOpcodeStr(Opc) << BinOp::getOpcodeStr(lhsopc),
Douglas Gregorfe6b2d42010-03-29 23:34:08 +00007235 Self.PDiag(diag::note_precedence_bitwise_first)
Douglas Gregor827feec2010-01-08 00:20:23 +00007236 << BinOp::getOpcodeStr(Opc),
Douglas Gregor55b38842010-04-14 16:09:52 +00007237 SourceRange(cast<BinOp>(lhs)->getRHS()->getLocStart(), rhs->getLocEnd()),
7238 Self.PDiag(diag::note_precedence_bitwise_silence)
7239 << BinOp::getOpcodeStr(lhsopc),
7240 lhs->getSourceRange());
Sebastian Redlaee3c932009-10-27 12:10:02 +00007241 else if (BinOp::isComparisonOp(rhsopc))
Sebastian Redl6b169ac2009-10-26 17:01:32 +00007242 SuggestParentheses(Self, OpLoc,
Douglas Gregorfe6b2d42010-03-29 23:34:08 +00007243 Self.PDiag(diag::warn_precedence_bitwise_rel)
Sebastian Redlaee3c932009-10-27 12:10:02 +00007244 << SourceRange(OpLoc, rhs->getLocEnd())
7245 << BinOp::getOpcodeStr(Opc) << BinOp::getOpcodeStr(rhsopc),
Douglas Gregorfe6b2d42010-03-29 23:34:08 +00007246 Self.PDiag(diag::note_precedence_bitwise_first)
Douglas Gregor827feec2010-01-08 00:20:23 +00007247 << BinOp::getOpcodeStr(Opc),
Douglas Gregor55b38842010-04-14 16:09:52 +00007248 SourceRange(lhs->getLocEnd(), cast<BinOp>(rhs)->getLHS()->getLocStart()),
7249 Self.PDiag(diag::note_precedence_bitwise_silence)
7250 << BinOp::getOpcodeStr(rhsopc),
7251 rhs->getSourceRange());
Sebastian Redl9e1d29b2009-10-26 15:24:15 +00007252}
7253
7254/// DiagnoseBinOpPrecedence - Emit warnings for expressions with tricky
7255/// precedence. This currently diagnoses only "arg1 'bitwise' arg2 'eq' arg3".
7256/// But it could also warn about arg1 && arg2 || arg3, as GCC 4.3+ does.
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00007257static void DiagnoseBinOpPrecedence(Sema &Self, BinaryOperatorKind Opc,
Sebastian Redl9e1d29b2009-10-26 15:24:15 +00007258 SourceLocation OpLoc, Expr *lhs, Expr *rhs){
Sebastian Redlaee3c932009-10-27 12:10:02 +00007259 if (BinaryOperator::isBitwiseOp(Opc))
Sebastian Redl9e1d29b2009-10-26 15:24:15 +00007260 DiagnoseBitwisePrecedence(Self, Opc, OpLoc, lhs, rhs);
7261}
7262
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00007263// Binary Operators. 'Tok' is the token for the operator.
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00007264ExprResult Sema::ActOnBinOp(Scope *S, SourceLocation TokLoc,
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00007265 tok::TokenKind Kind,
7266 Expr *lhs, Expr *rhs) {
7267 BinaryOperatorKind Opc = ConvertTokenKindToBinaryOpcode(Kind);
Steve Narofff69936d2007-09-16 03:34:24 +00007268 assert((lhs != 0) && "ActOnBinOp(): missing left expression");
7269 assert((rhs != 0) && "ActOnBinOp(): missing right expression");
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00007270
Sebastian Redl9e1d29b2009-10-26 15:24:15 +00007271 // Emit warnings for tricky precedence issues, e.g. "bitfield & 0x4 == 0"
7272 DiagnoseBinOpPrecedence(*this, Opc, TokLoc, lhs, rhs);
7273
Douglas Gregor6ca7cfb2009-11-05 00:51:44 +00007274 return BuildBinOp(S, TokLoc, Opc, lhs, rhs);
7275}
7276
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00007277ExprResult Sema::BuildBinOp(Scope *S, SourceLocation OpLoc,
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00007278 BinaryOperatorKind Opc,
7279 Expr *lhs, Expr *rhs) {
Douglas Gregor063daf62009-03-13 18:40:31 +00007280 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus &&
Fariborz Jahanianc4e1a682010-09-14 23:02:38 +00007281 ((!isa<ObjCImplicitSetterGetterRefExpr>(lhs) &&
7282 !isa<ObjCPropertyRefExpr>(lhs))
Fariborz Jahanianeb17e8b2010-09-17 20:45:45 +00007283 || rhs->isTypeDependent() || Opc != BO_Assign) &&
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007284 (lhs->getType()->isOverloadableType() ||
Douglas Gregor063daf62009-03-13 18:40:31 +00007285 rhs->getType()->isOverloadableType())) {
7286 // Find all of the overloaded operators visible from this
7287 // point. We perform both an operator-name lookup from the local
7288 // scope and an argument-dependent lookup based on the types of
7289 // the arguments.
John McCall6e266892010-01-26 03:27:55 +00007290 UnresolvedSet<16> Functions;
Douglas Gregor063daf62009-03-13 18:40:31 +00007291 OverloadedOperatorKind OverOp = BinaryOperator::getOverloadedOperator(Opc);
John McCall6e266892010-01-26 03:27:55 +00007292 if (S && OverOp != OO_None)
7293 LookupOverloadedOperatorName(OverOp, S, lhs->getType(), rhs->getType(),
7294 Functions);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007295
Douglas Gregor063daf62009-03-13 18:40:31 +00007296 // Build the (potentially-overloaded, potentially-dependent)
7297 // binary operation.
Douglas Gregor6ca7cfb2009-11-05 00:51:44 +00007298 return CreateOverloadedBinOp(OpLoc, Opc, Functions, lhs, rhs);
Sebastian Redlb8a6aca2009-01-19 22:31:54 +00007299 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007300
Douglas Gregoreaebc752008-11-06 23:29:22 +00007301 // Build a built-in binary operation.
Douglas Gregor6ca7cfb2009-11-05 00:51:44 +00007302 return CreateBuiltinBinOp(OpLoc, Opc, lhs, rhs);
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00007303}
7304
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00007305ExprResult Sema::CreateBuiltinUnaryOp(SourceLocation OpLoc,
John McCall2cd11fe2010-10-12 02:09:17 +00007306 unsigned OpcIn,
7307 Expr *Input) {
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00007308 UnaryOperatorKind Opc = static_cast<UnaryOperatorKind>(OpcIn);
Douglas Gregor74253732008-11-19 15:42:04 +00007309
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00007310 QualType resultType;
7311 switch (Opc) {
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00007312 case UO_PreInc:
7313 case UO_PreDec:
7314 case UO_PostInc:
7315 case UO_PostDec:
Sebastian Redle6d5a4a2008-12-20 09:35:34 +00007316 resultType = CheckIncrementDecrementOperand(Input, OpLoc,
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00007317 Opc == UO_PreInc ||
7318 Opc == UO_PostInc,
7319 Opc == UO_PreInc ||
7320 Opc == UO_PreDec);
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00007321 break;
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00007322 case UO_AddrOf:
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00007323 resultType = CheckAddressOfOperand(Input, OpLoc);
7324 break;
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00007325 case UO_Deref:
Douglas Gregora873dfc2010-02-03 00:27:59 +00007326 DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion(Input);
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00007327 resultType = CheckIndirectionOperand(Input, OpLoc);
7328 break;
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00007329 case UO_Plus:
7330 case UO_Minus:
Steve Naroffc80b4ee2007-07-16 21:54:35 +00007331 UsualUnaryConversions(Input);
7332 resultType = Input->getType();
Sebastian Redl28507842009-02-26 14:39:58 +00007333 if (resultType->isDependentType())
7334 break;
Douglas Gregor00619622010-06-22 23:41:02 +00007335 if (resultType->isArithmeticType() || // C99 6.5.3.3p1
7336 resultType->isVectorType())
Douglas Gregor74253732008-11-19 15:42:04 +00007337 break;
7338 else if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus && // C++ [expr.unary.op]p6-7
7339 resultType->isEnumeralType())
7340 break;
7341 else if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus && // C++ [expr.unary.op]p6
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00007342 Opc == UO_Plus &&
Douglas Gregor74253732008-11-19 15:42:04 +00007343 resultType->isPointerType())
7344 break;
John McCall2cd11fe2010-10-12 02:09:17 +00007345 else if (resultType->isPlaceholderType()) {
7346 ExprResult PR = CheckPlaceholderExpr(Input, OpLoc);
7347 if (PR.isInvalid()) return ExprError();
7348 return CreateBuiltinUnaryOp(OpLoc, OpcIn, PR.take());
7349 }
Douglas Gregor74253732008-11-19 15:42:04 +00007350
Sebastian Redl0eb23302009-01-19 00:08:26 +00007351 return ExprError(Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_unary_expr)
7352 << resultType << Input->getSourceRange());
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00007353 case UO_Not: // bitwise complement
Steve Naroffc80b4ee2007-07-16 21:54:35 +00007354 UsualUnaryConversions(Input);
7355 resultType = Input->getType();
Sebastian Redl28507842009-02-26 14:39:58 +00007356 if (resultType->isDependentType())
7357 break;
Chris Lattner02a65142008-07-25 23:52:49 +00007358 // C99 6.5.3.3p1. We allow complex int and float as a GCC extension.
7359 if (resultType->isComplexType() || resultType->isComplexIntegerType())
7360 // C99 does not support '~' for complex conjugation.
Chris Lattnerd3a94e22008-11-20 06:06:08 +00007361 Diag(OpLoc, diag::ext_integer_complement_complex)
Chris Lattnerd1625842008-11-24 06:25:27 +00007362 << resultType << Input->getSourceRange();
John McCall2cd11fe2010-10-12 02:09:17 +00007363 else if (resultType->hasIntegerRepresentation())
7364 break;
7365 else if (resultType->isPlaceholderType()) {
7366 ExprResult PR = CheckPlaceholderExpr(Input, OpLoc);
7367 if (PR.isInvalid()) return ExprError();
7368 return CreateBuiltinUnaryOp(OpLoc, OpcIn, PR.take());
7369 } else {
Sebastian Redl0eb23302009-01-19 00:08:26 +00007370 return ExprError(Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_unary_expr)
7371 << resultType << Input->getSourceRange());
John McCall2cd11fe2010-10-12 02:09:17 +00007372 }
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00007373 break;
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00007374 case UO_LNot: // logical negation
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00007375 // Unlike +/-/~, integer promotions aren't done here (C99 6.5.3.3p5).
Douglas Gregora873dfc2010-02-03 00:27:59 +00007376 DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion(Input);
Steve Naroffc80b4ee2007-07-16 21:54:35 +00007377 resultType = Input->getType();
Sebastian Redl28507842009-02-26 14:39:58 +00007378 if (resultType->isDependentType())
7379 break;
John McCall2cd11fe2010-10-12 02:09:17 +00007380 if (resultType->isScalarType()) { // C99 6.5.3.3p1
7381 // ok, fallthrough
7382 } else if (resultType->isPlaceholderType()) {
7383 ExprResult PR = CheckPlaceholderExpr(Input, OpLoc);
7384 if (PR.isInvalid()) return ExprError();
7385 return CreateBuiltinUnaryOp(OpLoc, OpcIn, PR.take());
7386 } else {
Sebastian Redl0eb23302009-01-19 00:08:26 +00007387 return ExprError(Diag(OpLoc, diag::err_typecheck_unary_expr)
7388 << resultType << Input->getSourceRange());
John McCall2cd11fe2010-10-12 02:09:17 +00007389 }
Douglas Gregorea844f32010-09-20 17:13:33 +00007390
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00007391 // LNot always has type int. C99 6.5.3.3p5.
Sebastian Redl0eb23302009-01-19 00:08:26 +00007392 // In C++, it's bool. C++ 5.3.1p8
7393 resultType = getLangOptions().CPlusPlus ? Context.BoolTy : Context.IntTy;
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00007394 break;
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00007395 case UO_Real:
7396 case UO_Imag:
7397 resultType = CheckRealImagOperand(Input, OpLoc, Opc == UO_Real);
Chris Lattnerdbb36972007-08-24 21:16:53 +00007398 break;
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00007399 case UO_Extension:
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00007400 resultType = Input->getType();
7401 break;
7402 }
7403 if (resultType.isNull())
Sebastian Redl0eb23302009-01-19 00:08:26 +00007404 return ExprError();
Douglas Gregorbc736fc2009-03-13 23:49:33 +00007405
Steve Naroff6ece14c2009-01-21 00:14:39 +00007406 return Owned(new (Context) UnaryOperator(Input, Opc, resultType, OpLoc));
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00007407}
7408
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00007409ExprResult Sema::BuildUnaryOp(Scope *S, SourceLocation OpLoc,
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00007410 UnaryOperatorKind Opc,
7411 Expr *Input) {
Anders Carlssona8a1e3d2009-11-14 21:26:41 +00007412 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus && Input->getType()->isOverloadableType() &&
Eli Friedman957c0942010-09-05 23:15:52 +00007413 UnaryOperator::getOverloadedOperator(Opc) != OO_None) {
Douglas Gregorbc736fc2009-03-13 23:49:33 +00007414 // Find all of the overloaded operators visible from this
7415 // point. We perform both an operator-name lookup from the local
7416 // scope and an argument-dependent lookup based on the types of
7417 // the arguments.
John McCall6e266892010-01-26 03:27:55 +00007418 UnresolvedSet<16> Functions;
Douglas Gregorbc736fc2009-03-13 23:49:33 +00007419 OverloadedOperatorKind OverOp = UnaryOperator::getOverloadedOperator(Opc);
John McCall6e266892010-01-26 03:27:55 +00007420 if (S && OverOp != OO_None)
7421 LookupOverloadedOperatorName(OverOp, S, Input->getType(), QualType(),
7422 Functions);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007423
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00007424 return CreateOverloadedUnaryOp(OpLoc, Opc, Functions, Input);
Douglas Gregorbc736fc2009-03-13 23:49:33 +00007425 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007426
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00007427 return CreateBuiltinUnaryOp(OpLoc, Opc, Input);
Douglas Gregorbc736fc2009-03-13 23:49:33 +00007428}
7429
Douglas Gregor6ca7cfb2009-11-05 00:51:44 +00007430// Unary Operators. 'Tok' is the token for the operator.
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00007431ExprResult Sema::ActOnUnaryOp(Scope *S, SourceLocation OpLoc,
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00007432 tok::TokenKind Op, Expr *Input) {
7433 return BuildUnaryOp(S, OpLoc, ConvertTokenKindToUnaryOpcode(Op), Input);
Douglas Gregor6ca7cfb2009-11-05 00:51:44 +00007434}
7435
Steve Naroff1b273c42007-09-16 14:56:35 +00007436/// ActOnAddrLabel - Parse the GNU address of label extension: "&&foo".
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00007437ExprResult Sema::ActOnAddrLabel(SourceLocation OpLoc,
Sebastian Redlf53597f2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00007438 SourceLocation LabLoc,
7439 IdentifierInfo *LabelII) {
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00007440 // Look up the record for this label identifier.
John McCall781472f2010-08-25 08:40:02 +00007441 LabelStmt *&LabelDecl = getCurFunction()->LabelMap[LabelII];
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00007442
Daniel Dunbar0ffb1252008-08-04 16:51:22 +00007443 // If we haven't seen this label yet, create a forward reference. It
7444 // will be validated and/or cleaned up in ActOnFinishFunctionBody.
Steve Naroffcaaacec2009-03-13 15:38:40 +00007445 if (LabelDecl == 0)
Steve Naroff6ece14c2009-01-21 00:14:39 +00007446 LabelDecl = new (Context) LabelStmt(LabLoc, LabelII, 0);
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00007447
Argyrios Kyrtzidis355a9fe2010-09-19 21:21:25 +00007448 LabelDecl->setUsed();
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00007449 // Create the AST node. The address of a label always has type 'void*'.
Sebastian Redlf53597f2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00007450 return Owned(new (Context) AddrLabelExpr(OpLoc, LabLoc, LabelDecl,
7451 Context.getPointerType(Context.VoidTy)));
Reid Spencer5f016e22007-07-11 17:01:13 +00007452}
7453
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00007454ExprResult
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00007455Sema::ActOnStmtExpr(SourceLocation LPLoc, Stmt *SubStmt,
Sebastian Redlf53597f2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00007456 SourceLocation RPLoc) { // "({..})"
Chris Lattnerab18c4c2007-07-24 16:58:17 +00007457 assert(SubStmt && isa<CompoundStmt>(SubStmt) && "Invalid action invocation!");
7458 CompoundStmt *Compound = cast<CompoundStmt>(SubStmt);
7459
Douglas Gregordd8f5692010-03-10 04:54:39 +00007460 bool isFileScope
7461 = (getCurFunctionOrMethodDecl() == 0) && (getCurBlock() == 0);
Chris Lattner4a049f02009-04-25 19:11:05 +00007462 if (isFileScope)
Sebastian Redlf53597f2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00007463 return ExprError(Diag(LPLoc, diag::err_stmtexpr_file_scope));
Eli Friedmandca2b732009-01-24 23:09:00 +00007464
Chris Lattnerab18c4c2007-07-24 16:58:17 +00007465 // FIXME: there are a variety of strange constraints to enforce here, for
7466 // example, it is not possible to goto into a stmt expression apparently.
7467 // More semantic analysis is needed.
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00007468
Chris Lattnerab18c4c2007-07-24 16:58:17 +00007469 // If there are sub stmts in the compound stmt, take the type of the last one
7470 // as the type of the stmtexpr.
7471 QualType Ty = Context.VoidTy;
Fariborz Jahaniane946fc82010-10-25 23:27:26 +00007472 bool StmtExprMayBindToTemp = false;
Chris Lattner611b2ec2008-07-26 19:51:01 +00007473 if (!Compound->body_empty()) {
7474 Stmt *LastStmt = Compound->body_back();
Fariborz Jahaniane946fc82010-10-25 23:27:26 +00007475 LabelStmt *LastLabelStmt = 0;
Chris Lattner611b2ec2008-07-26 19:51:01 +00007476 // If LastStmt is a label, skip down through into the body.
Fariborz Jahaniane946fc82010-10-25 23:27:26 +00007477 while (LabelStmt *Label = dyn_cast<LabelStmt>(LastStmt)) {
7478 LastLabelStmt = Label;
Chris Lattner611b2ec2008-07-26 19:51:01 +00007479 LastStmt = Label->getSubStmt();
Fariborz Jahaniane946fc82010-10-25 23:27:26 +00007480 }
7481 if (Expr *LastExpr = dyn_cast<Expr>(LastStmt)) {
Fariborz Jahanian4bdc4462010-10-27 20:44:00 +00007482 DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion(LastExpr);
Chris Lattnerab18c4c2007-07-24 16:58:17 +00007483 Ty = LastExpr->getType();
Fariborz Jahaniane946fc82010-10-25 23:27:26 +00007484 if (!Ty->isDependentType() && !LastExpr->isTypeDependent()) {
7485 ExprResult Res = PerformCopyInitialization(
7486 InitializedEntity::InitializeResult(LPLoc,
7487 Ty,
7488 false),
7489 SourceLocation(),
7490 Owned(LastExpr));
7491 if (Res.isInvalid())
7492 return ExprError();
7493 if ((LastExpr = Res.takeAs<Expr>())) {
7494 if (!LastLabelStmt)
7495 Compound->setLastStmt(LastExpr);
7496 else
7497 LastLabelStmt->setSubStmt(LastExpr);
7498 StmtExprMayBindToTemp = true;
7499 }
7500 }
7501 }
Chris Lattner611b2ec2008-07-26 19:51:01 +00007502 }
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00007503
Eli Friedmanb1d796d2009-03-23 00:24:07 +00007504 // FIXME: Check that expression type is complete/non-abstract; statement
7505 // expressions are not lvalues.
Fariborz Jahaniane946fc82010-10-25 23:27:26 +00007506 Expr *ResStmtExpr = new (Context) StmtExpr(Compound, Ty, LPLoc, RPLoc);
7507 if (StmtExprMayBindToTemp)
7508 return MaybeBindToTemporary(ResStmtExpr);
7509 return Owned(ResStmtExpr);
Chris Lattnerab18c4c2007-07-24 16:58:17 +00007510}
Steve Naroffd34e9152007-08-01 22:05:33 +00007511
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00007512ExprResult Sema::BuildBuiltinOffsetOf(SourceLocation BuiltinLoc,
John McCall2cd11fe2010-10-12 02:09:17 +00007513 TypeSourceInfo *TInfo,
7514 OffsetOfComponent *CompPtr,
7515 unsigned NumComponents,
7516 SourceLocation RParenLoc) {
Douglas Gregor8ecdb652010-04-28 22:16:22 +00007517 QualType ArgTy = TInfo->getType();
Sebastian Redl28507842009-02-26 14:39:58 +00007518 bool Dependent = ArgTy->isDependentType();
Abramo Bagnarabd054db2010-05-20 10:00:11 +00007519 SourceRange TypeRange = TInfo->getTypeLoc().getLocalSourceRange();
Douglas Gregor8ecdb652010-04-28 22:16:22 +00007520
Chris Lattner73d0d4f2007-08-30 17:45:32 +00007521 // We must have at least one component that refers to the type, and the first
7522 // one is known to be a field designator. Verify that the ArgTy represents
7523 // a struct/union/class.
Sebastian Redl28507842009-02-26 14:39:58 +00007524 if (!Dependent && !ArgTy->isRecordType())
Douglas Gregor8ecdb652010-04-28 22:16:22 +00007525 return ExprError(Diag(BuiltinLoc, diag::err_offsetof_record_type)
7526 << ArgTy << TypeRange);
7527
7528 // Type must be complete per C99 7.17p3 because a declaring a variable
7529 // with an incomplete type would be ill-formed.
7530 if (!Dependent
7531 && RequireCompleteType(BuiltinLoc, ArgTy,
7532 PDiag(diag::err_offsetof_incomplete_type)
7533 << TypeRange))
7534 return ExprError();
7535
Chris Lattner9e2b75c2007-08-31 21:49:13 +00007536 // offsetof with non-identifier designators (e.g. "offsetof(x, a.b[c])") are a
7537 // GCC extension, diagnose them.
Eli Friedman35183ac2009-02-27 06:44:11 +00007538 // FIXME: This diagnostic isn't actually visible because the location is in
7539 // a system header!
Chris Lattner9e2b75c2007-08-31 21:49:13 +00007540 if (NumComponents != 1)
Chris Lattnerdcd5ef12008-11-19 05:27:50 +00007541 Diag(BuiltinLoc, diag::ext_offsetof_extended_field_designator)
7542 << SourceRange(CompPtr[1].LocStart, CompPtr[NumComponents-1].LocEnd);
Douglas Gregor8ecdb652010-04-28 22:16:22 +00007543
7544 bool DidWarnAboutNonPOD = false;
7545 QualType CurrentType = ArgTy;
7546 typedef OffsetOfExpr::OffsetOfNode OffsetOfNode;
7547 llvm::SmallVector<OffsetOfNode, 4> Comps;
7548 llvm::SmallVector<Expr*, 4> Exprs;
7549 for (unsigned i = 0; i != NumComponents; ++i) {
7550 const OffsetOfComponent &OC = CompPtr[i];
7551 if (OC.isBrackets) {
7552 // Offset of an array sub-field. TODO: Should we allow vector elements?
7553 if (!CurrentType->isDependentType()) {
7554 const ArrayType *AT = Context.getAsArrayType(CurrentType);
7555 if(!AT)
7556 return ExprError(Diag(OC.LocEnd, diag::err_offsetof_array_type)
7557 << CurrentType);
7558 CurrentType = AT->getElementType();
7559 } else
7560 CurrentType = Context.DependentTy;
7561
7562 // The expression must be an integral expression.
7563 // FIXME: An integral constant expression?
7564 Expr *Idx = static_cast<Expr*>(OC.U.E);
7565 if (!Idx->isTypeDependent() && !Idx->isValueDependent() &&
7566 !Idx->getType()->isIntegerType())
7567 return ExprError(Diag(Idx->getLocStart(),
7568 diag::err_typecheck_subscript_not_integer)
7569 << Idx->getSourceRange());
7570
7571 // Record this array index.
7572 Comps.push_back(OffsetOfNode(OC.LocStart, Exprs.size(), OC.LocEnd));
7573 Exprs.push_back(Idx);
7574 continue;
7575 }
7576
7577 // Offset of a field.
7578 if (CurrentType->isDependentType()) {
7579 // We have the offset of a field, but we can't look into the dependent
7580 // type. Just record the identifier of the field.
7581 Comps.push_back(OffsetOfNode(OC.LocStart, OC.U.IdentInfo, OC.LocEnd));
7582 CurrentType = Context.DependentTy;
7583 continue;
7584 }
7585
7586 // We need to have a complete type to look into.
7587 if (RequireCompleteType(OC.LocStart, CurrentType,
7588 diag::err_offsetof_incomplete_type))
7589 return ExprError();
7590
7591 // Look for the designated field.
7592 const RecordType *RC = CurrentType->getAs<RecordType>();
7593 if (!RC)
7594 return ExprError(Diag(OC.LocEnd, diag::err_offsetof_record_type)
7595 << CurrentType);
7596 RecordDecl *RD = RC->getDecl();
7597
7598 // C++ [lib.support.types]p5:
7599 // The macro offsetof accepts a restricted set of type arguments in this
7600 // International Standard. type shall be a POD structure or a POD union
7601 // (clause 9).
7602 if (CXXRecordDecl *CRD = dyn_cast<CXXRecordDecl>(RD)) {
7603 if (!CRD->isPOD() && !DidWarnAboutNonPOD &&
7604 DiagRuntimeBehavior(BuiltinLoc,
7605 PDiag(diag::warn_offsetof_non_pod_type)
7606 << SourceRange(CompPtr[0].LocStart, OC.LocEnd)
7607 << CurrentType))
7608 DidWarnAboutNonPOD = true;
7609 }
7610
7611 // Look for the field.
7612 LookupResult R(*this, OC.U.IdentInfo, OC.LocStart, LookupMemberName);
7613 LookupQualifiedName(R, RD);
7614 FieldDecl *MemberDecl = R.getAsSingle<FieldDecl>();
7615 if (!MemberDecl)
7616 return ExprError(Diag(BuiltinLoc, diag::err_no_member)
7617 << OC.U.IdentInfo << RD << SourceRange(OC.LocStart,
7618 OC.LocEnd));
7619
Douglas Gregor9d5d60f2010-04-28 22:36:06 +00007620 // C99 7.17p3:
7621 // (If the specified member is a bit-field, the behavior is undefined.)
7622 //
7623 // We diagnose this as an error.
7624 if (MemberDecl->getBitWidth()) {
7625 Diag(OC.LocEnd, diag::err_offsetof_bitfield)
7626 << MemberDecl->getDeclName()
7627 << SourceRange(BuiltinLoc, RParenLoc);
7628 Diag(MemberDecl->getLocation(), diag::note_bitfield_decl);
7629 return ExprError();
7630 }
Eli Friedman19410a72010-08-05 10:11:36 +00007631
7632 RecordDecl *Parent = MemberDecl->getParent();
7633 bool AnonStructUnion = Parent->isAnonymousStructOrUnion();
7634 if (AnonStructUnion) {
7635 do {
7636 Parent = cast<RecordDecl>(Parent->getParent());
7637 } while (Parent->isAnonymousStructOrUnion());
7638 }
7639
Douglas Gregorcc8a5d52010-04-29 00:18:15 +00007640 // If the member was found in a base class, introduce OffsetOfNodes for
7641 // the base class indirections.
7642 CXXBasePaths Paths(/*FindAmbiguities=*/true, /*RecordPaths=*/true,
7643 /*DetectVirtual=*/false);
Eli Friedman19410a72010-08-05 10:11:36 +00007644 if (IsDerivedFrom(CurrentType, Context.getTypeDeclType(Parent), Paths)) {
Douglas Gregorcc8a5d52010-04-29 00:18:15 +00007645 CXXBasePath &Path = Paths.front();
7646 for (CXXBasePath::iterator B = Path.begin(), BEnd = Path.end();
7647 B != BEnd; ++B)
7648 Comps.push_back(OffsetOfNode(B->Base));
7649 }
Eli Friedman19410a72010-08-05 10:11:36 +00007650
7651 if (AnonStructUnion) {
Douglas Gregor8ecdb652010-04-28 22:16:22 +00007652 llvm::SmallVector<FieldDecl*, 4> Path;
7653 BuildAnonymousStructUnionMemberPath(MemberDecl, Path);
7654 unsigned n = Path.size();
7655 for (int j = n - 1; j > -1; --j)
7656 Comps.push_back(OffsetOfNode(OC.LocStart, Path[j], OC.LocEnd));
7657 } else {
7658 Comps.push_back(OffsetOfNode(OC.LocStart, MemberDecl, OC.LocEnd));
7659 }
7660 CurrentType = MemberDecl->getType().getNonReferenceType();
7661 }
7662
7663 return Owned(OffsetOfExpr::Create(Context, Context.getSizeType(), BuiltinLoc,
7664 TInfo, Comps.data(), Comps.size(),
7665 Exprs.data(), Exprs.size(), RParenLoc));
7666}
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00007667
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00007668ExprResult Sema::ActOnBuiltinOffsetOf(Scope *S,
John McCall2cd11fe2010-10-12 02:09:17 +00007669 SourceLocation BuiltinLoc,
7670 SourceLocation TypeLoc,
7671 ParsedType argty,
7672 OffsetOfComponent *CompPtr,
7673 unsigned NumComponents,
7674 SourceLocation RPLoc) {
7675
Douglas Gregor8ecdb652010-04-28 22:16:22 +00007676 TypeSourceInfo *ArgTInfo;
7677 QualType ArgTy = GetTypeFromParser(argty, &ArgTInfo);
7678 if (ArgTy.isNull())
7679 return ExprError();
7680
Eli Friedman5a15dc12010-08-05 10:15:45 +00007681 if (!ArgTInfo)
7682 ArgTInfo = Context.getTrivialTypeSourceInfo(ArgTy, TypeLoc);
7683
7684 return BuildBuiltinOffsetOf(BuiltinLoc, ArgTInfo, CompPtr, NumComponents,
7685 RPLoc);
Chris Lattner73d0d4f2007-08-30 17:45:32 +00007686}
7687
7688
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00007689ExprResult Sema::ActOnTypesCompatibleExpr(SourceLocation BuiltinLoc,
John McCall2cd11fe2010-10-12 02:09:17 +00007690 ParsedType arg1, ParsedType arg2,
7691 SourceLocation RPLoc) {
Abramo Bagnara3fcb73d2010-08-10 08:50:03 +00007692 TypeSourceInfo *argTInfo1;
7693 QualType argT1 = GetTypeFromParser(arg1, &argTInfo1);
7694 TypeSourceInfo *argTInfo2;
7695 QualType argT2 = GetTypeFromParser(arg2, &argTInfo2);
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00007696
Steve Naroffd34e9152007-08-01 22:05:33 +00007697 assert((!argT1.isNull() && !argT2.isNull()) && "Missing type argument(s)");
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00007698
Abramo Bagnara3fcb73d2010-08-10 08:50:03 +00007699 return BuildTypesCompatibleExpr(BuiltinLoc, argTInfo1, argTInfo2, RPLoc);
7700}
7701
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00007702ExprResult
Abramo Bagnara3fcb73d2010-08-10 08:50:03 +00007703Sema::BuildTypesCompatibleExpr(SourceLocation BuiltinLoc,
7704 TypeSourceInfo *argTInfo1,
7705 TypeSourceInfo *argTInfo2,
7706 SourceLocation RPLoc) {
Douglas Gregorc12a9c52009-05-19 22:28:02 +00007707 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
7708 Diag(BuiltinLoc, diag::err_types_compatible_p_in_cplusplus)
7709 << SourceRange(BuiltinLoc, RPLoc);
7710 return ExprError();
7711 }
7712
Sebastian Redlf53597f2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00007713 return Owned(new (Context) TypesCompatibleExpr(Context.IntTy, BuiltinLoc,
Abramo Bagnara3fcb73d2010-08-10 08:50:03 +00007714 argTInfo1, argTInfo2, RPLoc));
Steve Naroffd34e9152007-08-01 22:05:33 +00007715}
7716
Abramo Bagnara3fcb73d2010-08-10 08:50:03 +00007717
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00007718ExprResult Sema::ActOnChooseExpr(SourceLocation BuiltinLoc,
John McCall2cd11fe2010-10-12 02:09:17 +00007719 Expr *CondExpr,
7720 Expr *LHSExpr, Expr *RHSExpr,
7721 SourceLocation RPLoc) {
Steve Naroffd04fdd52007-08-03 21:21:27 +00007722 assert((CondExpr && LHSExpr && RHSExpr) && "Missing type argument(s)");
7723
Sebastian Redl28507842009-02-26 14:39:58 +00007724 QualType resType;
Douglas Gregorce940492009-09-25 04:25:58 +00007725 bool ValueDependent = false;
Douglas Gregorc9ecc572009-05-19 22:43:30 +00007726 if (CondExpr->isTypeDependent() || CondExpr->isValueDependent()) {
Sebastian Redl28507842009-02-26 14:39:58 +00007727 resType = Context.DependentTy;
Douglas Gregorce940492009-09-25 04:25:58 +00007728 ValueDependent = true;
Sebastian Redl28507842009-02-26 14:39:58 +00007729 } else {
7730 // The conditional expression is required to be a constant expression.
7731 llvm::APSInt condEval(32);
7732 SourceLocation ExpLoc;
7733 if (!CondExpr->isIntegerConstantExpr(condEval, Context, &ExpLoc))
Sebastian Redlf53597f2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00007734 return ExprError(Diag(ExpLoc,
7735 diag::err_typecheck_choose_expr_requires_constant)
7736 << CondExpr->getSourceRange());
Steve Naroffd04fdd52007-08-03 21:21:27 +00007737
Sebastian Redl28507842009-02-26 14:39:58 +00007738 // If the condition is > zero, then the AST type is the same as the LSHExpr.
7739 resType = condEval.getZExtValue() ? LHSExpr->getType() : RHSExpr->getType();
Douglas Gregorce940492009-09-25 04:25:58 +00007740 ValueDependent = condEval.getZExtValue() ? LHSExpr->isValueDependent()
7741 : RHSExpr->isValueDependent();
Sebastian Redl28507842009-02-26 14:39:58 +00007742 }
7743
Sebastian Redlf53597f2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00007744 return Owned(new (Context) ChooseExpr(BuiltinLoc, CondExpr, LHSExpr, RHSExpr,
Douglas Gregorce940492009-09-25 04:25:58 +00007745 resType, RPLoc,
7746 resType->isDependentType(),
7747 ValueDependent));
Steve Naroffd04fdd52007-08-03 21:21:27 +00007748}
7749
Steve Naroff4eb206b2008-09-03 18:15:37 +00007750//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
7751// Clang Extensions.
7752//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
7753
7754/// ActOnBlockStart - This callback is invoked when a block literal is started.
Steve Naroff090276f2008-10-10 01:28:17 +00007755void Sema::ActOnBlockStart(SourceLocation CaretLoc, Scope *BlockScope) {
Douglas Gregor9ea9bdb2010-03-01 23:15:13 +00007756 BlockDecl *Block = BlockDecl::Create(Context, CurContext, CaretLoc);
7757 PushBlockScope(BlockScope, Block);
7758 CurContext->addDecl(Block);
Fariborz Jahaniana729da22010-07-09 18:44:02 +00007759 if (BlockScope)
7760 PushDeclContext(BlockScope, Block);
7761 else
7762 CurContext = Block;
Steve Naroff090276f2008-10-10 01:28:17 +00007763}
7764
Mike Stump98eb8a72009-02-04 22:31:32 +00007765void Sema::ActOnBlockArguments(Declarator &ParamInfo, Scope *CurScope) {
Mike Stumpaf199f32009-05-07 18:43:07 +00007766 assert(ParamInfo.getIdentifier()==0 && "block-id should have no identifier!");
Douglas Gregor9ea9bdb2010-03-01 23:15:13 +00007767 BlockScopeInfo *CurBlock = getCurBlock();
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007768
John McCallbf1a0282010-06-04 23:28:52 +00007769 TypeSourceInfo *Sig = GetTypeForDeclarator(ParamInfo, CurScope);
John McCall82dc0092010-06-04 11:21:44 +00007770 CurBlock->TheDecl->setSignatureAsWritten(Sig);
John McCallbf1a0282010-06-04 23:28:52 +00007771 QualType T = Sig->getType();
Mike Stump98eb8a72009-02-04 22:31:32 +00007772
John McCallc71a4912010-06-04 19:02:56 +00007773 bool isVariadic;
John McCall82dc0092010-06-04 11:21:44 +00007774 QualType RetTy;
7775 if (const FunctionType *Fn = T->getAs<FunctionType>()) {
John McCallc71a4912010-06-04 19:02:56 +00007776 CurBlock->FunctionType = T;
John McCall82dc0092010-06-04 11:21:44 +00007777 RetTy = Fn->getResultType();
John McCallc71a4912010-06-04 19:02:56 +00007778 isVariadic =
John McCall82dc0092010-06-04 11:21:44 +00007779 !isa<FunctionProtoType>(Fn) || cast<FunctionProtoType>(Fn)->isVariadic();
7780 } else {
7781 RetTy = T;
John McCallc71a4912010-06-04 19:02:56 +00007782 isVariadic = false;
John McCall82dc0092010-06-04 11:21:44 +00007783 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007784
John McCallc71a4912010-06-04 19:02:56 +00007785 CurBlock->TheDecl->setIsVariadic(isVariadic);
Douglas Gregora873dfc2010-02-03 00:27:59 +00007786
John McCall82dc0092010-06-04 11:21:44 +00007787 // Don't allow returning an array by value.
7788 if (RetTy->isArrayType()) {
7789 Diag(ParamInfo.getSourceRange().getBegin(), diag::err_block_returns_array);
Mike Stump98eb8a72009-02-04 22:31:32 +00007790 return;
7791 }
7792
John McCall82dc0092010-06-04 11:21:44 +00007793 // Don't allow returning a objc interface by value.
7794 if (RetTy->isObjCObjectType()) {
7795 Diag(ParamInfo.getSourceRange().getBegin(),
7796 diag::err_object_cannot_be_passed_returned_by_value) << 0 << RetTy;
7797 return;
7798 }
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00007799
John McCall82dc0092010-06-04 11:21:44 +00007800 // Context.DependentTy is used as a placeholder for a missing block
John McCallc71a4912010-06-04 19:02:56 +00007801 // return type. TODO: what should we do with declarators like:
7802 // ^ * { ... }
7803 // If the answer is "apply template argument deduction"....
John McCall82dc0092010-06-04 11:21:44 +00007804 if (RetTy != Context.DependentTy)
7805 CurBlock->ReturnType = RetTy;
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00007806
John McCall82dc0092010-06-04 11:21:44 +00007807 // Push block parameters from the declarator if we had them.
John McCallc71a4912010-06-04 19:02:56 +00007808 llvm::SmallVector<ParmVarDecl*, 8> Params;
John McCall82dc0092010-06-04 11:21:44 +00007809 if (isa<FunctionProtoType>(T)) {
7810 FunctionProtoTypeLoc TL = cast<FunctionProtoTypeLoc>(Sig->getTypeLoc());
7811 for (unsigned I = 0, E = TL.getNumArgs(); I != E; ++I) {
7812 ParmVarDecl *Param = TL.getArg(I);
Fariborz Jahanian9a66c302010-02-12 21:53:14 +00007813 if (Param->getIdentifier() == 0 &&
7814 !Param->isImplicit() &&
7815 !Param->isInvalidDecl() &&
7816 !getLangOptions().CPlusPlus)
7817 Diag(Param->getLocation(), diag::err_parameter_name_omitted);
John McCallc71a4912010-06-04 19:02:56 +00007818 Params.push_back(Param);
Fariborz Jahanian9a66c302010-02-12 21:53:14 +00007819 }
John McCall82dc0092010-06-04 11:21:44 +00007820
7821 // Fake up parameter variables if we have a typedef, like
7822 // ^ fntype { ... }
7823 } else if (const FunctionProtoType *Fn = T->getAs<FunctionProtoType>()) {
7824 for (FunctionProtoType::arg_type_iterator
7825 I = Fn->arg_type_begin(), E = Fn->arg_type_end(); I != E; ++I) {
7826 ParmVarDecl *Param =
7827 BuildParmVarDeclForTypedef(CurBlock->TheDecl,
7828 ParamInfo.getSourceRange().getBegin(),
7829 *I);
John McCallc71a4912010-06-04 19:02:56 +00007830 Params.push_back(Param);
John McCall82dc0092010-06-04 11:21:44 +00007831 }
Steve Naroff4eb206b2008-09-03 18:15:37 +00007832 }
John McCall82dc0092010-06-04 11:21:44 +00007833
John McCallc71a4912010-06-04 19:02:56 +00007834 // Set the parameters on the block decl.
Douglas Gregor82aa7132010-11-01 18:37:59 +00007835 if (!Params.empty()) {
John McCallc71a4912010-06-04 19:02:56 +00007836 CurBlock->TheDecl->setParams(Params.data(), Params.size());
Douglas Gregor82aa7132010-11-01 18:37:59 +00007837 CheckParmsForFunctionDef(CurBlock->TheDecl->param_begin(),
7838 CurBlock->TheDecl->param_end(),
7839 /*CheckParameterNames=*/false);
7840 }
7841
John McCall82dc0092010-06-04 11:21:44 +00007842 // Finally we can process decl attributes.
Douglas Gregor9cdda0c2009-06-17 21:51:59 +00007843 ProcessDeclAttributes(CurScope, CurBlock->TheDecl, ParamInfo);
John McCall053f4bd2010-03-22 09:20:08 +00007844
John McCallc71a4912010-06-04 19:02:56 +00007845 if (!isVariadic && CurBlock->TheDecl->getAttr<SentinelAttr>()) {
John McCall82dc0092010-06-04 11:21:44 +00007846 Diag(ParamInfo.getAttributes()->getLoc(),
7847 diag::warn_attribute_sentinel_not_variadic) << 1;
7848 // FIXME: remove the attribute.
7849 }
7850
7851 // Put the parameter variables in scope. We can bail out immediately
7852 // if we don't have any.
John McCallc71a4912010-06-04 19:02:56 +00007853 if (Params.empty())
John McCall82dc0092010-06-04 11:21:44 +00007854 return;
7855
John McCall053f4bd2010-03-22 09:20:08 +00007856 bool ShouldCheckShadow =
7857 Diags.getDiagnosticLevel(diag::warn_decl_shadow) != Diagnostic::Ignored;
7858
Steve Naroff090276f2008-10-10 01:28:17 +00007859 for (BlockDecl::param_iterator AI = CurBlock->TheDecl->param_begin(),
John McCall7a9813c2010-01-22 00:28:27 +00007860 E = CurBlock->TheDecl->param_end(); AI != E; ++AI) {
7861 (*AI)->setOwningFunction(CurBlock->TheDecl);
7862
Steve Naroff090276f2008-10-10 01:28:17 +00007863 // If this has an identifier, add it to the scope stack.
John McCall053f4bd2010-03-22 09:20:08 +00007864 if ((*AI)->getIdentifier()) {
7865 if (ShouldCheckShadow)
7866 CheckShadow(CurBlock->TheScope, *AI);
7867
Steve Naroff090276f2008-10-10 01:28:17 +00007868 PushOnScopeChains(*AI, CurBlock->TheScope);
John McCall053f4bd2010-03-22 09:20:08 +00007869 }
John McCall7a9813c2010-01-22 00:28:27 +00007870 }
Steve Naroff4eb206b2008-09-03 18:15:37 +00007871}
7872
7873/// ActOnBlockError - If there is an error parsing a block, this callback
7874/// is invoked to pop the information about the block from the action impl.
7875void Sema::ActOnBlockError(SourceLocation CaretLoc, Scope *CurScope) {
Steve Naroff4eb206b2008-09-03 18:15:37 +00007876 // Pop off CurBlock, handle nested blocks.
Chris Lattner5c59e2b2009-04-21 22:38:46 +00007877 PopDeclContext();
Douglas Gregor9ea9bdb2010-03-01 23:15:13 +00007878 PopFunctionOrBlockScope();
Steve Naroff4eb206b2008-09-03 18:15:37 +00007879}
7880
7881/// ActOnBlockStmtExpr - This is called when the body of a block statement
7882/// literal was successfully completed. ^(int x){...}
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00007883ExprResult Sema::ActOnBlockStmtExpr(SourceLocation CaretLoc,
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00007884 Stmt *Body, Scope *CurScope) {
Chris Lattner9af55002009-03-27 04:18:06 +00007885 // If blocks are disabled, emit an error.
7886 if (!LangOpts.Blocks)
7887 Diag(CaretLoc, diag::err_blocks_disable);
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007888
Douglas Gregor9ea9bdb2010-03-01 23:15:13 +00007889 BlockScopeInfo *BSI = cast<BlockScopeInfo>(FunctionScopes.back());
Fariborz Jahaniana729da22010-07-09 18:44:02 +00007890
Steve Naroff090276f2008-10-10 01:28:17 +00007891 PopDeclContext();
7892
Steve Naroff4eb206b2008-09-03 18:15:37 +00007893 QualType RetTy = Context.VoidTy;
Fariborz Jahanian7d5c74e2009-06-19 23:37:08 +00007894 if (!BSI->ReturnType.isNull())
7895 RetTy = BSI->ReturnType;
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00007896
Mike Stump56925862009-07-28 22:04:01 +00007897 bool NoReturn = BSI->TheDecl->getAttr<NoReturnAttr>();
Steve Naroff4eb206b2008-09-03 18:15:37 +00007898 QualType BlockTy;
John McCallc71a4912010-06-04 19:02:56 +00007899
7900 // If the user wrote a function type in some form, try to use that.
7901 if (!BSI->FunctionType.isNull()) {
7902 const FunctionType *FTy = BSI->FunctionType->getAs<FunctionType>();
7903
7904 FunctionType::ExtInfo Ext = FTy->getExtInfo();
7905 if (NoReturn && !Ext.getNoReturn()) Ext = Ext.withNoReturn(true);
7906
7907 // Turn protoless block types into nullary block types.
7908 if (isa<FunctionNoProtoType>(FTy)) {
7909 BlockTy = Context.getFunctionType(RetTy, 0, 0, false, 0,
7910 false, false, 0, 0, Ext);
7911
7912 // Otherwise, if we don't need to change anything about the function type,
7913 // preserve its sugar structure.
7914 } else if (FTy->getResultType() == RetTy &&
7915 (!NoReturn || FTy->getNoReturnAttr())) {
7916 BlockTy = BSI->FunctionType;
7917
7918 // Otherwise, make the minimal modifications to the function type.
7919 } else {
7920 const FunctionProtoType *FPT = cast<FunctionProtoType>(FTy);
7921 BlockTy = Context.getFunctionType(RetTy,
7922 FPT->arg_type_begin(),
7923 FPT->getNumArgs(),
7924 FPT->isVariadic(),
7925 /*quals*/ 0,
7926 FPT->hasExceptionSpec(),
7927 FPT->hasAnyExceptionSpec(),
7928 FPT->getNumExceptions(),
7929 FPT->exception_begin(),
7930 Ext);
7931 }
7932
7933 // If we don't have a function type, just build one from nothing.
7934 } else {
7935 BlockTy = Context.getFunctionType(RetTy, 0, 0, false, 0,
7936 false, false, 0, 0,
7937 FunctionType::ExtInfo(NoReturn, 0, CC_Default));
7938 }
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00007939
John McCallc71a4912010-06-04 19:02:56 +00007940 DiagnoseUnusedParameters(BSI->TheDecl->param_begin(),
7941 BSI->TheDecl->param_end());
Steve Naroff4eb206b2008-09-03 18:15:37 +00007942 BlockTy = Context.getBlockPointerType(BlockTy);
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00007943
Chris Lattner17a78302009-04-19 05:28:12 +00007944 // If needed, diagnose invalid gotos and switches in the block.
John McCall781472f2010-08-25 08:40:02 +00007945 if (getCurFunction()->NeedsScopeChecking() && !hasAnyErrorsInThisFunction())
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00007946 DiagnoseInvalidJumps(cast<CompoundStmt>(Body));
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007947
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00007948 BSI->TheDecl->setBody(cast<CompoundStmt>(Body));
Mike Stumpa3899eb2010-01-19 23:08:01 +00007949
7950 bool Good = true;
7951 // Check goto/label use.
7952 for (llvm::DenseMap<IdentifierInfo*, LabelStmt*>::iterator
7953 I = BSI->LabelMap.begin(), E = BSI->LabelMap.end(); I != E; ++I) {
7954 LabelStmt *L = I->second;
7955
7956 // Verify that we have no forward references left. If so, there was a goto
7957 // or address of a label taken, but no definition of it.
Argyrios Kyrtzidis355a9fe2010-09-19 21:21:25 +00007958 if (L->getSubStmt() != 0) {
7959 if (!L->isUsed())
7960 Diag(L->getIdentLoc(), diag::warn_unused_label) << L->getName();
Mike Stumpa3899eb2010-01-19 23:08:01 +00007961 continue;
Argyrios Kyrtzidis355a9fe2010-09-19 21:21:25 +00007962 }
Mike Stumpa3899eb2010-01-19 23:08:01 +00007963
7964 // Emit error.
7965 Diag(L->getIdentLoc(), diag::err_undeclared_label_use) << L->getName();
7966 Good = false;
7967 }
Douglas Gregor9ea9bdb2010-03-01 23:15:13 +00007968 if (!Good) {
7969 PopFunctionOrBlockScope();
Mike Stumpa3899eb2010-01-19 23:08:01 +00007970 return ExprError();
Douglas Gregor9ea9bdb2010-03-01 23:15:13 +00007971 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007972
John McCalle0054f62010-08-25 05:56:39 +00007973 BlockExpr *Result = new (Context) BlockExpr(BSI->TheDecl, BlockTy,
7974 BSI->hasBlockDeclRefExprs);
7975
Ted Kremenekdbdbaaf2010-03-20 21:06:02 +00007976 // Issue any analysis-based warnings.
Ted Kremenekd064fdc2010-03-23 00:13:23 +00007977 const sema::AnalysisBasedWarnings::Policy &WP =
7978 AnalysisWarnings.getDefaultPolicy();
John McCalle0054f62010-08-25 05:56:39 +00007979 AnalysisWarnings.IssueWarnings(WP, Result);
Ted Kremenekdbdbaaf2010-03-20 21:06:02 +00007980
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00007981 PopFunctionOrBlockScope();
Douglas Gregor9ea9bdb2010-03-01 23:15:13 +00007982 return Owned(Result);
Steve Naroff4eb206b2008-09-03 18:15:37 +00007983}
7984
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00007985ExprResult Sema::ActOnVAArg(SourceLocation BuiltinLoc,
John McCallb3d87482010-08-24 05:47:05 +00007986 Expr *expr, ParsedType type,
Sebastian Redlf53597f2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00007987 SourceLocation RPLoc) {
Abramo Bagnara2cad9002010-08-10 10:06:15 +00007988 TypeSourceInfo *TInfo;
7989 QualType T = GetTypeFromParser(type, &TInfo);
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00007990 return BuildVAArgExpr(BuiltinLoc, expr, TInfo, RPLoc);
Abramo Bagnara2cad9002010-08-10 10:06:15 +00007991}
7992
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00007993ExprResult Sema::BuildVAArgExpr(SourceLocation BuiltinLoc,
John McCall9ae2f072010-08-23 23:25:46 +00007994 Expr *E, TypeSourceInfo *TInfo,
Abramo Bagnara2cad9002010-08-10 10:06:15 +00007995 SourceLocation RPLoc) {
Chris Lattner0d20b8a2009-04-05 15:49:53 +00007996 Expr *OrigExpr = E;
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00007997
Eli Friedmanc34bcde2008-08-09 23:32:40 +00007998 // Get the va_list type
7999 QualType VaListType = Context.getBuiltinVaListType();
Eli Friedman5c091ba2009-05-16 12:46:54 +00008000 if (VaListType->isArrayType()) {
8001 // Deal with implicit array decay; for example, on x86-64,
8002 // va_list is an array, but it's supposed to decay to
8003 // a pointer for va_arg.
Eli Friedmanc34bcde2008-08-09 23:32:40 +00008004 VaListType = Context.getArrayDecayedType(VaListType);
Eli Friedman5c091ba2009-05-16 12:46:54 +00008005 // Make sure the input expression also decays appropriately.
8006 UsualUnaryConversions(E);
8007 } else {
8008 // Otherwise, the va_list argument must be an l-value because
8009 // it is modified by va_arg.
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00008010 if (!E->isTypeDependent() &&
Douglas Gregordd027302009-05-19 23:10:31 +00008011 CheckForModifiableLvalue(E, BuiltinLoc, *this))
Eli Friedman5c091ba2009-05-16 12:46:54 +00008012 return ExprError();
8013 }
Eli Friedmanc34bcde2008-08-09 23:32:40 +00008014
Douglas Gregordd027302009-05-19 23:10:31 +00008015 if (!E->isTypeDependent() &&
8016 !Context.hasSameType(VaListType, E->getType())) {
Sebastian Redlf53597f2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00008017 return ExprError(Diag(E->getLocStart(),
8018 diag::err_first_argument_to_va_arg_not_of_type_va_list)
Chris Lattner0d20b8a2009-04-05 15:49:53 +00008019 << OrigExpr->getType() << E->getSourceRange());
Chris Lattner9dc8f192009-04-05 00:59:53 +00008020 }
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00008021
Eli Friedmanb1d796d2009-03-23 00:24:07 +00008022 // FIXME: Check that type is complete/non-abstract
Anders Carlsson7c50aca2007-10-15 20:28:48 +00008023 // FIXME: Warn if a non-POD type is passed in.
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00008024
Abramo Bagnara2cad9002010-08-10 10:06:15 +00008025 QualType T = TInfo->getType().getNonLValueExprType(Context);
8026 return Owned(new (Context) VAArgExpr(BuiltinLoc, E, TInfo, RPLoc, T));
Anders Carlsson7c50aca2007-10-15 20:28:48 +00008027}
8028
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00008029ExprResult Sema::ActOnGNUNullExpr(SourceLocation TokenLoc) {
Douglas Gregor2d8b2732008-11-29 04:51:27 +00008030 // The type of __null will be int or long, depending on the size of
8031 // pointers on the target.
8032 QualType Ty;
8033 if (Context.Target.getPointerWidth(0) == Context.Target.getIntWidth())
8034 Ty = Context.IntTy;
8035 else
8036 Ty = Context.LongTy;
8037
Sebastian Redlf53597f2009-03-15 17:47:39 +00008038 return Owned(new (Context) GNUNullExpr(Ty, TokenLoc));
Douglas Gregor2d8b2732008-11-29 04:51:27 +00008039}
8040
Sean Hunt1e3f5ba2010-04-28 23:02:27 +00008041static void MakeObjCStringLiteralFixItHint(Sema& SemaRef, QualType DstType,
Douglas Gregor849b2432010-03-31 17:46:05 +00008042 Expr *SrcExpr, FixItHint &Hint) {
Anders Carlssonb76cd3d2009-11-10 04:46:30 +00008043 if (!SemaRef.getLangOptions().ObjC1)
8044 return;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00008045
Anders Carlssonb76cd3d2009-11-10 04:46:30 +00008046 const ObjCObjectPointerType *PT = DstType->getAs<ObjCObjectPointerType>();
8047 if (!PT)
8048 return;
8049
8050 // Check if the destination is of type 'id'.
8051 if (!PT->isObjCIdType()) {
8052 // Check if the destination is the 'NSString' interface.
8053 const ObjCInterfaceDecl *ID = PT->getInterfaceDecl();
8054 if (!ID || !ID->getIdentifier()->isStr("NSString"))
8055 return;
8056 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00008057
Anders Carlssonb76cd3d2009-11-10 04:46:30 +00008058 // Strip off any parens and casts.
8059 StringLiteral *SL = dyn_cast<StringLiteral>(SrcExpr->IgnoreParenCasts());
8060 if (!SL || SL->isWide())
8061 return;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00008062
Douglas Gregor849b2432010-03-31 17:46:05 +00008063 Hint = FixItHint::CreateInsertion(SL->getLocStart(), "@");
Anders Carlssonb76cd3d2009-11-10 04:46:30 +00008064}
8065
Chris Lattner5cf216b2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00008066bool Sema::DiagnoseAssignmentResult(AssignConvertType ConvTy,
8067 SourceLocation Loc,
8068 QualType DstType, QualType SrcType,
Douglas Gregora41a8c52010-04-22 00:20:18 +00008069 Expr *SrcExpr, AssignmentAction Action,
8070 bool *Complained) {
8071 if (Complained)
8072 *Complained = false;
8073
Chris Lattner5cf216b2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00008074 // Decode the result (notice that AST's are still created for extensions).
8075 bool isInvalid = false;
8076 unsigned DiagKind;
Douglas Gregor849b2432010-03-31 17:46:05 +00008077 FixItHint Hint;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00008078
Chris Lattner5cf216b2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00008079 switch (ConvTy) {
8080 default: assert(0 && "Unknown conversion type");
8081 case Compatible: return false;
Chris Lattnerb7b61152008-01-04 18:22:42 +00008082 case PointerToInt:
Chris Lattner5cf216b2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00008083 DiagKind = diag::ext_typecheck_convert_pointer_int;
8084 break;
Chris Lattnerb7b61152008-01-04 18:22:42 +00008085 case IntToPointer:
8086 DiagKind = diag::ext_typecheck_convert_int_pointer;
8087 break;
Chris Lattner5cf216b2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00008088 case IncompatiblePointer:
Douglas Gregor849b2432010-03-31 17:46:05 +00008089 MakeObjCStringLiteralFixItHint(*this, DstType, SrcExpr, Hint);
Chris Lattner5cf216b2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00008090 DiagKind = diag::ext_typecheck_convert_incompatible_pointer;
8091 break;
Eli Friedmanf05c05d2009-03-22 23:59:44 +00008092 case IncompatiblePointerSign:
8093 DiagKind = diag::ext_typecheck_convert_incompatible_pointer_sign;
8094 break;
Chris Lattner5cf216b2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00008095 case FunctionVoidPointer:
8096 DiagKind = diag::ext_typecheck_convert_pointer_void_func;
8097 break;
8098 case CompatiblePointerDiscardsQualifiers:
Douglas Gregor77a52232008-09-12 00:47:35 +00008099 // If the qualifiers lost were because we were applying the
8100 // (deprecated) C++ conversion from a string literal to a char*
8101 // (or wchar_t*), then there was no error (C++ 4.2p2). FIXME:
8102 // Ideally, this check would be performed in
8103 // CheckPointerTypesForAssignment. However, that would require a
8104 // bit of refactoring (so that the second argument is an
8105 // expression, rather than a type), which should be done as part
8106 // of a larger effort to fix CheckPointerTypesForAssignment for
8107 // C++ semantics.
8108 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus &&
8109 IsStringLiteralToNonConstPointerConversion(SrcExpr, DstType))
8110 return false;
Chris Lattner5cf216b2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00008111 DiagKind = diag::ext_typecheck_convert_discards_qualifiers;
8112 break;
Sean Huntc9132b62009-11-08 07:46:34 +00008113 case IncompatibleNestedPointerQualifiers:
Fariborz Jahanian3451e922009-11-09 22:16:37 +00008114 DiagKind = diag::ext_nested_pointer_qualifier_mismatch;
Fariborz Jahanian36a862f2009-11-07 20:20:40 +00008115 break;
Steve Naroff1c7d0672008-09-04 15:10:53 +00008116 case IntToBlockPointer:
8117 DiagKind = diag::err_int_to_block_pointer;
8118 break;
8119 case IncompatibleBlockPointer:
Mike Stump25efa102009-04-21 22:51:42 +00008120 DiagKind = diag::err_typecheck_convert_incompatible_block_pointer;
Steve Naroff1c7d0672008-09-04 15:10:53 +00008121 break;
Steve Naroff39579072008-10-14 22:18:38 +00008122 case IncompatibleObjCQualifiedId:
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00008123 // FIXME: Diagnose the problem in ObjCQualifiedIdTypesAreCompatible, since
Steve Naroff39579072008-10-14 22:18:38 +00008124 // it can give a more specific diagnostic.
8125 DiagKind = diag::warn_incompatible_qualified_id;
8126 break;
Anders Carlssonb0f90cc2009-01-30 23:17:46 +00008127 case IncompatibleVectors:
8128 DiagKind = diag::warn_incompatible_vectors;
8129 break;
Chris Lattner5cf216b2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00008130 case Incompatible:
8131 DiagKind = diag::err_typecheck_convert_incompatible;
8132 isInvalid = true;
8133 break;
8134 }
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00008135
Douglas Gregord4eea832010-04-09 00:35:39 +00008136 QualType FirstType, SecondType;
8137 switch (Action) {
8138 case AA_Assigning:
8139 case AA_Initializing:
8140 // The destination type comes first.
8141 FirstType = DstType;
8142 SecondType = SrcType;
8143 break;
Sean Hunt1e3f5ba2010-04-28 23:02:27 +00008144
Douglas Gregord4eea832010-04-09 00:35:39 +00008145 case AA_Returning:
8146 case AA_Passing:
8147 case AA_Converting:
8148 case AA_Sending:
8149 case AA_Casting:
8150 // The source type comes first.
8151 FirstType = SrcType;
8152 SecondType = DstType;
8153 break;
8154 }
Sean Hunt1e3f5ba2010-04-28 23:02:27 +00008155
Douglas Gregord4eea832010-04-09 00:35:39 +00008156 Diag(Loc, DiagKind) << FirstType << SecondType << Action
Anders Carlssonb76cd3d2009-11-10 04:46:30 +00008157 << SrcExpr->getSourceRange() << Hint;
Douglas Gregora41a8c52010-04-22 00:20:18 +00008158 if (Complained)
8159 *Complained = true;
Chris Lattner5cf216b2008-01-04 18:04:52 +00008160 return isInvalid;
8161}
Anders Carlssone21555e2008-11-30 19:50:32 +00008162
Chris Lattner3bf68932009-04-25 21:59:05 +00008163bool Sema::VerifyIntegerConstantExpression(const Expr *E, llvm::APSInt *Result){
Eli Friedman3b5ccca2009-04-25 22:26:58 +00008164 llvm::APSInt ICEResult;
8165 if (E->isIntegerConstantExpr(ICEResult, Context)) {
8166 if (Result)
8167 *Result = ICEResult;
8168 return false;
8169 }
8170
Anders Carlssone21555e2008-11-30 19:50:32 +00008171 Expr::EvalResult EvalResult;
8172
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00008173 if (!E->Evaluate(EvalResult, Context) || !EvalResult.Val.isInt() ||
Anders Carlssone21555e2008-11-30 19:50:32 +00008174 EvalResult.HasSideEffects) {
8175 Diag(E->getExprLoc(), diag::err_expr_not_ice) << E->getSourceRange();
8176
8177 if (EvalResult.Diag) {
8178 // We only show the note if it's not the usual "invalid subexpression"
8179 // or if it's actually in a subexpression.
8180 if (EvalResult.Diag != diag::note_invalid_subexpr_in_ice ||
8181 E->IgnoreParens() != EvalResult.DiagExpr->IgnoreParens())
8182 Diag(EvalResult.DiagLoc, EvalResult.Diag);
8183 }
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00008184
Anders Carlssone21555e2008-11-30 19:50:32 +00008185 return true;
8186 }
8187
Eli Friedman3b5ccca2009-04-25 22:26:58 +00008188 Diag(E->getExprLoc(), diag::ext_expr_not_ice) <<
8189 E->getSourceRange();
Anders Carlssone21555e2008-11-30 19:50:32 +00008190
Eli Friedman3b5ccca2009-04-25 22:26:58 +00008191 if (EvalResult.Diag &&
8192 Diags.getDiagnosticLevel(diag::ext_expr_not_ice) != Diagnostic::Ignored)
8193 Diag(EvalResult.DiagLoc, EvalResult.Diag);
Mike Stumpeed9cac2009-02-19 03:04:26 +00008194
Anders Carlssone21555e2008-11-30 19:50:32 +00008195 if (Result)
8196 *Result = EvalResult.Val.getInt();
8197 return false;
8198}
Douglas Gregore0762c92009-06-19 23:52:42 +00008199
Douglas Gregor2afce722009-11-26 00:44:06 +00008200void
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00008201Sema::PushExpressionEvaluationContext(ExpressionEvaluationContext NewContext) {
Douglas Gregor2afce722009-11-26 00:44:06 +00008202 ExprEvalContexts.push_back(
8203 ExpressionEvaluationContextRecord(NewContext, ExprTemporaries.size()));
Douglas Gregorac7610d2009-06-22 20:57:11 +00008204}
8205
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00008206void
Douglas Gregor2afce722009-11-26 00:44:06 +00008207Sema::PopExpressionEvaluationContext() {
8208 // Pop the current expression evaluation context off the stack.
8209 ExpressionEvaluationContextRecord Rec = ExprEvalContexts.back();
8210 ExprEvalContexts.pop_back();
Douglas Gregorac7610d2009-06-22 20:57:11 +00008211
Douglas Gregor06d33692009-12-12 07:57:52 +00008212 if (Rec.Context == PotentiallyPotentiallyEvaluated) {
8213 if (Rec.PotentiallyReferenced) {
8214 // Mark any remaining declarations in the current position of the stack
8215 // as "referenced". If they were not meant to be referenced, semantic
8216 // analysis would have eliminated them (e.g., in ActOnCXXTypeId).
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00008217 for (PotentiallyReferencedDecls::iterator
Douglas Gregor06d33692009-12-12 07:57:52 +00008218 I = Rec.PotentiallyReferenced->begin(),
8219 IEnd = Rec.PotentiallyReferenced->end();
8220 I != IEnd; ++I)
8221 MarkDeclarationReferenced(I->first, I->second);
8222 }
8223
8224 if (Rec.PotentiallyDiagnosed) {
8225 // Emit any pending diagnostics.
8226 for (PotentiallyEmittedDiagnostics::iterator
8227 I = Rec.PotentiallyDiagnosed->begin(),
8228 IEnd = Rec.PotentiallyDiagnosed->end();
8229 I != IEnd; ++I)
8230 Diag(I->first, I->second);
8231 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00008232 }
Douglas Gregor2afce722009-11-26 00:44:06 +00008233
8234 // When are coming out of an unevaluated context, clear out any
8235 // temporaries that we may have created as part of the evaluation of
8236 // the expression in that context: they aren't relevant because they
8237 // will never be constructed.
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00008238 if (Rec.Context == Unevaluated &&
Douglas Gregor2afce722009-11-26 00:44:06 +00008239 ExprTemporaries.size() > Rec.NumTemporaries)
8240 ExprTemporaries.erase(ExprTemporaries.begin() + Rec.NumTemporaries,
8241 ExprTemporaries.end());
8242
8243 // Destroy the popped expression evaluation record.
8244 Rec.Destroy();
Douglas Gregorac7610d2009-06-22 20:57:11 +00008245}
Douglas Gregore0762c92009-06-19 23:52:42 +00008246
8247/// \brief Note that the given declaration was referenced in the source code.
8248///
8249/// This routine should be invoke whenever a given declaration is referenced
8250/// in the source code, and where that reference occurred. If this declaration
8251/// reference means that the the declaration is used (C++ [basic.def.odr]p2,
8252/// C99 6.9p3), then the declaration will be marked as used.
8253///
8254/// \param Loc the location where the declaration was referenced.
8255///
8256/// \param D the declaration that has been referenced by the source code.
8257void Sema::MarkDeclarationReferenced(SourceLocation Loc, Decl *D) {
8258 assert(D && "No declaration?");
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00008259
Douglas Gregorc070cc62010-06-17 23:14:26 +00008260 if (D->isUsed(false))
Douglas Gregord7f37bf2009-06-22 23:06:13 +00008261 return;
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00008262
Douglas Gregorb5352cf2009-10-08 21:35:42 +00008263 // Mark a parameter or variable declaration "used", regardless of whether we're in a
8264 // template or not. The reason for this is that unevaluated expressions
8265 // (e.g. (void)sizeof()) constitute a use for warning purposes (-Wunused-variables and
8266 // -Wunused-parameters)
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00008267 if (isa<ParmVarDecl>(D) ||
Douglas Gregorfc2ca562010-04-07 20:29:57 +00008268 (isa<VarDecl>(D) && D->getDeclContext()->isFunctionOrMethod())) {
Anders Carlsson2127ecc2010-10-22 23:37:08 +00008269 D->setUsed();
Douglas Gregorfc2ca562010-04-07 20:29:57 +00008270 return;
8271 }
Sean Hunt1e3f5ba2010-04-28 23:02:27 +00008272
Douglas Gregorfc2ca562010-04-07 20:29:57 +00008273 if (!isa<VarDecl>(D) && !isa<FunctionDecl>(D))
8274 return;
Sean Hunt1e3f5ba2010-04-28 23:02:27 +00008275
Douglas Gregore0762c92009-06-19 23:52:42 +00008276 // Do not mark anything as "used" within a dependent context; wait for
8277 // an instantiation.
8278 if (CurContext->isDependentContext())
8279 return;
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00008280
Douglas Gregor2afce722009-11-26 00:44:06 +00008281 switch (ExprEvalContexts.back().Context) {
Douglas Gregorac7610d2009-06-22 20:57:11 +00008282 case Unevaluated:
8283 // We are in an expression that is not potentially evaluated; do nothing.
8284 return;
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00008285
Douglas Gregorac7610d2009-06-22 20:57:11 +00008286 case PotentiallyEvaluated:
8287 // We are in a potentially-evaluated expression, so this declaration is
8288 // "used"; handle this below.
8289 break;
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00008290
Douglas Gregorac7610d2009-06-22 20:57:11 +00008291 case PotentiallyPotentiallyEvaluated:
8292 // We are in an expression that may be potentially evaluated; queue this
8293 // declaration reference until we know whether the expression is
8294 // potentially evaluated.
Douglas Gregor2afce722009-11-26 00:44:06 +00008295 ExprEvalContexts.back().addReferencedDecl(Loc, D);
Douglas Gregorac7610d2009-06-22 20:57:11 +00008296 return;
Douglas Gregorbe0f7bd2010-09-11 20:24:53 +00008297
8298 case PotentiallyEvaluatedIfUsed:
8299 // Referenced declarations will only be used if the construct in the
8300 // containing expression is used.
8301 return;
Douglas Gregorac7610d2009-06-22 20:57:11 +00008302 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00008303
Douglas Gregore0762c92009-06-19 23:52:42 +00008304 // Note that this declaration has been used.
Fariborz Jahanianb7f4cc02009-06-22 17:30:33 +00008305 if (CXXConstructorDecl *Constructor = dyn_cast<CXXConstructorDecl>(D)) {
Fariborz Jahanian485f0872009-06-22 23:34:40 +00008306 unsigned TypeQuals;
Fariborz Jahanian05a5c452009-06-22 20:37:23 +00008307 if (Constructor->isImplicit() && Constructor->isDefaultConstructor()) {
Chandler Carruth4e6fbce2010-08-23 07:55:51 +00008308 if (Constructor->getParent()->hasTrivialConstructor())
8309 return;
8310 if (!Constructor->isUsed(false))
8311 DefineImplicitDefaultConstructor(Loc, Constructor);
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00008312 } else if (Constructor->isImplicit() &&
Douglas Gregor9e9199d2009-12-22 00:34:07 +00008313 Constructor->isCopyConstructor(TypeQuals)) {
Douglas Gregorc070cc62010-06-17 23:14:26 +00008314 if (!Constructor->isUsed(false))
Fariborz Jahanian485f0872009-06-22 23:34:40 +00008315 DefineImplicitCopyConstructor(Loc, Constructor, TypeQuals);
8316 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00008317
Douglas Gregor6fb745b2010-05-13 16:44:06 +00008318 MarkVTableUsed(Loc, Constructor->getParent());
Fariborz Jahanian8d2b3562009-06-26 23:49:16 +00008319 } else if (CXXDestructorDecl *Destructor = dyn_cast<CXXDestructorDecl>(D)) {
Douglas Gregorc070cc62010-06-17 23:14:26 +00008320 if (Destructor->isImplicit() && !Destructor->isUsed(false))
Fariborz Jahanian8d2b3562009-06-26 23:49:16 +00008321 DefineImplicitDestructor(Loc, Destructor);
Douglas Gregor6fb745b2010-05-13 16:44:06 +00008322 if (Destructor->isVirtual())
8323 MarkVTableUsed(Loc, Destructor->getParent());
Fariborz Jahanianc75bc2d2009-06-25 21:45:19 +00008324 } else if (CXXMethodDecl *MethodDecl = dyn_cast<CXXMethodDecl>(D)) {
8325 if (MethodDecl->isImplicit() && MethodDecl->isOverloadedOperator() &&
8326 MethodDecl->getOverloadedOperator() == OO_Equal) {
Douglas Gregorc070cc62010-06-17 23:14:26 +00008327 if (!MethodDecl->isUsed(false))
Douglas Gregor39957dc2010-05-01 15:04:51 +00008328 DefineImplicitCopyAssignment(Loc, MethodDecl);
Douglas Gregor6fb745b2010-05-13 16:44:06 +00008329 } else if (MethodDecl->isVirtual())
8330 MarkVTableUsed(Loc, MethodDecl->getParent());
Fariborz Jahanianc75bc2d2009-06-25 21:45:19 +00008331 }
Fariborz Jahanianf5ed9e02009-06-24 22:09:44 +00008332 if (FunctionDecl *Function = dyn_cast<FunctionDecl>(D)) {
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00008333 // Implicit instantiation of function templates and member functions of
Douglas Gregor1637be72009-06-26 00:10:03 +00008334 // class templates.
Douglas Gregor6cfacfe2010-05-17 17:34:56 +00008335 if (Function->isImplicitlyInstantiable()) {
Douglas Gregorb3ae4fc2009-10-12 20:18:28 +00008336 bool AlreadyInstantiated = false;
8337 if (FunctionTemplateSpecializationInfo *SpecInfo
8338 = Function->getTemplateSpecializationInfo()) {
8339 if (SpecInfo->getPointOfInstantiation().isInvalid())
8340 SpecInfo->setPointOfInstantiation(Loc);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00008341 else if (SpecInfo->getTemplateSpecializationKind()
Douglas Gregor3b846b62009-10-27 20:53:28 +00008342 == TSK_ImplicitInstantiation)
Douglas Gregorb3ae4fc2009-10-12 20:18:28 +00008343 AlreadyInstantiated = true;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00008344 } else if (MemberSpecializationInfo *MSInfo
Douglas Gregorb3ae4fc2009-10-12 20:18:28 +00008345 = Function->getMemberSpecializationInfo()) {
8346 if (MSInfo->getPointOfInstantiation().isInvalid())
8347 MSInfo->setPointOfInstantiation(Loc);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00008348 else if (MSInfo->getTemplateSpecializationKind()
Douglas Gregor3b846b62009-10-27 20:53:28 +00008349 == TSK_ImplicitInstantiation)
Douglas Gregorb3ae4fc2009-10-12 20:18:28 +00008350 AlreadyInstantiated = true;
8351 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00008352
Douglas Gregor60406be2010-01-16 22:29:39 +00008353 if (!AlreadyInstantiated) {
8354 if (isa<CXXRecordDecl>(Function->getDeclContext()) &&
8355 cast<CXXRecordDecl>(Function->getDeclContext())->isLocalClass())
8356 PendingLocalImplicitInstantiations.push_back(std::make_pair(Function,
8357 Loc));
8358 else
Chandler Carruth62c78d52010-08-25 08:44:16 +00008359 PendingInstantiations.push_back(std::make_pair(Function, Loc));
Douglas Gregor60406be2010-01-16 22:29:39 +00008360 }
Gabor Greif40181c42010-08-28 00:16:06 +00008361 } else // Walk redefinitions, as some of them may be instantiable.
8362 for (FunctionDecl::redecl_iterator i(Function->redecls_begin()),
8363 e(Function->redecls_end()); i != e; ++i) {
Gabor Greifbe9ebe32010-08-28 01:58:12 +00008364 if (!i->isUsed(false) && i->isImplicitlyInstantiable())
Gabor Greif40181c42010-08-28 00:16:06 +00008365 MarkDeclarationReferenced(Loc, *i);
8366 }
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00008367
Douglas Gregore0762c92009-06-19 23:52:42 +00008368 // FIXME: keep track of references to static functions
Argyrios Kyrtzidis58b52592010-08-25 10:34:54 +00008369
8370 // Recursive functions should be marked when used from another function.
8371 if (CurContext != Function)
8372 Function->setUsed(true);
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00008373
Douglas Gregore0762c92009-06-19 23:52:42 +00008374 return;
Douglas Gregord7f37bf2009-06-22 23:06:13 +00008375 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00008376
Douglas Gregore0762c92009-06-19 23:52:42 +00008377 if (VarDecl *Var = dyn_cast<VarDecl>(D)) {
Douglas Gregor7caa6822009-07-24 20:34:43 +00008378 // Implicit instantiation of static data members of class templates.
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00008379 if (Var->isStaticDataMember() &&
Douglas Gregorb3ae4fc2009-10-12 20:18:28 +00008380 Var->getInstantiatedFromStaticDataMember()) {
8381 MemberSpecializationInfo *MSInfo = Var->getMemberSpecializationInfo();
8382 assert(MSInfo && "Missing member specialization information?");
8383 if (MSInfo->getPointOfInstantiation().isInvalid() &&
8384 MSInfo->getTemplateSpecializationKind()== TSK_ImplicitInstantiation) {
8385 MSInfo->setPointOfInstantiation(Loc);
Chandler Carruth62c78d52010-08-25 08:44:16 +00008386 PendingInstantiations.push_back(std::make_pair(Var, Loc));
Douglas Gregorb3ae4fc2009-10-12 20:18:28 +00008387 }
8388 }
Mike Stump1eb44332009-09-09 15:08:12 +00008389
Douglas Gregore0762c92009-06-19 23:52:42 +00008390 // FIXME: keep track of references to static data?
Douglas Gregor7caa6822009-07-24 20:34:43 +00008391
Douglas Gregore0762c92009-06-19 23:52:42 +00008392 D->setUsed(true);
Douglas Gregor7caa6822009-07-24 20:34:43 +00008393 return;
Sam Weinigcce6ebc2009-09-11 03:29:30 +00008394 }
Douglas Gregore0762c92009-06-19 23:52:42 +00008395}
Anders Carlsson8c8d9192009-10-09 23:51:55 +00008396
Douglas Gregorb4eeaff2010-05-07 23:12:07 +00008397namespace {
Chandler Carruthdfc35e32010-06-09 08:17:30 +00008398 // Mark all of the declarations referenced
Douglas Gregorb4eeaff2010-05-07 23:12:07 +00008399 // FIXME: Not fully implemented yet! We need to have a better understanding
Chandler Carruthdfc35e32010-06-09 08:17:30 +00008400 // of when we're entering
Douglas Gregorb4eeaff2010-05-07 23:12:07 +00008401 class MarkReferencedDecls : public RecursiveASTVisitor<MarkReferencedDecls> {
8402 Sema &S;
8403 SourceLocation Loc;
Chandler Carruthdfc35e32010-06-09 08:17:30 +00008404
Douglas Gregorb4eeaff2010-05-07 23:12:07 +00008405 public:
8406 typedef RecursiveASTVisitor<MarkReferencedDecls> Inherited;
Chandler Carruthdfc35e32010-06-09 08:17:30 +00008407
Douglas Gregorb4eeaff2010-05-07 23:12:07 +00008408 MarkReferencedDecls(Sema &S, SourceLocation Loc) : S(S), Loc(Loc) { }
Chandler Carruthdfc35e32010-06-09 08:17:30 +00008409
8410 bool TraverseTemplateArgument(const TemplateArgument &Arg);
8411 bool TraverseRecordType(RecordType *T);
Douglas Gregorb4eeaff2010-05-07 23:12:07 +00008412 };
8413}
8414
Chandler Carruthdfc35e32010-06-09 08:17:30 +00008415bool MarkReferencedDecls::TraverseTemplateArgument(
8416 const TemplateArgument &Arg) {
Douglas Gregorb4eeaff2010-05-07 23:12:07 +00008417 if (Arg.getKind() == TemplateArgument::Declaration) {
8418 S.MarkDeclarationReferenced(Loc, Arg.getAsDecl());
8419 }
Chandler Carruthdfc35e32010-06-09 08:17:30 +00008420
8421 return Inherited::TraverseTemplateArgument(Arg);
Douglas Gregorb4eeaff2010-05-07 23:12:07 +00008422}
8423
Chandler Carruthdfc35e32010-06-09 08:17:30 +00008424bool MarkReferencedDecls::TraverseRecordType(RecordType *T) {
Douglas Gregorb4eeaff2010-05-07 23:12:07 +00008425 if (ClassTemplateSpecializationDecl *Spec
8426 = dyn_cast<ClassTemplateSpecializationDecl>(T->getDecl())) {
8427 const TemplateArgumentList &Args = Spec->getTemplateArgs();
Douglas Gregor910f8002010-11-07 23:05:16 +00008428 return TraverseTemplateArguments(Args.data(), Args.size());
Douglas Gregorb4eeaff2010-05-07 23:12:07 +00008429 }
8430
Chandler Carruthe3e210c2010-06-10 10:31:57 +00008431 return true;
Douglas Gregorb4eeaff2010-05-07 23:12:07 +00008432}
8433
8434void Sema::MarkDeclarationsReferencedInType(SourceLocation Loc, QualType T) {
8435 MarkReferencedDecls Marker(*this, Loc);
Chandler Carruthdfc35e32010-06-09 08:17:30 +00008436 Marker.TraverseType(Context.getCanonicalType(T));
Douglas Gregorb4eeaff2010-05-07 23:12:07 +00008437}
8438
Douglas Gregorbe0f7bd2010-09-11 20:24:53 +00008439namespace {
8440 /// \brief Helper class that marks all of the declarations referenced by
8441 /// potentially-evaluated subexpressions as "referenced".
8442 class EvaluatedExprMarker : public EvaluatedExprVisitor<EvaluatedExprMarker> {
8443 Sema &S;
8444
8445 public:
8446 typedef EvaluatedExprVisitor<EvaluatedExprMarker> Inherited;
8447
8448 explicit EvaluatedExprMarker(Sema &S) : Inherited(S.Context), S(S) { }
8449
8450 void VisitDeclRefExpr(DeclRefExpr *E) {
8451 S.MarkDeclarationReferenced(E->getLocation(), E->getDecl());
8452 }
8453
8454 void VisitMemberExpr(MemberExpr *E) {
8455 S.MarkDeclarationReferenced(E->getMemberLoc(), E->getMemberDecl());
Douglas Gregor4fcf5b22010-09-11 23:32:50 +00008456 Inherited::VisitMemberExpr(E);
Douglas Gregorbe0f7bd2010-09-11 20:24:53 +00008457 }
8458
8459 void VisitCXXNewExpr(CXXNewExpr *E) {
8460 if (E->getConstructor())
8461 S.MarkDeclarationReferenced(E->getLocStart(), E->getConstructor());
8462 if (E->getOperatorNew())
8463 S.MarkDeclarationReferenced(E->getLocStart(), E->getOperatorNew());
8464 if (E->getOperatorDelete())
8465 S.MarkDeclarationReferenced(E->getLocStart(), E->getOperatorDelete());
Douglas Gregor4fcf5b22010-09-11 23:32:50 +00008466 Inherited::VisitCXXNewExpr(E);
Douglas Gregorbe0f7bd2010-09-11 20:24:53 +00008467 }
8468
8469 void VisitCXXDeleteExpr(CXXDeleteExpr *E) {
8470 if (E->getOperatorDelete())
8471 S.MarkDeclarationReferenced(E->getLocStart(), E->getOperatorDelete());
Douglas Gregor5833b0b2010-09-14 22:55:20 +00008472 QualType Destroyed = S.Context.getBaseElementType(E->getDestroyedType());
8473 if (const RecordType *DestroyedRec = Destroyed->getAs<RecordType>()) {
8474 CXXRecordDecl *Record = cast<CXXRecordDecl>(DestroyedRec->getDecl());
8475 S.MarkDeclarationReferenced(E->getLocStart(),
8476 S.LookupDestructor(Record));
8477 }
8478
Douglas Gregor4fcf5b22010-09-11 23:32:50 +00008479 Inherited::VisitCXXDeleteExpr(E);
Douglas Gregorbe0f7bd2010-09-11 20:24:53 +00008480 }
8481
8482 void VisitCXXConstructExpr(CXXConstructExpr *E) {
8483 S.MarkDeclarationReferenced(E->getLocStart(), E->getConstructor());
Douglas Gregor4fcf5b22010-09-11 23:32:50 +00008484 Inherited::VisitCXXConstructExpr(E);
Douglas Gregorbe0f7bd2010-09-11 20:24:53 +00008485 }
8486
8487 void VisitBlockDeclRefExpr(BlockDeclRefExpr *E) {
8488 S.MarkDeclarationReferenced(E->getLocation(), E->getDecl());
8489 }
Douglas Gregor102ff972010-10-19 17:17:35 +00008490
8491 void VisitCXXDefaultArgExpr(CXXDefaultArgExpr *E) {
8492 Visit(E->getExpr());
8493 }
Douglas Gregorbe0f7bd2010-09-11 20:24:53 +00008494 };
8495}
8496
8497/// \brief Mark any declarations that appear within this expression or any
8498/// potentially-evaluated subexpressions as "referenced".
8499void Sema::MarkDeclarationsReferencedInExpr(Expr *E) {
8500 EvaluatedExprMarker(*this).Visit(E);
8501}
8502
Douglas Gregor1c7c3fb2009-12-22 01:01:55 +00008503/// \brief Emit a diagnostic that describes an effect on the run-time behavior
8504/// of the program being compiled.
8505///
8506/// This routine emits the given diagnostic when the code currently being
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00008507/// type-checked is "potentially evaluated", meaning that there is a
Douglas Gregor1c7c3fb2009-12-22 01:01:55 +00008508/// possibility that the code will actually be executable. Code in sizeof()
8509/// expressions, code used only during overload resolution, etc., are not
8510/// potentially evaluated. This routine will suppress such diagnostics or,
8511/// in the absolutely nutty case of potentially potentially evaluated
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00008512/// expressions (C++ typeid), queue the diagnostic to potentially emit it
Douglas Gregor1c7c3fb2009-12-22 01:01:55 +00008513/// later.
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00008514///
Douglas Gregor1c7c3fb2009-12-22 01:01:55 +00008515/// This routine should be used for all diagnostics that describe the run-time
8516/// behavior of a program, such as passing a non-POD value through an ellipsis.
8517/// Failure to do so will likely result in spurious diagnostics or failures
8518/// during overload resolution or within sizeof/alignof/typeof/typeid.
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00008519bool Sema::DiagRuntimeBehavior(SourceLocation Loc,
Douglas Gregor1c7c3fb2009-12-22 01:01:55 +00008520 const PartialDiagnostic &PD) {
8521 switch (ExprEvalContexts.back().Context ) {
8522 case Unevaluated:
8523 // The argument will never be evaluated, so don't complain.
8524 break;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00008525
Douglas Gregor1c7c3fb2009-12-22 01:01:55 +00008526 case PotentiallyEvaluated:
Douglas Gregorbe0f7bd2010-09-11 20:24:53 +00008527 case PotentiallyEvaluatedIfUsed:
Douglas Gregor1c7c3fb2009-12-22 01:01:55 +00008528 Diag(Loc, PD);
8529 return true;
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00008530
Douglas Gregor1c7c3fb2009-12-22 01:01:55 +00008531 case PotentiallyPotentiallyEvaluated:
8532 ExprEvalContexts.back().addDiagnostic(Loc, PD);
8533 break;
8534 }
8535
8536 return false;
8537}
8538
Anders Carlsson8c8d9192009-10-09 23:51:55 +00008539bool Sema::CheckCallReturnType(QualType ReturnType, SourceLocation Loc,
8540 CallExpr *CE, FunctionDecl *FD) {
8541 if (ReturnType->isVoidType() || !ReturnType->isIncompleteType())
8542 return false;
8543
8544 PartialDiagnostic Note =
8545 FD ? PDiag(diag::note_function_with_incomplete_return_type_declared_here)
8546 << FD->getDeclName() : PDiag();
8547 SourceLocation NoteLoc = FD ? FD->getLocation() : SourceLocation();
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00008548
Anders Carlsson8c8d9192009-10-09 23:51:55 +00008549 if (RequireCompleteType(Loc, ReturnType,
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00008550 FD ?
Anders Carlsson8c8d9192009-10-09 23:51:55 +00008551 PDiag(diag::err_call_function_incomplete_return)
8552 << CE->getSourceRange() << FD->getDeclName() :
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00008553 PDiag(diag::err_call_incomplete_return)
Anders Carlsson8c8d9192009-10-09 23:51:55 +00008554 << CE->getSourceRange(),
8555 std::make_pair(NoteLoc, Note)))
8556 return true;
8557
8558 return false;
8559}
8560
John McCall5a881bb2009-10-12 21:59:07 +00008561// Diagnose the common s/=/==/ typo. Note that adding parentheses
8562// will prevent this condition from triggering, which is what we want.
8563void Sema::DiagnoseAssignmentAsCondition(Expr *E) {
8564 SourceLocation Loc;
8565
John McCalla52ef082009-11-11 02:41:58 +00008566 unsigned diagnostic = diag::warn_condition_is_assignment;
8567
John McCall5a881bb2009-10-12 21:59:07 +00008568 if (isa<BinaryOperator>(E)) {
8569 BinaryOperator *Op = cast<BinaryOperator>(E);
John McCall2de56d12010-08-25 11:45:40 +00008570 if (Op->getOpcode() != BO_Assign)
John McCall5a881bb2009-10-12 21:59:07 +00008571 return;
8572
John McCallc8d8ac52009-11-12 00:06:05 +00008573 // Greylist some idioms by putting them into a warning subcategory.
8574 if (ObjCMessageExpr *ME
8575 = dyn_cast<ObjCMessageExpr>(Op->getRHS()->IgnoreParenCasts())) {
8576 Selector Sel = ME->getSelector();
8577
John McCallc8d8ac52009-11-12 00:06:05 +00008578 // self = [<foo> init...]
8579 if (isSelfExpr(Op->getLHS())
8580 && Sel.getIdentifierInfoForSlot(0)->getName().startswith("init"))
8581 diagnostic = diag::warn_condition_is_idiomatic_assignment;
8582
8583 // <foo> = [<bar> nextObject]
8584 else if (Sel.isUnarySelector() &&
8585 Sel.getIdentifierInfoForSlot(0)->getName() == "nextObject")
8586 diagnostic = diag::warn_condition_is_idiomatic_assignment;
8587 }
John McCalla52ef082009-11-11 02:41:58 +00008588
John McCall5a881bb2009-10-12 21:59:07 +00008589 Loc = Op->getOperatorLoc();
8590 } else if (isa<CXXOperatorCallExpr>(E)) {
8591 CXXOperatorCallExpr *Op = cast<CXXOperatorCallExpr>(E);
8592 if (Op->getOperator() != OO_Equal)
8593 return;
8594
8595 Loc = Op->getOperatorLoc();
8596 } else {
8597 // Not an assignment.
8598 return;
8599 }
8600
John McCall5a881bb2009-10-12 21:59:07 +00008601 SourceLocation Open = E->getSourceRange().getBegin();
John McCall2d152152009-10-12 22:25:59 +00008602 SourceLocation Close = PP.getLocForEndOfToken(E->getSourceRange().getEnd());
Kovarththanan Rajaratnam19357542010-03-13 10:17:05 +00008603
Douglas Gregor55b38842010-04-14 16:09:52 +00008604 Diag(Loc, diagnostic) << E->getSourceRange();
Douglas Gregor827feec2010-01-08 00:20:23 +00008605 Diag(Loc, diag::note_condition_assign_to_comparison)
Douglas Gregor849b2432010-03-31 17:46:05 +00008606 << FixItHint::CreateReplacement(Loc, "==");
Douglas Gregor55b38842010-04-14 16:09:52 +00008607 Diag(Loc, diag::note_condition_assign_silence)
8608 << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(Open, "(")
8609 << FixItHint::CreateInsertion(Close, ")");
John McCall5a881bb2009-10-12 21:59:07 +00008610}
8611
8612bool Sema::CheckBooleanCondition(Expr *&E, SourceLocation Loc) {
8613 DiagnoseAssignmentAsCondition(E);
8614
8615 if (!E->isTypeDependent()) {
Argyrios Kyrtzidis11ab7902010-11-01 18:49:26 +00008616 if (E->isBoundMemberFunction(Context))
8617 return Diag(E->getLocStart(), diag::err_invalid_use_of_bound_member_func)
8618 << E->getSourceRange();
8619
Douglas Gregora873dfc2010-02-03 00:27:59 +00008620 DefaultFunctionArrayLvalueConversion(E);
John McCall5a881bb2009-10-12 21:59:07 +00008621
8622 QualType T = E->getType();
8623
8624 if (getLangOptions().CPlusPlus) {
8625 if (CheckCXXBooleanCondition(E)) // C++ 6.4p4
8626 return true;
8627 } else if (!T->isScalarType()) { // C99 6.8.4.1p1
8628 Diag(Loc, diag::err_typecheck_statement_requires_scalar)
8629 << T << E->getSourceRange();
8630 return true;
8631 }
8632 }
8633
8634 return false;
8635}
Douglas Gregor586596f2010-05-06 17:25:47 +00008636
John McCall60d7b3a2010-08-24 06:29:42 +00008637ExprResult Sema::ActOnBooleanCondition(Scope *S, SourceLocation Loc,
8638 Expr *Sub) {
Douglas Gregoreecf38f2010-05-06 21:39:56 +00008639 if (!Sub)
Douglas Gregor586596f2010-05-06 17:25:47 +00008640 return ExprError();
8641
Douglas Gregorff331c12010-07-25 18:17:45 +00008642 if (CheckBooleanCondition(Sub, Loc))
Douglas Gregor586596f2010-05-06 17:25:47 +00008643 return ExprError();
Douglas Gregor586596f2010-05-06 17:25:47 +00008644
8645 return Owned(Sub);
8646}
John McCall2a984ca2010-10-12 00:20:44 +00008647
8648/// Check for operands with placeholder types and complain if found.
8649/// Returns true if there was an error and no recovery was possible.
8650ExprResult Sema::CheckPlaceholderExpr(Expr *E, SourceLocation Loc) {
8651 const BuiltinType *BT = E->getType()->getAs<BuiltinType>();
8652 if (!BT || !BT->isPlaceholderType()) return Owned(E);
8653
8654 // If this is overload, check for a single overload.
8655 if (BT->getKind() == BuiltinType::Overload) {
8656 if (FunctionDecl *Specialization
8657 = ResolveSingleFunctionTemplateSpecialization(E)) {
8658 // The access doesn't really matter in this case.
8659 DeclAccessPair Found = DeclAccessPair::make(Specialization,
8660 Specialization->getAccess());
8661 E = FixOverloadedFunctionReference(E, Found, Specialization);
8662 if (!E) return ExprError();
8663 return Owned(E);
8664 }
8665
John McCall2cd11fe2010-10-12 02:09:17 +00008666 Diag(Loc, diag::err_ovl_unresolvable) << E->getSourceRange();
John McCall2a984ca2010-10-12 00:20:44 +00008667 return ExprError();
8668 }
8669
8670 // Otherwise it's a use of undeduced auto.
8671 assert(BT->getKind() == BuiltinType::UndeducedAuto);
8672
8673 DeclRefExpr *DRE = cast<DeclRefExpr>(E->IgnoreParens());
8674 Diag(Loc, diag::err_auto_variable_cannot_appear_in_own_initializer)
8675 << DRE->getDecl() << E->getSourceRange();
8676 return ExprError();
8677}